Advanced Satellite Modem (18 Kbps - 25 MBPS) Installation and Operation Manual
Advanced Satellite Modem (18 Kbps - 25 MBPS) Installation and Operation Manual
Advanced Satellite Modem (18 Kbps - 25 MBPS) Installation and Operation Manual
IMPORTANT NOTE: The information contained in this document supersedes all previously published
information regarding this product. Product specifications are subject to change without prior notice.
OriginalManualPart MNCDM625Rev13
Number/Rev:
ErrataNumber/PLM ERCDM625EA13
DocumentID:
PLMCONumber: C0027959
Comments: PageD45,QDIcommandchangesfollow.
Thisinformationwillbeaddedtothenextformalrevisionofthe
manual.
Example 2:
30412340000000000000000000000000000204123400000000000000000000000000002001000
Port 3s Drop channels 14 using timeslots 14. Same for Insert. E1 clock mode is asynchronous (Read-
only parameter in Port 3 string).
Note: This command is a bit forgiving in the sense that the modem accepts the command even though the
interface type is other than Quad Drop & Insert. This is intentional for use with the CRS-300 switch for 1:N
redundancy.
Copyright 2013 Comtech EF Data. All rights reserved. Printed in the USA.
Comtech EF Data, 2114 West 7th Street, Tempe, Arizona 85281 USA, 480.333.2200, FAX: 480.333.2161
ii
iii
iv
4.2 About Firmware Files, Naming, Versions, and Archive Formats ............................................ 41
vi
vii
viii
ix
7.7 TPC and Low Density Parity Check (LDPC) coding ................................................................. 76
7.7.1 Introduction ............................................................................................................................................... 76
7.7.2 LDPC versus TPC ........................................................................................................................................ 77
7.7.3 End-to-End Processing Delay .................................................................................................................710
xi
xii
xiii
16.4 Ethernet Network Configurations in Router Mode (with IP Packet Processor) ..................... 169
16.4.1 Point-to-Multipoint (Router Multipoint Hub) Mode ..........................................................................169
16.4.1.1 Router Multipoint Hub Configuration..............................................................................................169
16.4.2 Multicast Routing Mode ..................................................................................................................... 1611
16.4.2.1 Multicast Routing Configuration ................................................................................................... 1612
xiv
xv
18.4 List of Supported Internet RFCs (Requests for Comment) ................................................... 188
xvi
20.4 QoS with ACM (Adaptive Coding and Modulation) ........................................................... 2016
20.4.1 Maximum Clipping............................................................................................................................... 2016
20.4.2 Minimum Data Rate ............................................................................................................................ 2016
xvii
xviii
xix
xx
F.4 ODU Operations via the CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface ......................................... F36
F.4.1 Web Server Interface and Menu Tree .................................................................................................. F36
F.4.2 Web Page Descriptions .......................................................................................................................... F38
F.4.2.1 Configuration | BUC (Block Up Converter) Page ............................................................................ F38
F.4.2.2 Configuration | LNB (Low Noise Block Down Converter) .............................................................. F39
F.4.2.3 Status | Modem Logs | Base Modem Page .................................................................................... F40
F.4.2.4 ODU Pages........................................................................................................................................... F42
F.4.2.4.1 ODU | Enable ............................................................................................................ F43
F.4.2.4.2 ODU | Config Pages................................................................................................... F44
F.4.2.4.2.1 ODU | Config (CSAT-5060) ................................................................................. F44
F.4.2.4.2.2 ODU | Config (KST-2000A/B) ............................................................................. F47
F.4.2.4.3 ODU | Status ............................................................................................................. F49
F.4.2.4.3.1 ODU | Status (CSAT-5060) ................................................................................. F49
F.4.2.4.3.2 ODU | Status (KST-2000A/B) .............................................................................. F50
F.4.2.4.4 ODU | Utilities ........................................................................................................... F51
F.4.2.4.4.1 ODU | Utilities (CSAT-5060) ............................................................................... F51
F.4.2.4.4.2 ODU | Utilities (KST-2000A/B) ........................................................................... F53
xxi
F.5 ODU Operations via the CDM-625 Telnet Command Line Interface (CLI) ............................. F54
F.5.1 ODU Operations using the Telnet CLI ................................................................................................... F55
F.5.1.1 Home (Main) Menu ........................................................................................................................... F55
F.5.1.2 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) Submenu .......................................................................................... F56
F.5.1.2.1 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 Submenu ............................................... F57
F.5.1.2.1.1 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 > Up Converter Settings 1/2, 2/2 ... F58
F.5.1.2.1.2 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 > Down Converter Settings 1/2, 2/2 ......
............................................................................................................................ F59
F.5.1.2.1.3 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 > Unit Settings 1/2, 2/2 .................. F60
F.5.1.2.1.4 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 > LNA Settings ................................ F61
F.5.1.2.1.5 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 > Status .......................................... F62
F.5.1.2.1.6 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 > Logs ............................................. F63
F.5.1.2.1.7 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 > Redundancy ................................ F64
F.5.1.2.1.8 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 > Utilities ........................................ F64
TABLES
Table 1-1. CDM-625 Optional Hardware and Accessories ........................................................................ 16
Table 1-2. CDM-625 FAST and FAST-accessible Hardware Options.......................................................... 18
Table 3-1. CDM-625 Rear Panel Cabling Connections .............................................................................. 32
Table 3-2. Data Interface Connector Pinouts........................................................................................... 34
Table 3-3. CIC-60 Module HSSI/EIA-613 Side Connector Pinouts ......................................................... 36
Table 3-4. Balanced G.703 Connector Pinouts......................................................................................... 37
Table 3-5. Auxiliary G.703 Connector Pinouts ......................................................................................... 37
Table 3-6. CA-0000163 Connector Pinouts .............................................................................................. 38
Table 3-7. CA-0000164 Connector Pinouts .............................................................................................. 39
Table 3-8. CA-0000347/CA-0020710 Connector Pinouts....................................................................... 310
Table 3-9. IDR Data/Alarms/Audio Connector Pinouts .......................................................................... 311
Table 3-10. ESC Connector Pinouts ........................................................................................................ 312
Table 3-11. Remote Control Connector Pinouts .................................................................................... 312
Table 3-12. Alarm Interface Connector Pinouts..................................................................................... 313
Table 3-13. PMSI (Pre-Mapped Symbol Interface) Connector Pinouts.................................................. 313
Table 3-14. 1:1 Control Interface Connector Pinouts ............................................................................ 314
Table 7-1. Viterbi Decoding Summary ...................................................................................................... 72
Table 7-2. Sequential Decoding Summary ................................................................................................ 73
Table 7-3. Concatenated RS Coding Summary.......................................................................................... 74
Table 7-4. 8-PSK/TCM Coding Summary ................................................................................................... 75
Table 7-5. Available TPC/ LDPC Modes ..................................................................................................... 78
Table 7-6. Comparison of all Comtech EF Data TPC/LDPC Modes (CDM-625 with TPC/LDPC Codec) ..... 79
Table 7-7. TPC/LDPC Processing Delay Comparison ............................................................................... 710
Table 7-8. TPC/LDPC Summary ............................................................................................................... 710
Table 7-9. The VersaFEC ModCod set ..................................................................................................... 711
Table 10-1. Spectral Efficiency using DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier ....................................................... 107
Table 17-1. The VersaFEC ModCod set ................................................................................................... 177
Table 17-2. VersaFEC Implementation of ACM 100 ksymbols/sec Example Case ............................... 178
Table 20-1. Modem Tx Data Rate vs. QoS Tx Data Rate (Hardware-limited) ......................................... 202
xxii
FIGURES
Figure 1-1. CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem .................................................................................... 11
Figure 1-2. CDM-625 Dimensional Envelope .......................................................................................... 111
Figure 1-3. CDM-625 Front Panel Features ............................................................................................ 112
Figure 1-4. CDM-625 Rear Panel View .................................................................................................... 113
Figure 1-5. Rx Carrier Level vs. Symbol Rate L-Band (950-2000 MHz) ................................................. 120
Figure 1-6. Rx Carrier Level vs. Symbol Rate IF Band (50-180 MHz) .................................................... 120
Figure 2-1. Unpacking and Inspecting the CDM-625 ................................................................................ 21
Figure 2-2. Installing the CDM-625 Into a Rack Enclosure ........................................................................ 23
Figure 2-3. Installing the Optional Rear-Mounting Support Brackets Kit ................................................. 24
Figure 3-1. CDM-625 Rear Panel View ...................................................................................................... 31
Figure 3-2. CIC-60 Interface Adapter Module (CEFD P/N PL-0000307) .................................................... 35
Figure 3-3. CA-0000163 Adapter Cable (DB-9M (2X) DB-15F) ............................................................. 38
Figure 3-4. CA-0000164 Adapter Cable (DB-9M (2X) RJ-48F) .............................................................. 39
Figure 3-5. Quad E1 Balanced/Unbalanced Adapter Cable Kits ............................................................. 310
Figure 3-6. CDM-625 Chassis Ground Interface ...................................................................................... 315
Figure 3-7. CDM-625 Standard AC Chassis (CEFD P/N PL/12587-1) ....................................................... 316
Figure 3-8. Applying AC Power to the CDM-625 ..................................................................................... 317
Figure 3-9. Replacing CDM-625 AC Fuses ............................................................................................... 317
Figure 3-10. CDM-625 Optional DC Chassis (CEFD P/N PL/12587-2) ...................................................... 318
Figure 3-11. Applying Power to the CDM-625 Optional DC Chassis ....................................................... 319
Figure 3-12. Replacing CDM-625 Optional DC Chassis Fuses.................................................................. 320
Figure 5-1. CDM-625 Front Panel Features .............................................................................................. 51
Figure 5-2. CDM-625 Principle Menu Tree (FW Ver. 2.3.1) ...................................................................... 57
Figure 5-3. Loopback Modes ................................................................................................................... 568
Figure 6-1. CDM-625 Telnet Command Line Interface (CLI) ..................................................................... 67
Figure 6-2. CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface Menu Tree (FW Ver. 2.3.1) .................................... 611
Figure 6-3. CDM-625 Satellite Modem Home page ................................................................................ 613
Figure 6-4. Home | Contact page............................................................................................................ 614
Figure 6-5. Home | Support page ........................................................................................................... 615
Figure 6-6. Admin | Access page ............................................................................................................ 616
Figure 6-7. Admin | SNMP page ............................................................................................................. 618
Figure 6-8. Admin | Firmware | Base Modem page ............................................................................... 619
Figure 6-9. Admin | Firmware | Packet Processor page......................................................................... 620
Figure 6-10. Status | Firmware Info | Reboot page................................................................................ 621
Figure 6-11. Admin | FAST page ............................................................................................................. 622
Figure 6-12. Admin | Utilities page ......................................................................................................... 623
Figure 6-13. Configuration | Modem page ............................................................................................. 624
Figure 6-14. Configuration | LAN | IP page ............................................................................................ 625
Figure 6-15. Configuration | LAN | ARP page ......................................................................................... 629
Figure 6-16. Configuration | Routing | Routes page .............................................................................. 631
Figure 6-17. Configuration | Routing | IGMP page ................................................................................ 633
Figure 6-18. Configuration | Routing | DHCP page ................................................................................ 635
Figure 6-19. Configuration | Routing | DNS page................................................................................... 636
xxiii
xxiv
Figure 7-19. VersaFEC Codec QPSK, Rate 0.533, 0.631, 0.706 and 0.803 ............................................ 732
Figure 7-20. VersaFEC Codec 8-QAM, Rate 0.642, 0.711, and 0.780 ................................................... 733
Figure 7-21. VersaFEC Codec 16-QAM, Rate 0.731, 0.780, 0.829 and 0.853....................................... 734
Figure 9-1. TX Clock Modes ....................................................................................................................... 93
Figure 9-2. RX Clock Modes ...................................................................................................................... 95
Figure 9-3. Supported T1 and E1 Framing Formats .................................................................................. 97
Figure 9-4. Drop and Insert Clocking......................................................................................................... 99
Figure 9-5. Single-Source Multiple Modems (Looming) ......................................................................... 910
Figure 9-6. Single-Source Multiple Modems (Daisy-chain) ..................................................................... 910
Figure 9-7. G.703 Clock Extension Mode 1 ............................................................................................. 913
Figure 9-8. G.703 Clock Extension Mode 2 ............................................................................................. 914
Figure 9-9. G.703 Clock Extension Mode 3 ............................................................................................. 915
Figure 10-1. Conceptual Block Diagram .................................................................................................. 103
Figure 10-2. Conventional FDMA Link .................................................................................................... 105
Figure 10-3. Same Link Using CDM-625 and DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier............................................ 106
Figure 10-4. Duplex Link Optimization.................................................................................................... 106
Figure 10-5. DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Signals ................................................................................. 108
Figure 10-6. Carrier-in-Carrier Signal Processing Block Diagram ............................................................ 108
Figure 16-1. CDM-625 Ethernet Architecture Design ............................................................................. 161
Figure 16-2. Improper Use of External Ethernet Switch with CDM-625 ................................................. 162
Figure 16-3. Ethernet Networking Loop Example (Simplified) ............................................................... 162
Figure 16-4. Networking Loop Example .................................................................................................. 163
Figure 16-5. Hub-to-Hub with Standard Traffic using Routers ............................................................... 164
Figure 16-6. Hub-to-Remotes with Standard Traffic using Routers or Switches .................................... 165
Figure 16-7. Point-to-Point Configuration in Router Multipoint Hub Working Mode ........................ 166
Figure 16-8. Point-to-Multipoint using Routers ...................................................................................... 167
Figure 16-9. Point-to-Multipoint using Switches .................................................................................... 168
Figure 16-10. Point-to-Multipoint (Router Multipoint Hub Mode) ........................................................ 169
Figure 16-11. Multicast Routing Diagram ............................................................................................. 1611
Figure 16-12. Configuration Example for a Multicast Routing Network............................................... 1612
Figure 16-13. Configuration Example Point-to-Point Network with PTP ........................................... 1616
Figure 16-14. PTP Master/Slave Assignment Example ......................................................................... 1617
Figure 17-1. ACM-over-Satellite Generic Example............................................................................... 174
Figure 17-2. VersaFEC Codes vs. Constrained Capacity .......................................................................... 177
Figure 17-3. CDM-625 ACM ModCod Switch Points .......................................................................... 1710
Figure 17-4. CDM-625 ACM Congestion Control ............................................................................... 1712
Figure 20-1. IEEE 802.1q VLAN priority ................................................................................................... 206
Figure A-1. EIA-530 to RS-422/449 DCE Conversion Cable (CEFD P/N CA/WR0049) ............................... A-2
Figure A-2. EIA-530 to V.35 DCE Conversion Cable .................................................................................. A-3
Figure A-3. RS-232 Remote Control Cable (CDM-625 Remote Control Port to PC 9-Pin Serial Port) ....... A-4
Figure C-1. CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface ADMIN | FAST page ............................................ C4
Figure F-1. CDM-625 Front Panel Features ............................................................................................... F3
Figure F-2.CDM-625 Front Panel ODU Operation Menu Tree (FW Ver. 2.3.1) ...................................... F4
Figure F-3. CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface Home Page ............................................................. F36
Figure F-4. CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface Menu Tree (FW Ver. 2.3.1) .................................... F37
Figure F-5. Configuration | BUC page ..................................................................................................... F38
Figure F-6. Configuration | LNB page ..................................................................................................... F39
Figure F-7. Status | Modem Logs | Base Modem page .......................................................................... F40
xxv
xxvi
TechnicalPublications@comtechefdata.com
A WARNING gives information about a possible hazard that MAY CAUSE DEATH or
SERIOUS INJURY.
A CAUTION gives information about a possible hazard that MAY CAUSE INJURY or
PROPERTY DAMAGE.
xxvii
Metric Conversion
Metric conversion information is located on the inside back cover of this manual. This information
is provided to assist the operator in cross-referencing non-metric to metric conversions.
If the unit is operated in a vehicle or movable installation, make sure the unit is
stable. Otherwise, EN 60950 safety is not guaranteed.
Grounding
PROPER GROUNDING PROTECTION IS REQUIRED: The installation instructions
require that the integrity of the protective earth must be ensured and that the
equipment shall be connected to the protective earth connection at all times.
The CDM-625 is designed for connection to a power system that has separate
xxviii
ground, line and neutral conductors. The equipment is not designed for connection
to a power system that has no direct connection to ground. It is therefore
imperative during installation, configuration, and operation for the user to ensure
that the unit has been properly grounded using the ground stud provided on the
rear panel of the unit.
Electrical Installation
The unit is rated for a nominal operating range of 100-240 volts AC; for the appropriately
equipped DC option, nominal operating range is 43-60 volts DC. The unit has a maximum power
consumption of 300 watts.
The installation and connection to the line supply must be made in compliance to local or
national wiring codes and regulations.
The CDM-625 is shipped with a line inlet cable suitable for use in the country of operation. If it is
necessary to replace this cable, ensure the replacement has an equivalent specification.
Examples of acceptable ratings for the cable include HAR, BASEC and HOXXX-X.
Examples of acceptable connector ratings include VDE, NF-USE, UL, CSA, OVE, CEBEC, NEMKO,
DEMKO, BS1636A, BSI, SETI, IMQ, KEMA-KEUR and SEV.
Battery
THE MODEM CONTAINS A LITHIUM BATTERY. DANGER OF EXPLOSION EXISTS IF THE
BATTERY IS INCORRECTLY REPLACED. REPLACE ONLY WITH THE SAME OR EQUIVALENT
TYPE RECOMMENDED BY THE MANUFACTURER. DISPOSE OF USED BATTERIES IN
ACCORDANCE WITH LOCAL AND NATIONAL REGULATIONS.
Fuses
FOR CONTINUED OPERATOR SAFETY, ALWAYS REPLACE THE FUSES WITH THE CORRECT
TYPE AND RATING.
xxix
For AC operation, the unit requires two common 4 Amp/250 volts 20mm x 5mm Slow-
blow fuses that are contained within a fuse holder that is press-fit into the body of the
IEC power inlet module (on the rear panel of the unit).
For DC operation, the unit requires two different fuses that are contained within the
individual screw-in receptacles below the terminal block (on the rear panel of the unit).
Operating Environment
DO NOT OPERATE THE UNIT IN ANY OF THESE EXTREME OPERATING
CONDITIONS:
EXCESSIVE DUST.
FLAMMABLE GASES.
xxx
Federal Communications Commission Federal Code of Regulation FCC Part 15, Subpart
B.
TO ENSURE THAT THE UNIT COMPLIES WITH THESE STANDARDS, OBEY THESE
INSTRUCTIONS:
Use coaxial cable that is of good quality (e.g., RG58/U (50) or RG59/U (75)) for
connections to the IF Tx and Rx (transmit and receive) BNC female connectors.
Use Type 'D' connectors that have back-shells with continuous metallic shielding.
Type D cabling must have a continuous outer shield (either foil or braid, or both). The
shield must be bonded to the back-shell.
Symbol Description
<HAR> Type of power cord required for use in the European Community.
International Symbols
Symbol Definition Symbol Definition
Alternating Current Protective Earth
Fuse Chassis Ground
For additional symbols, refer to Warnings, Cautions and Notes listed earlier in this
Preface.
xxxi
CE Mark
Comtech EF Data declares that the unit meets the necessary requirements for the CE Mark.
Warranty Policy
Comtech EF Data products are warranted against defects in material and workmanship
for a specific period from the date of shipment, and this period varies by product. In
most cases, the warranty period is two years. During the warranty period, Comtech EF
Data will, at its option, repair or replace products that prove to be defective. Repairs are
warranted for the remainder of the original warranty or a 90 day extended warranty,
whichever is longer. Contact Comtech EF Data for the warranty period specific to the
product purchased.
For equipment under warranty, the owner is responsible for freight to Comtech EF Data
and all related customs, taxes, tariffs, insurance, etc. Comtech EF Data is responsible for
the freight charges only for return of the equipment from the factory to the owner.
Comtech EF Data will return the equipment by the same method (i.e., Air, Express,
Surface) as the equipment was sent to Comtech EF Data.
All equipment returned for warranty repair must have a valid RMA number issued prior
to return and be marked clearly on the return packaging. Comtech EF Data strongly
recommends all equipment be returned in its original packaging.
Comtech EF Data Corporations obligations under this warranty are limited to repair or
replacement of failed parts, and the return shipment to the buyer of the repaired or
replaced parts.
Limitations of Warranty
The warranty does not apply to any part of a product that has been installed, altered,
repaired, or misused in any way that, in the opinion of Comtech EF Data Corporation,
xxxii
would affect the reliability or detracts from the performance of any part of the product,
or is damaged as the result of use in a way or with equipment that had not been
previously approved by Comtech EF Data Corporation.
The warranty does not apply to any product or parts thereof where the serial number or
the serial number of any of its parts has been altered, defaced, or removed.
The warranty does not cover damage or loss incurred in transportation of the product.
The warranty does not cover replacement or repair necessitated by loss or damage from
any cause beyond the control of Comtech EF Data Corporation, such as lightning or
other natural and weather related events or wartime environments.
The warranty does not cover any labor involved in the removal and or reinstallation of
warranted equipment or parts on site, or any labor required to diagnose the necessity
for repair or replacement.
The warranty excludes any responsibility by Comtech EF Data Corporation for incidental
or consequential damages arising from the use of the equipment or products, or for any
inability to use them either separate from or in combination with any other equipment
or products.
A fixed charge established for each product will be imposed for all equipment returned
for warranty repair where Comtech EF Data Corporation cannot identify the cause of the
reported failure.
Exclusive Remedies
Comtech EF Data Corporations warranty, as stated is in lieu of all other warranties,
expressed, implied, or statutory, including those of merchantability and fitness for a
particular purpose. The buyer shall pass on to any purchaser, lessee, or other user of
Comtech EF Data Corporations products, the aforementioned warranty, and shall
indemnify and hold harmless Comtech EF Data Corporation from any claims or liability
of such purchaser, lessee, or user based upon allegations that the buyer, its agents, or
employees have made additional warranties or representations as to product
preference or use.
The remedies provided herein are the buyers sole and exclusive remedies. Comtech EF
Data shall not be liable for any direct, indirect, special, incidental, or consequential
damages, whether based on contract, tort, or any other legal theory.
xxxiii
Getting Help
Review the Warranty Policy before contacting Comtech EF Data Technical Support or
Customer Service.
Contact Comtech EF Data Customer & Technical Support during normal business hours (Monday
through Friday, 8 A.M. to 5 P.M Mountain Standard Time (MST)):
For: Contact:
xxxiv
Step Task
On the Comtech EF Data Home page: From the SUPPORT column at the bottom
of the page, select the RMA Request hyperlink;
OR
OR
On the Comtech EF Data Service page: Select the Return Material Authorizaion
hyperlink;
Alternately:
3 Pack the product in its original shipping carton and protective packaging.
4 Ship the product back to Comtech EF Data. Shipping charges should be prepaid.
xxxv
Notes:
xxxvi
The CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem (Figure 1-1) is intended for both closed network and
legacy Intelsat applications. The CDM-625 is a replacement for the CDM-600 and CDM-600L
Open Network Satellite Modems, and it includes many new or enhanced features:
It is compact 1RU high and 17.6 inches deep and consumes only 48 watts (typical).
It features front panel LED Indicators, a keypad, and a Vacuum Fluorescent Display (VFD)
for local configuration and monitoring and control (M&C). It also can be fully remote-
controlled through its serial remote control or Ethernet-based Web Server (HTTP) and
Telnet Command Line interfaces.
It provides a full range of built-in (i.e., no plug-in cards required) traffic data interface
types, including all G.703 types, Quad E1 Drop and Insert, HSSI, and ASI.
Its IF frequency range simultaneously covers 50-180 MHz and 950-2000 MHz.
It offers variable data rates, from 18 kbps to 25 Mbps, in BPSK, QPSK, Offset QPSK
(OQPSK), 8PSK, 8-QAM and 16-QAM modes. Viterbi, Sequential, concatenated Reed-
Solomon (RS), Trellis Coded Modulation (TCM), Turbo Product Coding (TPC), Low-density
Parity Check Coding (LDPC), and VersaFEC (short-block, low latency LDPC) are provided
as Forward Error Correction (FEC) options.
Its demod design incorporates fast acquisition, improved composite power handling,
and an integrated adaptive equalizer.
11
It can be equipped with a DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier option card that can save up to
50% transponder bandwidth.
It can be equipped with an optional IP Packet Processor card that, in addition to providing
Layer 3 functionality, incorporates a number of key features for Wide Area Network
(WAN) bandwidth optimization: very low overhead Streamline Encapsulation (SLE),
Header and Payload Compression, Advanced Quality of Service (QoS), and Advanced
Encryption Standard (AES) Encryption.
IEEE-1588v2 Precision Timing Protocol (PTP) and Jumbo Frame Support are available
options (either requires the CDM-625 Rev 2 Hardware configuration).
Carrier ID is a patent pending carrier identification (CID) technique that uses MetaCarrier
spread spectrum technology to embed a unique carrier identification sequence for the
transmitted carrier.
The IF interface provides a bidirectional link with the satellite via the uplink and
downlink equipment.
The data interface is a bidirectional path that connects with the customers equipment
(assumed to be the DTE) and the modem (assumed to be the DCE).
Transmit data is received by the terrestrial interface where line receivers convert the clock and
data signals to CMOS levels for further processing. A small FIFO follows the terrestrial interface
to facilitate the various clocking and framing options. If framing is enabled, the transmit clock
and data output from the FIFO pass through the framer, where the overhead data (IDR, IBS, D&I
or EDMAC) is added to the main data; otherwise, the clock and data are passed directly to the
Forward Error Correction encoder.
In the FEC encoder, the data is differentially encoded, scrambled, and then convolutionally or
block encoded. Following the encoder, the data is fed to the transmit digital filters, which
perform spectral shaping on the data signals. The resultant I and Q signals are then fed to the
BPSK, QPSK/OQPSK, 8PSK, 8-QAM, or 16-QAM modulator.
The carrier is generated by a frequency synthesizer, and the I and Q signals directly modulate
this carrier. For L-Band applications, the directly modulated signal comprises the main output.
For IF applications (50180 MHz), the L-Band signal is mixed down and filtered to produce the
desired output. The Rx-IF signal at L-Band is processed by a dual IF superheterodyne receiver.
12
For IF applications (50180 MHz), the signal is first mixed up to the first IF frequency. The
second conversion is a complex mix, resulting in the signal once more being split into an in-
phase (I) and a quadrature (Q) component, producing an output at near-zero frequency.
An AGC circuit maintains the desired signal level constant over a broad range. Following this, the
I and Q signals are sampled by high-speed (flash) A/D converters. All processing beyond this
conversion is purely digital, performing the functions of Nyquist filtering, carrier recovery, and
symbol timing recovery. The resultant demodulated signal is fed, in soft decision form, to the
selected FEC decoder, which can be Viterbi, Sequential, TCM, Reed-Solomon, TPC, LDPC or
VersaFEC (if installed).
After decoding, the recovered clock and data pass to the de-framer (if IBS, IDR, D&I or EDMAC
framing is enabled), where the overhead information is removed. Following this, the data passes
to the Plesiochronous/Doppler buffer, which has a programmable size, or may be bypassed.
From here, the receive clock and data signals are routed to the terrestrial interface, and are
passed to the externally connected DTE equipment.
1.3 Features
The CDM-625 modem chassis assembly (CEFD P/N PL/12587-1 Standard AC Chassis or CEFD P/N
PL/12587-2 Optional DC Chassis) is physically comprised of two main card assemblies:
Baseband Framing Card (CEFD P/N PL/11963-1). This first card includes all of the
interface circuits, the framer/de-framer, plesiochronous/Doppler buffer, Reed Solomon
outer codec, HDLC framer, Ethernet switch, and the main microcontroller.
Modem Card (CEFD P/N PL/12575-1). This second card is the modem itself. It performs
all signal processing functions of modulation, demodulation, and primary Forward Error
Correction.
The unit is also fully backwards-compatible with the CDM-600 and CDM-600L modems (with the
exception of a lower data rate range of 18 kbps). The modem includes software emulation of
CDM-600 and CDM-600L.
13
HDLC Encapsulation
Compatible CEFD
Compatible Compatible CEFD IP Modem
CDM-625 Configuration IP Modem
CEFD IP Modem Configuration
Firmware
Standard 4-port Ethernet Data CDM-570/570L must have Layer
CDM-570/570L IP
Interface without optional IP CDM-570/570L 2 (L2) Tx and Rx Header
Firmware Versions
Packet Processor Managed with IP Module Compression disabled
1.5.4 to 1.6.X
Switch Mode* Managed Switch Mode*
Standard 4-port Ethernet Data CDD-562L/564 must have Layer
CDD-562L/564 IP
Interface without optional IP CDD-562L/564 2 (L2) Tx and Rx Header
Firmware Versions
Packet Processor Managed IP Demodulator Compression disabled
1.5.4 to 1.6.X
Switch Mode* Managed Switch Mode*
Streamline Encapsulation
Compatible Compatible CEFD IP Compatible CEFD IP
CDM-625 Configuration
CEFD IP Modem Modem Firmware Modem Configuration
CDM-570/570L IP
Optional IP Packet Processor CDM-570/570L
Firmware Version 1.7.0 or Managed Switch Mode*
Managed Switch Mode* with IP Module
later
Optional IP Packet Processor CDD-562L/564 CDD-562L/564 IP Firmware
Managed Switch Mode*
Managed Switch Mode* IP Demodulator Version 1.7.0 or later
CDM-570/570L IP
Optional IP Packet Processor CDM-570/570L
Firmware Version 1.7.0 or Router Mode
Router Mode with IP Module
later
Optional IP Packet Processor CDD-562L/564 CDD-562L/564 IP Firmware
Router Mode
Router Mode IP Demodulator Version 1.7.0 or later
*Note: Managed Switch Mode is also known as Ethernet Bridge Mode.
1.3.4 Verification
The CDM-625 includes many test modes and loopbacks for rapid verification of the correct
functioning of the unit. Of particular note is the IF loopback, which permits you to perform a
quick diagnostic test without having to disturb external cabling. During the loopback, all of the
receive configuration parameters are temporarily changed to match those of the transmit side,
and an internal RF switch connects the modulator output to the demodulator input. When
normal operation is again selected, all of the previous values are restored.
The CDM-625 stores its firmware internally in flash memory, which simplifies the firmware
updating process without having to open the modem. Firmware downloads are available via the
14
Internet from Comtech EF Datas Web site, via e-mail, or on CD, and can be transferred from an
external client PC once connectivity has been established with the modem.
The CDM-625 includes a universal data interface that eliminates the need to exchange interface
cards for different applications. The interfaces offered, as standard, include:
ASI
Dual Audio, 600 (produces a single 64 kbps data stream with either IBS or EDMAC
framing)
15
16
The CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem incorporates a number of optional features. In order
to permit a lower initial cost, you may purchase the unit enabled with only the desired features.
If you wish to upgrade the functionality of a unit at a later date, Comtech EF Data provides Fully
Accessible System Topology (FAST), which permits the purchase and activation of options
through special authorization codes. You may purchase these unique, register-specific Fast
Access Codes from Comtech EF Data during normal business hours, and then load these codes
into the unit using either the front panel keypad or the CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface.
Contact a Comtech EF Data sales representative during normal business hours, or via e-mail to
sales@comtechefdata.com, to order the desired options.
FAST System Theory: FAST facilitates on-location upgrade of the operating feature set without
removing a unit from the setup. FAST technology allows you to order a unit precisely tailored for
the initial application. When your service requirements change, you can upgrade the topology of
the unit to meet these requirements within minutes. This accelerated upgrade can be
accomplished because of FASTs extensive use of the programmable logic devices incorporated
into Comtech EF Data products.
FAST Accessible Options: Hardware options can be ordered and installed either at the factory or
in the field (see Table 1-1 for hardware option details). Depending on the current hardware
configuration of the unit, you can select options that can be easily activated on-site. The FAST
Access Code that is purchased from Comtech EF Data enables configuration of the available
hardware.
Table 1-2 shows the FAST and FAST-accessible hardware options available for the CDM-625. The
base CDM-625 unit is equipped with Viterbi and Reed-Solomon codecs. It offers BPSK, QPSK, and
OQPSK modulation types, and data rates up to 5.0 Mbps, with all interface types. While it is
limited to Closed Network operation, it also includes EDMAC and AUPC.
17
18
19
For 1:1 redundancy applications, via its low-cost external CRS-170A L-Band and CRS-180
70/140 MHz IF 1:1 Redundancy Switches.
For M:N redundancy (hub) applications, via its external CRS-300 1:10 Redundancy
Switch or the CRS-500 M:N Redundancy System.
Transceiver Support: The CDM-625 is a companion product for Comtech EF Datas CSAT-5060
and KST-2000A/B RF Transceivers. The modem incorporates a Frequency Shift-keying (FSK) serial
link that can be activated on the Rx-IF port for the purpose of communicating with a transceiver,
if connected. In this manner, you may configure, monitor and control the transceiver using
either the CDM-625s front panel display and keypad or any of its remote control interfaces. The
EDMAC channel may also be used to convey M&C data to a transceiver at the distant end of a
satellite link, if it is connected to a CDM-625.
BUC Support: The CDM-625 incorporates an FSK serial link that can be activated on the Tx-IF
port for the purpose of communicating with an FSK-capable smart BUC. This link is designed to
be compatible with the Global VSAT Forum/ND SatCom specification. In this manner, you may
configure, monitor and control the BUC using either the CDM-625s front panel display and
keypad or any of its remote control interfaces.
Additionally, Comtech EF Data provides for an "Advanced FSK" for use with its LPOD BUCs, re-
using the existing FSK channel to pass additional "proprietary" commands to expand front panel
user control. The EDMAC channel can be used to convey M&C interface to a BUC at the distant
end of a satellite link, if it is connected to a CDM-625.
110
111
112
Figure 1-4 shows the rear panel of the modem. External cables are attached to connectors on
the rear panel of the CDM-625. They comprise:
Connector Group
Name Connector Type Function
(Chapter)
BNC female (70/140MHz band)
Rx IF Input
IF Type N female (L-Band)
(Sect. 3.2.1) BNC female (70/140MHz band)
Tx IF Output
Type N female (L-Band)
Data Interface 25-pin Type D female Serial synchronous data input/output
Balanced G.703 9-pin Type D female G.703, D&I or D&I++; Quad E1 Ports 1 & 2
Auxiliary G.703 9-pin Type D female Quad E1 Ports 3 & 4
Unbalanced Out BNC female Receive G.703 (IDO); ASI
G.703
Data Unbalanced In BNC female Transmit G.703 (DDI); ASI
Terrestrial Data
(Sect. 3.2.2) IDI BNC female Insert Data In / Sub-rate Auxiliary Tx G.703 In
Drop Data Output / Sub-rate Auxiliary Rx
DDO BNC female
G.703 Out
10/100 Ethernet (4X) RJ-45 female 10/100 BaseT management and data
IDR Data/Alarms/Audio 44-pin High Density Type D female Intelsat Open Network auxiliary signals
ESC 9-pin Type D female ESC input/output (RS232/485)
Remote Control 9-pin Type D male Serial Remote Interface (RS232/485)
Alarms 15-pin Type D male Form C Alarms (relay closures)
Utility
PMSI 9-pin Type D female Pre-Mapped Symbol Interface (CnC)
(Sect. 3.2.3
1:1 Control 9-pin Type D female Connection to External 1:1 Controller
External Reference BNC female Input/output
Ground #10-32 stud See Sect. 3.3.1 Common Chassis Ground
Ground / Power
AC Power (Standard) See Sect. 3.3.2 Chassis power
(Sect 3.3)
DC Power (Optional) See Sect. 3.3.3 Chassis power
The European EMC Directive 2004/108/EEC (EN 55022, EN 50024) requires using
properly shielded cables for DATA I/O. These cables must be double-shielded from
end-to-end, ensuring a continuous ground shield.
113
114
Transmit filtering Firmware prior to 1.4.0: Root-Raised Cosine, alpha = 0.35 (fixed)
Firmware 1.4.0 or later: Root-Raised Cosine, alpha = 0.35 and 0.25 front panel/software selectable
See graph of output spectrum provided at the end of this section
Scrambling IDR Mode, no RS, - per ITU V.35 (Intelsat variant)
IBS mode, no RS - per IESS-309, externally frame synchronized
Transparent Closed Network mode, no RS or Turbo coding - per ITU V.35 (Intelsat variant)
EDMAC mode, no RS coding - externally frame synchronized - proprietary
Turbo Product Code/LDPC/VersaFEC modes - externally frame synchronized - proprietary
All RS modes - externally frame synchronized per IESS-308/309/310
External Reference As an input: 1, 2, 5 or 10MHz -6dBm to +10dBm (nominal 50/75 , BNC female connector)
As an output: 10MHz, 2.7 volts peak-to-peak 0.4 volts, low impedance output
(The Ext. reference phase locks Tx and Rx synthesizers, and all baseband clock generation)
Harmonics/spurious Better than -60 dBC/4 kHz (typically <-65 dBC/4kHz)
measured from 1 to 500 MHz (50-180 MHz band)
measured F0 500 MHz (950-2000 MHz band)
Transmit on/off ratio -60 dBC minimum
Output phase noise < 0.480rms double sided, 100 Hz to 1MHz (minimum of 16 dB better overall than the INTELSAT IESS-308/309 requirement)
dB/Hz Frequency Offset
-63.0 100 Hz
-73.0 1 kHz
-83.0 10 kHz
-93.0 100 kHz
Fundamental AC line spurious is -42 dBc or lower
The sum of all other single sideband spurious, from 0 to 0.75 x symbol rate, is -48 dBc or lower
Output power 950-2000 MHz band: 0 to -40 dBm, 0.1 dB steps - manual mode. See AUPC section also
50-180 MHz band: 0 to -25 dBm, 0.1 dB steps - manual mode. See AUPC section also
Power accuracy 950-2000 MHz band:
0.7dB over frequency, data rate, modulation type and temperature range 15 to 35oC
1.0 dB over frequency, data rate, modulation type and temperature range 0 to 50oC
50-180 MHz band:
0.5dB over frequency, data rate, modulation type and temperature range 15 to 35oC
0.8dB over frequency, data rate, modulation type and temperature range 0 to 50oC
Output impedance 950-2000 MHz band: 50, 19 dB minimum return loss (21 dB typical)
50-180 MHz band: 50, or 75 16 dB minimum return loss (18 dB typical)
Output connector 950-2000 MHz band: Type N female
50-180 MHz band: BNC female
Clocking options Internal, 0.06 ppm (SCT)
External, locking over a 100 ppm range (TT)
Loop timing (Rx satellite clock) - supports asymmetric operation - Rx and Tx data rates need not be identical
External Clock
G.703 Clock Extension mode internal ST clock can be slaved to an external T1 or E1 G.703 signal, and a G.703 timing
signal re-constituted at the distant end of the link, regardless of the actual link data rate
External TX Carrier Off By TTL 'low' signal or external contact closure - hardware function automatically over-rides processor
BUC Reference On center conductor of L-Band output connector; 10.0 MHz 0.06 ppm (internal reference selected)
(10 MHz): 0.0 dBm, 3 dB; programmable ON/OFF
Phase Noise Source: either Internal Modem Reference or External Reference (10 MHz)
dB/Hz Frequency Offset
-105 10 Hz
-125 100 Hz
-138 1 kHz
-148 10 kHz
-150 100 kHz
BUC Supply Voltage Standard unit has no BUC supply.
Optional BUC Supply:
24VDC, 4.17 Amps maximum, 100W
48VDC, 3.125 Amps maximum, 150W @ 50oC (180 watts @ 30oC)
Supplied through Tx IF center conductor and selectable ON/OFF via M&C control.
BUC Current Monitor Min/Max programmable current alarm thresholds.
Tx Carrier ON Delay Selectable feature power on to allow internal ovenized reference to stabilize before turning on Tx carrier. Intelligent algorithm
minimizes delay time based on internal temperature at power-up.
BUC Monitoring Power level, temperature, power class, PLL lock.
Uses ND Satcom/Global VSAT Forum specification for FSK control and monitoring.
115
0.0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1.0 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 1.5
0 Symbol Rate, Rs
-5 Comtech EF Data
CDM-625 Transmit
-10 Power Spectral Note: Tx Alpha = 0.25 requires
Density, referred to Firmware v1.4.0 or higher
symbol rate
-15
-20
-25
-30
Intelsat
-35 IESS
Tx Alpha = 0.35
308/309
Limit
-40
CDM-625
-45 Modulator
typically < -50 dB, and
Intelsat guaranteed to be
-50 IESS < -45 dB at offsets
308/309
Spectral Tx Alpha = 0.25 > 0.75 Rs
Limit
density, dB
-55
1.4.2 Demodulator
Note: Data rate range, operating modes, descrambling, input impedance/return loss etc, as per Sect. 1.4.1 Modulator.
Input power range, 950-2000 MHz (950-1950 MHz w/Firmware prior to Ver. 1.4.1) band:
desired carrier -130 + 10log(symbol rate) to -80 + 10 log(symbol rate) dBm
50-180 MHz band:
-105 + 10 log(symbol rate) to -70 + 10 log(symbol rate) dBm
Maximum Composite 950-2000 MHz band:
Operating Level 102 10 log(symbol rate, desired carrier) dBC, +10 dBm max, with the additional requirement that within 10 MHz of the
desired carrier, composite power is +30 dBC.
50-180 MHz band:
94 10 log(symbol rate, desired carrier) dBC, +10 dBm max, with the additional requirement that
within 10 MHz of the desired carrier, composite power is +30 dBc
Absolute Maximum,
+20 dBm
No Damage
FEC Viterbi: 3 bit soft decision
Sequential: 2 bit soft decision
Trellis: Per IESS-310
Reed-Solomon(Open Network): Per IESS-308/309/310
Reed-Solomon(Closed Network): Proprietary
Turbo Product Codec: 6 bit soft decision, proprietary
LDPC: 5 bit soft decision, proprietary
VersaFEC: 6 bit soft decision, proprietary
Adaptive Equalizer 5-tap design, selectable on/off
Acquisition range Programmable in 1kHz increments, and subject to the following:
Below 64 ksymbols/sec: 1 to (Rs/2) kHz, where Rs = symbol rate in ksymbols/sec
Between 64 and 389 ksymbols/sec: 1 up to a maximum of 32kHz
Above 389 ksymbols/sec: 1 to (0.1Rs) kHz, up to a maximum of 200 kHz
Acquisition time Highly dependent on data rate, FEC rate, and demodulator acquisition range.
Examples: 120 ms average at 64 kbps, R1/2 QPSK, 10 kHz acquisition sweep range, 6dB Eb/No
2 s average at 18 kbps, R1/2 QPSK, 10 kHz, 6dB Eb/No
Note: The use of Reed-Solomon, TPC, LDPC, VersaFEC increases acquisition time, due to the additional time taken for these
decoders to declare synchronization.
Clock tracking range 100 ppm min
Clocking modes Full range of clocking options supported see plesiochronous/Doppler buffer section
116
LNB 10 MHz Reference On center conductor of L-Band input connector, selectable ON/OFF. Level: -3dBm 3 dB.
Source: either Internal modem reference or External reference
Performance: For phase noise, refer to L-Band modulator 10 MHz. Frequency stability same as the modulator 10 MHz
reference.
LNB Voltage On center conductor of L-Band input connector, selectable ON/OFF, 13, 18 volts per DiSEq 4.2 and 24VDC at 500 mA
maximum.
LNB Current Alarm Programmable MIN and MAX current alarms.
VITERBI BER performance Rate 1/2 (B, Q, OQ) Rate 3/4 (Q, OQ) Rate 7/8 (Q, OQ)
(met in the presence of two Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No:
adjacent carriers, each 7 dB (typical value in parentheses) (typical value in parentheses) (typical value in parentheses)
higher than the desired carrier)
For:
BER=10-5 5.4 dB (4.9 dB) 6.8 dB (6.3 dB) 7.7 dB (7.2 dB)
BER=10-6 6.0 dB (5.5 dB) 7.4 dB (6.9 dB) 8.4 dB (7.9 dB)
BER=10-7 6.7 dB (6.2 dB) 8.2 dB (7.7 dB) 9.0 dB (8.6 dB)
VITERBI and RS 220,200 or Rate 1/2 (B, Q, OQ) Rate 3/4 (Q, OQ) Rate 7/8 (Q, OQ)
200,180 Outer Code BER (with Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No:
two adjacent carriers, each 7 (typical value in parentheses) (typical value in parentheses) (typical value in parentheses)
dB higher than the desired For:
carrier) BER=10-5 4.3 dB (4.0 dB) 5.6 dB (4.7 dB) 6.5 dB (6.0 dB)
BER=10-6 4.4 dB (4.1 dB) 5.8 dB (4.8 dB) 6.7 dB (6.2 dB)
BER=10-7 4.5 dB (4.2 dB) 6.0 dB (5.2 dB) 6.9 dB (6.5 dB)
8PSK/TCM CODEC Rate 2/3 8PSK/TCM Rate 2/3 8PSK/TCM
BER (with two adjacent Guaranteed Eb/No: w/concatenated RS
carriers, each 7 dB higher than (typical value in parentheses) Guaranteed Eb/No:
the desired carrier) (typical value in parentheses)
For:
BER=10-5 7.9 dB (7.2 dB) 6.3 dB (5.4 dB)
BER=10-6 5.1 dB (4.6 dB) 5.8 dB (5.4 dB) 7.0 dB (6.6 dB)
BER=10-8 5.7 dB (5.2 dB) 6.4 dB (6.0 dB) 7.9 dB (7.4 dB)
SEQUENTIAL Rate 1/2 (Q, OQ) Rate 3/4 (Q, OQ) Rate 7/8 (Q, OQ)
at 2048 kbps BER Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No:
performance (met in the (typical value in parentheses) (typical value in parentheses) (typical value in parentheses)
presence of two adjacent For:
carriers, each 7 dB higher than BER=10-4 5.0 dB (4.6 dB) 5.6 dB (5.2 dB) 6.5 dB (6.0 dB)
the desired carrier)
BER=10-6 5.8 dB (5.4 dB) 6.4 dB (6.0 dB) 7.6 dB (7.2 dB)
BER=10-8 6.7 dB (6.3 dB) 7.3 dB (6.8 dB) 8.7 dB (8.2 dB)
117
SEQUENTIAL and RS 220,200 Rate 1/2 (B, Q, OQ) Rate 3/4 (Q, OQ) Rate 7/8 (Q, OQ)
Outer Code Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No:
at 512 kbps (typical value in parentheses) (typical value in parentheses) (typical value in parentheses)
BER performance (with two For:
adjacent carriers, each 7 dB BER=10-4 4.5 dB (4.1 dB) 5.0 dB (4.6 dB) 5.9 dB (5.5 dB)
higher than the desired carrier)
BER=10-6 4.7 dB (4.3 dB) 5.2 dB (4.8 dB) 6.1 dB (5.7 dB)
BER=10-8 4.9 dB (4.6 dB) 5.4 dB (5.0 dB) 6.3 dB (5.9 dB)
TURBO PRODUCT CODEC Rate 21/44 (B, Q, OQ)* Rate 5/16 (B)
BER Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No: * See Notes 1 and 2 (below)
Rate 21/44 B/Q/OQPSK (typical value in parentheses) (typical value in parentheses)
Rate 5/16 BPSK For:
BER (with two adjacent BER=10-6 3.1 dB (2.9 dB) 2.7 dB (2.5dB)
carriers, each 7 dB higher than
the desired carrier) BER=10-7 3.3 dB (3.1 dB) 2.9 dB (2.7dB)
118
LDPC CODEC BER 8-QAM Rate 2/3 LDPC 8-QAM Rate 3/4 LDPC
Rate 2/3 8-QAM Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No:
Rate 3/4 8-QAM (typical value in parentheses) (typical value in parentheses)
(With two adjacent carriers, For:
each 7 dB higher than the BER=10-5 4.6 dB (4.2 dB) 5.6 dB (5.2 dB)
desired carrier)
BER=10-9 5.0 dB (4.6 dB) 6.0 dB (5.6 dB)
LDPC CODEC BER 16-QAM Rate 3/4 LDPC
Rate 3/4 16-QAM Guaranteed Eb/No:
(With two adjacent carriers, (typical value in parentheses)
each 7 dB higher than the For:
desired carrier) BER=10-5 6.8 dB (6.2 dB)
BER=10-8 2.5 dB (2.2 dB) 3.0 dB (2.7 dB) 3.7 dB (3.4 dB) 4.1 dB (3.8 dB)
VersaFEC CODEC BER Rate 0.642 8-QAM Rate 0.711 8-QAM Rate 0.780 8-QAM
8-QAM Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No:
(With two adjacent carriers, (typical value in (typical value in (typical value in
each 7 dB higher than the parentheses) parentheses) parentheses)
desired carrier) For:
BER=10-5 4.6 dB (4.3 dB) 5.2 dB (4.9 dB) 5.6 dB (5.3 dB)
BER=10-8 4.9 dB (4.6 dB) 5.5 dB (5.2 dB) 6.0 dB (5.7 dB)
VersaFEC CODEC BER R 0.731 16-QAM R 0.780 16-QAM R 0.829 16-QAM R 0.853 16-QAM
16-QAM Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No:
(With two adjacent carriers, (typical value in (typical value in (typical value in (typical value in
each 7 dB higher than the parentheses) parentheses) parentheses) parentheses)
desired carrier) For:
BER=10-5 6.4 dB (6.1 dB) 7.0 dB (6.7 dB) 7.5 dB (7.2 dB) 8.0 dB (7.7 dB)
BER=10-8 6.6 dB (6.3 dB) 7.3 dB (7.0 dB) 7.8 dB (7.5 dB) 8.3 dB (8.0 dB)
VersaFEC CODEC - Extended R 0.576 8-QAM R 0.644 16-QAM
CCM BER Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No:
(With two adjacent carriers, (typical value in (typical value in
each 7 dB higher than the parentheses) parentheses)
desired carrier) For:
BER=10-5 4.5 dB (4.2 dB) 6.4 dB (6.1 dB)
BER=10-8 3.7 dB (3.4 dB) 3.7 dB (3.4 dB) 4.2 dB (3.9 dB) 4.7 dB (4.4 dB)
Plesiochronous/ Selectable size of 64 to 262,144 bits, in 16-bit steps (with added limitations for G.704 frame boundaries).
Doppler Buffer Size selection is displayed in bytes and milliseconds.
Supports asymmetric operation - when buffer is clocked from Tx clock, Rx and Tx rates do not need to be identical.
119
0
-10
Maximum
-20
Carrier Level in dBm
-30
-40
-50
-60
-70
Minimum
-80
-90
10 100 1000 10000 100000
Symbol Rate in ksps
Figure 1-5. Rx Carrier Level vs. Symbol Rate L-Band (950-2000 MHz)
10
0 Maximum
-10
Carrier Level in dBm
-20
-30
-40
-50 Minimum
-60
-70
-80
10 100 1000 10000 100000
Symbol Rate in ksps
Figure 1-6. Rx Carrier Level vs. Symbol Rate IF Band (50-180 MHz)
120
121
122
Notes:
1. Reed-Solomon is Off.
2. % for Rates 5/16 or 21/44 BPSK Turbo, Rate 1/2 QPSK/OQPSK Turbo, and all rates > 2 Mbps.
123
UNFRAMED (ANY REED SOLOMON) Lower Limit (kbps) Upper Limit (kbps)
VITERBI, BPSK, 1/2 18.0 5555.0
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 1/2 18.0 11111.0
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 3/4 27.0 16666.6
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 7/8 31.5 19444.0
SEQUENTIAL, BPSK, 1/2 18.0 1024.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 1/2 18.0 2048.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 3/4 29.0 2048.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 7/8 31.5 2048.0
TRELLIS, 8PSK, 2/3 36.0 22222.0
VIT 16-QAM, 3/4 54.0 22222.0
VIT 16-QAM, 7/8 63.0 22222.0
124
EDMAC, EDMAC-2, or EDMAC-3 (NO REED SOLOMON) Lower Limit (kbps) Upper Limit (kbps)
No FEC, BPSK 18.0 12295.0
No FEC, O/QPSK 35.5 24590.1
VITERBI, BPSK, 1/2 18.0 6147.5
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 1/2 18.0 12295.0
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 3/4 26.6 18442.6
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 7/8 31.0 21516.3
SEQUENTIAL, BPSK, 1/2 18.0 1024.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 1/2 18.0 2048.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 3/4 26.6 2048.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 7/8 31.0 2048.0
TRELLIS, 8PSK, 2/3 35.5 24590.1
TPC, BPSK, 5/16 18.0 3842.2
TPC, BPSK, 21/44 (aka 1/2) 18.0 5868.1
TPC, O/QPSK, 21/44 (aka 1/2) 18.0 11736.2
TPC, O/QPSK, 3/4 26.6 18442.6
TPC, O/QPSK, 17/18 (aka 0.95) 33.5 23224.0
TPC, O/QPSK, 7/8 31.0 21516.3
TPC, 8PSK/8-QAM, 3/4 39.9 24590.1
TPC, 8PSK/8-QAM, 17/18 (aka 0.95) 50.2 24590.1
TPC, 8PSK/8-QAM, 7/8 46.5 24590.1
TPC, 16-QAM, 3/4 53.2 24590.1
TPC, 16-QAM, 7/8 62.0 24590.1
LDPC, BPSK, 1/2 18.0 6147.5
LDPC, O/QPSK, 1/2 18.0 12295.0
LDPC, O/QPSK, 3/4 26.6 18442.6
LDPC, O/QPSK, 2/3 23.7 16393.4
LDPC, 8PSK/8-QAM, 3/4 39.9 24590.1
LDPC, 8PSK/8-QAM, 2/3 35.5 24590.1
LDPC, 16-QAM, 3/4 53.2 24590.1
EDMAC, EDMAC-2, or EDMAC-3 (ANY REED SOLOMON) Lower Limit (kbps) Upper Limit (kbps)
VITERBI, BPSK, 1/2 18.0 5532.7
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 1/2 18.0 11065.5
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 3/4 24.0 16598.3
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 7/8 27.9 19364.7
SEQUENTIAL, BPSK, 1/2 18.0 1024.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 1/2 18.0 2048.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 3/4 24.0 2048.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 7/8 27.9 2048.0
TRELLIS, 8PSK, 2/3 31.9 22131.1
VIT 16-QAM, 3/4 47.9 22131.1
VIT 16-QAM, 7/8 55.8 22131.1
IBS (NO REED SOLOMON) Lower Limit (kbps) Upper Limit (kbps)
No FEC, BPSK 64.0 8448.0
No FEC, O/QPSK 64.0 8448.0
125
IBS (ANY REED SOLOMON) Lower Limit (kbps) Upper Limit (kbps)
VITERBI, BPSK, 1/2 64.0 5208.0
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 1/2 64.0 8448.0
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 3/4 64.0 8448.0
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 7/8 64.0 8448.0
SEQUENTIAL, BPSK, 1/2 64.0 1024.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 1/2 64.0 2048.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 3/4 64.0 2048.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 7/8 64.0 2048.0
TRELLIS, 8PSK, 2/3 64.0 8448.0
VIT 16-QAM, 3/4 64.0 8448.0
VIT 16-QAM, 7/8 64.0 8448.0
ESC++ (NO REED SOLOMON) Lower Limit (kbps) Upper Limit (kbps)
No FEC, BPSK 64.0 12304.6
No FEC, O/QPSK 64.0 24609.3
VITERBI, BPSK, 1/2 64.0 5921.0
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 1/2 64.0 12304.6
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 3/4 64.0 18457.0
126
ESC++ (ANY REED SOLOMON) Lower Limit (kbps) Upper Limit (kbps)
VITERBI, BPSK, 1/2 64.0 5263.1
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 1/2 64.0 10937.5
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 3/4 64.0 16406.2
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 7/8 64.0 19140.6
SEQUENTIAL, BPSK, 1/2 64.0 1024.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 1/2 64.0 2048.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 3/4 64.0 2048.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 7/8 64.0 2048.0
TRELLIS, 8PSK, 2/3 64.0 21875.0
VITERBI, 16-QAM, 3/4 64.0 21875.0
VITERBI, 16-QAM, 7/8 64.0 21875.0
127
VersaFEC Adaptive Coding and Modulation (ACM): See Specifications that follow (Sect.1.4.8)
128
Adaptive Coding and Modulation, using BPSK, QPSK, 8-QAM , 16-QAM and
System type
VersaFEC short-block LDPC coding - total of 12 ModCods
Max fading rate Approximately 1 dB/second (higher if Target Eb/No margin > 1 dB)
Max ModCod update rate 1 update every 2 seconds (no restriction on distance between ModCods)
54 milliseconds max (for a system operating at 100 ksps, and assuming a WAN
System latency
buffer of 20 milliseconds, not including satellite path)
Tx and Rx ModCods
Local and Remote SNR
Monitored parameters (-3.0 dB to +22.0dB, 0.1dB resolution, +/- 0.5 dB accuracy)
Config and monitor menus displaying data rate, modulation and code rate update
dynamically with ModCod
129
1.4.9 Miscellaneous
Front Panel Tactile keypad, 6 keys (Up/Down), Left/Right, Enter/Clear)
Vacuum Fluorescent Display (blue) 2 lines of 40 characters
Loopbacks Internal IF loopback, RF loopback, digital loopback, and inward/outward loopback
Fault relays Hardware fault, Rx and Tx Traffic Alarms, Open Network Backward Alarms
Type: Form C Contacts. Rating: Up to +/-50 volts, max 0.5 Amp
M&C Interface EIA-232 and EIA-485 (addressable multidrop, 2-wire or 4-wire) or Ethernet (10/100 BaseT)
M&C Software Serial comms, SNMP, Telnet, Web Server (HTTP)
Firmware update Via Ethernet port. ftp protocol
Dimensions 1RU high, 17.65 inches (448 mm) deep
Weight 10.5 lbs (4.8 kg) max (All option cards and 48V BUC supply installed)
AC consumption 48 watts (typical, TPC/LDPC Codec and CnC module installed), 68watts (maximum)
280 watts (typical TPC/LDPC Codec, CnC module and 48 volt BUC supply installed, 300 watts (max)
AC operating voltage 100 - 240 VAC Nominal - autosensing
90 264 VAC Maximum
DC consumption (option) As above (AC consumption)
DC operating voltage 43-60 VDC Nominal
36 60 VDC Maximum
Operating temperature 0 to 50C (32 to 122F)
1.4.10 Approvals
EN 61000-3-2 EN 61000-4-6
CE as follows: EN 55022 Class B
EN 61000-3-3 EN 61000-4-8
(Emissions) EN 61000-4-9
EN 61000-4-2
EN 50082-1 (Immunity) EN 61000-4-4 EN 61000-4-11
EN 60950-1 (Safety) EN 61000-4-5 EN 61000-4-13
FCC Federal Communications Commission Federal Code of Regulation FCC Part 15, Subpart B.
130
21
Step Task
o Air temperature inside the rack enclosure should never exceed 50C
(122F).
22
The CDM-625 CANNOT have rack slides mounted to the sides of the chassis.
Cooling fans and exhaust vents are provided here air flow must not be
impeded. Comtech EF Data recommends that an alternate method of support is
provided within the rack, such as standard rack shelves or the optional Rear-
Mounting Support Bracket Kit. If there is any doubt, contact Comtech EF Data
Customer Support during normal business hours.
Feature Description
1 Custom Rack Enclosure
2 CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem
3 Standard Rack Shelving
Rack Enclosure Threaded Front
4
Mounting Rail (typical)
5 Unit Front Panel
6 User-supplied Screws
User-supplied screws to secure the front panel to the rack enclosure threaded front
mounting rails;
23
Detail Description
1 Back of modem
2 Rack Enclosure Threaded Rear Mounting Rail (typical)
Kit / Quantity
Item CEFD P/N Description
KT/6228-2 KT/6228-3
1 2 2 HW/10-32SHLDR Shoulder Screw, #10
2 4 4 HW/10-32FLT Flat Washer, #10
3 2 2 HW/10-32SPLIT Lock Washer, #10
4 2 2 HW/10-32HEXNUT Hex Nut, #10
5 4 4 HW/10-32x1/2RK Bolt, #10, Rear Support Bracket
2 FP/6138-2 Bracket, Rear Support 4
6
2 FP/6138-3 Bracket, Rear Support 10
Tools needed to install the optional KT/6228 (4) or KT/6228 (10) Rear-Mounting Support
Brackets Kit:
24
Follow these steps to install the optional KT/6228 (4) or KT/6228 (10) Rear-Mounting Support
Brackets Kit:
Step Task
Use the #10 flat washers, #10 split washers, and #10 hex nut to secure the #10 shoulder screws to the unit
1
chassis through the rear right and left side mounting slots as shown.
Use the #10 rack bracket bolts to install the rear support brackets onto the rack enclosure threaded rear
2
mounting rails.
Mount the unit into the rack enclosure. Ensure that the shoulders of the #10 shoulder screws properly engage
3
into the rear support bracket slots.
The unit is shipped with a default 64 kbps, QPSK, Rate 1/2 configuration. There are no internal
jumpers to configure, no interface cards to install, and no other options to install. All
configurations are carried out entirely via the modems installed firmware use the front panel
keypad and display to configure the modem locally.
The auto-sensing AC power supply does not require any adjustments. Simply plug
in the supplied line cord, and turn on the rear panel switch.
You may quickly verify proper operation of the modem without the need for externally
connected equipment. From the top level menu, select TEST: Mode IF (IF LOOP).The demod
should synchronize, and the Rx TRAFFIC LED should illuminate GREEN. If the unit does not pass
this test, call Comtech EF Datas Customer Support department for assistance.
Having verified correct operation via the Internal IF loop test, enter the desired configuration
and then connect all external cables. If difficulties occur, call Comtech EF Datas Customer
Support department for assistance.
25
Notes:
26
The CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modems rear panel, shown in Figure 3-1, provides all
necessary external connections between the modem and other equipment:
Section 3.2 details the cabling connections provided on the rear panel interface,
grouped according to service function. Where applicable, the connectors pinout table is
provided.
31
32
3.2.1.1 Rx IF Connectors
3.2.1.2 Tx IF Connectors
33
Notes:
1. When t he r ear-panel LE D m arked 1:N A ctive! i s OFF, al l of t he s ignals s hown abov e ar e av ailable and f unctional. I n
addition, pi ns not s hown are not connected, and therefore no damage will oc cur i f ot her signals ar e c onnected to the
additional pins.
34
2. When the rear-panel LED marked 1:N Active! is ON, the signals shown highlighted are no longer available. Furthermore,
pins 6, 18, 20, 21, 22, 23 and 25 are reserved for use by the 1:N system. DO NOT connect signals to any of these pins in
this mode. Certain pins have DC voltages present that may damage equipment other than a Comtech EF Data redundancy
switch.
3. For X.21 operation, use the EIA-422 pins, but ignore Receive Clock if the Modem is DTE, and ignore Transmit clocks if the
Modem is DCE.
4. For IDR operation using G.703, this primary interface becomes the 8 kbps EIA-422 overhead channel.
See Table 3-3 for the pinouts for the HSSI/EIA-613 side of the CIC-60 Adapter Module.
The modem must first be configured for the appropriate HSSI operation, via the
CDM-625 Front Panel, before using this adapter:
35
36
37
For Quad E1 operation, optional Comtech EF Data cabling accessories may be purchased from
Comtech EF Data to adapt the Balanced G.703 or Auxiliary G.703 connectors as follows:
Figure CEFD Part No. Converts (1) 9-pin Type D Connector (DB-9F) to:
3-3 CA-0000163 (2) DB-15F connections see Table 3-6 for the connector pinout
3-4 CA-0000164 (2) RJ-48 F connections see Table 3-7 for the connector pinout
KT-0000122 or
3-5 (2) BNC 75 BNC-F connections see Table 3-8 for the connector pinout
KT-0020570
38
39
310
3.2.2.2.5 G.703 IDI (Insert Data In), DDO (Drop Data Out)
These are four standard RJ-45 female connectors, operating at 10/100 Mbps, half
and full duplex, auto-negotiating.
\
311
312
313
The 1:1 Control connector is intended only for connection to a CRS-170A or CRS-180
Redundancy Switch.
314
Use the #10-32 stud, located adjacent to the power interface, for connecting a
common chassis ground among equipment.
315
Feature Description
1 On / Off Switch
2 Press-fit Fuse Holder
3 IEC-60320 Type C14 Three-prong Connector
AC Power Specifications
48 watts (typical with TPC/LDPC Codec and
CnC module installed), 68 watts (max)
Input Power 280 watts (typical TPC/LDPC Codec, CnC
module and 48 volt BUC supply installed),
300 watts (max)
100V to 240V AC, +6%/-10%, autosensing
Input Voltage (total absolute max. range is 90V to 264V
AC)
Connection Type IEC-60320 Type C13/C14
Line and neutral fusing
Fuse Protection (2X) 5mm x 20mm Slow-blow type fuses:
T4A ( 250V AC operation)
316
First, plug the provided AC power cord female end into the unit.
Then, plug the AC power cord male end into the user-supplied power source.
First, unseat the fuse holder from the IEC power module.
317
o Use the slot to pry the holder outward from the IEC power module.
o Pull the holder straight out, and then swing the holder away from the module.
FOR CONTINUED OPERATOR SAFETY, ALWAYS REPLACE THE FUSES WITH THE
CORRECT TYPE AND RATING.
This DC input design supersedes the configuration featured on modems built prior
to May 2009.
Feature Description
1 On / Off Switch
2 Power Terminal Block
3 Screw-in Fuse Holders / Receptacles
DC Power Specifications
48 watts (typical with TPC/LDPC Codec and CnC
module installed), 68 watts (max)
Input Power
280 watts (typical TPC/LDPC Codec, CnC module
and 48 volt BUC supply installed), 300 watts (max)
43 60 VDC Nominal
Input Voltage
36 60 VDC Maximum
Connector Type Terminal Block
(2X) 5mm x 20mm Slow-blow type fuses:
Fuse Protection Modem Fuse: 3Amp/250Volts
BUC Fuse: 6.3 Amp/250 Volts
318
First, connect the user-supplied (+) and () DC power leads to their respective terminals.
Number 18 AWG minimum wires are recommended.
319
First, unscrew either fuse holder from its receptacle. Then, remove and replace the modem
and/or the BUC fuse(s):
o Use T3A (3 Amp) 250V fuses for modem operation (left-hand receptacle).
o Use T6.3A (6.3 Amp) 250V fuses when a Block Upconverter (BUC) is installed (right-hand
receptacle).
320
The CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem is factory-shipped with its latest version of operating
firmware. If a firmware update is needed, once Ethernet connectivity has been established with
the unit, the update can be downloaded from the Comtech EF Data Web site
(www.comtechefdata.com), or obtained through Comtech EF Data Customer Support via e-mail
or on CD by standard mail delivery.
Perform the update without opening the CDM-625 by connecting the rear panel serial
Remote Control port or 10/100 Ethernet port to a serial or 10/100 BaseT Ethernet port
of the user PC.
Download the firmware update via the Internet to the user PC.
Transfer the firmware update, via File Transfer Protocol (FTP), from the user PC to the
CDM-625.
In addition to this base modem bulk firmware archive file, downloads are available for the
CDM-625s optional IP Packet Processor Module, available with or without AES Encryption. This
module requires separate firmware update.
41
Firmware updates are available from Comtech EF Data per the following table:
Web Hyperlink EXE/ZIP Filename Contains Image File ( where * denotes revision letter)
Fw12864*.bin
F12864*_V### FW12864*
Base modem firmware up to FW Version 1.6.0
Fw-0020534*.bin
F0020534*_V### Fw-0020534*
Base modem firmware from FW Version 2.0.1 to current
FW-0000342*.bin
F0000342*_V### FW0000342*
IP Packet Processor Module option without AES Encryption.
FW-0000438*.bin
CONTACT CEFD FW0000438*
IP Packet Processor Module option with AES Encryption.
Only firmware for the CDM-625 base modem and IP Packet Processor Module
without AES Encryption is available for download from the CEFD Web site. To
obtain the firmware update for the CDM-625 IP Packet Processor Module with
AES Encryption, contact Network Product Customer Support:
Phone: 480.333.2433
E-mail: cdmipsupport@comtechefdata.com.
The firmware download files are available from Comtech EF Data in two archive file formats:
*.exe (self extracting) and *.zip (compressed). Some firewalls will not allow the downloading of
*.exe files; in this case, download the *.zip file instead. If applicable, one version prior to the
current release is also available for download.
For additional help with "zipped" file types, refer to the help files provided with the
"PKZIP for Windows", "WinZip", or "ZipCentral" file archiving programs. PKZIP for
Command-line is not supported due to file naming conventions.
To verify the correct firmware number, see Step 2 in Sect. 4.3.1 Getting Started: Preparing for
the Firmware Download.
42
Step Task
1 Connect the Windows-based user PC to the CDM-625:
Connect the appropriate modem Ethernet port either via a hub or a switch or directly with an Ethernet or
crossover cable. Make sure that a compatible web browser is running on the PC.
Connect the modem Remote Control port to a serial port on the PC. Make sure that a terminal emulator
program such as Hyper Terminal is running on the PC.
2 Identify the CDM-625 configuration in use, and its firmware number and current version:
A. For the CDM-625 Base Modem, the firmware number and running version can be obtained as follows:
From the modem front panel The firmware version is available from the VFDs top-level splash screen. To
view this screen, press the [CLEAR] key several times.
The firmware numbers are provided within the SELECT: UTIL Firmware Info Image#1 or
Image#2 menu screens. For more information, see Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL OPERATION.
From HTTP via the Base Modem Web Server Interface The Bootrom, Bulk1 and Bulk2 firmware loads may
be viewed on the Admin | Firmware | Base Modem page. For more information, see Chapter 6.5. Web
Server (HTTP) Interface.
Using serial Remote Control query The firmware number, versions, and revision level can be queried as
follows:
B. For the CDM-625 with installed IP Packet Processor, the firmware number and running version can be
obtained as follows:
From the modem front panel Select the Utilities: Firmware Packet-Processor Info Image#1 or
Image#2 menu trees. For more information, see Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL OPERATION.
From HTTP via the Base Modem Web Server Interface Select the Admin | Firmware | Packet Processor
page. The Bootrom, Bulk1 and Bulk2 firmware loads may be viewed here. For more information, see Chapter 6.5
Web Server (HTTP) Interface.
Using serial Remote Control query Use the IP Packet Processors firmware revision query <0/VS1? (Image
1) or <0/VS2? (Image 2).
43
Step Task
3 Create a temporary folder (subdirectory) on the user PC for the firmware archive file download.
Drive letter c: is used in these examples. Any valid, writable drive letter can be used.
Typical for all tasks: Type the command without quotes, and then press Enter to execute.
A. Use the Windows Desktop to create and rename the temporary folder.
Right-click anywhere on the desktop to open the popup submenu, and then select New > Folder to create the
temporary folder. The New Folder will be created on the desktop.
Right-click on the New Folder and then select Rename from the popup submenu. Rename this folder to
"temp" or some other convenient, unused name.
First, click [Start] on the Windows taskbar, and then click the Run... icon (or, depending on Windows OS
versions prior to Windows 95, click the MS-Command-line Prompt icon from the Main Menu).
o For any Windows OS versions later than Windows 98, type cmd or command.
o Alternately, from [Start], select All Programs > Accessories > Command Prompt.
Finally, from the Command-line prompt (c:\>), type mkdir temp or md temp (mkdir and md stand for
make directory), and then click [OK].
C. Use the Run and Browse windows to create and rename the temporary folder.
Select [Start] on the Windows taskbar, and then click the Run... icon. The Run window will open.
Click [Browse] in the Run window. The Browse window will open.
Click the Create New Folder icon in the Browse window. The New Folder will be created.
Right-click the New Folder folder name, and then rename this folder to temp or some other convenient,
unused name.
There should now be a "temp" folder created and available for placement of the firmware archive file
download.
44
Step Task
1 Download the correct firmware archive file to the user PC temporary folder.
A. Go online to www.comtechefdata.com.
B. On the Main page under Support Information or the Support tab, select the Software Downloads hyperlink.
C. On the Software Downloads page click Download Flash and Software Update Files.
D. On the Flash & Software Update Files page select the (Select a Product Line) Modems hyperlink.
F. Select the appropriate firmware EXE or ZIP download hyperlink (i.e. the CDM-625 Base Modem, or the CDM-
625 with IP Packet Processor without AES Encryption; otherwise, contact CEFD Network Product Customer
Support to obtain the firmware download for the IP Packet Processor with AES Encryption).
Refer to the table in Sect. 4.2 About Firmware Numbers, File Versions, and Formats in this chapter for the
naming and availability of the firmware download hyperlinks, archive files, and downloaded image files.
Once the EXE or ZIP hyperlink is selected, the File Download window opens and prompts selection of
[Open] or [Save]:
Click [Open] to turn over file extraction to the user-supplied utility program. Be sure to extract the
firmware files to the temp folder created earlier.
Click [Save] to open the Save As window. Be sure to select and [Save] the *.exe or *.zip archive file to
the temp folder created earlier.
Otherwise, click [Cancel] to quit and exit the file download process.
2 Extract the firmware files from the downloaded *.exe or *.zip archive file with the user-supplied utility program (if not
already done with File Download > [Open]).
A. For the Base Modem update, a minimum of two files should be extracted:
Fw12864*.bin or Fw-0020534*.bin The base modem bulk image file (where * is the revision letter).
CDM625_ReleaseNotes_v###.pdf (or a variation of this filename, where ### is the firmware version).
B. For the IP Packet Processor update, a minimum of two files should be extracted:
CDM625_ #.#.#_ReleaseNotes.pdf (or a variation of this filename, where #.#.# is the firmware
version).
45
Step Task
3 Confirm availability of the firmware files in the temporary folder. There are a number of ways the user may view the
contents of the temporary folder on a Windows-based PC:
Use Windows Explorer to locate, and then double-left-click the temp folder.
Use the Browse window ([Start] > ...Run > [Browse]) to locate, and then double-click the c:\temp
folder.
B. Using Command-line:
Type cd c:\temp at the prompt to change to the temporary directory created earlier using Command-
line.
Type dir to list the files extracted to the temporary directory from the downloaded archive file.
The firmware files have been successfully downloaded to the user PC and are now available for FTP
upload to the CDM-625.
46
After each FTP, the active image MUST be switched, and the modem MUST be rebooted
from the other image.
Step Task
1 Verify that the Base Modem firmware update has been downloaded to the user PC and is available in the temporary
folder, and ensure that the user PC is properly connected to the CDM-625.
2 Confirm that there is proper connection and communication between the user PC and the modem.
First, determine the IP Address as follows:
Using the front panel SELECT: CONFIG IP Addresses Add/Range
Using serial Remote Control query <0/IPA?
Then, use Command-line to ping the modem:
From Windows, click [Start] on the Windows toolbar, and then select the Run... option (as an alternative, use
the Command-line Prompt or Command Prompt icon in the Start menu):
o Using Win95 or Win98 Type command.
o Using WinNT, Win2K or WinXP Type cmd.
Type ping xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx at the Command-line prompt (where "xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx" is the CDM-625 IP Address). The
results should confirm whether or not the modem is connected and communicating.
3 Use Command-line to initiate the FTP session with the CDM-625.
A. Type "ftp xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx" (where "xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx" is the CDM-625 IP Address).
B. If the optional IP Packet Processor is installed and enabled, enter the User Name and Password when
prompted. Otherwise, press ENTER.
C. Type "bin" to set the binary transfer mode.
D. Type "prompt", and then type "hash" to facilitate the file upload.
If the IP Packet Processor is installed and enabled, type put Fw-0020534*.bin (i.e., as per Step 3(A)
but without typing the destination bulk:).
For either selection, it will take a few seconds to transfer the file.
47
Step Task
5 Observe the file upload process:
A. The PC should report that the file transfer has occurred, and the CDM-625 front panel will display:
B. The process sequences through several blocks this will take several minutes. When it has finished, the
CDM-625 front panel will display:
C. Type bye to terminate the FTP session, and then close the Command-line window.
D. Verify that the new firmware version has uploaded using any of the methods described in Step 2 in Sect.
4.3.1.
E. If you are running a CDM-625 Base Modem without the optional IP Packet Processor, you may now
reboot the system to activate the new firmware. However, if you are running a CDM-625 equipped
with the optional IP Packet Processor installed, do NOT reboot at this time proceed to Step 6 to
continue the Ethernet FTP Upload Procedure.
From the Admin| Reboot web page, click [Reboot Now]. Both the web page and the CDM-625 front panel
will display Rebooting, Please wait...
The system reboot has completed once the CDM-625 front panel displays the top-level splash screen:
If you are a Base Modem user, the CDM-625 is now operating with its latest firmware. The firmware update
process is now complete.
6 Upgrading the IP Packet Processor:
Type "prompt", and then type "hash" to facilitate the file upload.
7 Upload the firmware file from the temporary folder on the user PC:
Type put FW#######*.bin (where ####### is the designated image FW file number 0000342 or 0000438
and * is the revision letter) to begin the file upload.
It will take several minutes to transfer and write the files to flash memory.
48
Step Task
8 Observe the file upload process:
A. The PC should report that the file transfer has occurred, and the display on the modem will report:
Followed by:
B. The process will complete in less than a minute. When it has finished, the modem front panel will display:
C. Type "bye" to terminate the FTP session, and then close the Command-line window.
D. Verify that the new file has loaded into its designated Image slot by viewing the Admin | Firmware | Packet
Processor web page (as per Step 2 in Sect. 4.3.1). Press the PCs F5 key to ensure that the web page has
properly refreshed.
E. Change the desired image to boot using the Admin | Firmware | Packet Processor web page: Use the
Boot From drop-down menu to boot the system from Latest (or the Image slot that was automatically
selected for the FTP upload) then click [Submit] to save this change.
F. Use the Admin| Reboot web page to reboot the system to activate the new firmware:
Click [Reboot Now]. Both the web page and the CDM-625 front panel will display Rebooting, Please wait...
If the Top Card Application has been changed, when booting into a new image an
additional step will occur as the modem downloads to a different flash memory. This
additional upload takes approximately two minutes. The following messages will appear
on the CDM-625 front panel display:
Followed by:
Then:
49
Step Task
8 G. The system reboot has completed once the CDM-625 front panel displays the top-level splash screen:
(cont.)
Comtech CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem
PktP present Ver2.3.1
The Ethernet FTP Upload Procedure is now complete. The CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem is now
operating with its current firmware.
410
5.1 Introduction
See Chapter
Feature Description Function
Section...
1 LED Indicators The LEDs indicate, in a summary fashion, the status of the modem. 5.1.1
The keypad comprises six individual keyswitches. The keys have a
positive click action that provides tactile feedback. Enter data via
2 Keypad 5.1.2
the k eypad. D ata, pr ompts, and m essages ar e di splayed on t he
VFD.
The VFD i s an ac tive di splay s howing t wo l ines of 40 characters
Vacuum
each. It produces a blue light with adjustable brightness. Nested
3 Fluorescent 5.1.3
menus (Figure 5-2) display all available options and prompt you to
Display (VFD)
carry out a required action.
51
Rx (Receive) Green No Rx Traffic Faults (demod and Viterbi decoder are locked, everything is OK).
TRAFFIC Off An Rx Traffic fault exists (the demod may still be OK).
Orange The Unit is in Remote Mode local monitoring is possible, but no local control.
ODU control has been enabled, and there is a communications fault, or there is
REMOTE Flashing
an ODU status fault.
The Unit is in Local Mode remote monitoring is possible, but no remote
Off
control.
Framing on, EDMAC on, and unit defined as Slave local monitoring is
Orange
EDMAC MODE possible, but no local control.
Off No EDMAC, EDMAC Master, or Transparent mode is selected.
52
5.1.2 Keypad
The keypad has an auto-repeat feature. If you hold
down a key for more than one second, the key action
repeats, automatically, at the rate of 15 keystrokes per
second. This is particularly useful when editing numeric
field with many digits, such as frequency or data rate.
Key Description
Use t his k ey to di splay t he ne sted m enu f or a s elected function, or t o ex ecute ( save) a
ENTER
configuration change.
Use t his ke y t o back out of a s election or t o c ancel a c onfiguration c hange t hat has not been
CLEAR
executed using ENTER. Press CLEAR to return to the previous menu screen.
Use these keys to navigate between available selections, or to move the cursor position, on any
(Left, Right) menu screen.
Use these keys primarily to change the alphanumeric selection ( i.e., numbers for configuration
data, l etters f or t ext s trings) at t he c urrent c ursor pos ition, o r to s croll t hrough pr e-defined
(Up, Down)
parameter settings that may be provided at the current cursor position.
53
On most menu screens, you will observe a flashing solid block cursor, which blinks at a once-per-
second rate. This indicates the currently selected menu item, digit, or field. Where this solid
block cursor would obscure the item being edited (e.g., a numeric field) the cursor automatically
changes to an underline cursor.
This screen identifies the modem model, its installed firmware version, and information about
installed hardware options. From any other nested menu, press CLEAR repeatedly to access this
screen.
54
Note that, while emulating a CDM-600 or CDM-600L modem, the I/O responses (including
that of remote query EID?) replicate those of the emulated modem; further, the firmware
version number displayed on the opening screen, and the response from the SWR? remote
query reflects that of the emulated modems firmware version number.
Warm-up Delay Mode counter When selecting the warm-up delay mode, the modem
turns the carrier off during the warm-up time and the countdown message High-
Stability Ref Warming up : ### sec displays on the bottom line of the screen
as follows:
55
Figure 5-2 shows the hierarchal structure of the CDM-625 principle menu tree from the SELECT:
menu on down.
Press ENTER or CLEAR to immediately access the SELECT: menu screen from the opening screen.
From any nested menu, press CLEAR repeatedly until this screen reappears.
The table that follows identifies each menu branch available from the SELECT: menu and its
content section in this chapter. Functionality of each menu sub branch is further explained in
the subsequent chapter sections.
The actual choices displayed in the submenus may vary according to which
FAST options have been activated and enabled. Where a FAST option affects a
menu, this is shown in the descriptive text.
From the top SELECT: menu, use the arrow keys to select from the choices shown, and then
press ENTER to continue.
56
57
Use the arrow keys to select from the submenu choices shown, and then press ENTER. The
submenus available from the Configuration menu are as follows:
This submenu is hi ghly r ecommended f or new us ers, as i t leads you through the
All 5.2.1.1
complete modem configuration process on a step-by-step basis.
Mode 5.2.1.2 Used to select Frame Type and Data Format for Tx and Rx.
Used to select (Quad) Drop & Insert options (NOT SELECTABLE/VISIBLE IN IP-ACM
D&I 5.2.1.6
MODE).
(VersaFEC Adaptive Coding and Modulation) Used to c onfigure ACM operating
ACM 5.2.1.7
parameters. (SELECTABLE/VISIBLE IN PLACE OF D&I IN IP-ACM MODE ONLY).
(DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier) Used t o s elect D oubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier ( CnC)
CnC 5.2.1.8
options.
Misc 5.2.1.10 (Miscellaneous) Used to select, view, or change various other parameters.
(Remote Control) Used to define whether the unit is being controlled locally, remotely,
Remote 5.2.1.12 or via IP, and to configure the serial Remote Control parameters: baud rate, I/O format,
address.
Used t o c onfigure v arious I P par ameters, i ncluding I P addr ess, gat eway, M AC
IP 5.2.1.13
addresses, VLAN, and QoS.
Only one method of remote access may control the modem at a time. The modem
may be monitored over the remote control bus at any time (i.e., queries only), and
the front panel may be viewed.
To make configuration parameter changes from the front panel, Local Mode is
required. Via serial remote, Remote Mode is required. Via IP, Ethernet Mode is
required.
58
All = Stop
(Stop, Start)
Use this menu to configure the unit on a step-by-step basis. Every available configuration menu
displays in succession. Use the arrow keys to select Stop or Start, and then press ENTER to
execute. Then:
Use the arrow keys to select, and the arrow keys to edit, parameters as
needed.
Configuration Notes:
59
If selecting a G.703 interface, the data rate menu is restricted to only the
appropriate G.703 rates.
If selecting an IDR framing mode, the data rate choices are limited to only
those rates specified by IESS-308.
The screen shown here depicts an Interface Type menu screen. You may select Interface Type
and Framing for both Tx and Rx from this menu. Use the arrow keys to select the
parameter to edit. The bottom line indicates the available options for the active parameter. Not
all options are always available they depend on other settings or on the modems activated
FAST options.
Interface Notes:
1. The IP-ACM mode choice restricts the available framing types to NONE or EDMACs.
2. The list of available Interface Types includes Audio when a unit ships with the Two
Channel Audio Drop Hardware Option installed. The Audio mode choice permits you
to carry 2 x 32 kbps ADPCM audio as the primary data. This mode restricts the
available framing types to IBS or EDMAC (see the selection table and the
explanations on the next page).
Use the arrow keys to scroll through the available options, and then press ENTER.
If the cursor is on the second parameter the Framing Type the display appears as shown:
Mode:Tx=RS422:NONE Rx=RS422:None
(None IBS IDR D&Is EDMACs ESC++)
510
Use the arrow keys to scroll through the available options, and then press ENTER. The
available Framing Types are as follows:
None ---
o QDI (Quad Drop & Insert) QDI is another variation of D&I that allows up to four E1 terrestrial ports to
(FAST option) be used.
511
5.2.1.3 CONFIG: Tx
On the top line Use the arrow keys to select Tx-IF, Freq, Power, FEC, Mod, Data (Symb
when in IP-ACM mode), or Scrambler, and then press ENTER.
Use the arrow keys to select Carrier, POCO (Power-On Carrier-Off), SpectrumInvert, or Tx
(for Tx Alpha Filter Rolloff Factor), and then use the arrow keys to edit the option setting
(the available choices may be shown in parentheses). Press ENTER when done.
For the Carrier, use the arrow keys to select Off, On, RTI-01s, RTI-02s, RTI-04s, RTI-07s,
or RTI-10s, and then press ENTER when done.
USE THE RTI FEATURE WITH EXTREME CARE! RTI (RECEIVE/TRANSMIT INHIBIT),
when selected, prevents transmission of the Tx carrier until the demodulator is
locked. To avoid shutdown of the Tx Carrier when the demodulator loses lock for
a very short duration, before the transmit carrier is inhibited the demodulator
must be unlocked continuously for the selected time period (1, 2, 4, 7, or 10
seconds).
Enabling RTI does not affect the Internal IF Loopback feature. However, be
aware that, if an External IF Loopback is attempted (i.e., connecting an external
cable from the Tx IF output to the Rx IF input), this will not work! (The Tx carrier
cannot turn on until the demod is locked the demod cannot lock because the
Tx output is off. The net result is that the demod will not lock and the Tx carrier
will not turn on.)
When POCO (Power-On Carrier-Off) is enabled (selected as ON), this feature overrides the
Tx setting to OFF in the event of a power-cycle of the modem. Use with caution.
SPECTRUM INVERT should normally be in the OFF position. For all FEC types
except BPSK, when Spectrum Invert is in the ON position the transmit spectrum is
inverted (which is the same as reversing the direction of phase rotation in the
512
modulator). In BPSK, the time-order of bits out of the FEC encoder is reversed to
make the modem compatible with certain other manufacturer modems.
For the Tx (Tx Alpha Filter Rolloff Factor) selection, you may select 0.25 instead of the
default value of 0.35.
To edit the Tx-IF Frequency, use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit, and then use the
arrow keys to change that digit. The available ranges are 50-180 MHz, and 950-2000 MHz
(L-Band) (FAST option). The resolution is 100Hz. Press ENTER when done.
When you use the ODU menus to configure a BUC LO-frequency, this menu displays a second
line of information:
Use the arrow keys to select the Output Power Mode (top line) or to edit the Output Power
Level (bottom line) and then press ENTER.
On the top line Use the arrow keys to select the Output Power Mode as MANUAL or
AUPC (see next section for conditional selection).
On the bottom line To edit the Output Power Level, use the arrow keys to first select a
digit of the Tx Output Power Level, and then use the arrow keys to change that digit. For Tx
frequencies of 50-180 MHz, the permitted level range is 0 to 25dBm. For 950-2000 MHz
(L-Band), the range is 0 to 45dBm. Press ENTER when done.
513
The AUPC Output Power Mode Is selectable only when the T0x framing is EDMAC, D&I++, ESC++
or D&I. Otherwise, if you attempt to select the Output Power Mode as AUPC, you are blocked
from selecting AUPC and a message displays on the bottom line:
Otherwise, with an appropriate framing type selected, the bottom line appears as shown:
Use the arrow keys to select Target-EbNo-Range or Alarm-Action and then press ENTER.
On the top line To edit the Target Eb/No of the remote modem, use the arrow keys to
select a digit to edit, and then use the arrow keys to change that digit. The default value is
3.0 dB. The upper limit is 14.9 dB.
On the bottom line To edit the maximum permitted increase in power level when in AUPC
Mode, use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit, and then use the arrow keys to
change that digit. Press ENTER when done. The default value is 1 dB. The upper limit is 9 dB,
except when CnC Mode is ON the upper limit value is instead 3 dB.
On the top line To determine the action that occurs if the AUPC causes the maximum output
power level to be reached, use the arrow keys to select None or Tx Alarm.
On the bottom line To determine the action that occurs if the remote demod is unlocked, use
the arrow keys to select Nom-Pwr or Max-Pwr. Note the following:
514
Selection Function
Nom-Pwr (Nominal Power) The output level reverts to the nominal power level set under Manual.
Max-Pwr (Maximum Power) The output level changes to the maximum permitted.
Selecting CnC Automatic Power Control (CnC-APC) mode displays the following menu:
On the bottom line To edit the power output level and the maximum permitted increase in
power level when in APC Mode, use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit, and then use
the arrow keys to change that digit. Press ENTER when done.
Note that, when APC is in an active state, the power level values display in the bottom left as
AUTO.
Enc=Vit (Vit,Seq,TCM,TPC,LDPC,VFEC,ULL)
Reed-Solomon=On (Off, On) ()
Use the arrow keys to select Encoder or Reed-Solomon / Diff Encoder, and then press
ENTER.
On the top line Use the arrow keys to select an available Encoder option (shown in
parentheses), and then press ENTER. The choices are:
None (i.e., uncoded) Vit (Viterbi)
515
1. When selecting None for the Encoder setting, the bottom line of the display changes
from Reed-Solomon to Diff Encoder (Differential Encoding).
2. The TPC (Turbo) and LDPC encoding selections display only when the optional
TPC/LDPC Codec is installed.
3. The VFEC and ULL encoding selections display only when the optional VersaFEC Codec
is installed.
On the bottom line When Reed-Solomon is selectable, use the arrow keys to select On or
Off. Press ENTER when done.
Use the arrow keys to select one of the listed parameters, and then press ENTER. Possible
selections, depending on the Framing mode, are as follows:
IESS-310, open or closed network 219/201
Enc=None(Vit,Seq,TCM,TPC,LDPC,VFEC,ULL)
Diff Encoder=On (Off,On) ()
516
Mod=QPSK (B,Q,OQ,8PSK,16Q,8QAM)
FEC Rate=1/2 (1/2,3/4,7/8) ()
Use the arrow keys to select the Modulation type (top line) or the FEC rate (bottom line),
and then use the arrow keys to change that parameter selection. The Encoder type dictates
the Modulation Type and FEC rate choices:
If selecting TPC from the FEC menu with TPC/LDPC Codec installed, the options appear as
shown:
If selecting VFEC from the FEC menu with VersaFEC Codec installed, the options appear as
shown:
Mod=BPSK (B,Q,8QAM,16QAM) ()
FEC Rate=0.488 (Fixed)
If selecting ULL from the FEC menu with VersaFEC Codec installed, the options appear as shown:
517
Mod=BPSK (B,Q) ()
FEC Rate=0.493 (Fixed)
Use the arrow keys to select Tx Data Rate or Tx Sub-Mux, and then press ENTER.
If Tx Sub-Mux is ON, this menu provides read-only IP Info Rate information on the bottom line:
Use the top line to edit the Tx Data Rate. The bottom line permits selection of the Data Inversion
or the Clock Inversion features (added for compatibility with certain older equipment).
On the top line To edit the Tx Data Rate, use the arrow keys to select the digit to edit,
and then use the arrow keys to change that digit. Press ENTER. when done.
The maximum limits for the Tx Data Rate are 18kbps to 25Mbps. The actual minimum and
maximum data rates are dependent on Framing mode, Interface type, Modulation type and FEC
Code Rate. If you change any of the higher-priority parameters causing the data rate to
become invalid the Data Rate adjusts automatically. The installed FAST option(s) also dictate
the upper range of data rate.
When configuring for D&I or IDR framing or for G.703 interface type, the arrow keys scroll
through only the available data rates. If you edit the data rate to 1920 kbps while in D&I
framing, a message appears to indicate that E1 Fixed Channel Mode is implemented.
When using G.703, three auxiliary rates (512, 1024 and 2048 kbps) are also available, indicated
by the word AUX appearing to the right of the decimal place (for example, 00512.AUX
kbps).
AUX G.703 Data Rate Connectors Reference: Sect. 3.3.2.5 G.703 IDI (Insert Data In),
DDO (Drop Data Out) Connectors in Chapter 3. REAR PANEL CONNECTOR PINOUTS
518
Note that in QDI (Quad D&I) mode, these data rates are read-only! The data rate is the sum of
the tributary rates for all ports. You must edit them via the QDI menu.
On the bottom line To set the Data Invert or Clock Invert operation, for either, use the
arrow keys to select On or Off. Press ENTER when done.
Use the arrow keys to select the desired ratio, and then press ENTER. There are a total of
34 ratio options available:
1/59 1/39 1/19 1/9 1/8 1/7 1/6 1/5 1/4
Take care to note that the use of IP-ACM is a fundamental departure from the way you would
typically configure the modem. When IP-ACM mode is active, the CONFIG: Tx menu changes the
Data option to Symb.
Use the arrow keys to select TxSymbolRate, Data Invert, or Clock Invert, and then press
ENTER.
On the top line To edit the Tx Symbol Rate, use the arrow keys to first select the digit to
edit, and then use the arrow keys to change that digit. Press ENTER when done.
On the bottom line To edit the Data Invert or Clock Invert: For either, use the arrow keys
to select On or Off, and then press ENTER.
519
Use the arrow keys to select Normal, IESS, or Off, and then press ENTER.
The modem automatically selects the actual scrambler used for Normal, depending on the exact
operating mode:
If Reed-Solomon is on but IBS/D&I is off, its frame synchronous scrambler is used per
IESS-310, App. H. An exception to this is legacy EF Data Reed-Solomon, which uses a
proprietary modified V.35 scrambler instead.
If configured for TPC (Turbo) encoding and all of the above settings are off, the TPC
frame scrambler is used except for 8-QAM.
For CDM-570 compatibility, TPC with 8-QAM uses the V.35 scrambler.
ITU V.35 scrambler (Intelsat variant) is the default scrambler when all of the above
settings are off.
When selecting IESS, the default ITU V.35 scrambler specified in IESS-315 takes priority over all
normal scramblers and is used instead. Therefore, for many operating modes, the two
scrambler choices are redundant.
When using TPC and Carrier-in-Carrier simultaneously, the IESS-315 (V.35) scrambler is the only
permitted choice.
520
5.2.1.4 CONFIG: Rx
On the top line Use the arrow keys to select RxIF, Freq, FEC, Demod, Data (Symb when in
IP-ACM Mode), Descram, Eq, or EbNo, and then press ENTER.
When Sub-Mux is ON, the Data Rate information on the bottom line of this display
is replaced by Composite Rate information.
Use the arrow keys to select Acquisition Sweep Range or Spectrum Invert (available
options are shown in parentheses).
The Acquisition Sweep Range value determines the amount of frequency uncertainty the
demodulator will sweep over in order to find and lock to an incoming carrier. When operating at
low bit rates, large values of sweep range (compared to the data rate) cause excessively long
acquisition times. For example, when selecting 32 kHz with a data rate of 2.4 kbps, BPSK will
result in an average acquisition time of around 3 minutes.
Use the arrow keys to edit the setting in 10 kHz increments, and then press ENTER. The Rx
symbol rate determines the Sweep Range limits:
Use the arrow keys to set Spectrum Invert as Off or On, and then press ENTER.
521
To edit the Rx Frequency, use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit, and then use the
arrow keys to change that digit. The available frequency ranges are 50-180 MHz, and 950-2000
MHz (L-Band) (FAST option). Press ENTER when done.
When you use the ODU menus to configure a LNB LO-frequency, this screen displays a second
line of information (this example uses low-sided mix):
Dec=Vit (Vit,Seq,TCM,TPC,LDPC,VFEC,ULL)
Reed-Solomon=Off (Off,On) ()
Use the arrow keys to select Decoder or Reed-Solomon / Diff Encoder, and then press
ENTER.
On the top line Use the arrow keys to select an available Decoder option (shown in
parentheses), and then press ENTER. The choices are:
None (i.e., uncoded) Vit (Viterbi)
1. If selecting None for the Encoder setting, the bottom line of the screen
changes from Reed-Solomon to Diff Encoder (Differential Encoding).
2. The TPC (Turbo) and LDPC encoding selections display only when the optional
522
3. The VFEC and ULL encoding selections display only when the optional
VersaFEC Codec is installed.
On the bottom line When Reed-Solomon is selectable, use the arrow keys to select On or
Off, and then press ENTER.
Use the arrow keys to select an available parameter, and then press ENTER. Depending on
the Framing mode, possible selections are as follows:
IESS-310, open or closed network 219/201
IBS or D&I 126/112
EDMAC or EDMAC2, closed network 200/180
IDR, open network 225/205, 219/201 or 194/178
ESC++ or D&I++, closed network 126/112
Unframed closed network:
Comtech standard 220/200
Legacy EF Data 225/205, with V.35 scrambling
Otherwise, when Diff Encoder is selectable, use the arrow keys to select On or Off, and
then press ENTER.
Enc=None (None,Vit,Seq,TCM,TPC,LDPC,VFEC)
Diff Encoder=On (Off,On) ()
523
Demod=QPSK (B,Q,OQ,8PSK,16QAM)
FEC Rate=1/2 (1/2,3/4,7/8) ()
Use the arrow keys to select Demod (top line) or FEC Rate (bottom line), and then press
ENTER. Then, for either, use the arrow keys to select the setting. The Decoder type dictates
the FEC Rate choices:
If selecting TPC from the FEC menu with TPC/LDPC Codec installed, the options appear as
shown:
If selecting VFEC from the FEC menu with VersaFEC Codec installed, the options appear as
shown:
Demod=BPSK (B,Q,8QAM,16QAM) ()
FEC Rate=0.488 (Fixed)
524
If selecting ULL from the FEC menu with VersaFEC Codec installed, the options appear as shown:
Demod=BPSK (B,Q) ()
FEC Rate=0.493 (Fixed)
Use the arrow keys to select Rx Data Rate or Rx Sub-Mux, and then press ENTER.
If Rx Sub-Mux is ON, this menu provides read-only IP Info Rate information on the bottom line,
as shown:
Use the top line to edit the Rx Data Rate. The bottom line permits selection of the Data
Inversion or the Clock Inversion features (added for compatibility with certain older equipment).
On the top line To edit the Rx Data Rate, use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit, and
then use the arrow keys to change that digit. Press ENTER when done.
The maximum limits for the Rx Data Rate are 18kbps to 25Mbps. The actual minimum and
maximum data rates are dependent on Framing mode, Interface type, Modulation type and FEC
Code Rate. If you change any of the higher-priority parameters causing the data rate to
become invalid the Data Rate adjusts automatically. The installed FAST option(s) also dictate
the upper range of data rate.
When configuring for D&I or IDR framing or for G.703 interface type, the arrow keys scroll
through only the available data rates. If you edit the data rate to 1920 kbps while in D&I
framing, a message appears to indicate that E1 Fixed Channel Mode is implemented.
When G.703 is used, three auxiliary rates 512, 1024, and 2048 kbps are available as indicated
by the word AUX appearing to the right of the decimal place (for example, 00512.AUX
kbps).
525
AUX G.703 Data Rate Connectors Reference: Sect. 3.3.2.5 G.703 IDI (Insert Data In),
DDO (Drop Data Out) Connectors in Chapter 3. REAR PANEL CONNECTORS AND
PINOUTS.
Note that, in QDI (Quad D&I) mode, these data rates are read-only! The data rate is the sum of
the tributary rates for all ports, and you must the data rate via the QDI menu.
On the bottom line To edit the Data Invert or Clock Invert operation: For either, use the
arrow keys to select On or Off, and then press ENTER.
Use the arrow keys to select the desired ratio, and then press ENTER. There are a total of
34 ratio options available:
Note that the use of IP-ACM is a fundamental departure from the way you would typically
configure the modem. When IP-ACM mode is active, the CONFIG: Rx menu changes the Data
option to Symb.
On the top line To edit the Rx Symbol Rate, use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit,
and then use the arrow keys to change that digit. Press ENTER when done. Note that
asymmetric operation is supported transmit and receive symbol rates do not have to be equal.
On the bottom line To set the Data Invert or Clock Invert operation: For either, use the
arrow keys to select On or Off, and then press ENTER.
526
Use the arrow keys to select Normal, IESS, or Off, and then press ENTER.
The modem automatically selects the actual scrambler used for Normal, depending on the exact
operating mode:
If Reed-Solomon is on but IBS/D&I is off, its frame synchronous scrambler is used per
IESS-310, App. H. An exception to this is legacy EF Data Reed-Solomon, which uses a
proprietary modified V.35 scrambler instead.
If configured for TPC (Turbo) encoding and all of the above settings are off, the TPC
frame scrambler is used except for 8-QAM. For CDM-570 compatibility, TPC with 8-QAM
uses the V.35 scrambler.
ITU V.35 scrambler (Intelsat variant) is the default scrambler when all of the above
settings are off.
When selecting IESS, the default ITU V.35 scrambler specified in IESS-315 takes priority over all
normal scramblers and is used instead. Therefore, for many operating modes, the two
scrambler choices are redundant.
When using TPC and Carrier-in-Carrier simultaneously, the IESS-315 (V.35) scrambler is the only
permitted choice.
Rx Equalizer:
Disabled (Enable,Disable) ()
Use the arrow keys to select Enable or Disable, and then press ENTER. The integrated 5-tap
adaptive equalizer can compensate for:
527
It is particularly useful at higher symbol rates (up to 12.5 Msymbols/second) in situations with
long cable runs between equipment (downconverter and modem, for example).
The Eb/No estimate is performed after the adaptive equalizer block, which provides an easy way
to determine if the equalizer is providing any benefit. If the equalizer is first turned off, the
Eb/No may be viewed on the monitor screen. The equalizer is then turned on, and the Eb/No
viewed on the monitor screen to determine any improvement.
To edit the EbNo Alarm Point, use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit, and then use the
arrow keys to change that digit. The permitted range is from 00.1 to 16.0 dB. Press ENTER
when done.
If the Rx Eb/No falls below this value and the fault is NOT masked, a receive traffic
fault will be generated.
528
Use the arrow keys to select TxClock, RxBuffer/Clock, Clock-Ext, Freq-Ref, or Int-Ref-
Adjust, and then press ENTER.
Use the arrow keys to select from the choices shown in parentheses, and then press
ENTER. Note the following:
Selection Function
Internal (SCT) This is the required setting when the Tx interface type is Audio. Indicates that the unit
will supply a clock to the DTE, which is derived from its internal high-stability source.
Tx-Terrestrial (TT) This is the required setting when the modems interface type is G.703. Indicates that
the unit expects to receive a clock from the DTE, to which the unit can phase-lock its
internal circuits. If no clock is detected the modem will substitute its internal clock and
generate an alarm.
Rx-Loop-timed Allows the modems internal clock to be phas e locked to the Rx buffer clock source.
This output clock is Send Timing. Choosing Rx-Loop does not automatically select Rx-
Sat as t he buf fer c lock s ource. This al lows f or i ncreased f lexibility f or m odem c lock
selection. While you typically should select Rx-Sat, other choices are also available.
This m ode is a vailable to per mit a par ticular v ariation of Loop T iming. In t his m ode,
transmit timing is taken from the TT pins, but ST is active and gives out a copy of the
Rx Satellite Clock.
529
Clk=Rx-Sat (Rx-Sat,TxTerr,Int(SCT),Ins)
Buffer-Size = 00016bytes(00002ms) Center
Use the arrow keys to set the Rx Clock (top line) or the Buffer-Size (bottom line).
On the top line To set the Rx Clock, use the arrow keys to select Rx-Sat, Tx-Terr, Int (SCT),
or Ins, and then press ENTER. Note the following:
Selection Function
Sets the Receive buffer clock source to the satellite clock (the receive buffer is bypassed).
Rx-Sat
Note: This will fix the buffer size to minimum.
Tx-Terr In this timing mode, data is clocked out of the receive buffer using the external transmit clock.
Int(SCT) Data is clocked out of the buffer using the same reference that drives the modem Internal(SCT).
Available only if Rx framing is D&I and Rx interface is G.703. Sets the buffer clock to the Insert
Ins(ert)
stream.
On the bottom line To set the Buffer-Size, use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit, and
then use the arrow keys to change that digit. Press ENTER when done.
Buffer Size indicates the size in bytes (and size in milliseconds) of the Plesiochronous /
Doppler Buffer. The minimum buffer size and step size are usually the same, and are
dictated by the following rules:
530
Use the arrow keys to select Mode or Interface, and then press ENTER.
Use the arrow keys to select None, TxLock, or RxEnable, and then press ENTER. Note the
following:
Selection Function
None All G.703 Clock extension modes are disabled.
The CDM-625 (operating in a non-G.703 mode) locks its transmit clock timing to an externally
TxLock
presented G.703 reference signal.
The CDM-625 (operating in a non-G.703 mode) synthesizes a G.703 timing reference from the
RxEnable
Rx satellite signal, regardless of its actual data rate.
When selecting TxLock as the mode, the transmit timing of the CDM-625 locks to the timing
presented of the interface type selected here.
When selecting RxEnable as the mode, the CDM-625 generates a timing signal of the interface
type selected here.
The two interface types do not need to be the same for a particular link. For
example, if it is required to generate an E1 reference signal at the remote site, but
at the local end only a T1 reference signal is available, this is supported.
531
Use the arrow keys to select one of the two internal reference modes Internal and
Internal (with Output) and then press ENTER.
Internal (with Output) mode uses the internal reference as an output on the rear panel Ext Ref
In/Out BNC connector. This mode is useful if a user wishes to use a single frequency reference
for both the modem and another piece of equipment in the system. When selecting this mode,
an amber LED adjacent to the connector illuminates to alert you that the connector, normally
used as input, now has an output signal present.
Very fine adjustment of the Internal 10MHz Reference is possible when selecting the Internal 10
MHz Reference. The adjustment value is retained in EEPROM memory, and is therefore not lost
when the NVram memory is cleared.
Use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit, and then use the arrow keys to change that
digit. Press ENTER when done.
Changes made to the adjust value are executed immediately upon entry, not after
pressing the ENTER key.
532
2. D&I (Drop & Insert) is not available when IP-ACM mode is selected.
If you configure the modem for Quad Drop and Insert (QDI), then a different menu displays
see Sect. 5.2.1.6.4.
On the top line Use the arrow keys to select the Drp-Type (Drop-Type); its Chan/TS
(Channel Timeslot); or the Loop.
On the bottom line Select the Ins-Type (Insert-Type) or its Chan/TS (Channel Timeslot).
For any of these selections, press ENTER to continue on to that selections submenu branch, and
then use the arrow keys to individually edit those parameters.
533
Drp-Ch: 1 2 3 4
TS: 01 02 03 04
Ins-Ch: 1 2 3 4 5
TS: 01 02 03 04 na
For the Drop-Type or Insert-Type Channel Timeslots, use the arrow keys to select the
Channel to edit, and then use the arrow keys to edit that timeslots value. Press ENTER
when done.
If the data rate is 1920 kbps and the framing is D&I, then only the E1 formats are
available and the Chan/TS menus are disabled. This is the Fixed Channel Mode where
all timeslots are allocated in order. D&I++ does not have Fixed Channel Mode.
If the framing is D&I and Drop/Insert Type is E1-CAS, Timeslot 16 is used solely for CAS
signaling and therefore may not be allocated for traffic data.
Use the arrow keys to select Drop or Insert, and then press ENTER.
The Drop or Insert submenus show information for all four ports of the Drop or Insert sides, and
the cumulative Tx or Rx data rates.
Each port may be allocated between 0 and 32 channels, accumulating to no less than one
channel and no more than 32 channels.
534
Use the arrow keys to select the port to edit, and then use the arrow keys to edit the
number of channels for that port. The cumulative data rate calculates and displays as you edit
the number of channels.
After pressing ENTER, a submenu appears based on the port that the cursor had been on (where
#X is the tributary port number):
Each display can only show up to eight channels. A > character displays at the top right-hand
side of either screen to indicate that there are more channels to view beyond Channel 8 (as
shown in the preceding examples). Use the arrow key to scroll further to more channels.
Use the arrow keys to select a timeslot, and then use the arrow keys to edit that
timeslot value. Press ENTER when done.
535
Use the arrow keys to select the Min(imum) or Max(imum) ModCod range setting. Then,
use the arrow keys to define the range of ModCods (00 through 11) over which the system
will operate. Press ENTER when done.
ModCod 00 is BPSK Rate 0.488 (0.49 bps/Hz), while ModCod 11 is 16-QAM Rate 0.853
(3.41bps/Hz).
If you wishes to constrain the system to run at a fixed ModCod, set the Min and
Max ModCod values to be equal.
The value of Max ModCod may be limited by other FAST codes installed. For
example, suppose the 4100 ksps FAST option is installed, and the symbol rate set
to 4100 ksps, the theoretical maximum data rate would be 14 Mbps at ModCod 11.
However, if CnC is being used, with a 10 Mbps FAST limit the ACM Max ModCod
will be limited to ModCod 7, or 9.6 Mbps.
Use this submenu to establish the desired action when the remote demod loses lock. This is
important, as the ACM system depends on the feedback of the SNR metric from the remote
demod to determine the optimum ModCod. Use the arrow keys to select Go to min Tx
ModCod (recommended) or Maintain Tx ModCod, and then press ENTER.
536
Use the arrow keys to select a margin value from 0.0 to 4.5 dB, in 0.5 dB increments. Press
ENTER when done.
Use the arrow keys to select Mode, Freq-Offset, Search-Delay, or PMSI-control, and then
press ENTER.
On the top line Use the arrow keys to select the appropriate CnC operating mode.
Available selections are:
Off On (normal) APC,Side A,C-band
APC,Side A,X-band APC,Side A,Ku-band APC,Side A,Ka-band
537
With no CnC module (card) installed, CnC Mode is Off, this menu is inaccessible, and the
CONFIG: CnC Mode screen appears as shown:
Use this menu to enter the maximum expected frequency offset between the outbound
interferer and the desired inbound. It normally corresponds to the demod acquisition range.
Use the arrow keys to edit the CnC Frequency Offset value, and then press ENTER. The
upper limit of Frequency Offset is determined by the Rx symbol rate:
To reduce the time taken for the CnC algorithm to converge, you may apply restrictions to the
range of delay used by the search. During initial link testing, it should be set to 240 ms (min) and
300 ms (max). Once CnC has found the exact delay, the value can be further reduced but care
should be taken to allow sufficient range to accommodate changes in path delay due to
Doppler.
If CnC is being bench-tested with two units in a back-to-back configuration, the
minimum delay should be set to 0 ms, and the maximum to 20 ms. This takes into
account the lack of satellite delay.
538
To edit the Min or Max delay, use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit, and then use the
arrow keys to change that digit. Press ENTER when done.
The Pre-Mapped Symbol Interface (PMSI) is an RS-485 multi-drop bus system where one device
transmits and all other devices on the multi-drop bus are configured to receive. Its function, as
associated with DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier, permits the modulator in a selected unit to
provide a direct copy of its output (the outbound interferer) to one or many other modems. The
other modem(s) may then choose to take the PMSI signal and use it for its own CnC reference.
This applies to 1:1 and 1:N systems, and to certain other configurations.
In order to use this mode of operation, you must connect the appropriate cable to the PMSI
connector on the rear panel of each modem:
For 1:N multi-drop applications Use Comtech EF Data cable P/N CA-0000275;
Contact Comtech EF Data Customer Service for further details about either cable.
Use the arrow keys to select the desired PMSI control configuration, and then press ENTER.
Note the following:
Selection Function
Idle Select when CnC is not used.
Redundancy Select when CnC is used in a 1:1 or 1:N redundancy applications.
Select w hen C nC i s us ed i n o ther c onfigurations, or f or m anual t esting ( the m odem w ill
Talk
transmit a copy of its baseband modulated signal on the PMSI port).
Select when CnC is used in other configurations, or for manual testing (the modem will receive
Listen the P MSI s ignal, and l ock its m odulator t o t his, per mitting t he C nC m odule t o us e t he ot her
modems reference outbound interferer).
539
Use the arrow keys to select the mode as Idle, Master, or Slave, and then press ENTER.
If the mode is Master or Slave, the bottom line shows an address. To edit the address, use the
arrow keys to select a digit to edit, and then use the arrow keys to change that digit.
Press ENTER when done. Note the following:
An EDMAC Master is a modem that is local to the M&C computer, and which passes
messages, via the overhead, to a distant-end modem. The Master address always ends
in 0.
An EDMAC Slave is a modem that is not local to the M&C computer. It is at the distant-
end of a satellite link. The Slave EDMAC address always ends in 1. When configured as
a Slave, reconfiguration is expected to be via the EDMAC link, and is therefore not
permitted via the front panel or via serial remote control.
540
Use the arrow keys to select G.703-LineCode, IDR-ESC, HSSI, RTS, Audio-Vol, HiRateESC,
WarmUp, Stats, or MEO and then press ENTER.
Parameters are editable only when the Data Interface Type is G.703.
The choices displayed here depend on the selected G.703 interface type. Use the arrow
keys to select either the G.703 Tx or Rx Ternary Code, and then use the arrow keys to select
the desired code. Press ENTER when done. The available choices are as follows:
Selection For:
AMI
Use this menu to determine if the 64 kbps channel in the IDR Engineering Service Channel (ESC)
overhead, normally reserved for the two 32 kbps ADPCM audio channels, should instead carry
user data. The rear panel Overhead connector provides the appropriate EIA-422 interface for
this option.
541
Use the arrow keys to select the parameter to edit, and then use the arrow keys to
select its setting. Press ENTER when done.
This control setting is applicable only when the Data Interface Type is HSSI.
Use the arrow keys to select HSSI handshake control as TA -> CA loop, RR cntl CA, or TA
cntl Tx, and then press ENTER.
This control setting is effective only when the Data Interface is set for RS-422 or
V.35.
Use the arrow keys to set the RTS/CTS control, and then press ENTER. The available choices
are as follows:
Selection Function
RTS and CTS are looped so that CTS echoes the state of RTS, but RTS does
RTS/CTS Loop, No Action
not control the ON/OFF state of the carrier.
RTS and C TS ar e l ooped s o t hat C TS ec hoes t he s tate of R TS, and R TS
Loop, RTS controls Tx out controls the ON/OFF state of the carrier (i.e., the modem will not bring up its TX
carrier until RTS is asserted).
Use this menu to adjust the gain (or volume) of the audio ESC circuits for both Transmit (Tx) and
Receive (Rx). Use the arrow keys to select the volume to edit, and then use the arrow
542
keys to change the value. The permitted range of the volumes is 6 dB to +8 dB, in 2 dB steps.
Press ENTER when done.
The ESC (Engineering Service Channel) is determined by the framing type (IBS, D&I, or ESC++)
selected under CONFIG: Mode. The High Rate IBS (Engineering Service Channel) requires the
Open Network FAST option. Both Tx and Rx Framing must be configured as IBS or D&I for this
feature to be enabled. When enabled, the lower of the Tx or Rx primary data rate limits the
maximum baud rate, in accordance with the following table:
ESC++ is available as standard. Both Tx and Rx framing must be set to ESC++. When enabled, the
lower of the Tx or Rx primary data rate limits the maximum baud rate, in accordance with the
following table:
Use the arrow keys to select the parameter to edit, and then use the arrow keys to
select its setting. The available choices are as follows:
543
RS-232 or RS-485.
Character format (number of data bits, parity, number of stop bits): 8N1 (8-None-1), 7E2
(7-Even-2) or 7O2 (7-Odd-2).
The High-Stability Reference Module contains an oven for its crystal. During the short time it
takes for the oven and crystal to come up to temperature, frequency accuracy is not
guaranteed.
Use this menu to select a Warm-up Delay that executes upon power-up. This delay is calculated
by the modem and is based on temperature and the amount of time the unit was turned off.
This is much more important at L-Band (950-2000 MHz) than at 50-180 MHz, where the 10 MHz
reference may also be used for RF conversion equipment.
Once this feature is enabled and the modem is powered up, a Warm-Up Delay Countdown is
activated during which time the Tx is suppressed. This countdown displays in decremented
fashion as shown in this example:
The Logging Interval is the period over which performance statistics are to be measured. Use the
arrow keys either to set this interval as 00 to disable the feature (i.e., no logging), or to
select a logging interval, in 10-minute increments, from 10 through 90 minutes. Press ENTER
when done.
544
To view compiled Statistic logs, access the SELECT: Monitor Statistics menu (see Sect.
5.2.2.8 for detailed information about viewing compiled Statistics data).
CDM-625 modems are configurable for continuous pairing as Primary and non-Primary Modems
in an Antenna Handover System when the MEO (Medium Earth Orbit) feature is enabled.
Ethernet data traffic is transmitted and received via the Primary and Non-Primary CDM-625s
four 10/100 Ethernet ports. The Antenna Handover signal received from the user-provided IF/RF
switch determines which modem is the ONLINE or OFFLINE unit:
The ONLINE unit transmits traffic only to the WAN side while, at the same time, the
OFFLINE units Tx is muted.
Both the ONLINE and OFFLINE units receive the satellite traffic, but only the ONLINE unit
forwards traffic to the LAN side while the OFFLINE unit drops the packets.
Any time a unit switches from the OFFLINE to ONLINE state, the traffic destined for the
WAN is buffered, preconfigured in milliseconds (base modem Antenna Handover
delay).
With MEO disabled, the CONFIG: Misc MEO screen appears as follows:
MEO: Feature
Use the arrow keys to select the MEO feature as Disabled or Enabled, and then press
ENTER. Once the MEO feature is enabled, you are returned back to the MEO screen, only now
the Antenna Handover function is visible and available for selection:
Use the arrow keys to select Feature or Antenna Handover, and then press ENTER.
545
First, on the top line Use the arrow keys to select the Antenna Handover operational
control, and to set the DPD (Digital Pre-Distortion) limit.
To set the Antenna Handover operation, use the arrow keys to select operation as
Enabled or Disabled.
To set a value for the DPD limit for this unit, use the arrow keys to select a DPD
value from -13 to (+)13.
Next, on the bottom line Use the arrow keys to set the Antenna Handover switching
mode as Manual or Auto.
Use the arrow keys to select AIS, Buffer, Ref, RxIF, TxClk, TxSat, RxSat, Terr, ROp, BUC, LNB
and CEX, and then press ENTER.
Use the arrow keys to select Tx-Terr-AIS or Rx-Sat-AIS, and then use the arrow keys to
select either as Active or Masked. Press ENTER when done. Note the following:
Selecting Tx-Terr-AIS as Active generates a fault whenever the modulator senses that
the all ones condition is present in the terrestrial data.
546
Selecting Rx-Sat-AIS as Active generates a fault whenever the demodulator senses that
the all ones condition is present in the receive data.
Use the arrow keys to select Buffer Slip Alarm or Reference Alarms, and then typical for
either use the arrow keys to select as Active or Masked. Press ENTER when done. Note the
following:
Selecting the Buffer Slip Alarm as Active generates a Buffer Slip fault in the Rx faults
whenever the receive circuitry senses that the buffer is either underflowing or
overflowing.
Use the arrow keys to select AGC or EbNo and then, typical for either, use the arrow
keys to select the alarms as Active or Masked. Press ENTER when done. Note the following:
Selecting the AGC Rx IF Alarm as Active generates an AGC fault whenever the receive
signal level exceeds 20 dBm (for the desired carrier).
Selecting the EbNo Rx IF Alarm as Active generates an Eb/No fault whenever the
demodulator sees the receive Eb/No fall below the pre-determined value.
Use the arrow keys to select the Tx Clock Alarm as Active or Masked, and then press
ENTER. Note the following:
547
Selecting the Tx Clock Alarm as Active generates a Tx Traffic alarm if a G.703 interface is
active and the input is lost or removed, or if selecting another interface type where the
Tx Clock mode is External and the clock is lost or removed.
To determine how the Tx IDR backward alarm inputs are to be used, the alarm may be disabled
(Off); otherwise, an activated alarm may respond to a hardware input at P5A (H/W) or be
software controlled by a receive fault on the modem (S/W).
Use the arrow keys to select which Backward Alarm is to be configured BWA1, BWA2,
BWA3, or BWA4 and then use the arrow keys to set that alarm as Off, H/W, or S/W.
Press ENTER when done.
Use the arrow keys to select which Rx IDR backward alarms are to be monitored BWA1,
BWA2, BWA3, or BWA4 and then use the arrow keys to select Yes (to monitor) or No (to
mask). Press ENTER when done.
Use the arrow keys to select Terr-Alm Tx or Rx and then, typical for either, use the
arrow keys to set that alarm as Active or Masked. Press ENTER when done.
548
Although selectable/viewable, this mask is reserved for the RAN Optimization option card which,
at present, is not supported. It will be supported in a future release.
When using L-Band, a Block Up Converter (BUC) may be included in the system. A smart BUC
may be monitored and/or controlled via the modem via FSK (Frequency-Shift Keying control).
For a modem in a 1:1 redundancy setup, you must customize the fault indications for the
physical setup.
When using L-Band, a Low-Noise Block Down Converter (LNB) may be included in the system. It
cannot be monitored and/or controlled by the modem, except for the power supply values. For a
modem in a 1:1 redundancy setup, you must customize the fault indications for the physical setup.
Use the arrow keys to select Active or Masked, and then press ENTER.
Selecting Active generates a CEX alarm if the G.703 Clock Extension mode is set to TxLock and
the input is lost or removed from the G.703 interface.
549
Remote Control=Local
(Local,Serial remote,Ethernet) ()
Use the arrow keys to select Local, Serial remote, or Ethernet, and then press ENTER.
If selecting Local, then reconfiguration via Serial Remote or Ethernet is not permitted although
remote monitoring is still possible. If Local or Serial Remote selected, a typical submenu is
displayed proceed to the next section.
If selecting either Local or Serial remote control, use the arrow keys to select Interface,
Address, or Baudrate; then, use the arrow keys to edit the Interface type, Baudrate, and
each digit of the Address. Note the following:
5.2.1.13 CONFIG: IP
Use the arrow keys to select Addresses, SNMP, Setup, ANT, AccessList, or displayed only
when the optional IP Packet Processor card is installed PktP-Enable, and then press ENTER.
Use the arrow keys to select MAC, Gateway, or Addr/Range, and then press ENTER.
550
This read-only screen displays the unit MAC address. Press ENTER or CLEAR to return to the
previous menu.
Ethernet IP Gateway:
192.168.001.002 ()
To edit the IP Gateway Address for the Ethernet M&C port for this unit, use the arrow keys
to select a digit to edit, and then use the arrow keys to change that digit. Press ENTER
when done.
Ethernet IP Address/Range:
192.168.001.002/24 ()
To configure the IP Address for the Ethernet M&C port for this unit, use the arrow keys to
select a digit to edit, and then the arrow keys to change that digit. Press ENTER when done.
SNMP:
Communities Traps ()
Use the arrow keys to select Communities or Traps, and then press ENTER.
SNMP Communities:
Read Write ()
Use the arrow keys to select Read or Write, and then press ENTER.
551
To edit the SNMP Read Community string, use the arrow keys to select a character to edit,
and then use the arrow keys to edit that character.
All printable ASCII characters are available with the exception of the backslash (ASCII code 92)
and ~ (ASCII code 126).
Press ENTER after composing the SNMP Read Community String. All trailing spaces are removed
from the string upon entry.
To edit the SNMP Write Community string, use the arrow keys to select a character to edit,
and then use the arrow keys to edit that character.
All printable ASCII characters are available with the exception of the backslash (ASCII code 92)
and ~ (ASCII code 126).
Press ENTER after composing the SNMP Write Community String. All trailing spaces are removed
from the string upon entry.
Use the arrow keys to select Community, Versions, IP-Addr#1 or IP-Addr#2, and then press
ENTER.
To edit the SNMP Traps Community string, use the arrow keys to select a character to edit,
and then use the arrow keys to edit that character.
552
All printable ASCII characters are available with the exception of the backslash (ASCII code 92)
and ~ (ASCII code 126).
Press ENTER after composing the SNMP Traps Community String. All trailing spaces are removed
from the string upon entry.
Use the arrow keys to select SNMP-ver1 or SNMP-ver2, and then press ENTER.
To edit the SNMP Trap Destinations IP Address, use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit,
and then use the arrow keys to change that digit.
Use the arrow keys to select Mode, WAN, PerPortCnfg, DDMgmtPt, MAC-Learning, VLAN,
QoS, Stats, or displayed only on modems with Hardware Version 2.X or higher FrmSize, and
then press ENTER.
If the optional IP Packet Processor card is installed and enabled, then both the PTP
and VLAN options are selectable but non-functional.
Use the arrow keys to select ManagedSwitch, R-PtoP (Router Point-to-Point), R-MPHub
(Router Multipoint-to-Hub), or R-MPRm (Router Multipoint-to-Remote), and then press ENTER.
553
If the optional IP Packet Processor card is either not installed or installed but
disabled, the mode is Fixed at Managed Switch Mode.
On the top line Use the arrow keys to edit the WAN Buffer Length, and then press ENTER.
The value is configurable from 20ms to 780ms in 20ms increments. Packets are dropped when
the buffer is exceeded.
On the bottom line (read-only) The percentage of the Average WAN Buffer Fill State displays
across a 4-second duration.
If the optional IP Packet Processor card is installed and enabled, this menu is non-
functional and displays as follows:
Per-Port-Config:
Port1 Port2 Port3 Port4 ()
Use the arrow keys to select Port1, Port1, Port1 or Port4, and then press ENTER.
On the top line Pause Frame Flow Control is set on a per port basis; use the arrow keys to
set this control as On or Off (default is Off). To turn Pause on for the selected (active) port, you
must meet the following conditions:
1. Tx Data Rate, or IP Info Rate (if Sub-Mux is on), or a data rate calculated based on
ModCod0 from the Symbol Rate in ACM, must be at least 128 kbps.
554
-and-
2. WAN Buffer Length must be large enough, so that Data Rate in kbps x buffer
length / 4096 24.
The actual negotiated speed (NegoSpeed:) is provided here as a read-only status display.
On the bottom line Use the arrow keys to edit the desired speed setting. Note the
following:
Selection Function
Sets the port speed as Auto Negotiated. This allows the ports to negotiate speed and half/duplex
Auto
operation.
100Full Forces the Port to 100/Full.
Dedicated Management Port mode is not available when the optional IP Packet
Processor card is installed and enabled. Should you attempt to execute this
command under such a configuration, the screen is non-functional, and appears as
follows:
Use the arrow keys to set the Dedicated Management Port as Disabled, or select one of
the Ethernet ports (Port1, Port2, Port3 or Port4). Press ENTER when done.
555
Unit power must be cycled whenever MAC Learning mode is enabled or disabled.
MAC learning:
Off (Off, On) ()
MAC Learning is an Ethernet switch function that allows the LAN (user) side of the Ethernet
ports to learn the MAC addresses of the equipment connected to those ports. Learning applies
only to the LAN (user) side of the Ethernet ports. There is no learning on the WAN (modem) side
of the ports.
If On (enabled), the interface is in LAN-to-WAN learning mode, and the connections are learned
based on source MAC addresses and ingress ports. Once the connections are learned, the switch
will not send any more packets destined to local node over WAN.
If Off (disabled), the interface passes all packets from the LAN to the WAN.
Use the arrow keys to select On (to enable) or Off (to disable) MAC learning. Press ENTER,
and then cycle the unit power.
VLAN Operation Use the arrow keys to first select this operation parameter, and then use
the arrow keys to set VLAN Operation as Disabled or Enabled.
Mgmt-VLAN To configure a Management Ports VLAN ID, use the arrow keys to select a
digit to edit, and then use the arrow keys to change that digit. The value range is from 1 to
4095.
Hold down the arrow keys to quickly scroll between 1 and 4095.
PortMode or VLAN-Table From the VLAN submenu, use the arrow keys to select either
parameter, and then press ENTER.
556
Port Mode:
Port1 Port2 Port3 Port4 ()
Use the arrow keys to select Port1, Port2, Port3 or Port4, and then press ENTER.
Where # denotes the selected Port, use the arrow keys to select the operation parameter.
Then, use the arrow keys to select Access or Trunk.
When Port Mode is selected as Trunk, VLAN ID (PVID) is not applicable. On the bottom line of
the display, the selected ports PVID will display as PVID=N/A.
Otherwise, when Port Mode set to Access, configure the VLAN IDs (PVIDs). To edit the PVID, first
use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit, and then use the arrow keys to change that
digit. Enter a PVID in the range from 0001 to 4095. The default is 0001.
Hold down the arrow keys to quickly scroll between 0001 and 4095.
VLAN Table:
View/Edit/Delete Add-Entry ()
The VLAN table supports up to 32 entries. Use the arrow keys to select View/Edit/Delete
or Add-Entry, and then press ENTER.
To view, edit, or delete existing VLAN IDs, first use the arrow keys to select the desired
parameter:
VLAN ID Selects the tabulated VLAN ID. After selecting VLAND ID, use the arrow
keys to scroll through the available VLAN IDs.
557
ACT Choose an action to undertake for the selected VLAN ID NONE (default), Edit, or
Del (Delete).
P1 (Port1) through P4 (Port4) With ACT=Edit active, you may update the selected
ports behavior attributes, as assigned under the selected VLAN ID.
View, without changing, the behavior attributes assigned to each port under the
selected VLAN ID: ACT=NONE (default).
Edit the behavior attributes assigned to each port under the selected VLAN ID. Once the
VLAN ID targeted for editing is selected, use the arrow keys to select the ACT
parameter, and then use the arrow keys to select ACT=Edit.
Next, to change the behavior attribute of a specific port as needed, use the arrow keys to
select P1, P2, P3, or P4. Then, use the arrow keys to designate the attribute for that port as
Tagged or Filtered for a Trunk port, or Untagged or Filtered for an Access port.
The Untagged option is available only when Port Mode has been set to Access
for the selected port.
You may not designate the behavior attributes for all four ports as Filtered is
this is done, and you presses ENTER to save this configuration change, an error
message will display as follows:
Once the port attributes have been changed (with ACT=Edit active), press ENTER to save those
changes. ENTER must be pressed to save the change. CLEAR will discard the change.
You must take into consideration, when editing VLAN table entries, the following rules:
All Untagged/Tagged packets arriving at the LAN port are tagged (four byte VLAN
frame is added) with the configured VLAN ID.
If the port is in Port Mode, any packet arriving from the WAN that matches this PVID
will have the VLAN tag removed and passed out the Ethernet.
If the port is in Port Mode and the packet does not match the PVID, the VLAN table
must be checked to determine if the packet should pass. Packets leaving a port in Port
Mode are always untagged.
If the port behavior Port Mode attribute is set to Trunk, then the VLAN table is
referenced to determine if the packet should pass. In this mode, packets will either be
filtered (dropped) or passed as is with the VLAN header intact.
558
Delete the selected VLAN ID. After targeting a VLAN ID for deletion, use the arrow
keys to select the ACT parameter, and then use the arrow keys to select ACT=Del.
Press ENTER to execute deletion of the selected VLAN ID.
You must take into consideration that, when deleting VLAN IDs, an entry
associated with an enabled PVID cannot be deleted.
First, use the arrow keys to select the ???? character string following the VLAN ID:
parameter.
Then, use the arrow keys to replace the string with a new VLAN ID.
Hold down the arrow keys to quickly scroll between 1 and 4095.
Next, use the arrow keys to select the port (P1/Port1 through P4/Port4), and then
use the arrow keys to set the behavior attribute for that port as Tagged, Filtered,
or Untagged.
Once you assign the VLAN ID and the port behavior attributes, press ENTER to create
the new entry. You are then returned to the previous menu.
If you attempt to add an entry that is named identically to an existing VLAN ID, an error
message displays as follows:
ERROR: vid already exists in table
If you attempt to add a new entry, and the VLAN table has already reached the 32
maximum allowable entries, an error message displays as follows:
559
You must follow these rules when creating or adding a VLAN table entry:
If a port is not in Trunk Mode (PortMode = Trunk), the behavior attribute for each port
may be set as Tagged or Filtered.
For any VLAN ID (Trunk Mode) created, at a minimum, one port must be
defined as Tagged.
If a port is in Access Mode (Port Mode = Access), the behavior attribute for each port
may be set as Untagged or Filtered.
PVIDs are automatically entered into the VLAN ID Table when changed.
When a new PVID entry is added to the VLAN ID Table, the other ports will default to
Filtered.
When a PVID is changed, the entry in the VLAN ID Table for that port will change to
Filtered. If the rest of the ports are also Filtered, then delete that entry. If any other port
has been marked Tagged, leave the entry in the table.
THE FOLLOWING EXAMPLES OF THE VLAN PORT CONFIGURATION AND ID TABLES ARE
PROVIDED FOR USER REFERENCE:
VLAN ID Table
VLAN ID Port 1 Port 2 Port 3 Port 4
344 Tagged Filtered Tagged Filter
454 Filtered Tagged Tagged Untagged (Access mode)
3400 Filter Tagged Filter Untagged (Access mode)
560
QoS functionality is dependent on whether the optional IP Packet Processor card is either a) not
installed or installed but disabled, or b) installed and enabled.
Use the arrow keys to select the basic QoS setup as L2 QoS or L3 QoS:
Select L2 QoS (Layer 2) when the optional IP Packet Processor card is either not
installed or installed but disabled.
Select L3 QoS (Layer 3) when the optional IP Packet Processor card is installed and
enabled. L3 QoS is required to support IP Packet Processor Managed Switch Mode.
L2 QoS=Off (Off,VLAN,PT,VLAN&Port)
()
Use the arrow keys to set the L2 QoS operational priority, and press ENTER when done. The
choices are as follows:
Selection Function
Off QoS disabled.
(VLAN Priority o nly) QoS traffic prioritization is applied based o n the priority bits in the LAN
VLAN
ingress packets VLAN tag.
PT (Port Priority only) QoS traffic prioritization is applied based on LAN ingress traffic port.
(VLAN and Port Priority) In this mode, if the LAN ingress packet contains a V LAN tag, it will
VLAN&Port
then apply the VLAN Priority scheme; otherwise it applies the port-based priority scheme.
When selecting Port (only) or VLAN&Port, the display updates to include Port Priority on the
bottom line:
To define Port Priority, use the arrow keys to select the port (P1, P2, P3, or P4), and then
use the arrow keys to designate a priority from 1 to 4 (with Priority 4 being the highest).
561
L3 QoS=Off
(Fixed at Off) ()
Otherwise, when the optional IP Packet Processor card is installed and enabled, the L3 QoS
menu appears as follows:
L3 QoS=Off
(Off,Max/Prio,MinMax,DiffServ) ()
To set the L3 QoS operational priority, use the arrow keys, and press ENTER when done.
The choices are as follows:
Selection Function
This screen provides IP traffic statistics for both the In (Ingress) and Out (Egress) directions. Use
the arrow keys to navigate to the proper line, in this order:
First, on the top line Use the arrow keys to select the bottom-line IPstats type as WAN,
Ports 1 through 4, HDLC FPGA, or Management. (In and Out are column labels for the
bottom line parameters and are not selectable.)
Next, on the bottom line Use the arrow keys to view the desired statistical parameter.
The following statistics are available:
562
Tx Dropped
Rx CRC Error
Port 1 *Indicates In only
Unicasts 511 Octets
Port 2 **Indicates Out only
Port 3 Broadcasts 1023 Octets
Port 4
Pause Max Octets
HDLC FPGA
Management Multicasts Jabber*
Undersize Multiple**
Fragments* Single**
64 Octets Deferred**
To clear the IP Statistics accumulators, use the arrow keys to move the cursor to Clr:N;
then, use the arrow keys to select Clr:Y. Press ENTER when done.
This feature is supported only on modems with Hardware Version 2.X or higher.
Use the arrow keys to set 2048-byte Ethernet packet sizes as Enabled or Disabled, and then
press ENTER.
563
Use the arrow keys to select SNTP or PTP, and then press ENTER.
Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) is used to synchronize computer clocks throughout a
computer network when the ultimate performance of the full NTP implementation as per
RFC-1305 (Requests for Comment No. 1305: Network Time Protocol, Version 3, Specification,
Implementation and Analysis) is not needed or justified.
On the top line Use the arrow keys to select SNTP as Enabled or Disabled. If Enabled,
SNTP contacts the time server to update the Real-Time Clock (RTC) every 24 hours. If Disabled,
no such notifications take place.
On the bottom line Use the arrow keys to first navigate to the bottom line, and then
select the Primary or Backup Server submenu. Pressing ENTER to continue:
(Where [######] Time Server denotes Primary Time Server or Backup Time Server):
On the top line To edit the selected Time Servers IP Address, use the arrow keys to select
a digit to edit, and then use the arrow keys to change that digit.
On the bottom line this read-only field displays the time and date that the selected server was
last updated. The time is shown in military format (HH:MM:SS); the date is shown in DAY-
MONTH-YEAR format in accordance with European convention. This line specifies Never if no
update information exists.
564
Sect. 16.7.2 Precision Time Protocol (PTP) (Chapter 16. ETHERNET NETWORK
MANAGEMENT)
1. If the optional IP Packet Processor card is installed and enabled, then the
CONFIG: IPANTPTP menu and its available submenus and operations
described hereafter, while selectable, are not functional.
2. All network devices between the Grandmaster and Slave devices must support
PTP for sub-microsecond accuracy.
Precision Time Protocol (PTP) is a FAST-activated feature used to synchronize computer clocks
throughout a computer network. On LANs, PTP achieves clock accuracy in the sub-microsecond
range much more accurate than what is attainable by NTP (Network Time Protocol) and it is
also used in network applications where GPS is either unaffordable or inaccessible.
On the top line Use the arrow keys to select PTP as Enabled or Disabled. Then, use the
arrow keys to first navigate to the bottom line. Use the arrow keys to select the PTP
Grandmaster as follows:
Selection Function
LAN The LAN port receives messages from the PTP master.
WAN The WAN port receives messages from the PTP master.
Use this menu to restore SNMP/HTTP access if your own IP Address is inadvertently
excluded from the Host Access List while configuring the list through either the
SNMP or Web Server (HTTP) interface.
The Host Access List allows a user to define which remote clients can connect when the Access
List is enabled. Each entry allows a user to specify an IP address and a subnet mask to define a
unique class of machines that are allowed access.
565
After defining and enabling an access list via SNMP or the CDM-625 Web Server interface
Admin | Access page, functionality of this menu appears as follows:
Use the arrow keys to select N (No) to maintain the active Host Access List, or Y to disable
the list. Press ENTER when done. Once disabled, the following message appears whenever this
menu is selected:
This menu is visible/selectable only when the optional IP Packet Processor card is
installed.
Use the arrow keys to select the card as Ena(bled) or Dis(abled), and then press ENTER. The
modem will automatically reboot after this configuration change. Note the following:
When the IP Packet Processor is disabled, the card and its accompanying functionality is
completely bypassed and the modem reverts to its base modem Layer 2 switch
functionality.
566
Use the arrow keys to select Mode, BERT, CnC-APC-Monitor, or Uncorrected-BER, and
then press ENTER.
Select Normal Operation or a Test Mode from the parameters shown in the parentheses. Use
the arrow keys, and then press ENTER, to select one of the following modes:
Selection Function
(Normal) This c lears any t est modes or l oopbacks, and pl aces t he uni t bac k i nto an
NORM
operational state.
(Transmit C W) Use t his test m ode to f orce t he m odulator t o t ransmit a pur e c arrier
Tx-CW
(unmodulated).
(Transmit an al ternating 1, 0,1,0 p attern) Use t his test mode t o c heck t he carrier
suppression of the Modulator This mode forces the modulator to transmit a carrier modulated
Tx-Alt-1/0
with an al ternating 1,0,1,0 pat tern, at the currently selected symbol rate; t his causes two
(Tx-1/0)
discrete s pectral l ines t o appe ar, s paced at half t he s ymbol r ate, about t he c arrier
frequency.
(IF Loopback) Use this test mode to invoke an i nternal IF loop. This is a par ticularly useful
feature, as it permits you to perform a quick diagnostic test without having to disturb external
IF-LOOP (IF) cabling. Furthermore, all of the receive configuration parameters are temporarily changed to
match t hose of t he t ransmit s ide. All pr evious values ar e restored onc e Normal is agai n
selected.
(RF Loopback) Use this test mode to perform a satellite loopback. It is almost identical to the
IF loop mode, except that all receive configuration parameters (except Rx Spectrum Invert)
RF-LOOP (RF)
are temporarily changed to match those of the transmit side; however, no internal connection
is made. All previous values are restored once Normal is again selected.
(Digital Loopback) Use this test mode to invoke a di gital loopback, which loops data at the
Dig-Loop output of the Reed-Solomon encoder on t he transmit side and back into the Reed-Solomon
(DIG) decoder on t he receive side. This tests the entire interface, transmit baseband circuits, FEC
encoder, FEC decoder, and buffer.
(Inward/Outward Loopback) Use this test mode to invoke two distinct loopbacks. The first is
the i nward l oop, w hich t akes dat a bei ng r eceived f rom t he s atellite di rection and pas ses i t
I/O-Loop (IF)
directly to the modulator. Simultaneously, the outward loop is invoked, whereby data being
fed to the transmit data interface is routed directly back out of the receive data interface.
567
Figure 5-3 illustrates the IF, Digital, and I/O Loopback Test modes.
568
Use the arrow keys to select Config or Monitor, and then press ENTER.
Use the arrow keys to select a BERT configuration parameter, and then use the arrow
keys to select a parameter setting. The configuration options are as follows:
Option Selection
Tx/Rx Options Off or On
Pattern Options Space, Mark, 1:1, 1:2, 63, 511, 2047, 2047R, MIL188, 215-1, 220-1, 223-1
Test Description
BER Bit Error Rate
FER Frame Error Rate
To restart either Test, use the arrow keys to select (BER) Reset or (FER) Reset, and then
press ENTER.
569
Note that, when CnC-APC is disabled, this menu is inaccessible and displays the following
message:
CnC-APC is disabled.
()
In order for a valid test run, you must first configure the modem with Viterbi, VersaFEC CCM, or
ULL (Ultra Low Latency) FEC. If the modem is not configured with the required FEC, this screen
displays N/A in the place of a proper test value on the top line, and a configuration advisory
follows on the bottom line:
Uncorrected BER=N/A
Requires Viterbi, VersaFEC CCM or ULL()
Additionally, if the demodulator is in unlocked state, this menu is inaccessible and displays the
following message:
Demodulator is unlocked
570
Use the arrow keys to select Live-Alarms, Stored-Events, ACM, Statistics, Rx-Params,
AUPC, CnC, or IP, and then press ENTER.
Live BUC=None
Alarms LNB=None ()
Six alarm types are available between two screens, as shown in the preceding examples. Use the
arrow keys to navigate between these read-only pages. The highest priority alarm
currently active for each of the alarm types is as follows:
Tx and Rx Synth The PLLs in the IF sections are monitored for an unlocked condition.
Calibration dat a s tored i n E EPROM i s c hecked at pow er-up t o v erify
Power Cal that the factory calibration has not been corrupted.
571
BER >10E-3 This error rate monitor is enabled for IBS and IDR framing.
Loss of T x m ultiframe oc curs i n E 1-CAS D &I oper ation, w hen t he
Loss TxMul multiframe marker for CAS signaling data cannot be found.
An A IS condition i n t he s ignaling pos itions of an i ncoming E 1-CAS
Tx Sig AIS frame is monitored.
Indicates t he pr esence of t he Tx t errestrial r emote al arm on t he
Tx Terr RM incoming T1 or E1 frame.
Indicates t he pr esence of t he I BS satellite r emote al arm ( backward
IBS Rx Rem alarm) on the incoming IBS frame from the transmit side of the link.
Multi-destination backward al arms ar e t he c orresponding s atellite
IDR Rx BW1-4 alarms used by the IDR frame structure.
Backward alarms 1-4 indicate that the hardware inputs available on the
IDR Tx BW1-4 back panel of the modem have t riggered, resulting in the generation,
by the modems IDR framer, of a corresponding Tx backward alarm.
BUC
Appendix F. CDM-625 ODU (TRANSCEIVER, BUC, LNC) OPERATIONS
LNB
An example of a Stored Events screen is shown here. Use the arrow keys to select the #
character on the bottom line, and then use the arrow keys to scroll up and down through
the event log entries. Press ENTER or CLEAR to return to the previous menu.
572
The event log can store up to 255 events. When a fault condition occurs, it is time- and date-
stamped and put into the log. Similarly, when the fault condition clears, this is also recorded.
Use the arrow keys to select Clear-All, and then use the arrow keys to select Yes or
No. Press ENTER when done.
Upon selecting Clear-All=Yes, the event log clears and the modem returns you to the previous
menu. However, if there already are faults present on the unit at this time, they are re- stamped
and new log entries are generated.
This read-only screen provides the active IP-ACM mode information as follows:
Selection Function
If you attempt to access this display when the modem is not in IP-ACM mode, the following
message appears:
This display shows the statistics data that has been measured and recorded. (To enable statistics
logging, see Sect. 5.2.1.10.8.) Use the arrow keys to scroll backwards or forwards through
the statistics log entries. The top line displays the statistics log entry number (the statistics log
can store up to 255 log entries), followed by that log entrys statistical content. The bottom line
indicates the time and date of the entry shown in DAY-MONTH-YEAR format.
573
For statistics logging, you define a measurement interval (see CONFIG: Stats); then, during this
interval, Eb/No, Transmit Power Level Increase (TPLI), and Receive Signal Level (RSL) are
observed at a rate of once every second.
Per the example, at the end of the defined measurement interval period, the modem calculates
statistics data in the order that follows (from left to right on the top line):
(16.0,16.0) First, the Eb/No is calculated: The minimum Eb/No value observed in the
interval is provided first, and then the average Eb/No value observed follows. If the
measured values are 16.0 dB, then 16.0 is displayed.
(9.0,9.0) Next, the TPLI is calculated: The maximum TPLI observed in the interval is
provided first, and then the average TPLI value observed follows.
(16.5,16.5) Finally, the RSL is calculated: The minimum value observed in the interval is
provided first, and then the average RSL value observed follows (note that both values
are negative).
If the demod has lost lock during the measurement interval, the
minimum Eb/No will show LOSS rather than indicate a value
however, the average value (while the demod was locked) will still be
calculated and shown.
If, on the other hand, the demodulator has been unlocked for the entire
measurement interval, the average Eb/No will also show Loss (i.e., the
display will show Loss,Loss).
Example 2:
Loss,04.5,0.0,0.0,29.0,29.0 means:
(Loss) There was a loss of demod lock during the measurement interval
(04.5) Average Eb/No observed in the measurement interval = 4.5 dB
(0.0) Maximum TPLI observed in the measurement interval = 0 dB
(0.0) A verage T PLI obs erved in t he m easurement i nterval = 0 dB (which indicates no
AUPC activity, or that AUPC is disabled.)
(29.0) Minimum RSL is observed in the measurement interval = -29.0 dB
(29.0) Average RSL is observed in the measurement interval = -29.0 dB
574
Press ENTER or CLEAR when done viewing to return to the previous menu, or use the arrow
keys to select the Clear-All option. Then, at the prompt, use the arrow keys to select Yes or
No and press ENTER to implement.
Item Description
This s hows the v alue of Eb/No calculated by t he dem odulator. The v alue r eferred t o her e i s t he
Eb/No
energy per information bit (Ebi), divided by the noise spectral density (No).
F The frequency offset of the received carrier, in kHz, with a displayed resolution of 100 Hz.
The top line displays the value of Remote Eb/No of the demodulator at the distant end of the
satellite link. The Remote Eb/No displays Unlock if the remote Demod is unlocked.
The bottom line shows how much the AUPC system has increased the output power. If AUPC is
not enabled, then the value of Tx Power Increase displays as 0.0 dB.
CnC-Params:PwrRatio=-04.1dB PSDR=+01.9dB
Freq-offset=-123.4kHz Delay=123.4ms
When enabled and locked, the screen displays the CnC performance data. This read-only display
updates once every second.
575
This screen is identical to and displays the same performance information as the screen shown
in Sect. 5.2.1.13.3 CONFIG: IP Setup Stats.
The read-only INFO screens display the modems current configuration information without
risking inadvertent changes.
Use the arrow keys to select All, ID, Mode, Tx, Rx, Clocks, EDMAC, Drop, Insert, Remote,
Alarm-Mask, or Misc, and then press ENTER.
After viewing any Info screen except All: Press ENTER or CLEAR to return to the previous menu.
All = Start
(Stop, Start) ()
Use this menu to scroll through and review configuration settings on a sequential basis. The
configuration displays are read-only no editing is possible.
To view the configurations Use the arrow keys to select between Stop and Start. Press
ENTER to continue through all the displays.
To discontinue viewing Press CLEAR, use the arrow keys to select Stop, and then press
ENTER.
5.2.4.2 Info: ID
This screen displays the 40-character, user-defined Circuit ID string that was created using the
Utility Circuit-ID menu. The Circuit ID also appears in the title bar of compatible web browsers
for easy unit identification.
576
5.2.4.4 Info: Tx
An example of the Tx Info screen is shown here. It displays the following information:
Bottom Data Rate xxxxx.xxx kbps (an asterisk * indicates that the data sense is inverted).
line Modulation BPSK, QPSK, OQPSK, 8-PSK, 8-QAM, 16-QAM.
FEC Rate 1/2, 2/3, 3/4, 7/8, 0.95, 5/16, 21/44 or 1/1.
Scrambler Scrm, None, or IESS (Turbo Only).
5.2.4.5 Info: Rx
An example of the Rx Info screen is shown here. It displays the following information:
577
An example of a Clocks Info screen is shown here. It displays information for Tx Clock, G.703
Clock Extension, Rx Clock, Reference, and Buffer.
EDMAC Function= On
EDMAC Mode= Master EDMAC Addr= 0020
An example of an EDMAC Info screen is shown here. This screen indicates whether or not
EDMAC is enabled and, when EDMAC is enabled, it provides the EDMAC Mode and Address.
An example of an Info Drop screen is shown here. This screen shows the Drop Type and channel
allocations.
When in QDI (Quad Drop & Insert) Mode, this screen displays the same
information as the CONFIG: D&I Drop menu.
578
An example of an Insert Info screen is shown here. This screen shows the Insert Type and
channel allocations. Press ENTER or CLEAR to return to the previous menu.
When in QDI (Quad Drop & Insert) Mode, this screen displays the same
information as the CONFIG: D&I Drop menu.
An example of a Remote Info screen is shown here. This screen shows if the unit is in Local,
Remote or Ethernet (IP) mode. It also displays the electrical interface type selected, the units
address, and the active baud rate.
A sample Alarms Mask Info screen is shown here. Note that, while all available masks are
displayed here, this screen will show only the alarm(s) that are currently masked. For any alarm
that is not masked, a blank space assumes that items designated screen position.
Miscellaneous: Normal
1:1 Switch=Not connected Online
579
First, use the arrow keys to move the cursor to the configuration slot number
(Configuration #X) and then use the arrow keys to select a slot number from 0
to 9.
Next, use the arrow keys to select Load, and press ENTER when done. Modem
operation then updates as per the configuration settings stored in this slot.
Next, use the arrow keys to move the cursor to the configuration slot number
(Configuration #X) and then use the arrow keys to select a slot number from 0
to 9.
Finally, use the arrow keys to select Store, and press ENTER when done.
Once a modem configuration is stored into the designated slot, the time and date are recorded,
and this information appears on the bottom line.
Store Override When storing into a configuration slot that previously had information saved
into the working memory, you are required to confirm the request, as the existing information
will be overwritten:
Use the arrow keys to select the Override choice (Y or N), and then press ENTER.
580
Use the arrow keys to select Set-RTC, Display-Bright, CarrID, LED, Redundancy, Circuit-ID,
Firmware, or Em, and then press ENTER.
To edit the time and date settings of the Real-Time Clock, use the arrow keys to select a
digit to edit, and then use the arrow keys to change that digit. Press ENTER when done.
To edit the brightness of the VFD (Vacuum Fluorescent Display), use the arrow keys to
select a suitable brightness level. The selectable values are 25%, 50%, 75% or 100%. Press
ENTER when done.
Use the arrow keys to select the Carrier ID (MetaCarrier) function as Enabled or Disabled,
and then press ENTER.
581
Use the arrow keys to select Enable or Disable, and then press ENTER to continue. When
enabled, a test of all of the LEDs on the front panel is executed. Normal operations resume upon
completion of the test.
Redundancy:
Traffic-IP-Addr/Range 1:1 1:N
Use the arrow keys to select Traffic-IP-Addr/Range, 1:1, or 1:N, and then press ENTER.
Traffic IP address/Range
192.168.001.001/24 ()
To edit the Traffic IP Address and range, when the modem is part of a 1:1 or 1:N redundancy
application: First, use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit, and then use the arrow
keys to change that digit. Press ENTER when done.
For use when the modem is part of a 1:1 redundancy application (e.g., via a CRS-170A L-Band or
CRS-180 70/140 MHz 1:1 Redundancy Switch) and this unit is currently Online, press ENTER to
cause the unit to switch to Standby (i.e., go Offline).
For use when the unit is part of a 1:N redundant application (e.g., via a CRS-300 1:10
Redundancy Switch). Use the arrow keys to select 1:N Mode operation as Enable or
Disable, and then press ENTER.
582
When the unit is connected to a 1:N switch, a red LED located on the rear panel
labeled 1:N Active! indicates that caution is required, as there may be DC voltages
and other control signals present on certain pins on the 25-pin Data Interface
connector.
To compose a Circuit ID string On the bottom line, first use the arrow keys to select the
alphanumeric character space to edit, and then use the arrow keys to edit that character.
You may use the following characters to compose a Circuit ID string of up to 40 characters in
length or a MetaCarrier Custom Message of 24 characters or less:
Press ENTER once you finish composing the Circuit ID string. As created here, in addition to the
front panel VFD, the Circuit ID also appears in the title bar of compatible web browsers for easy
unit identification.
2. With Carrier ID disabled, the Circuit ID full 40 character length is available for
creation of the unit identification label that displays on the front panel VFD
screen saver and the Web browser title care.
583
Firmware Images:
Base-Modem Packet-Processor ()
Use the arrow keys to select Base-Modem or Packet-Processor, and then press ENTER.
Firmware Information:
Boot-ROM Image#1* Image#2 Select ()
Use these submenus to view information about the CDM-625 Base Modem internal firmware.
This screen identifies the firmware image that is loaded on startup or reboot of the Base Modem
with an asterisk (*). Use the arrow keys to select Boot-Rom, Image#1, Image#2, or Select,
and then press ENTER.
Bootrom: DD/MM/YY
FW/12865X #.#.#
The example shown here is for the Bootrom firmware opening screen. Typical for the Image#1
or Image#2 screens, you may use the arrow keys to scroll through information for all the
constituent firmware blocks that make up the bulk.
This read-only information is provided for: firmware type; its number (where X is the revision
letter); its build date (in day/month/year format); and its version number (e.g., 2.1.0). Press
ENTER or CLEAR to return to the previous menu.
The modem can store two complete firmware images. Use this menu to select which image is
loaded the next time the unit reboots. The top line shows the current active image while, on the
bottom line, you may use the arrow keys to select the other image. Press ENTER when
584
done a message will then prompt you to reboot the unit in order for the newly-selected image
to be loaded upon startup.
This screen identifies the optional CDM-625 IP Packet Processor internal firmware image that is
loaded on startup or reboot of the Base Modem with an asterisk (*).
Use the arrow keys to select Boot-Rom, Image#1, Image#2, or Select, and then press
ENTER.
The example shown here is for the IP Packet Processor Bootrom firmware opening screen.
Typical for the Bootrom, Image#1 or Image#2 screens, read-only information is provided for:
firmware type; its number (where X is the revision letter); its build date- and time-stamps (in
day/month/year and hours/minutes/seconds formats); and its version number (e.g., 1.3.3).
Press ENTER or CLEAR to return to the previous menu.
The modem can store two complete firmware images, and you can select which image loads the
next time the unit reboots. The top line shows the current active image while, on the bottom
line, you may use the arrow keys to select the other image. Press ENTER when done a
message will then prompt you to reboot the unit in order for the newly-selected image to load
upon startup.
585
When emulating a CDM-600 or CDM-600L modem, the CDM-625 opening screen displays the
mode of operation, as per this example:
Note that, while emulating a CDM-600 or CDM-600L modem, the I/O responses (including that
of remote query EID?) replicate those of the emulated modem; further, the firmware version
number displayed on the opening screen, and the response from the SWR? remote query
reflects that of the emulated modems firmware version number.
There are some features that the CDM-625 does not support, and as a result are not possible
while in CDM-600 or CDM-600L Emulation Modes:
BUC leveling;
Impedance;
External Clock.
See Appendix F. CDM-625 ODU (TRANSCEIVER, BUC, LNB) OPERATION for complete
details about this product-specific menu branch.
ODU: BUC:PwrSupply+Ref
LNB:PwrSupply+Ref FSK-control ()
586
Depending on 70/140 MHz or L-Band operation: Use to monitor and control a standalone or
redundant Comtech EF Data RF Transceiver (CSAT-5060 or KST-2000A/B) or LPOD BUC if
connected.
FAST (Fully Accessible System Topology) allows you to enable new options in the modem. Use
the arrow keys to select Options, Demo-Mode, or CnC, and then press ENTER.
You can access the FAST options via three separate internal EEPROM registers. Each register
requires its own FAST access code. Use the arrow keys to select View Options or Set
Registers (to continue via the correct register menu), and then press ENTER.
Use the arrow keys to scroll through the available options. The modem identifies each
selected FAST option as installed or not installed.
You must contact a Comtech EF Data sales representative, during normal business hours or via
e-mail to sales@comtechefdata.com, to purchase the FAST Access Code for the desired option.
Data Rate
587
Modulation:
8PSK/8-QAM
16-QAM
1-port D&I
L-Band
AES Encryption
Where # is the appropriate register #1, #2, or #3: FAST: Options Set Registers is used to
enable new options in the modem on a per-register basis. It is important to use the appropriate
FAST access code for the appropriate register.
Contact a Comtech EF Data sales representative, during normal business hours or via e-mail to
sales@comtechefdata.com, to order the desired options (see Sect. 5.2.7.1.1) be prepared to
provide the Modem Serial Number. The Comtech EF Data Customer Support representative will
588
verify the order and provide an invoice and instructions, including a register-specific 20-digit
FAST Access Code.
Enter the FAST Access Code that you have obtained from Comtech EF Data carefully using the
front panel keypad or, alternately, the CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface:
From the CDM-625 front panel First, use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit,
and then use the arrow keys to change that digit. Compose the code carefully, and
then press ENTER only when you are ready to execute the upgrade.
For Firmware Ver. 1.5.1 or earlier, enter the FAST access code for option
register(s) #1, #2 and/or #3 as required. For Firmware Ver. 1.5.2 and later,
all three FAST access codes must be entered in sequence in order for the
purchased option upgrades to be properly activated.
Repeat the FAST access code entry procedure. Should the code entry error persist,
contact Comtech EF Data Customer Support for further assistance.
From the CDM-625 Web Server Interface See Sect. 6.5.4.2.5 Admin | FAST.
FAST Options Demo Mode allows access to ALL CDM-625 FAST options for 2592000 seconds (30
calendar days). On the top line, use the arrow keys to select Demo Mode as Off or On, and
then press ENTER. The bottom line displays the time remaining the time format is in seconds.
Note the following:
The time count decrements only when Demo Mode is turned On. Demo Mode may be
turned on and off an unlimited number of times until the full 30 calendar days have
expired. Upon expiration of the Demo period, the following message displays:
589
Once the timer decrements to 0000000, FAST Options Demo Mode may no longer be
enabled. Your modem will still function with the purchased FAST enabled features.
If the Demo Mode timer reaches 0000000 while the modem is running a
FAST feature that is not a purchased FAST feature, the modem will fall into
an invalid state, turn off its carrier, and revert all settings to factory default
settings.
FractionalCnC:1-YearCounter=00000000 sec
90-DayCounter= 0000000 sec
Fractional CnC is common in 1:1 or 1:N redundancy systems where the primary modem has a
full CnC license, and the backup modem(s) has a Fractional CnC license. A Fractional CnC licenses
allows 90 full calendar days of CnC usage in one calendar year. This lowers the cost of the
modem but does not allow for constant, round-the-clock operation.
When Fractional CnC Mode is ordered, the number of seconds remaining for both the 1-year
(top line) and 90-day (bottom line) activation timers are displayed here.
As per the previous screen examples, if Fractional CnC is not installed in the CDM-625, the
modem displays a message that no CnC license is installed and provides time remaining and
time remaining refill timers; or that a Full CnC license is installed and the screen displays no
timers. Note the following:
1-YearCounter This is the calendar year counter, in seconds, that resets the 90-
DayCounter to 90 full days of CnC usage when it reaches 00000000. This counter continually
decrements and accounts for time even when the modem is powered Off. Once this timer
fully decrements, the 1-YearCounter resets to 31536000 once again and immediately begins
to decrement.
The 1-Year Counter cannot be reset or refilled in the field. Once the timer has
run out, your only options are to:
Using Fractional CnC is not a normative mode of operation. To best inform you
that your modem is running Fractional CnC (i.e., the 1-YearCounter counter
590
o The front panel RED Unit Status LED will blink on and off.
o The modem generates an Event in the Event Log every 12 hours that
indicates Fractional CnC is running.
90-DayCounter This is the amount of time, in seconds, that that the modem can be run in
CnC mode. This counter decrements under the following conditions:
o The modems TX is On
o The modem is NOT in Demo Mode. If the timer reaches 00:00:00:00, the modem
will turn its TX Off and the circuit will be down.
591
Notes:
592
When Dedicated Management is disabled, you may use any port for Ethernet-based
remote product management (monitor and control) purposes.
When Dedicated Management is enabled, you may use only that specific port for remote
monitor and control (M&C) purposes.
Telnet Interface This requires use of a user-supplied terminal emulation program such as
HyperTerminal (for use with the remote control protocol) or PuTTY (for use with the Telnet
Command Line Interface), installed on the user PC.
CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface This requires a compatible user-supplied web
browser such as Internet Explorer, installed on the user PC.
61
The managed device This includes the CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem.
The SNMP Agent The software that runs on the CDM-625. The CDM-625 SNMP Agent
supports both SNMPv1 and SNMPv2c.
The user-supplied Network Management System (NMS) The software that runs on
the manager.
MIB File/Name
Description
(where * is revision letter)
FW10874-2*.mib ComtechEFData MIB file gives the root tree for ALL Comtech EF Data products
ComtechEFData Root MIB file and consists of only the following OID:
Name:comtechEFData
Type:MODULE-IDENTITY
OID:1.3.6.1.4.1.6247
Full path:
iso(1).org(3).dod(6).internet(1).private(4).enterprises(1).comtechEFData(6247)
Module: ComtechEFData
FW-0000083*.mib
MIB file consists of all of the OIDs for management of the modem functions
CDM-625 MIB file
FW-0000084*.mib
Trap MIB file is provided for SNMPv1 traps common for modem.
CDM-625 Traps MIB file
FW-0000345*.mib MIB file consists of all of the OIDs for management of the optional IP Packet
IP Packet Processor MIB file Processor functions.
FW10874-8*.mib
MIB file consists of all of the OIDs for management of the CSAT-5060 Transceiver
CSAT-5060 Transceiver MIB
connected to the CDM-625 modem through FSK.
file
FW10874-9*.mib
MIB file consists of all the OIDs for management of the KST-2000A/B Transceiver
KST-2000A/B Transceiver connected to the CDM-625 modem through FSK.
MIB file
MIB file consists of a subset of the CDM-625 MIB with all OIDs used manage to a
FW-0000165*.mib
distant-end CDM-625. SNMP "gets" and "sets" are sent to the local CDM-625 and
DistantEnd CDM-625 MIB file
EDMAC3 is used to communicate efficiently with the distant end modem.
62
In SNMP v1/v2c, the SNMP Community String is sent unencrypted in the SNMP
packets. Caution must be taken by the network administrator to ensure that SNMP
packets travel only over a secure and private network if security is a concern.
The CDM-625 uses Community Strings as a password scheme that provides authentication
before gaining access to the modem agents MIBs. They are used to authenticate users and
determine access privileges to the SNMP agent.
Type the SNMP Community String into the user-supplied MIB Browser or Network Node
Management software.
For proper SNMP operation, the CDM-625 MIB files must be used with the
associated version of the CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem M&C. Refer to the
CDM-625 FW Release Notes for information on the required FW/SW compatibility.
For the trap to work, the modem must be in Ethernet remote mode, and it must
have the Trap IP Address properly configured.
You only need to compile the Traps file if you intend to use SNMPv1 traps. You may configure
which style of traps the modem sends by using the CDM625SNMPTrapVersion OID.
63
The CDM-625 supports the following Alarms and Faults SNMPv1 traps / SNMPv2 notifications:
64
The Telnet interface requires login at the Administrator and Read/Write User Access Levels. An
example of the login process is shown here:
Once logged into the Telnet interface as the Administrator, the standard Remote Control
interface defined in Appendix D. REMOTE CONTROL is accessible, as shown here:
65
line Target-to-Controller response (e.g., the response to the FRW? query) will be displayed as
one line, with the latter lines overwriting the previous lines.
In order to view the full response messages, use of the HyperTerminal terminal emulation
program configured as a Telnet client is permissible.
2. For ASCII Setup (File Properties Settings ASCII Setup), as shown above at the far
right:
A) Check the "Send line ends with line feeds" option in the ASCII Sending section.
B) Check the "Append line feeds to incoming line ends" option in the ASCII Receiving
section.
Examples of login and remote command/query execution, when using HyperTerminal as the
interface, appear as follows:
66
6.4.2 Using the Telnet Interface for Telnet Command Line Interface (CLI)
Operation
1. The CDM-625 Telnet Command Line Interface (CLI) is accessible only when the
optional IP Packet Processor is installed and enabled.
2. The CDM-625 Telnet CLI uses Telnet TCP Port 107. Be sure to specify this port
when configuring your terminal emulator for CLI operation.
3. The HyperTerminal terminal emulator, while compatible for use with remote
control operations, is not supported or recommended for CDM-625 Telnet CLI
operation. Instead, for best results Comtech EF Data recommends PuTTY or
Tera Term or as the preferred terminal emulators (Figure 6-1).
67
Admin comtech/comtech
Read/Write opcenter/1234
Read Only monitor/1234
To properly access the CDM-625 Web Server Interface, you must first configure remote control
access for the unit to Ethernet mode. If you attempt to log in to the Web Server Interface and
68
remote control for the CDM-625 has not been set to Ethernet mode, access is blocked and the
following error message displays in the browser window:
Click [Enable Ethernet Mode] to switch over from your current mode to Ethernet Mode.
Alternately, From the CDM-625 front panel, use the arrow keys to navigate to, and the
arrow keys to edit, the remote control configuration menu (press ENTER when done):
6.5.2.1 Navigation
The CDM-625 Web Server Interface features navigation tabs
located at the top of each page. After you click a navigation
tab, you may click an available primary page tab. In turn, any
nested tabs appear for further selection.
This manual uses a naming format for all pages to indicate the depth of navigation needed to
view the subject page: Top Level Tab | Primary Page Tab | Nested Tab.
For example: Admin | Firmware | Base Modem is interpreted to mean first click the top-
level Admin navigation tab; then, click the Firmware primary page tab; finally, click the nested
Base Modem tab.
This manual explains the purpose and operation for each Web page on a per-page, per-section
basis.
69
If you edit a field, make sure to click the action button before you leave the page.
If you go to another page without first clicking the action button, your changes are
not saved.
For any text box, left-click anywhere inside the box, type the
desired information into that field, and be sure to press
[ENTER] when done.
If you edit any field, make sure to click the action button before you leave the
page. If you go to another page without first clicking the action button, your
changes are not saved.
610
Pages marked with double asterisks (**) are operable only when the specified
auxiliary products, such as BUCs or LNBs, are installed.
The menu tree diagram (Figure 6-2) lists the features available through the CDM-625 Web Server
(HTTP) Interface. This interface features six navigation tabs (shown in blue). Primary page tabs
(green) and nested page tabs (yellow) provide access to individual Web pages. Click any
navigation tab to continue.
Figure 6-2. CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface Menu Tree (FW Ver. 2.3.1)
611
A significant number of pages in the CDM-625 Web Server Interface address operation of the
CDM-625 when equipped with the optional IP Packet Processor card. These pages are accessible
only when the optional IP Packet Processor card is installed and enabled.
As specified in Sect. 6.5.1, access to these pages is further restricted to Admin (administrative)
users only. If a user with Read/Write or Read Only user access privileges attempts to select
any IP Packet Processor-specific page, access to that page is prohibited and either of the
following error messages may display in the browser window:
-or-
Once logged in, if the Admin user attempts to access any IP Packet Processor-specific page when
the optional IP Packet Processor card is not installed, the following message displays:
If the Admin user attempts to access these pages when the optional IP Packet Processor card is
installed but card operation is Disabled, the following message displays:
Click [Back to previous page] to continue any other available operations, or go to the Packet
Processor drop-down list (in the Network Configuration section of the Configuration | LAN | IP
page) to select its operation as Enabled (the modem will automatically reboot).
612
The CDM-625 Web Server Interface menu tree diagram (Figure 6-2) indicates those primary and
nested IP Packet Processor pages having conditional access and operation with an asterisk (*).
Further, each interface page subsection (under Sect. 6.5.4 Web Server Page Descriptions)
governed by such restrictions contains an advisory note similar to this example:
These pages are accessible only to Admin users and when the optional IP Packet
Processor card is installed and enabled. See Sect. 6.5.3.1 for complete details
about using these conditional access pages.
613
614
This page uses SMTP (Simple Mail Transport Protocol) to compose and send e-mail messages
about the modem to Comtech EF Data Modem Support (cdmipsupport@comtechefdata.com).
Contact Information
Use this section to provide your contact information to Comtech EF Data when you submit a
Problem Report.
Problem Report
Use this section to compose a message of up to 256 characters maximum to Comtech EF Data.
Be sure to provide your Contact Information, and then click [Submit Email] to send the
message.
615
The Admin pages are available only to users who have logged in using the
Administrator Name and Password.
Click the Access, SNMP, Firmware, Reboot, FAST, or Utilities tab to continue.
SMTP Server Specify the mail server IP Address from where e-mail may be sent.
SMTP Domain Name / Destination The Administrator can assign the SMTP Domain Name
and Destination. This is required if the e-mail feature of the Home | Support page (Sect.
6.5.4.1.3) is to be used.
616
o SMTP Domain Name Specify the domain of the e-mail server (usually found to the
right of the @ symbol in an e-mail address).
o SMTP Domain Destination Specify the e-mail recipient name (usually found to the left
of the @ symbol in an e-mail address).
For example, if a user wanted to grant access to a PC with an IP Address of 10.10.10.1 and
any PC on a subnet of 192.168.10.XXX, and then the Access List would be defined as:
IP 1 / Mask 10.10.10.1/32
IP 2 / Mask 192.168.10.0/24
The check box before the IP (#) / Mask must be checked in order for that list
entry to take effect.
Access List The Access List allows a user to grant access via HTTP and SNMP to a defined
list of client machines.
Use the drop-down to select Enable or Disable. If Disable is selected, then any client
machine will be able to connect via HTTP and SNMP.
617
The Administrator must use this page to set and return administration information for the
CDM-625 SNMP (Simple Network Management Protocol) feature.
SNMP
Simple Network Management Use the drop-down list to select as Disabled or Enabled.
Enable Authentication Trap Use the drop-down list to select as Disable or Enable.
618
Click the Base Modem tab, or when the optional IP Packet Processor card is installed, the Packet
Processor tab to continue.
Boot
This window identifies the firmware number, version, and release date that is loaded upon
power-up/boot up of the unit.
Image 1 / Image 2
These scrollable windows identify the Firmware numbers, versions, and release dates that
comprise the aggregate image load.
619
Use this page to view the status window for the optional IP Packet Processors currently loaded
firmware, and to set the firmware load preference for the IP Packet Processor upon power-
up/reboot of the unit.
Firmware
(Read-only) The IP Packet Processors Bootrom, Image 1, Image 2, and current Running
image are identified here.
Boot From Use the drop-down list to boot the IP Packet Processor from Latest, Image 1, or
Image 2, and then click [Submit] to save this selection.
620
Click [Reboot Now] to perform the soft reboot of the CDM-625. The page updates to indicate
the reboot in progress as follows:
Depending on the number of installed hardware and firmware options, it may take up to one
minute for soft reboot to execute. Once the CDM-625 splash screen appears on the front
panel VFD, you must log in to begin a new Web Server Interface session:
2. Upon reboot, you will need to refresh your browser window. Once the Login
window appears, type in your User name and Password.
3. Click [OK] in the Login window; the browser window will refresh to show the Web
Server Interface splash (Home) page.
621
The CDM-625 has a number of optional features that may be activated after the units purchase.
Fully Accessible System Topology (FAST) Access Codes are register-specific authorization codes
that may be purchased from Comtech EF Data, and then activated in the unit using this page.
Contact a Comtech EF Data sales representative during normal business hours, or via e-mail to
sales@comtechefdata.com, to order the desired options and obtain your unique FAST Access
Codes.
FAST code
When you obtain a FAST access code from Comtech EF Data, it will be for a specific option
register. Carefully enter each register-specific 20-character FAST access code in sequence, and
then click [Submit FAST code] when done. A message will display at the top of this section that
states whether or not the codes are accepted or if the upgrade is successful.
622
* The AES Feature is available only when the CDM-625 is equipped with the
optional IP Packet Processor with AES software.
Use the drop-down list to set Demo-Mode as Enabled or Disabled, and then click [Submit] to
execute the selection.
Equipment ID
This read-only section displays the operational status for a number of FAST-enabled features.
Installed Options
This scrollable, read-only list box displays the installed and presently operational FAST-enabled
features.
Ping
IP Address Enter the IP Address for the network device in the format XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX.
Number of Pings (1-20) Specify the number of ping attempts to be executed, from a
minimum of 1 up to a maximum of 20 attempts.
Click [Ping] to execute the function. The scrollable window displays the result of the
command.
623
Use the Configuration | Modem page to configure these modem operating parameters:
Tx / Rx Interfaces and Framing* Carrier-in-Carrier (CnC) Parameters
Tx / Rx Operating Parameters ACM Parameters
*The Tx / Rx Interface Types and Framing Modes have higher priority than other
parameters, and should be configured before setting other parameters.
624
Network Configuration
Ping Reply Use the drop-down list to select Ping Reply as Disabled or Enabled. When
Enabled, the modem responds to ICMP ping requests.
WAN Buffer Length Enter a value between 20ms and 400ms, in 20ms increments.
625
L2 QoS (Layer 2 QoS) Use the drop-down list to select this feature as Off, VLAN only, Port
only, or VLAN & Port.
L
L2 QoS can be enabled only when the optional IP Packet Processor is disabled.
Dedicated Management Port This feature is available in Managed Switch Mode, but it is
unavailable when VLAN Mode is Enabled or when the optional IP Packet Processor is
enabled.
Use the drop-down list to select Port 1, Port 2, Port 3, or Port 4 as the Dedicated
Management Port. If Port 1 (2,3,4) - Local Only is selected, management is restricted to LAN
only. Note that, when the optional IP Packet Processor is Enabled, the drop-down list
displays Disabled as the sole listed option. When VLAN is Enabled, the drop-down list
displays all options as described previously, but the selections are non-functioning.
2048 Ethernet Frame Size This feature is supported only on modems with Hardware
Revision 2.X or higher.
IP Gateway (applicable only in Managed Switch Mode), and Traffic/Mgmt IP Address (and
subnet mask) Configure the modems IP Addresses using these fields.
MAC Learning (applicable only in Managed Switch Mode) Use the drop-down list to select
MAC Learning as On or Off.
L3 QoS (Layer 3 QoS) This feature is operational only when the optional IP Packet
Processor card is installed and enabled.
Use the drop-down list to select the L3 (Advanced) QoS as Off, Max/Priority, Min Max, or
DiffServ.
Working Mode Use the drop-down list to select the Working Mode as follows:
When the optional IP Packet Processor is either not installed or is installed but disabled,
Managed Switch Mode provides support for Layer 2 QoS, and Dedicated Management
Port or VLAN.
When the optional IP Packet Processor is installed and enabled, advanced features are
available, such as Layer 3 (Advanced) QoS, Header and Payload Compression, Streamline
Encapsulation (SLE), and Encryption. Most are supported only under Admin user
access.
626
Packet Processor This feature is operational only when the optional IP Packet Processor
card is installed. Use the drop-down list to select the IP Packet Processor card as Enabled or
Disabled.
When you change the optional IP Packet Processor card operation (i.e.,
Enabled or Disabled), after you click the [Submit] tab the modem is forced to
reboot and you will see the following message:
Note that, before clicking [OK] to proceed with reboot of the modem, you may
first need to clear the PCs ARP table.
627
VLAN Mode
VLAN Mode is supported in Managed Switch Mode, with or without the optional IP
Packet Processor enabled.
VLAN Mode Use the drop-down list to select the mode as Disabled or Enabled.
Management VLAN ID A Management VLAN ID may be assigned to the selected port using
a value range from 0001 to 4095.
The Access VLAN ID (PVID) is used to tag arriving packets that have no
VLAN tag. Likewise, when packets arrive from the WAN with the same
VLAN tag as the Access VLAN ID, and then the VLAN header is removed
and passed to the LAN interface.
VLAN Table
VLAN Entry / Action Set the table entry action as None, Edit, Delete, or Add:
o None No actions will be taken on the VLAN priority rule for the selected VLAN ID.
o Edit Click to modify an existing VLAN priority rule in the VLAN table. The VLAN rule will
be updated in the VLAN Table once the user clicks [Submit].
o Delete Click to flag a VLAN priority rule for removal from the VLAN Table. The VLAN
rule will be deleted from the VLAN Table once the user clicks [Submit].
o Add Click to add a VLAN priority rule. The entry will be added to the VLAN Table for
processing once the user clicks [Submit].
VLAN ID This parameter is read-only and reflect the ID value assigned in the Per Port
Configuration section of this page (i.e., any ID has a value range of 0001-4095).
Port 1 through Port 4 Use the drop-down list to select the port as Untagged, Tagged, or
Filtered.
Action Use the drop-down list to select the action for this active ID as None, Edit, Delete,
or Add.
628
VLAN Table This read-only table provides the user with the status for VLAN entry on a per-
ID (0001-4095) and per-Port (1-4) basis, where U=Untagged, T=Tagged, and F=Filtered.
ARP (Address Resolution Protocol) is a technique by which the Web Server Interface in Router
Mode on a given network answers the ARP queries for a network address that is not on this
network, but is reachable via the IP Packet Processor Interface.
629
630
631
Column Description
Next HOP IP Enter t he des ired N ext H op I P Address f or toLAN routes. N ote t hat no N ext H op ent ry i s
needed for toWAN routes.
Header Comp. When the optional Header Compression FAST feature is available, use the drop-down list to
Disable or Enable operations.
Payload Comp. When the optional Payload Compression FAST feature is available, use the drop-down list to
Disable or Enable operations.
Encryption When t he opt ional AES Encryption F AST f eature i s av ailable, use t he dr op-down lis t t o
Disable or Enable operations.
With AES Encryption disabled, all routed traffic is transmitted in the
clear regardless of the Encryption Key specified in the Route Table.
Encryption With enc ryption enabled, u se t he dr op-down l ist t o s elect Key 1 through Key 8 (assigned
Key using the Configuration | WAN | Encryption page, Sect. 6.5.4.3.5.3) or Random Key.
You must program all eight encryption and decryption keys before
selecting Random Key otherwise, the modem will select any of the eight
allotted keys, even if a key is currently clear (set to all zeroes).
Click [Add Entry] to save these settings. Note that, when a new route is added, the index
automatically increments to the next available number.
Delete Route
Enter Route Index to Delete, and then click [Delete Entry] once all changes have been made in
this section. The specified route entry will then be deleted from the route table.
632
IGMP, when enabled, responds to IGMP queries for the configured multicast routes on the
transmit side and generates IGMP queries on the receive side. If there are no active IGMP
receivers on the LAN, it will stop forwarding the multicast traffic (received from the satellite) to
the LAN.
Last Member Query Interval This is the maximum response time inserted into group-
specific queries that are set in response to Leave Group messages, and is also amount of
time between group-specific query messages. This value may be tuned to modify the "leave
latency" of the network; a reduced value results in reduced time to detect the loss of the
last member of a group.
633
Query Interval This is the interval between general queries sent by the modem. By varying
the query interval, a modem administrator may tune the number of IGMP messages on the
subnet; note that larger numbers cause the IGMP queries to be sent less often.
Query Response Interval This is the maximum response time inserted into the periodic
general queries. By varying the Query Response Interval, a modem administrator may tune
the burstiness of IGMP messages on the subnet; note that larger values make the traffic
less bursty as host responses are spread out over a large interval.
The number of seconds assigned to the Query Response Interval must be less
than the Query Interval.
Click [Refresh] to update this section with its latest available statistics.
Multicast Routes
This read-only table lists the Multicast Routes that are active on the modem.
Click [Refresh] to update this section with its latest available statistics.
634
DHCP allows a device to be configured automatically eliminating the need for intervention by a
network administrator and provides a server located at the hub for keeping track of devices
that are connected to the network. This prevents two devices from accidentally being
configured with the same IP Address.
The CDM-625 DHCP Relay feature allows you to deploy a single DHCP server at the hub that
manages all of the devices throughout your remote networks. When a device on the CDM-625's
network issues a DHCP request, it is relayed to the DHCP server as specified by the "DHCP Server
IP Address". The DHCP response is then sent directly to the requesting device.
DHCP Relay
Relay Feature Use the drop-down list to Disable or Enable the DHCP Relay Feature.
DHCP Server IP Address Specify the IP Address to be used for the DHCP server at the hub
in the form XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX.
635
DNS Caching
Use the drop-down list to set DNS as Enabled or Disabled. Click [Submit] to save.
636
For configuration of Managed Switch Mode features that do not require the
presence or enabling of the optional IP Packet Processor (i.e., L2 QoS, Dedicated
Management Port, VLAN Mode), see Sect. 6.5.4.3.2.1 Configuration | LAN | IP.
Payload Compression When this optional feature is available, use the drop-down list to
Disable or Enable Payload Compression.
Encryption When this optional feature is available , use the drop-down list to Disable or
Enable Encryption.
Encryption Key When this optional feature is available and encryption has been Enabled,
the Encryption keys are used to encrypt traffic being sent over the satellite interface:
637
o Select Key 1 through Key 8 to use the key specified in the Encryption/Decryption
Configuration Page (Sect. 6.5.4.3.5.3) to encrypt WAN traffic.
o Select Disable to force the IP Module to not encrypt any WAN traffic.
o Select Random to cause the IP Module to randomly use any of the eight Tx Keys to
encrypt the traffic destined for the satellite link.
638
With QoS disabled, if the nested QoS tab is selected, in place of a populated page the following
message appears:
With QoS enabled, the appearance of this page depends on the active mode of operation. The
active mode is labeled in the upper left-hand page corners, below the nested QoS tab:
The label for each page is appended with the following message:
Packet Segmentation and Reassembly (SAR) is an adaptive process; it will trigger only if the
packet latency exceeds the threshold value (default to 25 msec). SAR is needed, when running
small-speed (<700 kbps) links, to keep latency and jitter within specifications (25 msec
latency/10 msec jitter) when the lower priority queue contains large packets.
Use the drop-down list to select SAR as Disable or Enable, and then click [Submit].
639
640
This section displays all existing QoS Rules Table entries. From left to right:
Column Description
Index This is the internal table index that is automatically assigned and cannot be edited.
Protocol Specifies the protocol for the specific rule.
VLAN Range Specifies the minimum-to-maximum range of VLAN IDs (applicable only in Managed Switch
Mode)
TOS Specifies the Type Of Service
Src IP/Mask Identifies the Source IP Address/Mask in the form XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX/YY.
Dst IP/Mask Identifies the Destination IP Address/Mask in the form XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX/YY.
Min Src Port Specifies the Minimum Source Port.
Max Src Port Specifies the Maximum Source Port.
Min Dst Port Specifies the Minimum Destination Port.
Max Dst Port Specifies the Maximum Destination Port.
Min BW (Kbps) (Min/Max page only) Specifies the minimum bandwidth value.
Max BW (Kbps) Specifies the maximum bandwidth value.
Priority (Max/Priority page only) Specifies the priority established for the specific rule.
WRED Specifies the WRED (Weighted Random Early Detection) setting for the specific rule as
Disable or Enable.
Filter All Specifies the flow filter setting for the specific rule as Disable or Enable.
641
Min/Max Src Port Selection of Source/Destination Ports should only be done if you are aware of the
port us age of t he de sired pr otocol or a pplication. There ar e w ell-known por ts f or
various protocols, but often only the command messaging is transacted on t hese ports
Min/Max Dst Port and the data is transferred through a negotiated port.
Min BW (Kbps) (Min/Max page only) Assign a value to a flow to restrict the Minimum Bandwidth that
any particular flow will utilize; otherwise, the default of no bandwidth restriction can be
selected.
Max BW (Kbps) Assign a value to a flow to restrict the Maximum Bandwidth that any particular flow will
utilize; otherwise, the default of no bandwidth restriction can be selected.
Priority (Max/Priority page only) Use the drop-down list to assign a Priority Level from 1 to 8
for each flow:
The IP Module classifies each packet that is to be forwarded over the satellite; the
packet then has a Priority assigned according to the defined QoS Rules;
Any latency critical traffic such as VoIP/RTP should always be assigned Priority 1;
Priority 1 pac kets are forwarded immediately; Priority 2 packets are forwarded as
soon as there are no Priority 1 packets in the Queue; and so on;
Any packet that does not meet a QoS Rule is assigned to the Default Rule and i s
assigned a Priority of 9.
WRED Use the drop-down list to set WRED (Weighted Random Early Detection) as Disable or
Enable.
Filter All Use the drop-down list to set Filter All to Disable or Enable. QoS allows specific flows to
be designated as filtered so the IP Packet Processor card will discard traffic that you do
not want to forward over a satellite link.
For either page, click [Add Rule] to execute the addition of the new rule to the QoS Rules Table.
642
Delete Rule
This section is identical for both the Max/Priority and Min/Max pages.
Enter Rule Index to Delete, and then click [Delete Rule] to execute deletion of the specified rule
from the QoS Rules Table.
For either page, use the drop-down list to select Yes, and then click [Submit] to execute the
deletion of all rules from the QoS Rules Table.
643
Differentiated Services
From left to right, note the following:
Column Description
Priority IP traffic is prioritized based upon the DSCP (DiffServ Code Points) Class Selector
Precedence.
Per-Hop Behavior (PHB) Traffic class that determines how packets will be forwarded.
Codepoint (DSCP) Codepoint value in Type of Service (ToS) byte in IP header.
The user has the option of configuring each queue to one of the following attributes (the
acceptable ranges are shown in brackets):
644
Column Description
Service Rate [ -0.000 / (Tx Data Rate)] The minimum bandwidth will be s erved first among the
Assured F orwarding (ASFD) c lasses in case of band width availability once Class
Selector 7 through Class Selected 1 have been serviced.
Drop Preferences ASFD Class 4 through 1 Code Points (b100xx0, b011xx0, b010xx0, and b001xx0)
carry the drop precedence value (xx). In case of network congestion, a W eighted
Random E arly D etection ( WRED) c ongestion av oidance al gorithm i s i mposed on
these queues to drop the packets randomly rather than tail drop.
645
Compression Availability
This section provides a hyperlink to the Configuration | Managed Switch page (see Sect.
6.5.4.3.4). Use this Managed Switch link to enable Header and Payload Compression.
Header Compression
Header Comp. RTP Refresh Rate Enter a time for the Real Time Protocol refresh rate, from
1 to 600 seconds.
Header Comp. UDP Refresh Rate Enter a time for the User Datagram Protocol refresh
rate, from 1 to 600 seconds.
Header comp. Default Refresh Rate Enter a time for the Default Protocol refresh rate,
from 1 to 600 seconds.
Payload Compression
Payload Comp. Refresh Rate Enter for the Payload Compression refresh rate, in number of
packets, from 1 to 255.
646
Per the example shown in Figure 6-24, when the AES Encryption FAST feature is enabled,
this section displays the message Encryption is available. All functionality of this page is
operable you can encrypt a specific route.
647
Route encryption is set using the Configuration | Routing | Routes page (see Sect.
6.5.4.3.3.1) when the modem is in a router mode, or the Configuration | Managed Switch
page (see Sect. 6.5.4.3.4) when the modem is in Managed Switch Mode.
When the AES Encryption FAST feature has not been purchased and is therefore disabled,
the Encryption section of this page appears as follows:
While the AES Encryption FAST feature itself is disabled, the this page may still be used to
program the Encryption and Decryption keys in anticipation of future use.
For situations where, for example, export restrictions prohibit the availability of the AES
Encryption option, the CDM-625 runs an FPGA chipset that does not allow encryption
operations. The Configuration | WAN | Encryption page is therefore disabled: The page, when
accessed, notes the operational restriction by hiding the Encryption Key and Decryption Key
programming sections and displaying the following message in the Encryption section:
Under the default Allow setting, the local modem allows receipt of unencrypted (plain text)
packets from the remote modem over the WAN, even when encryption is enabled.
Under the Drop setting, the modem drops all unencrypted traffic received over the WAN
interface when encryption is enabled. The remote modem may therefore transmit only
encrypted data.
To program a key, enter the desired 32-character string in the appropriate key row, and then
click [Set]. Any previously programmed key may be overwritten in this manner.
Alternately, click [Clear] to reset a previously programmed entry to all zeroes, and then re-enter
the new key string as instructed here.
648
Up to eight keys may be programmed for each function; once set, a specified Encryption Key
may then be selected for active use via the Configuration | Routing | Routes page (Sect.
6.5.4.3.3.1).
The user must program all eight encryption and decryption keys before selecting
Random Key operation on the Configuration | Routing | Routes page. Otherwise,
the modem will select any of the eight allotted keys, even if a key is currently clear
(set to all zeroes).
649
ESC including Tx / Rx IDR Esc Type, Audio Volume, High Rate ESC
650
Redundancy
If the unit is part of a 1:1 redundant pair of modems, and this unit is currently online, click
[Force 1:1 Switch] to cause the unit to switch to standby.
Re-Center Buffer
Click [Re-Center Buffer] to force the re-centering of the Plesiochronous/Doppler buffer.
Unit
Use the drop-down lists provided in this section to configure Test Mode, Stats Sample Interval,
Front Panel Lockout, RTS/CTS Control, and HSSI Handshake Control.
651
Clocks
Use the drop-down lists provided in this section to configure Tx / Rx Clock Sources, Rx Buffer
Size, External Clock, External Frequency Reference, and G.703 Clock Extended Mode /
Interface.
With Carrier ID enabled, the first 24 characters of the 40-character Circuit ID are
intended for and sent as the MetaCarrier Custom Message. While you must limit
your MetaCarrier Custom Message to 24 characters or less, the full 40 characters of
the Circuit ID will display on the front panel screen saver (see Sect. 5.1.3.1 Screen
Saver).
The Circuit ID / MetaCarrier Custom Message, as created here, also appears in the title bar
of compatible web browsers for easy unit identification.
Click [Enter Date/Time] once you set the desired date and time.
652
BERT Config
Use the drop-down lists provided in this section to configure Bit Error Rate Test for Tx or Rx as
On or Off; configure the pattern for Tx or Rx; and set Error Insertion as either Off or 10E-3.
Click [Submit BERT] once you select the desired BERT settings.
BERT Monitor
This read-only section displays the ongoing BERT. Click [Restart] to restart the BERT Monitor, or
[Update] to refresh a test already in progress.
The Save/Load feature stores and retrieves the CDM-625 Base Modem settings
only. It does not include the optional IP Packet Processor settings.
As a safeguard, to prevent any inadvertent action the Save Location and Load Location drop-
down lists default selections are Dont Save and Dont Load, respectively. Otherwise:
Save Location / Load Location Use the drop-down lists to save or load up to 10 different
modem configurations 0 through 9. An empty location is noted on its menu line as
Available.
653
If the selected framing mode is Quad Drop & Insert, the section heading and the available
parameters adjust accordingly:
654
After configuring the CDM-625 for L-Band operation, and when a Block Up Converter (BUC) is
installed, you may use this page to configure its operating parameters and to view the BUC
operational status.
After configuring the CDM-625 for L-Band operation, and when a Low Noise Block Down
Converter (LNB) is installed, you may use this page to configure its operating parameters and to
view the LNB operational status.
655
Sect. 16.7 Advanced Network Timing (ANT) (Chapter 16. ETHERNET NETWORK
CONFIGURATION)
The ANT feature provides IP-based protocols to synchronize the modem's internal time-of-day
clock to an external device such as a time server, Base Station Controller (BSC), or Radio
Network Controller (RNC).
Sect. 16.7.2 Precision Time Protocol (PTP) (Chapter 16. ETHERNET NETWORK
MANAGEMENT)
If the optional IP Packet Processor card is installed and enabled, then the
Configuration | ANT | PTP menu, while selectable, are not functional.
All network devices between the Grandmaster and Slave devices must support PTP
for sub-microsecond accuracy.
Precision Time Protocol (PTP) is a FAST-activated feature used to synchronize computer clocks
throughout a computer network. On LANs, PTP achieves clock accuracy in the sub-microsecond
range much more accurate than what is attainable by NTP (Network Time Protocol) and it is
also used in network applications where GPS is either unaffordable or inaccessible.
PTP
Feature Use the drop-down list to set PTP operation as Enabled or Disabled.
656
Grandmaster Use the drop-down list to assign to which side (either the LAN port or the
WAN port) the PTP Grandmaster is connected. Note the following:
Selection Function
LAN The LAN port receives messages from the PTP master.
WAN The WAN port receives messages from the PTP master.
Status
Click [Refresh] to update this section with its most recently accumulated statistics.
These status parameters are read-only and cannot be changed. Note the following:
Row Title Description
PTP Engine Specifies whether or not PTP is actively attempting to synchronize time.
Top Displays the time that has been synchronized with the master device and is being
PTP Time
propagated to the slave devices.
Displays whether or not the Ethernet link is detected. The PTP Port is always
PTP Port
Ethernet Port 2 on the modem.
Bottom
Displays the presumed time for the modem. While the PTP time depends on the
RTV Time
Grandmaster device, the RTC Time changes only when set by the user.
657
Sect. 16.7.1 Simple Network Timing Protocol (SNTP) (Chapter 16. ETHERNET
NETWORK MANAGEMENT)
Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) is used to synchronize computer clocks throughout a
computer network when the ultimate performance of the full NTP implementation as per
RFC-1305 (Requests for Comment No. 1305: Network Time Protocol, Version 3, Specification,
Implementation and Analysis) is not needed or justified.
F
i
g
u
r
e
6
-
3
1
.
Configuration | ANT | SNTP page
SNTP
Primary / Backup Ethernet Time Server Enter the desired Time Servers IP Address in the
form XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX.
Last Update This read-only field displays the time and date that the selected server was
last updated. The time in shown military format (HH:MM:SS); the date is shown in DAY-
MONTH-YEAR format in accordance with European convention. This line specifies Never if
no update information exists.
Click [Enter Date/Time] once you set the desired date and time.
658
The ONLINE unit transmits traffic only to the WAN side while, at the same time, the
OFFLINE units Tx is muted.
Both the ONLINE and OFFLINE units receive the satellite traffic, but only the ONLINE unit
forwards traffic to the LAN side while the OFFLINE unit drops the packets.
Any time a unit switches from the OFFLINE to ONLINE state, the traffic destined for the
WAN is buffered, preconfigured in milliseconds (base modem Antenna Handover
delay).
MEO
Use the drop-down list to select the MEO Feature operation as Disabled or Enabled, and then
click [Submit] to save this setting.
Antenna Handover
Feature Use the drop-down list to select the Antenna Handover Feature operation as
Disabled or Enabled.
Mode Use the drop-down list to select the enabled Antenna Handover Feature switching
operation as Manual or Automatic.
Differential Path Delay Enter a DPD limit value from -30 to +30.
659
660
Click the Base Modem tab, or when the optional IP Packet Processor card is installed and
enabled the Packet Processor tab to continue.
Events Log
Read Next Five Events Click to buffer the next group of five stored events into the
scrollable events window.
Clear Events Log Click to wipe clean the stored events log.
661
Unread Events Displays the total number of unread stored events in the scrollable events
window. As stored event groups are displayed, this number decrements accordingly.
Statistics Log
Read Next Five Statistics Click to buffer the next group of five stored events into the
scrollable statistics window.
Clear Statistics Log Click to wipe clean the stored statistics log.
Unread Statistics Displays the total number of unread stored statistics in the scrollable
statistics window. As stored statistics are displayed, this number decrements accordingly.
Alarm Mask
Use the option buttons provided to define a designated alarm as Masked or Active, and then
click [Submit Alarm Mask] to save these changes.
662
This page provides you with a scrollable window showing the optional IP Packet Processors
cumulative events, plus control over what information is displayed for IP Packet Processor
operations.
Event Logging
The Event Log can display a maximum of 256 events. Each event is assigned a sequential Index
number; its type, the date and time of occurrence, and a description of the event follows.
Logging Level Use the drop-down list to select the type of information displayed in the log:
Errors Only, Errors and Warnings, or All Information.
Click [Submit] once the desired settings have been entered in this section.
663
664
Click [Refresh] to update the page with the latest available statistics.
665
Clear Statistics
Click [Clear] to clear all router statistics from the buffer.
Click [Refresh] to update the page with the latest available statistics.
666
Clear Statistics
Click [Clear] to clear all Managed Switch statistics from the buffer.
Click [Refresh] to update the page with the latest available statistics.
667
668
Click [Refresh] to update the page with the latest available statistics.
Use this page to view cumulative Header Compression and Payload Compression statistics.
Click [Refresh] to update the page with the latest available statistics.
669
Click [Refresh] to update the page with the latest available statistics.
670
Sect. 16.7.2 Precision Time Protocol (PTP) (Chapter 16. ETHERNET NETWORK
MANAGEMENT)
Use this page to obtain data intended to troubleshoot PTP operational issues.
PTP Status
Click [Refresh] to update this section with its most recently accumulated statistics.
These status parameters are read-only and cannot be changed. Note the following:
Row Title Description
PTP Engine Specifies whether or not PTP is actively attempting to synchronize time.
Top Displays the time that has been synchronized with the master device and is being
PTP Time
propagated to the slave devices.
Displays whether or not the Ethernet link is detected. The PTP Port is always
PTP Port
Ethernet Port 2 on the modem.
Bottom
Displays the presumed time for the modem. While the PTP time depends on the
RTV Time
Grandmaster device, the RTC Time changes only when set by the user.
671
PTP Statistics
Click [Refresh] to update the page with the latest available statistics.
This statistics table breaks down the number of PTP packets sent or received on the WAN and
LAN ports as follows:
Row Description (LAN/WAN Rx/Tx Columns)
Event Port Number of packets (PTP or other) received on the PTP UDP event-message port.
General Port Number of packets (PTP or other) received on the PTP UDP general-message port.
Announce Number of PTP announce messages received from another PTP device.
Sync Number of synchronization messages received from a master PTP device.
Followup Number of follow-up messages received from a 2-step-clock master PTP device.
Delay Req Number of Delay Request messages received from a slave device.
Delay Resp Number of Delay Response messages sent to a slave device.
Mgmt Number of PTP management messages received by the modem.
Signal Number of PTP signaling messages received by the modem.
Total number of PTP packets discarded by the modem.
Discarded
Note: Some discarded messages are normal. For example, if the modem receives
a PTP message while it is configuring its PTP port, it will discard that message.
2. PTP Master Devices send Announce, Sync, Followup, and Delay Response
messages, while PTP Slave Devices send Delay Request messages.
3. PTP is a UDP multicast protocol. When negotiating with devices over the
LAN interface, the modem uses UDP Port 319 for events, and UDP Port 320
for general packets. On the WAN interface, the modem uses UDP Port 59319
for events, and UDP Port 59320 for general packets.
672
MAC Table
Click [Refresh] to update the page with the latest discovered MAC Addresses.
673
674
CPU Usage
At present, CPU Usage (%) is the only viewable parameter; more functionality will
be selectable in future firmware releases.
675
Typical for both line graph types, the X-axis denotes elapsed time; the Y-axis denotes
performance, in percent. Either graph scrolls from right to left as viewing time increments.
Click [Add Big] to display a line graph with an extended scale Y-axis.
Click [Add Small] to display a line graph with a compressed scale Y-axis.
For either line graph, use the component check box, located to the right of each graph, to select
that graphs viewable parameter. The line graph will update to incorporate performance
tracking for that item.
At present, CPU Usage (%) is the only selectable parameter; more functionality
will be available in future firmware releases.
Each new graph is added to the bottom of the scrollable page. Any combination of graph types
may be displayed on this page. Click [Remove] to delete the bottom-most graph from the page.
676
See Appendix F. CDM-625 ODU (TRANSCEIVER, BUC, LNB) Operation for complete
details on using the Web Server Interface for ODU operations.
Figure 6-48. ODU Page Examples (Enable, Config, Status, and Utilities)
677
Refer to the pertinent switch Installation and Operation Manuals for detailed
information on using the CDM-625 in a redundancy configuration.
Redundancy Config
Redundancy Traffic IP Address Enter the IP Address and subnet mask in the form
XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX/YY.
678
The Redundancy Traffic IP Address and subnet mask is different from the
Traffic/Management IP Address and subnet mask that is defined on the
Configuration | LAN | IP page (Sect. 6.5.4.3.2.1).
1: N Mode (use with CAUTION!) Use the drop-down list to set 1:N Redundancy mode as
Disabled or Enabled.
Packet Processor Redundancy When the optional IP Packet Processor card is installed and
enabled in a 1:1 redundancy configuration (i.e., both the traffic and backup modems are
equipped with the optional IP Packet Processor and are connected to a CRS-170A L-Band or
CRS-180 70/140 MHz 1:1 Redundancy Switch), there is no need to use the drop-down list
here, as Packet Processor Redundancy is enabled automatically.
If it is desired to operate either modem outside of the redundant setup as a standalone unit, use
the drop-down list to select Packet Processor Redundancy for that specific modem as Disabled.
Redundancy Monitor
Monitoring of the redundancy setup both the status of the active modem (i.e., Online or
Offline) and the detected presence of a redundancy switch is provided in this read-only
section. Click [Refresh] to manually update this page section.
679
Notes:
680
Turbo Product Coding (TPC) and Low-Density Parity Check (LDPC) coding represent a very
significant development in the area of FEC. An option card, field upgradeable, combines LDPC
and TPC together on one module.
While the performance of LDPC is exceptional in terms of coding gain, its higher latency is
considered disadvantageous in some applications. For this reason, Comtech EF Data and
Comtech AHA have jointly developed a completely new family of short-block LDPC codes, which
we have called VersaFEC. (The name VersaFEC is a trademark registered to Comtech AHA.) It is
ideal for lower data rates that demand the shortest possible latency, and is available as a field
upgradeable option card.
VersaFEC represents the best Forward Error Correction technology currently available, and is
offered with a sufficient range of code rates and modulation types that link performance can be
optimized under almost any conditions.
7.2 Viterbi
The combination of convolutional coding and Viterbi decoding has become an almost universal
standard for satellite communications. The CDM-625 complies with the Intelsat IESS 308/309
standards for Viterbi decoding with a constraint length of seven. This is a de facto standard,
even in a closed network environment, which means almost-guaranteed interoperability with
other manufacturers equipment. It provides very useful levels of coding gain, and its short
decoding delay and error-burst characteristics make it particularly suitable for low data rate
coded voice applications. It has a short constraint length, fixed at 7, for all code rates. (The
71
constraint length is defined as the number of output symbols from the encoder that are affected
by a single input bit.)
By choosing various coding rates (Rate 1/2, 3/4 or 7/8) the user can trade off coding gain for
bandwidth expansion. Rate 1/2 coding gives the best improvement in error rate, but doubles
the transmitted data rate, and hence doubles the occupied bandwidth of the signal. Rate 7/8
coding, at the other extreme, provides the most modest improvement in performance, but only
expands the transmitted bandwidth by 14%.
A major advantage of the Viterbi decoding method is that the performance is independent of
data rate, and does not display a pronounced threshold effect (i.e., does not fail rapidly below a
certain value of Eb/No). Note that, in BPSK mode, the CDM-625 only permits a coding rate of
1/2. Because the method of convolutional coding used with Viterbi, the encoder does not
preserve the original data intact, and is called non-systematic.
7.3 Sequential
Although the method of convolutional coding and Sequential decoding appears to be very similar
to the Viterbi method, there are some fundamental differences. To begin with, the convolutional
encoder is said to be systematic it does not alter the input data, and the FEC overhead bits are
simply appended to the data. Furthermore, the constraint length k is much longer (Rate 1/2, k=36.
Rate 3/4, k= 63. Rate 7/8, k=87). This means that, when the decoding process fails (i.e., when its
capacity to correct errors is exceeded), it produces a burst of errors which is in multiples of half
the constraint length. An error distribution is produced which is markedly different to that of a
Viterbi decoder; this gives rise to a pronounced threshold effect.
A Sequential decoder does not fail gracefully a reduction in Eb/No of just a few tenths of a dB
can make the difference between acceptable BER and a complete loss of synchronization. The
decoding algorithm itself, called the Fano algorithm, uses significantly more path memory 4 kbps
in this case than the equivalent Viterbi decoder, giving rise to increased latency. Furthermore, a
fixed computational clock is used to process input symbols and to search backwards and forwards
in time to determine the correct decoding path.
72
At lower data rates there are sufficient number of computational cycles per input symbol to
permit the decoding process to perform optimally. However, as the data rate increases, there are
fewer cycles available, leading to a reduction in coding gain. This is clearly illustrated in the
performance curves that follow. For data rates above ~1 Mbps, Viterbi should be considered the
better alternative; the practical upper limit in this implementation is 2.048 Mbps.
Table 7-2. Sequential Decoding Summary
FOR AGAINST
Pronounced t hreshold ef fect does not f ail gr ace-fully i n
poor Eb/No conditions.
Higher coding gain (1-2 dB) at lower data rates, Higher processing delay than Viterbi (~4 k bits) not good
compared to Viterbi. for low-rate coded voice.
Upper data rate limit 2.048Mbps
Coding gain varies with data rate favors lower data rates.
Reed-Solomon codes are block codes as opposed to Viterbi, which is convolutional; in order to
be processed correctly, the data must be framed and de-framed. Additionally, R-S codes are
limited in how well they can correct errors that occur in bursts. This, unfortunately, is the nature
of the uncorrected errors from Viterbi decoders, which produce clusters of errors that are
multiples of half the constraint length. For this reason, the data must be interleaved following R-
S encoding, and is then de-interleaved prior to decoding. This ensures that a single burst of
errors leaving the Viterbi or Sequential decoder is spread out over a number of interleaving
frames, so errors entering the R-S decoder do not exceed its capacity to correct those errors. In
the case of the CDM-625, different R-S code rates are used according to the mode of operation:
Closed Network Modes and Open Network Modes.
73
A characteristic of concatenated R-S coding is the very pronounced threshold effect. For any
given modem design, there will be a threshold value of Eb/No below which the demodulator
cannot stay synchronized. This may be due to the carrier-recovery circuits, or the
synchronization threshold of the primary FEC device, or both. In the CDM-625, and Rate 1/2
operation, this threshold is around 4 dB Eb/No. Below this value, operation is not possible, but
above this value, the error performance of the concatenated R-S system produces exceptionally
low error rates for a very small increase in Eb/No.
Care should be taken not to operate the demodulator near its sync threshold. Small
fluctuations in Eb/No may cause total loss of the link, with the subsequent need for
the demodulator to re-acquire the signal.
Table 7-3. Concatenated RS Coding Summary
FOR AGAINST
Exceptionally good BER performance several Very pronounced threshold effect does not fail
orders of magnitude improvement in link BER gracefully in poor Eb/No conditions. Additional
under given link conditions coding overhead actually degrades sync
threshold, and reduces link fade margin.
Very small additional bandwidth expansion. Significant processing delay (~25 kbps) not
good for voice or IP applications.
Adds to demod acquisition time.
When convolution coding is used, the overall coded modulation approach is referred to as Trellis
Coded Modulation (TCM). Ungerboeck was an early pioneer and developed optimum mapping
and decoding schemes. However, the decoding scheme was seen as complex and expensive, and
Qualcomm Inc. developed a variation on the theme that uses a Viterbi decoder at the core,
surrounded by adjunct processing. The scheme, called pragmatic Trellis Coded Modulation, is able
to achieve performance very close to the optimum Ungerboeck method, but with far less
complexity.
74
As more and more high power transponders are put in to service, Intelsat recognized that the
transponders are no longer power limited, but bandwidth limited. In order to maximize
transponder capacity, 8-PSK was looked at as a method of reducing the occupied bandwidth of a
carrier, and Qualcomms pragmatic TCM, at Rate 2/3, was adopted.
A Rate 2/3 8-PSK/TCM carrier occupies only 50% of the bandwidth of a Rate 1/2 QPSK carrier.
However, the overall coding gain of the scheme is not adequate by itself, so Intelsats IESS-310
specification requires that the scheme be concatenated with an outer RS codec. When
combined, there is a threshold value of Eb/No of around 6 dB and, above approximately 7 dB,
the bit error rate is better than 1 x 10-8.
The detractions of the concatenated RS approach apply here also, along with more stringent
requirements for phase noise and group delay distortion the natural consequences of the
higher-order modulation.
The CDM-625 fully implements the IESS-310 specification at data rates up to 20 Mbps. In
accordance with the specification, the R-S outer code can be disabled. Performance curves for
both cases are shown in the following figures.
Table 7-4. 8-PSK/TCM Coding Summary
FOR AGAINST
Needs c oncatenated R S out er codec t o give ac ceptable
coding gain performance.
Exceptionally bandwidth efficient compared to
Demod acquisition threshold much higher than for QPSK.
QPSK.
8-PSK is m ore s ensitive t o phas e noi se and gr oup del ay
distortion than QPSK.
Unlike the popular method of concatenating an R-S codec with a primary FEC codec, Turbo
Product Coding is an entirely stand-alone method. It does not require the complex interleaving/
de-interleaving of the R-S approach, and consequently, decoding delays are significantly
reduced. Furthermore, the traditional concatenated R-S schemes exhibit a very pronounced
threshold effect a small reduction in Eb/No can result in total loss of demod and decoder
synchronization. TPC does not suffer from this problem the demod and decoder remain
synchronized down to the point where the output error rate becomes unusable. This is
considered to be a particularly advantageous characteristic in a fading environment. Typically, in
QPSK, 8-PSK and 16-QAM TPC modes the demod and decoder can remain synchronized 2 3 dB
below the Viterbi/Reed-Solomon or TCM cases.
75
7.7.1 Introduction
In the past few years there has been an unprecedented resurgence in interest in Forward Error
Correction (FEC) technology. The start of this new interest has its origins in the work done by
Claude Berrou et al, and the 1993 landmark paper, Near Shannon Limit Error Correcting Coding
and Decoding Turbo Codes. FEC is considered an essential component in all wireless and
satellite communications in order to reduce the power and bandwidth requirements for reliable
data transmission.
Claude Shannon, considered by many to be the father of modern communications theory, first
established the concept of Channel Capacity in his 1948 paper A Mathematical Theory of
Communication. This places an absolute limit on how fast it is possible to transmit error-free
data within a channel of a given bandwidth, and with given noise conditions within that channel.
He concluded that it would only be possible to approach this limit through the use of source
encoding what is familiar today as Forward Error Correction.
Shannon postulated that if it were possible to store every possible message in the receiver,
finding the stored message that most closely matched the incoming message would yield an
optimum decoding method. However, for all but the shortest bit sequences, the memory
required for this, and the time taken to perform the comparisons, makes this approach
impractical. For all practical purposes, the memory requirement and the decoding latency
become infinite.
For many years, there were few advances in the quest to approach the Shannon Limit. The
Viterbi algorithm heralded a major step forward, followed in the early 1990s by the
concatenation of a Viterbi decoder with Reed-Solomon hard-decision block codes. It remained
clear, however, that the Shannon Limit was still an elusive target.
Berrous work on Turbo Codes showed, through the use of an ingeniously simple approach
(multiple, or iterative decoding passes) that it is possible to achieve performance close to the
Shannon Limit. Berrous early work dealt exclusively with iteratively-decoded convolutional
codes (Turbo Convolutional Coding, or TCC), but in time the iterative approach was applied to a
particular class of block codes called Product Codes hence Turbo Product Coding (TPC). TPC
exhibits inherently low decoding latency compared with TCC, and so is considered much more
desirable for 2-way, interactive satellite communications applications.
In August 1999, Comtech became the first company in the world to offer satellite modems that
incorporate TPC. Since its inception, Comtech has continued to develop and refine its
implementation of TPC in its products, and now offers a comprehensive range of code rates
(from Rate 5/16 to Rate 0.95) and modulations (from BPSK to 16-QAM). However, in the past
few years, as part of the general interest in Turbo coding, a third class of Turbo coding has
emerged: Low Density Parity Check Codes (LDPC).
LDPC is more like TPC than TCC in that it is an iteratively-decoded block code. Gallager first
suggested this in 1962 but, at the time, the implementation complexity was considered to be
76
too great; for decades, it remained of purely academic interest. Further interest in LDPC was
stimulated in 2003, when the Digital Video Broadcasting (DVB) committee adopted LDPC codes
(proposed by Hughes Network Systems) as the basis for the new DVB-S2 standard. Now,
however, with silicon gates being cheap, plentiful and fast, an LDPC decoder can easily be
accommodated in a large Field Programmable Gate Array (FPGA) device.
The LDPC method on its own produces an undesirable flaring in the Bit Error Rate (BER) vs.
Eb/No characteristic, and for this reason it is desirable to concatenate a short BCH code with
LDPC. This concatenation produces almost vertical BER vs. Eb/No curves, as can be seen in the
performance graphs that are presented later. In order to take full advantage of the coding gain
increase that LDPC provides, it became necessary to find an alternative to 8-PSK. Comtech EF
Data has therefore developed an 8-QAM approach that permits acquisition and tracking at much
lower values of Eb/No than 8-PSK. Comtechs implementation of 8-QAM is the subject of a U.S.
Patent, granted in 2007.
Comtech EF Data chose the CDM-600 platform as the first satellite modem in which to
implement both LDPC and 8-QAM, and the CDM-625 includes a newer technology version of the
original design.
It can be seen from this graph that, for Code Rates above 3/4, Comtechs TPCs are very close
(1-1.5 dB) to the Shannon Limit. However, at 3/4 and below, LDPCs are performing 0.7-1.2 dB
better than TPCs.
Figure 7-1. TPC & LDPC Modes Performance (Relative to Shannon Limit)
77
It is clear that, in order to provide the best possible performance over the range of code rates
from 1/2 to 0.95, both an LDPC and a TPC codec need to be offered.
In order to meet this requirement, Comtech EF Data has developed a combination LDPC/TPC
Codec module that can be added to the CDM-625 Modem. Table 7-5 outlines the operating
modes provided by this module.
Table 7-5. Available TPC/ LDPC Modes
Lower Data Rate Limit Upper Data Rate Limit
Mode Code Rate/Modulation
(kbps) (kbps)
TPC Rate 21/44 BPSK (aka 1/2) 18.0 5965.9
Rate 5/16 BPSK 18.0 3906.2
Rate 21/44 QPSK, OQPSK (aka 1/2) 18.0 11931.8
Rate 3/4 QPSK, OQPSK 27.0 18750.0
Rate 3/4 8-PSK , 8-QAM 40.0 25000.0
Rate 3/4 16-QAM 54.0 25000.0
Rate 7/8 QPSK, OQPSK 31.5 21875.0
Rate 7/8 8-PSK , 8-QAM 48.0 25000.0
Rate 7/8 16-QAM 63.0 25000.0
Rate 0.95 QPSK, OQPSK (aka 17/18) 34.2 23611.1
Rate 0.95 8-PSK , 8-QAM (aka 17/18) 52.0 25000.0
LDPC Rate 1/2 BPSK 18.0 6250.0
Rate 1/2 QPSK, OQPSK 18.0 12500.0
Rate 2/3 QPSK, OQPSK 24.0 16666.6
Rate 2/3 8-PSK , 8-QAM 36.0 25000.0
Rate 3/4 QPSK, OQPSK 27.0 18750.0
Rate 3/4 8-PSK , 8-QAM 40.5 25000.0
Rate 3/4 16-QAM 54.0 25000.0
This LDPC/TPC codec module may be installed in any existing CDM-625 as a simple field
upgrade, or it can be pre-installed in new modems ordered from the factory. It also requires the
appropriate FAST codes for enabling operation beyond the base data rate limit of 5 Mbps.
Contact a Comtech EF Data Sales representative during normal business hours for pricing and
delivery information.
Table 7-6 compares all TPC and LDPC modes available in Comtech EF Datas CDM-625, and
shows Eb/No performance and spectral efficiency (occupied bandwidth) for each case. This
information will be of particular interest to satellite operators wishing to simultaneously balance
transponder power and bandwidth. The large number of modes offered will permit, in the
majority of cases, significant power and/or bandwidth savings when compared with existing
schemes such as concatenated Viterbi/Reed-Solomon, or the popular 8-PSK/Trellis/Reed-
Solomon (Intelsat IESS-310).
78
Table 7-6. Comparison of all Comtech EF Data TPC/LDPC Modes (CDM-625 with
TPC/LDPC Codec)
Eb/No at Eb/No at Spectral Occupied *
Mode BER = 10-6 BER = 10-8 Efficiency Symbol Rate Bandwidth for
(typical) (typical) (bps per Hz) 1 Mbps Carrier
QPSK Rate 1/2 Viterbi ** 5.5 dB 6.8 dB 1.00 bps/Hz 1.0 x bit rate 1190 kHz
BPSK Rate 1/2 LDPC 1.7 dB 1.9 dB 0.50 bps/Hz 2.0 x bit rate 2380 kHz
BPSK Rate 21/44 TPC 2.8 dB 3.0 dB 0.48 bps/Hz 2.1 x bit rate 2493 kHz
BPSK Rate 5/16 TPC 2.4 dB 3.0 dB 0.31 bps/Hz 3.2 x bit rate 3808 kHz
QPSK/OQPSK Rate 1/2 LDPC 1.7 dB 1.9 dB 1.00 bps/Hz 1.0 x bit rate 1190 kHz
QPSK/OQPSK Rate 21/44 TPC 2.8 dB 3.3 dB 0.96 bps/Hz 1.05 x bit rate 1246 kHz
QPSK/OQPSK Rate 2/3 LDPC 2.1 dB 2.4 dB 1.33 bps/Hz 0.75 x bit rate 892 kHz
QPSK/OQPSK Rate 3/4 LDPC 2.7 dB 2.9 dB 1.50 bps/Hz 0.67 x bit rate 793 kHz
QPSK/OQPSK Rate 3/4 TPC 3.4 dB 4.0 dB 1.50 bps/Hz 0.67 x bit rate 793 kHz
QPSK/OQSK Rate 7/8 TPC 4.2 dB 4.3 dB 1.75 bps/Hz 0.57 x bit rate 678 kHz
QPSK/OQPSK Rate 0.95 TPC 6.0 dB 6.5 dB 1.90 bps/Hz 0.53 x bit rate 626 kHz
8-PSK Rate 2/3 TCM **
5.6 dB 6.2 dB 1.82 bps/Hz 0.56 x bit rate 666 kHz
and RS (IESS-310)
8-QAM Rate 2/3 LDPC 4.3 dB 4.6 dB 2.00 bps/Hz 0.50 x bit rate 595 kHz
8-QAM Rate 3/4 LDPC 5.3 dB 5.5 dB 2.25 bps/Hz 0.44 x bit rate 529 kHz
8-PSK/8-QAM Rate 3/4 TPC 6.1 dB 6.7 dB 2.25 bps/Hz 0.44 x bit rate 529 kHz
8-PSK/8-QAM Rate 7/8 TPC 6.7 dB 6.9 dB 2.62 bps/Hz 0.38 x bit rate 453 kHz
8-PSK/8-QAM Rate 0.95 TPC 9.2 dB 10.2 dB 2.85 bps/Hz 0.35 x bit rate 377 kHz
16-QAM Rate 3/4 LDPC 6.7 dB 6.8 dB 3.00 bps/Hz 0.33 x bit rate 396 kHz
16-QAM Rate 3/4 TPC 7.4 dB 8.1 dB 3.00 bps/Hz 0.33 x bit rate 396 kHz
16-QAM Rate 7/8 TPC 7.9 dB 8.1 dB 3.50 bps/Hz 0.28 x bit rate 340 kHz
16-QAM Rate 3/4 **
7.5 dB 8.0 dB 2.73 bps/Hz 0.37 x bit rate 435 kHz
Viterbi/Reed-Solomon
16-QAM Rate 7/8 **
9.0 dB 9.5 dB 3.18 bps/Hz 0.31 x bit rate 374 kHz
Viterbi/Reed-Solomon
* The occupied bandwidth is defined at the width of the transmitted spectrum taken at the 10 dB points on t he plot of power
spectral density. This equates to 1.19 x symbol rate for the CDM-625 transmit filtering.
79
*A larger block is used for the Rate 7/8 code, which increases decoding delay.
Note that, in all cases, the delay is inversely proportional to data rate, so for 128 kbps, the delay
values would be half of those shown above. It can be seen that the concatenated Reed-Solomon
cases increase the delay significantly (due mainly to interleaving/de-interleaving), while the TPC
cases yield delays which are less than or equal to Sequential.
710
Since the introduction of Comtechs LDPC, considerable research has been carried out to find
ways to reduce the block size of LDPC (and hence its latency) while preserving the coding gain
performance very close to the Shannon bound.
The set of VersaFEC codes was developed with two distinct purposes:
1) To provide an expanded choice of combinations of modulation and coding that maintain the
same coding gain performance as Comtechs existing LDPC, while significantly reducing
latency. The existing LDPC approach (and DVB-S2 short-block) uses blocks that are 16 kbits
in length. VersaFEC, on the other hand, uses block sizes that vary between 2k and 8.2 kbits,
and at the same time reduces latency still further through a novel design approach.
2) To provide combinations of modulation and coding (ModCods) that are suitable not only for
Constant Coding and Modulation (CCM) applications, but are also the basis for a patent-
pending Adaptive Coding and Modulation (ACM) system. The modulation types (BPSK, QPSK,
8-QAM and 16-QAM) and the code rates have been chosen to give a continuous progression
of performance in terms of both Eb/No and spectral efficiency an essential aspect of a well-
engineered ACM system. There are 12 ModCods in the VersaFEC set. For a detailed discussion
on ACM, see Chapter 17. ADAPTIVE CODING AND MODULATION (ACM).
As a comparison, looking at LDPC Rate 2/3 8-QAM and VersaFEC Rate 0.642 8-QAM essentially
identical spectral efficiency and Eb/No performance. However, at 64 kbps, the latency has been
reduced from 350 milliseconds to 89 milliseconds a factor of 4 reduction.
711
The performance of the VersaFEC codes compared with the Shannon bound is shown in Figure 7-2.
This puts the performance of VersaFEC at or near the DVB-S2 performance with 16 kbit blocks.
Note that SNR is used in place of Eb/No a convention for comparing ACM ModCods. SNR is
defined as Eb/No + 10log(Spectral Efficiency).
712
These two new codes (Rate 0.576 8-QAM and Rate 0.644 16-QAM) ) have been added to fill in
perceived gaps in the progression of spectral efficiency versus SNR. They do not, in fact, provide
any discernible improvement in Eb/No performance (compared with their nearest neighbors in
the initial VersaFEC family), but exhibit a modest SNR improvement.
Table 7-10. Extended CCM Codes
Spectral Typical Latency at Min. Data Max. Data
Modulation Code Rate efficiency, Eb/No, for 64 kbps, in Rate, Rate,
bps/Hz BER = 5 x 10-8 milliseconds CCM mode CCM mode
8-QAM 0.576 1.73 4.5 dB 87 32 kbps 11 Mbps
16-QAM 0.644 2.58 6.5 dB 121 47 kbps 11 Mbps
713
Comtech EF Data cannot be held responsible for incorrect operation if the user does
not adhere to these guidelines when using uncoded operation.
There are occasions where a user may wish to operate a satellite link with no forward error
correction of any kind. For this reason, the CDM-625 offers this uncoded mode for three
modulation types BPSK, QPSK, and OQPSK. However, the user should be aware of some of the
implications of using this approach.
PSK demodulators have two inherent undesirable features. The first, known as phase
ambiguity, is due to the fact the demodulator does not have any absolute phase reference and,
in the process of carrier recovery, the demodulator can lock up in any of K phase states where K
= 2 for BPSK, K = 4 for QPSK. Without the ability to resolve these ambiguous states, there would
be a 1-in-2 chance that the data at the output of the demodulator would be wrong in the case of
BPSK. For QPSK, the probability would be 3-in-4.
The problem is solved in the case of BPSK by differentially encoding the data prior to
transmission, then performing the inverse decoding process. This is a very simple process, but
has the disadvantage that it doubles the receive BER. For every bit error the demodulator
produces, the differential decoder produces two.
The problem for QPSK is more complex, as there are four possible lock states leading to four
ambiguities. When FEC is employed, the lock state of the FEC decoder can be used to resolve
two of the four ambiguities, and the remaining two can be resolved using serial differential
encoding/decoding. However, when no FEC is being used, an entirely different scheme must be
used. Therefore, in QPSK, a parallel differential encoding/decoding technique is used, but has
the disadvantage that it again doubles the receive BER.
OQPSK is a different situation again, where the ambiguities result not only from not having an
absolute phase reference, but also not knowing which of the two parallel paths in the demod, I
or Q, contains the half-symbol delay. Another type of differential encoding is used, but yet again
the error rate is doubled, compared to ideal.
NOTE: Whenever uncoded operation is selected, the modem offers the choice between
enabling and disabling the differential encoder/decoder appropriate for the modulation type.
714
The second problem inherent in PSK demodulators is that of data false locking. In order to
accomplish the task of carrier recovery, the demodulator must use a non-linear process. A
second-order non-linearity is used for BPSK, and a fourth-order non-linearity is used for QPSK.
When data at a certain symbol rate is used to modulate the carrier, the demodulator can lock at
incorrect frequencies, spaced at intervals of one-quarter of the symbol rate away from the
carrier. Fortunately, when FEC decoding is used, the decoder synchronization state can be used
to verify the correct lock point has been achieved, and to reject the false locks.
However, if uncoded operation is used, there is no way to recognize a data false lock. The
demodulator will indicate that it is correctly locked, but the data out will not be correct.
715
Eb/No i n dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1
Uncoded BPSK/QPSK
Viterbi
1E-2
Decoding
Typical
Performance
1E-3
1E-4
1E-5
1E-6
Specification
1E-7 limit, Rate 7/8
Coding
1E-8
Specification Specification
limit Rate 1/2 limit, Rate 3/4
Coding Coding
1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER
716
Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1
1E-3
Sync
threshold,
Rate 7/8
1E-4
Combined sync
1E-5 threshold, demod
and Viterbi
Decoder, Rate 1/2
1E-6 Specification
Limit Rate 1/2
and 220,200
Outer Code
1E-7
Specification
Limit Rate 3/4
and 220,200
Typical performance
Outer Code
1E-8
Specification
Limit Rate 7/8
and 220,200
Outer Code
1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER
717
Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1
Uncoded BPSK/QPSK
8-PSK/TCM Rate 2/3
Decoding, with and
1E-2
without 219, 201 RS
Outer Code
1E-3
1E-4 Typical
Performance
1E-5
1E-6
1E-7
1E-8
Specification limit
Rate 2/3 Coding and Specification
219, 201 RS Outer Code limit, Rate 2/3
Coding
1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER
Figure 7-5. 8-PSK/TCM Rate 2/3 with and without Concatenated RS Outer Code
718
Eb/No i n dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1
Uncoded 16-QAM
1E-3
1E-4
Specification
limit Rate 7/8
Viterbi and
220,200 RS
Outer Code
1E-5
Typical
Performance
1E-6
1E-7
1E-8
719
Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1
Uncoded BPSK/QPSK
Sequential Decoding
64 kbps, BPSK,
1E-2
QPSK and OQPSK
Typical
Performance
1E-3
1E-4
1E-5
1E-6
Specification limit,
Rate 7/8 Coding,
1E-7 QPSK, OQPSK
Specification limit,
1E-8 Rate 1/2 Coding,
BPSK, QPSK, OQPSK
Specification limit,
Rate 3/4 Coding,
QPSK, OQPSK
1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER
720
Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1
Sequential Decoding
Uncoded BPSK/QPSK
2048 kbps,
QPSK, OQPSK
1E-2
Typical
Performance
1E-3
1E-4
1E-5
1E-7
Specification limit,
Rate 3/4 Coding
1E-8 QPSK, OQPSK
Specification limit,
Rate 1/2 Coding
QPSK, OQPSK
1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER
721
Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1
1E-3
1E-4
1E-5
1E-7
1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER
Figure 7-9. Sequential Decoding at 512 kbps with RS 220,200 Outer Code
722
Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1
1E-3
Spec limit
Rate 5/16
BPSK
1E-4
1E-5
1E-6
1E-7
1E-8
Typical performance
1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER
723
Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1
1E-5
1E-6
1E-7
1E-8
Typical performance
1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER
Figure 7-11. Rate 21/44 BPSK, QPSK, OQPSK Turbo Product Codec
724
Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1
1E-4
1E-5
1E-6
1E-7
Spec limit
Rate 3/4
16-QAM
1E-8
Typical performance
1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER
Figure 7-12. Rate 3/4 QPSK/OQPSK, 8-PSK/8-QAM and 16-QAM Turbo Product Codec
725
Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1
Spec limit
Rate 7/8
8-PSK
8-QAM
1E-4
1E-5
1E-6
1E-7
Spec limit
Rate 7/8
16-QAM
1E-8
Typical performance
1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER
Figure 7-13. Rate 7/8 QPSK/OQPSK, 8-PSK/8-QAM and 16-QAM Turbo Product Codec
726
Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1
Spec limit
Rate 0.95
QPSK/OQPSK
1E-3
Uncoded
8-PSK
1E-4
1E-5
1E-6
1E-8
Typical performance
1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER
Figure 7-14. Rate 0.95 QPSK and Rate 0.95 8-PSK Turbo Product Codec
727
Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1
Note:
The OQPSK demod
1E-3 acquisition and tracking
threshold is about 1 dB
Spec limit worse than the QPSK
Rate 1/2 case
B/Q/OQPSK
1E-4
1E-5
1E-6
1E-7
Typical
performance
1E-8
1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER
728
Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1
Comtech LDPC
Uncoded Rate 2/3 QPSK/OQPSK
BPSK/QPSK
1E-2 and 8-PSK/8-QAM
1E-3
1E-5
1E-6
Spec limit
Rate 2/3
8-PSK
1E-7
Typical
performance
1E-8
1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER
Figure 7-16. Rate 2/3 QPSK, OQPSK, 8-PSK, 8-QAM LDPC Codec
729
Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1
Comtech LDPC
Uncoded Rate 3/4 QPSK/OQPSK
BPSK/QPSK
1E-2 8-PSK/8-QAM and 16-QAM
1E-3
Spec limit
Spec limit Rate 3/4
Rate 3/4 8-PSK
QPSK/OQPSK 8-QAM Uncoded
8-PSK
1E-4
1E-5
1E-6
Spec limit
Rate 3/4
16-QAM
1E-7
Typical
performance
1E-8
1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER
Figure 7-17. Rate 3/4 QPSK, OQPSK, 8-PSK, 8-QAM, 16-QAM LDPC Codec
730
Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1
1E-3
Rate
0.488
BPSK
1E-4
1E-6
1E-7
1E-8
1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER
731
Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1
1E-4
1E-6
1E-7
1E-8
1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER
Figure 7-19. VersaFEC Codec QPSK, Rate 0.533, 0.631, 0.706 and 0.803
732
Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1
Uncoded
8-PSK
1E-4
1E-5
1E-6
1E-7
1E-8
1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER
Figure 7-20. VersaFEC Codec 8-QAM, Rate 0.642, 0.711, and 0.780
733
Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1
Uncoded 16-QAM
Rate Rate Rate Rate
0.731 0.780 0.829 0.853
16-QAM 16-QAM 16-QAM 16-QAM
1E-3
1E-4
1E-5
1E-6
1E-7
1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER
Figure 7-21. VersaFEC Codec 16-QAM, Rate 0.731, 0.780, 0.829 and 0.853
734
Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1
Comtech VersaFEC
Uncoded Codec - Extended CCM
BPSK/QPSK
1E-2
0.576 8-QAM and
0.644 16-QAM
Rate Rate
0.576 0.644
1E-3 8-QAM 16-QAM
Uncoded
8-PSK
1E-4
1E-5
1E-6
1E-7
1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER
Figure 7-22. VersaFEC Extended CCM 8-QAM Rate 0.576 and 16-QAM, Rate 0.644
735
Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1
Comtech Ultra-Low-Latency
Uncoded (ULL) Codec - Rate 0.493
BPSK/QPSK
1E-2
BPSK/QPSK,
0.654 and 0.734 QPSK
1E-4
1E-6
1E-7
1E-8
1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER
Figure 7-23. ULL Codec BPSK/QPSK Rate 0.493 and QPSK, Rate 0.654 and 0.734
736
Eb/No i n dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1
Differential
Encoding -
No FEC, no
1E-2 Uncoded BPSK/QPSK
scrambling
1E-3
1E-4
1E-5
1E-6
1E-7
1E-8
1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER
737
Notes:
738
AUPC is an acronym for Automatic Uplink Power Control. This feature permits a local modem to
adjust its own output power level in order to attempt to maintain the Eb/No at the remote
modem. To accomplish this, you must use one of the following framing types:
D&I++
ESC++
Framed QDI
The remote modem constantly sends back information about the demodulator Eb/No using
reserved bytes in the overhead structure. The local modem then compares this value of Eb/No
with a pre-defined target value. If the Remote Eb/No is below the target, the local modem will
increase its output power, creating a closed-loop feedback system over the satellite link. A
particularly attractive benefit of this feature is that, whenever framed operation is selected, the
remote demodulators Eb/No can be viewed from the front panel display of the local modem.
Note that both EDMAC and AUPC can be used simultaneously with either framing type.
There are several important parameters associated with this mode of operation. You must
understand how the AUPC feature works, and what the implications are for setting these
parameters.
81
1) Use the SELECT: Configuration Mode menu to first select EDMAC framing. You may
select EDMAC as IDLE, or define the unit as an EDMAC Master or Slave.
2) Verify that the remote modem also has EDMAC framing enabled.
3) Set the nominal output power of the modem: Use the SELECT: Configuration Tx
POWER menu to select MANUAL mode, and then edit the displayed Tx output power level.
4) Select AUPC as the operating mode. At this point, you are prompted to define four key
parameters: Target Eb/No, Max Range, Alarm, and Demod Unlock.
The minimum value to enter is 0.0 dB. If the Eb/No falls below this value, the AUPC
control will increase the Tx output power, but will never exceed the value determined
by the parameter MAX RANGE.
The maximum value to enter is 14.9 dB. If the Eb/No exceeds this value, the AUPC
control will reduce the Tx output power, but will never drop below the nominal value
set.
82
8.2.3 Alarm
This defines modem behavior if the maximum power limit is reached while under AUPC control.
The two choices are:
NOMINAL (reduce the Tx Output Power to the nominal value) default setting.
MAXIMUM (increase the Tx Output Power to the maximum value permitted by the
parameter MAX RANGE).
If the local demod loses lock, then the modem automatically moves its output power
to the nominal value.
First, corrections for which the output power can be made are fixed at the rate of once
every 4 seconds. This takes into account the round trip delay over the satellite link, the
time taken for a power change to be reflected in the remote demodulators value of
Eb/No, and other processing delays in the modems.
Second, if the comparison of actual and target Eb/No yields a result that requires a
change in output power, to avoid the possibility of overshoot the first correction made
will be at 80% of the calculated step. Subsequent corrections are made until the
difference is less than 0.5 dB. At this point, the output power is only changed in
increments of 0.1 dB to avoid hunting around the correct set point.
83
8.4 Monitoring
Comtech F Data strongly cautions against the use of large values of permitted
power level increase under AUPC control. Users should consider using the absolute
minimum range necessary to improve rain-fade margin.
The remote demodulators value of Eb/No can be monitored at all times, either from the front
panel (SELECT: Monitor AUPC) or via the remote control interface. The resolution of the
reading is 0.2 dB. For all values greater than or equal to 16 dB, a value of 16.0 dB will be
displayed. As long as framing is enabled, the value will still be available, even though AUPC may
be disabled.
The current value of Tx power increase is also displayed. If EDMAC framing is enabled but AUPC
is disabled, this will indicate 0.0 dB. This value is also available via the remote control interface.
84
Synchronous clock and data interfaces (EIA-422, V.35, etc.) that permit great flexibility
concerning the source and direction of clocks. These cause the most confusion.
G.703 interfaces, in which the clock and data are combined into a single signal (and are
referred to as self-clocking). In their basic form, these are less flexible and therefore
easier to understand. However, when used with Drop and Insert operation, the subject
again becomes more complex.
G.703 and ASI: The internal clock mode does not apply the clock is always recovered from the
incoming signal, and the modem locks its modulator clocks to this.
91
9.2.2 TX Terrestrial
In this mode, the modem expects to see the DTE provide the clock so that it can phase-lock its
internal circuits. In this case, the modem does not provide any signal on ST, but instead requires
a clock signal on Terminal Timing (TT) that is synchronous with the data. If no clock is present, an
alarm will be generated and the modem will substitute its internal clock.
92
RS-422, V.35, HSSI, and LVDS are the only interfaces supported and used on the Type D
25-pin connector.
93
G.703: Applicable.
G.703: Applicable.
G.703: Applicable.
94
95
If Modem = DCE (normal assumption), then X.21 mode is just a matter of ignoring ST and TT
and, instead, using RT to run both directions. Using the clock settings TX Clk = Loop and RX
Buffer Clk = RX assumes that the desired timing is coming from the far-end modem. The
modems ST is forced to be a copy of RT, because the latter assumes use by the terrestrial DTE
to drive SD data into the modem.
If, instead, the local modem supplies the timing, the clock settings should be TX Clk = Int and RX
Buffer Clk = TX or Int. These settings instead force RT to be a copy of ST. In either case, it is SD
that has an uncertain phase relationship to the clock due to round-trip delays, so the modems
TX clock invert feature may be necessary to avoid clocking in SD on its transitions.
If Modem = DTE, then ST and RT are ignored, and TT from the terrestrial DCE is used. The
correct modem settings are TX Clk = TT and RX Buffer Clk = TX. These settings force RT (which
drives out the modems RD) to be a copy of TT. It is now RD that has an uncertain phase
relationship to the clock, so the modems RX clock invert may be necessary to please the
terrestrial DCE.
The D&I option provides fully compliant baseband processing in accordance with Intelsat
IESS-309 for the terrestrial information rate of 2048 kbps (E1) and 1544 kbps (T1), using G.703
interfaces. The data rate sent over the satellite link is n x 64 kbps. See the Frame Formats
diagram for the permissible values of n. The modem provides the interface to transmission level
framing compliant to IESS-309 Data Type 2.
96
Time 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30
Slot 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
No.
Reserved for May be reserved for Signalling. All signalling
Framing information is common to all 30 TS and no signalling is
transmitted.
Time 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30
Slot 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
No.
Reserved for Reserved for Signalling. All signalling is transmitted
Framing for TS's dropped in IBS overhead (500Hz per TS)
Signalling information in TS 16 is associated to
specific TS's.
Time 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
Slot 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
No.
Time 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
Slot 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
No.
97
For E1, you can select any timeslot (TS) from 1 to 31. Selection of TS 0 is permitted (on the front
panel menus, use z to add to the list of timeslots to be dropped/inserted).
For T1, you can select any timeslot (TS) from 1 to 24. You may also select N/A to leave a
satellite channel unused.
The configuration menu allows timeslots to be selected for transmission or reception up to the
maximum dictated by the selected transmit or receive data rate, and may be selected in
arbitrary order. For example, if the data rate is set to 256 kbps, the maximum number of
timeslots that can be dropped or inserted is 4 (being 4 x 64 kbps).
Note that, for 1920 kbps data rate, the timeslots may not be manipulated. This is the fixed
channel mode where Timeslot 1 is assigned to Channel 1, and so on.
For D&I++ framing, all increments of 64 kbps are allowed up to a maximum of 31 (1984 kbps).
For this mode, the satellite rate is 46/45 of the front panel data rate (2.22%).
98
This arrangement permits you to choose between fully independent operation of the incoming
and outgoing E1/T1 signal, or to use the same T1/E1 signal for both Dropping and Inserting
(looped mode). If Loop has been selected under the Drop and Insert configuration menu, the
Drop Data Out (DDO) signal is automatically looped internally, to become the Insert Data In (IDI).
In this mode, timeslots are dropped from an incoming E1/T1 signal for transmission over the
satellite, and the same E1/T1 signal has timeslots re-inserted into it that will over-write data in
existing timeslots.
99
If Insert is not the selected buffer clock reference, the clock and data from the IDI port is
ignored, and a new E1/T1 frame is generated. The timeslots coming from the satellite are then
re-inserted into the selected timeslots of this new blank frame, and output on the IDO port.
IDI
Multiple Modem Drop & Insert Application: This application shows how the loop is extended
to one or more additional modems.
Terrestrial Trunk
DDO- IDI connection may be made internally using Loop = Y under D&I menu.
910
This is accomplished by the use of a novel frequency synthesis and phase locking scheme. This
feature of the CDM-625 permits the distant end to generate a G.703 synchronizing signal that,
depending on a sufficiently accurate local reference, has short term accuracy to within parts in
10-8, and is solely dependent on link Doppler shift.
The subsections and figures that follow illustrate three possible G.703 clock extension modes.
Details of how to set up the modems for these various operating modes are given in Chapter 5.
FRONT PANEL OPERATION.
(Note: the G.703 signal is not intended to convey data its function is only to provide a
synchronizing clock. The data is transferred using the EIA-530/V.35 serial interface.)
The internal clock reference generator locks in both frequency and phase to this recovered
clock, and a special synthesizer generates an ST clock of ANY ARBITRARY FREQUENCY over the
range 2.4 kHz to 9.98 MHz with a resolution of 1 Hz. The synthesis is exact there is no
approximation or residual error. For example, if you select 168.231 kbps as the transmit data
rate, and an E1 reference, there will be exactly 168,231 clock cycles generated for every
2,048,000 cycles of the E1 reference.
The internal ST clock is now used, as in the standard Internal Clock mode, to provide the timing
reference for the externally-connected equipment. The data is then transmitted at the desired
data rate to the distant end (or distant ends this works for broadcast applications as well).
Now, at the distant end modem (timing mode: RX Satellite), the RX signal is received,
demodulated, and the clock is recovered. A second synthesizer, very similar to the one used at
the local modem, is now used to generate an E1 or T1 timing signal. Again, it should be
911
emphasized that the synthesis is exact. The net result is that the E1 or T1 timing signal used at
the local end is reproduced at the distant end, regardless of the link data rate.
The only thing that affects the overall accuracy and stability of the copy of the clock is the
Doppler shift of the link itself. This will be very dependent on the particular satellite used, and
the accuracy of the orbital station keeping (often referred to as orbital inclination). Typically the
Doppler variations are in the order of parts in 10-8, but more importantly it should be recognized
that, over a 24 hour period, the net error would be zero due to a fundamental characteristics of
geostationary orbits.
The T1 or E1 signal, available on the rear panel of the modem on the G.703 connectors, is now
used to provide a synchronizing source for equipment connected to the modem. The form of
this is an all ones signal, which provides the maximum transition density in the AMI signal.
Note: This scheme is sufficiently flexible to permit an E1 signal to be used at the local end, and a
T1 signal to be reproduced at the distant end, or vice versa.
At the distant end, an E1 or T1 synchronizing signal is generated regardless of the link data rate,
as in Mode 1.
At the distant end, an E1 or T1 synchronizing signal is generated regardless of the link data rate,
as in Mode 1
.
912
CDM-625 CDM-625
913
CDM-625 CDM-625
914
CDM-625 CDM-625
915
Selected timeslots for each active port are dropped onto the transmit satellite frame in order
of port number and drop channel number, with the reverse insert operation on the receive
side. For each port, if n=32 is selected, then it is not assumed that the E1 into the modem
contains framing. Data may be framed or unframed, and the modem will simply transmit the
entire 2048 kbps stream on that ports portion of the satellite frame; this is why timeslot
selection is disabled for n=32. However, for any fractional value of n, the incoming E1 to that
port must have TS0 framing so that the selected timeslots to be dropped can be identified.
Beginning with Firmware Version 2.0.1, changes to Quad E1 operation allow the combining of
asynchronous E1 streams. Prior to Firmware Version 2.0.1, it was important for all ports to be
synchronous to one another in order to operate without data loss bit stuffing is now
performed on slower data streams to match them to faster ones. Satellite overhead is used to
identify extra data on each port that was sent over the link. The extra data is then removed at
the receiver, so that each ports timing is maintained. As a result, it is important that the ports
used and the number of timeslots for each port match at both ends of the link. The
recommendation for G.703 requires that the actual bit rate be within 50 ppm of 2048 kbps.
If asynchronous E1 streams are used at the transmit side of the link, it is important to keep the
receive buffer set to Rx Satellite. The Tx Terrestrial setting should only be used if all E1
streams are synchronous to one another (no bit stuffing over the satellite frame) and the
resulting E1 streams from the receiver need to be retimed to a local reference.
There is a hardware limitation for base modem boards previous to HW Rev 2.x (see front panel
under the SELECT: FAST menu): Older boards use a common receive E1 clock for ports 3 and 4,
so it is necessary that ports 3 and 4 at the transmitting modem remain synchronized to one
another.
916
10.1 Introduction
Space segment costs are typically the most significant operating expense for any satellite-based
service, having a direct impact on the viability and profitability of the service. For a satellite
transponder that has finite resources in terms of bandwidth and power, the leasing costs are
determined by bandwidth and power used. Therefore, a satellite circuit should be designed for
optimal utilization to use a similar share of transponder bandwidth and power.
The traditional approach to balancing a satellite circuit once the satellite and earth station
parameters are fixed involves trade-off between modulation and coding. A lower order
modulation requires less transponder power while using more bandwidth; conversely, higher
order modulation reduces required bandwidth, albeit at a significant increase in power.
1
DoubleTalk is licensed from Raytheon Applied Signal Technology.
DoubleTalk is a registered trademark of Raytheon Applied Signal Technology.
Carrier-in-Carrier is a registered trademark of Comtech EF Data.
101
CnC was first introduced in Comtech EF Datas CDM-Qx Satellite Modem and, more recently, in
the CLO-10 Link Optimizer. The implementation of DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier in the CDM-625
has been further refined, and some of the limitations that existed in the CDM-Qx
implementation have been overcome.
Reduced operating expense (OPEX) e.g., Occupied Bandwidth & Transponder Power;
A CDM-625 must be used at the end of the link where the cancellation needs to take
place.
The transponder is operated as Loopback. That is, each end of the link must be able to
see a copy of its own signal in the return (downlink) path from the satellite. The looped
back signal is then subtracted which leaves the signal from the distant end of the link.
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier cannot be used in spot beam systems.
Figure 10-1 shows a simplified conceptual block diagram of CnC processing. The two ends of the
link are denoted A and B and the uplink and downlink are shown.
102
1) Time varying delay: In addition to the static delays of the electronics and the round-trip
delay associated with propagation to the satellite and back, there is a time-varying
component due to movement of the satellite. The CnC module tracks and compensates
for this variation.
2) Frequency offset and drift: Common sources are satellite Doppler shift, up and down
converter frequency uncertainties, and other drift associated with the electronics in the
CDM-625 itself. The CnC module tracks and compensates for this frequency offset and
drift.
3) Atmospheric effects: Fading and scintillation can affect amplitude, phase, and spectral
composition of the signal and the degree to which it correlates with the original signal.
The CnC module tracks and compensates for these atmospheric related impairments.
103
4) Link Asymmetries: Various asymmetries in the forward and return link can produce
differences in the relative power of the two received signal components. These can be
both deterministic (static) or random (and time varying). An example of the former
would be the differences resulting from antenna size/gain variations between the two
ends of the link. An example of the latter would be transient power differences due to
different levels of atmospheric fading in the uplinks. CnC compensates for the
asymmetries, up to a certain extent.
In a number of ways, CnC carriers behave similar to conventional carriers in satellite links. They
are both exposed to adjacent carriers, cross-polarization and rain fade, and exhibit impairments
when any of these become too great. In addition, CnC operates in an environment where:
Both earth stations share the same footprint so each sees both carriers
Keep the search delay range as narrow as possible once the modem has reported the
search delay, narrow the search delay range to the nominal reported value 5 ms for
example, if the modem reported delay is 245 ms, narrow the search range to say 240-
250 ms
Use external data source (e.g. Firebird) or internal BER tester when testing Carrier-in-
Carrier performance
To prevent self-locking in case the desired carrier is lost, it is recommended that the two
carriers have some configuration difference for example, use different settings for
Spectrum Inversion
104
The transponder downlinks the composite signal containing both carriers on the same band to
the CDM-625 which then translates the signal to near baseband where it can be filtered
(decimated) and then processed as a complex envelope signal. The CDM-625 then suppresses
the version of the near end carrier on the downlink side and then passes the desired carrier to
the demodulator for normal processing.
To further illustrate, as shown in Figure 10-4, without DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier, the two
carriers in a typical full duplex satellite link are adjacent to each other. With DoubleTalk Carrier-
in-Carrier, only the composite signal is visible when observed on a spectrum analyzer. Carrier 1
and Carrier 2, shown here for reference only, are overlapping, thus sharing the same spectrum.
105
Because acquiring the delay and frequency offset of the interfering carrier is fundamentally a
correlation operation, anything deterministic in the interfering carrier (within the correlation
window of the algorithm) will potentially produce false correlation peaks and result in incorrect
delays and/or frequency. Normally, this is not a problem, since energy dispersal techniques are
utilized in the vast majority of commercial and military modems. However, it is something that
106
must be kept in mind when troubleshooting a system that utilizes the DoubleTalk Carrier-in-
Carrier technique for signal suppression.
One possible way to mitigate false peaks is to narrow the correlation window. For example, if
the delay is known to be around 240ms, set the minimum search delay to 230ms and the
maximum search delay to 250ms.
As all advances in modem technologies including advanced modulation and FEC techniques
approach their theoretical limits of power and bandwidth efficiencies, DoubleTalk Carrier-in-
Carrier allows satellite users to achieve spectral efficiencies (bps/Hz) that cannot be achieved
with modulation and FEC alone. Table 10-1 illustrates how DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier, when
used with 16-QAM, approaches the bandwidth efficiency of 256-QAM (8bps/Hz).
Table 10-1. Spectral Efficiency using DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier
As shown here, DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier allows equivalent spectral efficiency using a lower
order modulation and/or FEC Code Rate; CAPEX is therefore reduced by allowing the use of a
smaller BUC/HPA and/or antenna. And, as DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier can be used to save
transponder bandwidth and/or transponder power, it can be successfully deployed in
bandwidth-limited as well as power-limited scenarios.
When a full duplex satellite connection is established between two sites, separate satellite
channels are allocated for each direction. If both directions transmitted on the same channel,
each side would normally find it impossible to extract the desired signal from the aggregate due
107
to interference originating from its local modulator. However since this interference is produced
locally, it is possible to estimate and remove its influence prior to demodulation of the data
transmitted from the remote location.
Referring to Figure 10-5: Modem 1 and Modem 2 transmit signals S1 and S2 respectively. The
satellite receives, translates, and retransmits the composite signal. The downlink signals S1* and
S2*, received at Modem 1 and Modem 2 differ from the transmit signals primarily in terms of
phase, frequency, and delay offsets.
108
The resulting estimate of the unwanted interfering signal is then subtracted from the composite
signal. In practical applications, the estimate of the unwanted signal can be extremely accurate.
Unwanted interfering signal suppression of 30 dB or more has been achieved in commercial
products with minimal degradation of the demodulator performance.
Carrier-in-Carrier combined with VersaFEC ACM can provide 100-200% increase in average
throughput.
For optimal Carrier-in-Carrier performance, it is recommended that the two carriers have similar
symbol rate and power. This can be achieved by selecting appropriate ModCods as shown in
following sections.
109
The traditional link was based on QPSK TPC 3/4 and required 0.96 MHz of leased BW. The LST 2
summary for the traditional link is as follows:
Carrier-in-Carrier link design involved trying different Modulation & FEC Code Rates to find the
optimal combination:
2
LST is Intelsats Lease Transmission Plan Program.
1010
Link parameters and LST summary for QPSK, LDPC 2/3 with Carrier-in-Carrier is as follows:
1011
The link budget summary for the different ModCod combinations is as follows:
PSD
Allocated Leased BW Savings Compared
S. No. Modulation & FEC PEB (MHz) Ratio
BW (MHz) (MHz) to Original
(dB)
1 8-QAM, LDPC 2/3 0.3584 1.1468 1.1468 -20% 2.1
2 QPSK, LDPC 3/4 0.47785 0.6734 0.6734 30% 2.1
3 QPSK, LDPC 2/3 0.53735 0.5777 0.5777 40% 2.1
4 QPSK, LDPC 1/2 0.7168 0.5184 0.7168 25% 2.1
Based on this analysis, QPSK, LDPC 2/3 with Carrier-in-Carrier provides the maximum savings of
40%. In addition to 40% reduction in Leased Bandwidth, using Carrier-in-Carrier also reduced the
required HPA Power by almost 40%:
Lower order modulation uses less transponder power this reduces total transponder,
and increases available link margin;
Lower order modulation uses less transmit power on the ground this can significantly
reduce the BUC/SSPA size by not only reducing the transmit EIRP, but also reducing the
BUC/SSPA backoff
While the traditional link was based on QPSK, TPC 3/4 and required 3.9 MHz of leased
bandwidth, the Carrier-in-Carrier link was based on QPSK, LDPC 3/4 and QPSK, LDPC 1/2 and
required 2.8 MHz of leased bandwidth.
1012
If this link was designed using QPSK, LDPC 3/4 in both directions, it would have required:
1013
Whereas the original link used 8-PSK TPC 3/4, the Carrier-in-Carrier link used QPSK VersaFEC
0.803. The savings summary is as follows:
Using Carrier-in-Carrier and VersaFEC reduced the leased bandwidth by almost 44% and HPA
power by 60%.
1014
The following steps are recommended for Carrier-in-Carrier commissioning and deployment:
Step Task
1 Turn ON the carrier at Site A. Carrier from Site B is OFF. CnC function is OFF at both sites.
Using a spectrum analyzer, measure Co+No/No at the input to the modem at Site A.
Using a spectrum analyzer, measure Co+No/No at the input to the modem at Site B.
Measure/record Eb/No at Site B. Make sure there is sufficient margin to account for
CnC.
Measure/record Receive Signal Level (RSL) at Site B.
2 Turn OFF the carrier at Site A. Turn ON the carrier at Site B. CnC function is OFF at both sites.
Using a spectrum analyzer, measure Co+No/No at the input to the modem at Site A.
Using a spectrum analyzer, measure Co+No/No at the input to the modem at Site B.
Measure/record Eb/No at Site A. Make sure there is sufficient margin to account for
CnC.
Measure/record RSL at Site B.
3 Using Co+No/No readings calculate PSD ratio at Site A and Site B. If it is not within
specification, make necessary adjustments to bring it within specification and repeat
measurements in Step (1) and (2).
Also verify that the RSL is within spec.
4 Now without changing the transmit power levels, turn ON both the carriers (on the same
frequency) and turn CnC ON.
Measure/record Eb/No at Site A and B.
Measure/record RSL at Site A and B.
Now compare Eb/No in presence of 2 over lapping carriers with CnC with Eb/No when
only 1 carrier was ON. Eb/No variation should be within spec for that modulation, FEC
and PSD ratio.
5 The test can be repeated for different PSD ratio and Eb/No.
1015
1016
2 Verify that the PDS ration is within spec for the CDM-625.
3 Calculate the Allocated Bandwidth (BW) and Power Equivalent Bandwidth (PEB) for the duplex
link:
BWDuplex Link = Greater of (BWCarrier 1, BWCarrier 2)
4 For an optimal link, the Leased Bandwidth and the Power Equivalent Bandwidth should be
equal / nearly equal.
5 Repeat the link budget process by selecting different Modulation and FEC, until the BW and
PEB is nearly balanced.
1017
1018
CnC Ratio (in dB) = PowerC1 (in dBm) PowerC2 (in dBm)
PSD Ratio (in dB) = (PowerC1 10 log BWC1 (in Hz)) (PowerC2 10 log BWC2 (in Hz))
= CnC Ratio 10 log (BWC1 / BWC2)
If the two carriers have same Symbol Rate / Bandwidth, then the CnC Ratio is same as the PSD
Ratio.
1019
10.6.1 Introduction
A number of Comtech EF Data modems, including the CDM-625, offer Automatic Uplink Power
Control (AUPC) to mitigate the effects of rain fading and other link impairments.
It is important to note that the simple system employed in AUPC (whereby distant-end Eb/No is
monitored, and local power is increased when a degraded link is detected) has an undesirable
characteristic, which leads to some operators not permitting its use on their transponders: The
inability of classic AUPC to determine at which side of link the fade (or other impairment) has
occurred. More specifically:
If the fade is at the local side, all is well the drop in Eb/No at the distant site
corresponds exactly to the drop in power (due to excess attenuation) on the local
uplink; when uplink power is increased, the power at the transponder does not exceed
its clear-sky value.
Conversely, if the fade occurs at the distant side, the AUPC system increases power in
exactly the same way but now, there is no excess uplink attenuation and, as a result,
the clear-sky power at the satellite will be exceeded.
In a transponder with many carriers using AUPC, a fade event at the wrong side can cause
many carriers to simultaneously increase power beyond their authorized maximums, leading to
intermod problems, adjacent channel interference (ACI) issues, and in some extreme cases,
saturation of the transponder.
When considering power control in the Carrier-in-Carrier case, not only must the issue of
exceeding allocated power limits be respected, but the problem of driving CnC ratios outside
working limits during fading must also be taken into account.
1020
carrier in the CnC pair. Furthermore, the power control algorithm developed by Comtech EF
Data ensures that the CnC ratio remains within the correct working range.
Carrier 1
Do
k wn
lin lin
Up kt
o
Composite Carrier
T1 T2
Satellite
Target PSD
T1 T2
to
k Up
lin Carrier 2 lin Carrier 1
wn k
Do
Carrier 2
Terminal 1 Terminal 2
Satellite Link CnC Carriers
Whenever power is adjusted on Carrier 1, the power in Carrier 2 needs to be adjusted so the
composite carrier power remains constant (or does not exceed its allocated limit), while keeping
the CnC ratio within limits.
1) In order for the CnC-APC algorithm to work effectively, it must first analyze the CnC Ratio
and Eb/No margins on each side of the link, and based on the starting conditions, re-
distribute power between the two ends so that good protection against fades can be
achieved. This process is referred as re-balancing, and is done so that total composite power
(TCP) in the two carriers remains constant (within 0.5 dB).
In this process, both sides of the link calculate power changes, based on their ability to see
not only local parameters, including CnC Ratio, Eb/No, Receive signal level, power level and
max power increase, but those of the modem at the other end of the link. After these
calculations are performed, a comparison of the results is performed, and if they are in close
agreement, the power changes are implemented.
It may not always be possible to drive the powers to an optimum point. The calculations
take into account:
The minimum and maximum power levels possible in the modem (which is affected
by the operating band 70/140 MHz IF versus L-Band).
1021
If the power changes calculated would put the CnC Ratio out of its working range.
If the Rx signal level is above its minimum level if it is not, the CnC Ratio monitor
will not be accurate, which is essential correct calculations.
If the power change would result in the Eb/No margin on either side becoming
negative (see below).
At the end of the re-balance procedure, the modem will display the result:
Full re-balance.
Partial re-balance.
In the case of a partial or no re-balance, the modem displays the reason for this result; you
can then adjust an operating parameter and try again.
IMPORTANT NOTES:
You should be aware that after the re-balance has been carried out, it is
very likely that the CnC Ratio will not be at 0dB, and the Eb/No margins will
not be equal. This is particularly true for cases where there is an asymmetry
in antenna size, terminal G/T, symbol rate etc. This is an inherent function
of the re-balancing algorithm, and is not a cause for concern.
It is not necessary for there to be a person at each end the re-balance can
be initiated from either side, with the other side unattended.
Following the re-balance, the CDM-625 stores key parameters, such as Tx Power level, that
are referred to as the Home State. In the event of a loss of communication between the two
sides, the modem will revert to Home State, which is a known safe condition that will not
cause TCP to be exceeded. Once the link conditions have improved so that communication is
re-established, CnC-APC will automatically re-activate.
2) In the second phase of the algorithm, Eb/No, CnC ratio, and RSL are continuously
monitored. For every combination of the modulation, FEC type and FEC code rate, the
modem calculates an Eb/No margin. An Eb/No margin of 0 dB is arbitrarily determined to
be the Eb/No value that produces a BER of 1 x 10-7 at the output of the decoder, plus 1 dB.
If the algorithm senses that Eb/No margin is dropping, power is increased at one or both
1022
ends of the link, but in a manner that ensures that TCP is not exceeded. In the vast majority
of cases the TCP during a fade will not exceed its clear-sky value by more than +0.5 dB.
The algorithm uses a number of inputs, from both sides of the link, including a knowledge of
the satellite band in use (which you are required to know at the time of set-up). The
characteristics of rain fading changes with frequency, and there are different models for
C-Band, X-Band, Ku-Band, and Ka-Band. Not only does downlink attenuation vary as a
function rain rate, but in some cases (depending on the G/T of the terminals at each end,
and the satellite transponder itself) may be dominated by an increase in receive noise
temperature when the antenna is pointing through rain and clouds, rather than cold sky.
The depth of fade that the CnC-APC algorithm can tolerate is highly dependent on a number
of factors, including:
The CnC Ratio and Eb/No margins following a re-balance. In general, with a highly
asymmetric link, where CnC Ratio is not close to zero, the tolerance to fade depth
on one side will be less than the other.
The maximum permitted level of power increase that you have defined. If, for
example, you have programmed a TPLImax value of 2 dB (because thats the only
headroom the RF chain has) you should not expect the link to tolerate a fast 10 dB
fade at Ku-Band.
Recognizing that this overhead needs to have a minimal impact on occupied bandwidth and
Eb/No performance, the overhead has been kept as low as possible:
The overhead rate is fixed at 0.5%, causing the symbol rate of the carrier to grow by an
almost imperceptible amount (no need to re-calculate channel spacing) and causing a
loss of Eb/No performance of only 0.02dB.
This choice of overhead rate effectively gives you the functionality of the CnC-APC
channel without having to pay a penalty in power or bandwidth its essentially free.
The CnC-APC channel constantly passes a number of metrics and parameters, including CnC
Ratio, Eb/No, Receive signal level, power level and max power increase, as well as information
required for the initial set-up, including the modem operating band (L-Band or 70/140 MHz),
and the satellite band in use.
In addition to the information fields in the frame, there is a control field that permits commands
to be sent from one side or the other during initial re-balancing, and re-balancing during fade
events.
1023
Note that the CnC-APC frame size (and the latency associated with it) limits the lower end of the
range of bit rates that are supported to 64 kbps. If you select the CnC-APC mode at a data rate
below 64 kbps, an error message will be generated if a re-balance operation is requested.
In the case where both ends of the link are up and running, the CnC canceller performs as
intended. However, if the carrier at the remote side stops transmitting a carrier, the CnC
canceller will still cancel the interferer (its own outbound Tx signal), but the cancelation is not
perfect (it may be in the order -30 dB) and hence a weak signal appears at the input to the
demodulator that, because of the correct settings of data rate, FEC and modulation, is
sometimes acquired by the demod. This can sometimes be an issue because, although the Tx
carrier from the distant side is not transmitting, no demodulator alarm is generated and hence
the local end is not alerted and data being transmitted is looped back to the receiver, and back
into the network.
The use of CnC-APC framing provides the means to eliminate the self-locking problem. Rather
than having an identical framing structure for the local and distant sides of the link, by
designating each side as Side A and Side B, each side has a different framing structure and is
therefore non-identical and incompatible. This makes it impossible for a modem in this CnC
mode to lock to itself. With this approach, there is no master-slave relationship both sides
are peers, and either side can be designated as A or B.
This procedure should be done only when there are CLEAR SKY conditions at both ends
of the link.
1) Set up the CnC link in normal mode according to the instructions earlier in this chapter, and
according to an appropriately calculated link budget.
1024
The initial selection of CnC-APC normally requires that a person be present at both ends, to
coordinate the change of CnC from normal to CnC-APC mode. Alternately, if an IP
connection is available to the distant end that does not depend on the satellite link for
primary connectivity, the setup can be performed remotely.
Once the link is established, a further re-balance, activation or suspension does not require
another person to be present, or independent remote IP access.
2) Once the normal CnC link has been established, determine that the link is stable and that it
has an acceptable link margin at both ends.
4) From the CDM-625 front panel, select the CONFIG CnC Mode menu:
On the top line, use the arrow keys to select the appropriate CnC operating mode.
Available selections are:
Once the mode has been selected, press ENTER do not select Activate (on the bottom
line) yet.
If Side A is selected at both sides, or Side B is selected at both sides, both modems
will display a Frame Sync fault (under Rx faults). No further action is possible until
this error has been corrected.
If different satellite bands are selected on each side (for instance, Side A is Ku-Band,
while side B is C-Band) the modem will display an APC Band Mismatch fault (under
Rx faults). No further action is possible until this error has been corrected.
5) Based on the known RF terminal equipment in use, determine a value for the maximum
allowed power increase (TPLImax) and then set this value. From the CDM-625 front panel,
select the CONFIG Tx Power menu:
1025
On the bottom line, to edit the power output level and the maximum permitted increase in
power level when in APC Mode: Use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit, and then
use the arrow keys to change the value of that digit. Press ENTER when done.
Note that when APC is in an active state, the value of the power level displayed in the
bottom left will show AUTO.
6) Go back to the SELECT: CONFIG CnC MODE menu. On the bottom line, which will be
displaying Activate? N (Y,N ), use the arrow keys to select Y(Yes)and then
press ENTER.
The message on the bottom line can be any one of the following:
1026
If the message shown begins with OK, then after approximately 5 seconds, the display
changes as per the following example:
At this point, as indicated on the bottom line of the display, CnC-APC is active.
To suspend CnC-APC at any time: On the bottom line, which will be displaying Suspend?
N (Y,N), use the arrow keys to select Y(Yes)and then press ENTER. The CnC-APC
status message on the bottom line of the display will update accordingly, as per the
following example:
If a message other than OK is displayed after attempting to perform a re-balance, the CnC-
APC system will not activate, and you should correct the link conditions before re-
attempting to activate it.
IMPORTANT NOTE:
1027
2. At this time, 1:N redundancy in the CRS-300/CRS-500 is not yet supported a firmware
update for these switches will be available in the future. Please consult Comtech EF Data
Technical Support for updated information.
1028
Note: With asymmetric carriers the absolute power ratio (or CnC ratio) would be different,
depending on the ratio of the symbol rates.
Example:
Absolute power ratio (CnC Ratio) = +7dB + (10 log Outbound/desired symbol rate) = +10 dB
Maximum Symbol Rate Ratio 3:1 (TX:RX or RX:TX)
Inbound/Outbound Within the normal acquisition range of the demod, as follows:
frequency uncertainty
Below 64 ksymbols/sec: 1 to (Rs/2) kHz, where Rs = symbol rate in ksymbols/sec
Monitor Functions Frequency offset (between outbound interferer and desired inbound). 100 Hz resolution
1029
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier can only be used for full duplex links where the
transmitting earth station is able to receive itself.
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier can be used in both bandwidth limited and power limited
situations.
The maximum savings is generally achieved when the original link is symmetric in data
rate.
10.9 Glossary
Bandwidth, Allocated or Occupied
Bandwidth or Allocated Bandwidth or Occupied Bandwidth is the frequency space required by a carrier on
a transponder.
For example: A Duplex 10 Mbps Circuit with 8PSK Modulation, FEC Rate 3/4 and 1.4 Spacing requires:
Allocated BW = (DR / SE) * CSF [(Data Rate / Spectral Efficiency) * Carrier Spacing Factor]
Almost all satellite operators charge for the Leased Bandwidth (LBW). Leased Bandwidth or Leased
Resource is the greater of the Allocated Bandwidth and Power Equivalent Bandwidth.
For example: If a carrier requires 3 MHz of Allocated BW and 4.5 MHz of PEB, the Leased Bandwidth is 4.5
MHz
Power Equivalent Bandwidth (PEB) is the transponder power used by a carrier, represented as bandwidth
equivalent.
1030
2.4
If a carrier uses 24 dBW, its PEB = 10 / 55.424 = 4.532 MHz
CnC Ratio
The Interfering Carrier is the Tx Carrier from local modulator; the Desired Carrier is the carrier from the
distant end received by the local demodulator.
At the station transmitting C1: CnC Ratio (in dB) = PowerC1 (in dBm) PowerC2 (in dBm)
Eb/No
Ratio of Energy per bit (Eb) to Noise density (No) (unit in dB):
Es/No
Ratio of Energy per symbol (Es) to Noise density (No) (unit in dB):
C/N
Ratio of Carrier Power (C) to Noise (N) (unit in dB):
C/No
1031
Co+No/No
Ratio of Carrier Density (Co) + Noise (No) to Noise Density (No) (unit in dB):
PSD Ratio
Ratio of Power Spectral Density (PSD) of the interfering carrier to the desired carrier.
[Note: PER (packet error rate) is based upon a 188-byte MPEG frame size]
1032
11.1.1 EDMAC
EDMAC is an acronym for Embedded Distant-end Monitor And Control. This feature permits
user access to the M&C features of modems that are at the distant-end of a satellite link. This is
accomplished by adding extra information to your data, but in a manner that is otherwise
transparent.
The data is split into frames each frame containing 1008 bits (except Rate 21/44 BPSK Turbo,
or when the data rates exceed 2048 kbps, where the frame length is 2928 bits, and Rate 5/16
BPSK Turbo where the frame length is 3072 bits). 48 bits in each frame are overhead, and the
rest of these bits are user data. This increases the rate of transmission by 5% (approximately
1.5% for the Turbo BPSK cases, and for all data rates greater than 2.048 Mbps). For example, if
the user data rate is 64 kbps, the actual transmission rate will now be at 67.2 kbps. Note that
you may also select EDMAC-2 framing, which always uses a 2928 bit frame, and yields a 1.6%
overhead for all modulation types and data rates.
At the start of each frame, a 12-bit synchronization word is added. This allows the demodulator
to find and lock to the start of frame. At regular intervals throughout the frame, additional data
bytes and flag bits are added (a further 36 bits in total). It is these additional bytes that convey
the M&C data.
When framing is used, the normal V.35 scrambler is no longer used. This V.35 approach is called
self synchronizing because no external information is required in the receiver in order for the
de-scrambling process to recover the original data.
The disadvantage of this method is that it multiplies errors. On average, if one bit error is
present at the input of the descrambler, three output errors are generated. However, there is an
alternative when the data is in a framed format: in this case, a different class of scrambler may
be used one that uses the start of frame information to start the scrambling process at an
exact known state.
In the receiver, having synchronized to the frame, the de-scrambler can begin its processing at
exactly the right time. This method does not multiply errors, and therefore has a clear
111
advantage over V.35 scrambling. This is fortunate, as there is a penalty to be paid for adding the
framing: by adding the extra 5% to the transmitted data rate, the effective Eb/No that is seen
will degrade by a factor of 10log(1.05), or 0.21 dB (0.07dB in the case of the two BPSK Turbo
rates or EDMAC-2).
The use of an externally synchronized scrambler and descrambler almost exactly compensates
for this degradation. The net effect is that you will see effectively identical BER performance,
whether or not framing is used.
When the demodulator locks to the incoming carrier, it must go through the additional step of
searching for and locking to the synchronization word. This uniquely identifies the start of
frame, and permits the extraction of the overhead bytes and flag bits at the correct position
within the frame. Additionally, the start of frame permits the de-scrambler to correctly recover
the data: your data is extracted and sent through additional processing in the normal manner.
The extracted overhead bytes are examined to determine if they contain valid M&C bytes.
11.1.3 EDMAC-3
EDMAC-3 is another variation of EDMAC, which uses the same rate exchange as the original
EDMAC frame:
With EDMAC-3, however, the EDMAC channel operates at 1/3 the rate of original EDMAC
because most of the overhead is dedicated to carrying the remote modems complete status
information (including AUPC), so that it is available to the near-end modem at nearly real-time
speed. EDMAC-3 is best suited for SNMP proxy applications.
112
Before the M&C data can be successfully transmitted and received, pairs of units must be split
into EDMAC Masters and EDMAC Slaves. Masters are local to the M&C Computer, and Slaves are
distant-end.
Now, a unit that has been designated an EDMAC master not only responds to its own unique
bus address, but it will also be configured to listen for the address that corresponds to its
EDMAC Slave. When a complete message packet has been received by the EDMAC Master, it will
begin to transmit this packet over the satellite channel, using the overhead bytes that become
available.
The normal protocol for the message packet is not used over the satellite path, as it
is subject to errors. For this reason, a much more robust protocol is used which
incorporates extensive error checking.
At the distant-end, the EDMAC slave, configured for the correct address, receives these bytes,
and when a complete packet has been received, it will take the action requested, and then send
the appropriate response to the EDMAC Master, using the return overhead path on the satellite
link. The EDMAC Master assembles the complete packet, and transmits the response back to the
M&C Computer.
Apart from the round-trip satellite delay, the M&C Computer does not see any difference
between local and distant-end units it sends out a packet, addressed to a particular unit, and
gets back a response. It can be seen that the EDMAC Master simply acts as forwarding service, in
a manner that is completely transparent.
This approach does not require any additional cabling; connection is made using the normal
M&C remote port. Furthermore, you do not have to worry about configuring the baud rate of
the M&C connection to match the lowest data rate modem in the system. The M&C system can
have mixed data-rate modems, from 18 kbps to 25 Mbps, and still run at speeds in excess of
19200 baud. It should be pointed out that, at 18 kbps, the effective throughput of the overhead
channel is only 56 asynchronous characters/second. For a message of 24 bytes, the time
between sending a poll request and receiving a response will be around 1 second. (Note that
when EDMAC-2 or either of the BPSK Turbo rates is in use, the overhead rate is reduced by a
factor of three, and therefore the response time will be around 3 seconds.)
113
On the local-end unit, enable framing and EDMAC, define the unit as MASTER, then
enter the bus address. This is constrained to be base 10' meaning that only addresses
such as 10, 20, 30, 40 etc, are allowed.
Choose a unique bus address for the distant-end. This should normally be set to the
base 10' address + 1. For example, if the MASTER unit is set to 30, choose 31 for the
distant-end unit.
On the distant-end unit, enable framing and EDMAC, define the unit as SLAVE, then
enter the bus address. The orange EDMAC Mode LED on the modem front panel should
be illuminated.
Set the local-end unit to RS485 remote control, and set the bus address of this local unit.
The orange Remote Mode LED on the modem front panel should be illuminated.
Once the satellite link has been established, connect the M&C Computer, and begin
communications with both the local and distant end units.
114
Because 38400 baud is the maximum rate available, the actual overhead percentage for ESC++
framing changes as the data rate increases, thereby saving bandwidth at high data rates. The
added overhead is as follows:
Note that 64 kbps is the minimum data rate allowable with ESC++. Depending upon code rate
and modulation used, the modems maximum data rate of 25 Mbps may be used with ESC++. In
all cases, if the Reed-Solomon outer codec is used, the 126/112 ratio is employed with ESC++.
The new frame structure may be used with any FEC codec type available with the CDM-625.
121
12.4 Configuration
Use the SELECT: Configure Mode menu to select ESC++. Then, use the SELECT: Configure
Misc HiRateESC menu select the baud rate and asynchronous character format.
The Eb/No displayed by the modem (SELECT: Monitor RX-Params) takes this into account in
the value that is calculated.
122
However, when band limited QPSK is passed through a non-linearity (e.g., a saturated power
amplifier), there is a tendency for the carefully filtered spectrum to degrade. This phenomenon
is termed spectral regrowth, and at the extreme (hard limiting), the original unfiltered sin(x)/x
spectrum would result. In most systems, this would cause an unacceptable level of interference
to adjacent carriers, and would cause degradation of the BER performance of the corresponding
demodulator.
To overcome the problem of the envelope collapsing to a point of zero amplitude, Offset QPSK
places a delay between I and Q channels of exactly 1/2 symbol. Now, the modulator cannot
transition through zero when faced with non-adjacent phase states; the result is that there is far
less variation in the envelope of the signal, and non-linearities do not cause the same level of
degradation.
The demodulator must realign the I and Q symbol streams before the process of carrier recovery
can take place. For various reasons, this makes the process of acquisition more difficult. In the
CDM-625, the two consequences of this are as follows:
1. Demodulator acquisition may be longer than standard QPSK, especially at low symbol
rates.
2. The acquisition threshold is slightly higher than for normal QPSK. This effect is only an
issue for LDPC Rate 1/2 and TPC Rate 21/44 code rates, where the Eb/No values are
typically less than 2 dB. In this case, the acquisition and tracking threshold is
approximately 1dB higher than for QPSK.
131
Notes:
132
14.2 IBS
Primary Data Rates Supported
G.703 1544, 2048, 6312 and 8448 kbps SD, RD
EIA-422, V.35, LVDS N x 64 kbps SD, RD (up to 8448 kbps)
ADPCM Audio (2 Channels) 64 kbps only, full duplex
141
Alternately, a high-rate ESC channel at up to 1/20th of the primary data rate is available,
using Async EIA-232 format.
142
143
The data rate must be at T1 or E1 rates only. This includes additional links for Drop Data
Out and Insert Data In.
144
14.4 IDR
145
It receives and performs clock and data recovery on incoming G.703 T1 and E1 pseudo-
ternary data.
Clock dejitter is performed per G.823 and G.824, and any data decoding (AMI, B8Z5, or
HDB3) required per G.703 is also accomplished.
It multiplexes in compliance with the standard IESS-308 96 kbps ESC overhead onto the
data and provides both the data and rate-exchanged clock to the modulator portion of
the base modem.
It provides the option of using the ADPCM portion of the satellite overhead for a single
64 kbps ESC data channel in addition to (and with the same format as) the 8 kbps data
channel.
When using G.703 format for the primary IDR data path, the P3B primary data interface
(25-pin) is used for the 8kbps overhead channel. If EIA-422 or V.35 is used, P3B becomes
the primary interface and the 8kbps channel is unavailable.
146
151
This gives you 34 ratios from which to choose. If framing is on, the overhead associated with the
selected frame structure is applied to the primary data only, and the IP ratios above are
fractions of the framed primary data.
IP ratios that put the composite rate above the maximum data rate of the modem cannot be
selected. For example if the primary rate is 8192.000 kbps and the maximum rate of the modem
was 25000.000 kbps, then a ratio above 2 cannot be selected. Also, if Sub-Mux is on and the
primary rate is raised so the composite rate goes above the maximum of the modem, then the
IP ratio will be lowered so that the composite rate stays below the maximum.
Once Sub-Mux is enabled, the data rate display is replaced with the composite rate. This is the
sum of the primary interfaces data rate which now includes framing overhead and the IP
rate at the selected ratio. The later is displayed by itself as IP INFO Rate under the CONFIG: Tx
Tx Data Rate or CONFIG: Rx Rx Data Rate submenu. Note that Reed-Solomon overhead, if
enabled, is also included in the composite rate calculation.
(See Sect. 5.2.1.3 CONFIG: Tx or Sect. 5.2.1.4 CONFIG: Rx and their respective subsections in
Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL OPERATION for detailed information).
Example: For a G.703 E1 primary interface, with a 4/5 Sub-Mux ratio selected:
Unframed
Primary data rate = 2048.000 kbps
IP info rate = 2048 x 4/5 = 1638.400 kbps
Composite rate = 2048 + 1638.4 or 2048 x 9/5 = 3686.400 kbps
The Sub-Mux frame does contain a very small overhead required for acquisition and
identification of primary vs. IP data: As this overhead is taken from the "IP info rate" rather
than the primary data rate, actual IP throughput will be slightly reduced.
152
This chapter explains the CDM-625s Ethernet interface and illustrates the functional differences
between the available operating modes. Additional modes of operation are also explained.
161
This interface design allows for multiple customer Ethernet interfaces, as well as the
convenience of daisy-chaining together of multiple CDM-625s.
Additionally, because the M&C processor is connected to the internal Ethernet Switch, M&C
traffic is available via all LAN interfaces as well as via the over-the-air WAN interface.
Figure 16-3 shows a simplified version of this loop. As shown here, two switches have been
connected each switch has two or more separate connections. This is not how the CDM-625s
Ethernet switches are designed to be used, and this configuration will cause a network outage.
162
163
164
165
When a CDM-625s working mode is configured as Router Multipoint Hub, the modem is
allowed to egress on the WAN interface the same packet as was originally ingressed from the
WAN interface. This is necessary to allow the Point-to-Multipoint configuration.
However, configuring more than one modem as a Router Hub across the WAN Interface, then
adding default routes on either side or any other invalid routes will cause the same packet to
ping-pong between these two modems until TTL times out.
166
167
168
169
section, add a route entry for each remote subset. Make sure to select toWAN
from the Interf. drop-down menu (this defines the route as LAN WAN).
1610
As shown, there are two key components to this configuration the LAN Downstream
Interface, and the WAN Upstream Interface. Observe the following:
LAN Downstream Interface the LAN Downstream Interface is the interface to which
multicast packets arriving at the upstream interface are forwarded if a multicast group
has at least one listener.
WAN Upstream Interface the WAN Upstream Interface is where all multicast packets
are forwarded to the uplink interface if the multicast routing exists in the Routing table.
1611
1612
Additionally, on average, an additional 3% of overhead is added to account for HDLC bit stuffing.
Note that in SLE Framing, no bit stuffing overhead is involved; hence, WAN overhead is
deterministic. After Ethernet packets are sent from the internal switch to the IP Packet
Processor interface, per packet overhead on the WAN Interface is as follows:
1613
1:1 Redundancy is supported using either a CRS-170A L-Band 1:1 Redundancy Switch or
a CRS-180 70/140 MHz 1:1 Redundancy Switch, and a user-provided, off-the-shelf
Ethernet switch.
Refer to the pertinent switch Installation and Operation Manuals for detailed information on
using the CDM-625 in a redundancy configuration.
1614
16.7.1 Overview
The Advanced Network Timing (ANT) feature provides IP-based protocols to synchronize the
modem's internal time-of-day clock to an external device such as a time server, Base Station
Controller (BSC), or Radio Network Controller (RNC).
SNTP is a UDP protocol that works on port 123. If the modem is not updating its time, verify that
there are no network devices between the modem and time server that might block UDP packets
on that port.
2. For better PTP clock accuracy, ingress and egress port sync interval shall
be at least 2 seconds.
The Precision Time Protocol is used to synchronize clocks throughout a computer network.
Based on the IEEE 1588v2 (2008) standard, PTP achieves clock accuracy in the nanosecond range
much more accurate than what is attainable by NTP (Network Time Protocol) and it is also
used in network applications where GPS is either unaffordable or inaccessible.
Comtech EF Datas implementation of PTP in the CDM-625 operates over IP, without the
presence of the optional IP Packet Processor. To achieve high accuracy time and frequency
synchronization, PTP relies on hardware time stamping at the ingress and egress ports of the
network; therefore, all devices in the network must support PTP.
Figure 16-13 shows a typical network configuration. Here, the RNC/BSC (Radio Network
Controller/Base Station Controller) at the near-end side of the network and the BTS (Base
Transceiver Station) on the distant-end side of the network are the IEEE 1588v2-capable devices.
In this topology the RNC/BSC serves as the Grandmaster the root timing reference that
transmits synchronization information to the clocks residing on its network segment or slave
to the Grandmaster.
1615
The CDM-625 bridges PTP from LAN to WAN and vice versa, and uses 2-step synchronization
(i.e., it sends both Sync and Follow-up messages when acting as a master). When negotiating
with devices over the LAN interface, the modem uses UDP multicast PTP messages on UDP Port
319 for events, and UDP Port 320 for general packets. On the WAN interface, the modem uses
UDP Port 59319 for events, and UDP Port 59320 for general packets.
Some devices use the Announce message to negotiate which is the PTP master, a process known
as the Best Master Clock (BMC) algorithm. This algorithm allows PTP devices to vote on which
device has the best clock resolution. The CDM-625 will become a PTP master if there is no
Grandmaster device or the Grandmaster is not reachable.
When the modem can reach the Grandmaster device only through its LAN interface, set
Grandmaster to LAN.
When Grandmaster is LAN, then the modem knows it must become a slave to the
Grandmaster on the LAN interface, and will set its PTP Clock Priority1 value to 255 (the
lowest).
1616
When the modem must synchronize with the Grandmaster over the WAN interface, set
Grandmaster to WAN.
When Grandmaster is WAN, the modem will set its PTP Clock Priority1 value to 1 (the highest)
to force slave devices that use the BMC algorithm to accept the modem as the PTP master.
S Slave The Slave device synchronizes its clock to the Master devices clock.
The first segment is between the RNC/BSC and the CDM-625 A (near-end modem) LAN
port. In this segment, the RNC/BSC is the master, and the near-end modem LAN port is
the slave.
Using the CDM-625 A front panel or its Web Server Interface, set the PTP Grandmaster
on this near-end modem as LAN.
The second segment is from the CDM-625 A (near-end modem) WAN port to the
CDM-625 B (distant-end modem) WAN port, in which the near-end modem WAN port
is the master and the distant-end modem WAN port is the slave.
Using the CDM-625 B front panel or its Web Server Interface, set the PTP Grandmaster
on this distant-end modem as WAN.
1617
Accordingly, the third segment between the CDM-625 B (distant-end modem) LAN
port and the BTS defines the distant-end modems LAN port as the master and the BTS
as the slave.
1618
17.1 Introduction
The VersaFEC Adaptive Coding and Modulation (ACM) feature is a patents-pending technology,
wholly owned and developed by Comtech EF Data and CEFD sister division Comtech AHA Corp. It
serves as a very significant operational enhancement for the CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem:
ACM turns fade margin into increased link capacity gains of 100% or more are
possible, compared to traditional Constant Coding and Modulation (CCM). This is
accomplished by automatically adapting the modulation type and FEC code rate to give
highest possible throughput.
With a CCM system, severe rain fading can cause the total loss of the link, and zero
throughput. ACM keeps the link up (with lower throughput) and can yield much higher
system availability.
ACM in the CDM-625 is used in conjunction with VersaFEC and is currently for IP traffic
only.
The VersaFEC ACM feature requires Firmware Version 1.4.0 or later, the VersaFEC plug-in module,
and the appropriate FAST codes.
171
17.2 Background
ACM is not a new concept. It has been used for some time in wireless communications, including
terrestrial microwave applications and, more recently, over satellite links. Its primary function is to
optimize throughput in a wireless data link, by adapting the modulation order used and the
Forward Error Correction code rate both of which directly affect spectral efficiency (expressed in
bits per second per Hertz) according to the noise conditions (or other impairments) on the link.
Implicit in this concept is that the symbol rate (and power) of the wireless communication system
must remain constant. This ensures that the bandwidth allocated for a particular link is never
exceeded.
Given that the symbol rate does not change, if modulation and coding are changed, the data
rate must therefore be modified. This is expressed in the simple equation:
For example, for Rate 3/4 QPSK (where modulation order = 2):
So, in changing to a higher modulation order or code rate, the bit rate is increased, and in
changing to a lower modulation order or code rate, the bit rate is reduced.
The digital communications system must be able to tolerate a change in bit rate.
Synchronous serial interfaces (such as G.703 E1, which operated at a fixed data rate of
2.048 Mbps) are totally unsuitable in a scheme where data rate is changing. The only
practical application for this scheme is a packet-based scheme that will tolerate a
change in data rate, and which has mechanisms within its protocols to recognize when
increased or reduced bandwidth is available. The best example of this is Ethernet, and
this discussion is limited to schemes that employ it.
The bit rate cannot be changed arbitrarily. The link noise conditions, described in terms
of Eb/No or SNR, must be able to support reliable communications for the given
modulation order and code rate. This is a key point, as in fact, the link SNR is the input
that drives the adaptation.
172
a) A modulator and FEC encoder that can instantaneously, when commanded, change
either modulation type (order) or FEC encoder rate, or both. This needs to be
accomplished without the corruption of data anywhere in the path. Block FEC codes are
considered to be the most practical in achieving the required synchronization. Recently,
a specific nomenclature has emerged to describe a combination of a modulation type
and code rate namely, ModCod (also referred to as Mod/Code). The modulator is
required to send the value of ModCod at the start of each code block to signal the
demodulator/decoder how to configure for the correct modulation type and FEC code
rate.
c) The receiver in b) needs to derive an estimate of the link quality (in terms of Eb/No, SNR,
etc) and then communicate this estimate, via a return channel, to the modulator in a).
d) The modulator in a) needs to able to process the link quality metric from the
demodulator in b), and then, based upon a pre-determined algorithm, adapt the data
rate and change the ModCod sent to the receiver at the distant end. Thus, the data rate
on the link can be maximized, given the current link noise conditions.
173
174
Four modulation types are defined: QPSK, 8PSK, 16APSK and 32APSK.
The primary FEC type is low-density parity check coding (LDPC), concatenated with a
short BCH code.
There are ten code rates defined: 1/4, 1/3, 2/5, 1/2, 3/5, 2/3, 3/4, 4/5, 5/6, 8/9 and
9/10, which depend on the modulation type and other system requirements.
A single FEC block may be 64800 bits (normal, referred to as 64k blocks) or 16200 bits
(short, referred to as 16k blocks)
Adaptive coding and modulation is defined for optimizing satellite transponder capacity.
Hughes Network Systems (Germantown, MD) have commercially deployed DVB-S2 with ACM
over satellite.
Excessive latency. The so-called short blocks are too long for low latency IP applications
at low data rates. This is exacerbated by the addition of interleaving.
Overly complex in its implementation. The design of DVB-S2 dictated that all FEC blocks
should be constant in bits. This means that for each ModCod, there are a varying
number of symbols. This then makes the task of synchronization a much more
demanding task. Also, because of the limitations of tracking the higher-order
modulations in a very low SNR environment, so-called pilot symbols were added in
order to aid tracking.
Concatenated BCH code added to mitigate the problem of error rate flaring and
flooring. This is no longer necessary. Since the introduction of the original LDPC/BCH
scheme, an enormous amount of research has been done on the design of LDPC codes.
175
Most importantly, however, LDPC codes can now be designed that yield almost
equivalent coding gain, but with considerably shorter block lengths.
In an ACM mode, no overhead channel was defined by DVB-S2 for the purpose of
reporting SNR metrics to the originating end. It has been left to individual equipment
manufacturers to decide their own method. This illustrates that all ACM systems,
DVB-S2 or not, are proprietary. In addition, it implies that additional bandwidth needs to
be consumed for the SNR reporting, and this is not accounted for in the code rate.
VersaFEC covers a family of 12 short-block LDPC ModCods, specifically designed for low latency
and ACM applications. However, the VersaFEC codes are equally well suited to Constant Coding
and Modulation (CCM) applications.
The requirements for an ACM system that approaches the minimum possible latency are:
The shortest possible LDPC codes that give performance at or very close to DVB-S2, in
order to minimize latency, and which do not use interleaving.
A constant number of symbols per block, to reduce the demodulator and decoder
complexity, and significantly, also reduces latency in the ACM case.
The elimination of the need for pilot symbols for carrier tracking at low SNR by
substitution of other modulation techniques. This further reduces the complexity of the
demodulator.
The inclusion, at the physical layer, of an overhead channel to permit the reporting of
SNR metrics back to the originating end. Note that this does not have to be enabled or
disabled it is part of the fundamental frame structure of VersaFEC ACM, and has been
take into account in the code rate.
The family of VersaFEC short-block LDPC codes is presented in Table 17-1. The modulation types
include BPSK, QPSK, 8-QAM, and 16-QAM. It will be seen from the table that in order to
maintain a constant number of symbols per block, the block size in bits (data + parity) must
necessarily change, depending on both the modulation type (which affects the number of bits
per symbol) and the code rate. For VersaFEC, the block size varies between 2k and 8.2k bits. At
worst, therefore, the VersaFEC codes are 50% shorter than the short DVB-S2 codes.
176
The VersaFEC codes compared with the Shannon bound are shown below in Figure 17-2. It can be
seen that the performance of VersaFEC at or near the DVB-S2 performance with 16 kbit blocks.
Note that SNR is used in place of Eb/No, a convention for comparing ACM ModCods. SNR is
defined as Eb/No + 10log (Spectral Efficiency).
177
Examining the data in Table 17-2, latency for each ModCod is shown for the example of
VersaFEC ACM at a fixed 100 ksymbols/second rate. Of particular note is that even though the
ModCods span a 7:1 variation in throughput, the latency is only varying between 25 and 34
milliseconds. A careful analysis will show that this is a consequence of using a constant number
of symbols per block. In the example shown the worst-case latency for this ACM scheme is 34
milliseconds, + WAN Buffer delay (which is configurable, with a minimum value of 20ms).
Table 17-2. VersaFEC Implementation of ACM 100 ksymbols/sec Example Case
Minimum Latency,
Spectral efficiency,
ModCod Modulation Code Rate Bit rate (throughput) In milliseconds,
bps/Hz
for each ModCod
0 BPSK 0.488 0.49 49 kbps 34 + WAN BUFFER
1 QPSK 0.533 1.07 107 kbps 32 + WAN BUFFER
2 QPSK 0.631 1.26 126 kbps 30 + WAN BUFFER
3 QPSK 0.706 1.41 141 kbps 28 + WAN BUFFER
4 QPSK 0.803 1.61 161 kbps 26 + WAN BUFFER
5 8-QAM 0.642 1.93 193 kbps 30 + WAN BUFFER
6 8-QAM 0.711 2.13 213 kbps 28 + WAN BUFFER
7 8-QAM 0.780 2.34 234 kbps 27 + WAN BUFFER
8 16-QAM 0.731 2.93 293 kbps 27 + WAN BUFFER
9 16-QAM 0.780 3.12 312 kbps 26 + WAN BUFFER
10 16-QAM 0.829 3.32 332 kbps 25 + WAN BUFFER
11 16-QAM 0.853 3.41 341 kbps 25 + WAN BUFFER
OVERALL SYSTEM LATENCY = Worst-case ModCod (ModCod0)
Latency = 34 milliseconds + WAN Buffer delay
By way of comparison, consider the same 100 ksymbols/second rate, but this time using DVB-S2. It
becomes clear that there is an unintended penalty (besides demodulator complexity) to having a
constant number of bits per block. Each time the ModCod is lowered and the throughput is
reduced, the latency grows accordingly due to the block size being related to data rate, not symbol
rate.
Remembering that, for the ACM case, the system latency is equal to the latency of the worst-case
ModCod, DVB-S2 shows a severe penalty. For 16k short blocks, this calculates to be 329
milliseconds (+ WAN Buffer delay) versus 34 milliseconds (+ WAN Buffer delay) for VersaFEC ACM.
For 64k block DVB-S2, the core latency is 4 times higher. Assuming a WAN Buffer of 20
milliseconds:
Latency for 64k block DVB-S2 ACM at 100 ksps = 1336 milliseconds
178
Latency for 16k block DVB-S2 ACM at 100 ksps = 349 milliseconds
For the example shown, the latency for a 16k block DVB-S2 ACM scheme is
approximately 7 times higher than VersaFEC ACM.
The latency for a 64k block DVB-S2 ACM scheme is approximately 25 times
higher than VersaFEC ACM.
Follow these steps to configure the CDM-625 for VersaFEC ACM operation:
Step Task Front Panel VFD Mnemonic
1 (SELECT) CONFIG: MODE Mode:Tx=IP-ACM:None Rx=IP-ACM:None
Set the Tx and Rx modes as IP-ACM. (422,V35,G703s,Audio,LVDS,HSSI,IP,ASI)
2 (SELECT) CONFIG: TX SYMB Tx-IF Freq Power FEC Mod Symb Scrambler
Enter the desired transmit symbol rate. Note that (Data 00192.000kbps, 00131.657ksps)()
this is a fundamental departure from the way in
which the modem is typically configured.
TxSymbolRate = 01000.000 ksps (ACM Mode)
Data Invert=Off Clock Invert=Off ()
179
If you wish to constrain the system to run at a fixed ModCod, set the Min and Max ModCod
values to be equal.
The value of Max ModCod may be limited by other FAST codes installed. For example, suppose
the 4100 ksps FAST option is installed, and the symbol rate set to 4100 ksps, the theoretical
maximum data rate would be 14 Mbps at ModCod 11. However, is CnC is being used, with a 10
Mbps FAST limit, the ACM Max ModCod will be limited to ModCod 7, or 9.6 Mbps.
ii. Unlock-Action: Choose the d esired action When distant-end demod loses lock:
when t he remote demod l oses l ock. T his i s Go to min Tx ModCod (Maintain,Min) ()
important, as t he ACM s ystem depends o n t he
feedback of t he S NR me tric f rom the r emote
demod t o d etermine t he op timum M odCod. T he
choices are:
1710
The graph shows the switch points with the Target Eb/No margin set to 0dB. However, the
switch points can be moved (increased) by configuring the Target Eb/No margin parameter,
which can vary from 0 to 4.5 dB, in 0.5dB steps. In a fading environment it is highly
recommended to add sufficient margin to maintain an adequate link quality (and to maintain
demod lock) during the interval between the Eb/No degrading and the ACM controller
responding by lowering the ModCod. See Sect. 17.11 Notes and Recommendations.
Use the front panel menu to select MONITOR: ACM. The current Tx and Rx ModCod, along with
the Local and Remote SNR, are displayed here. The SNR displays values between 3.0 dB and
+22.0 dB, with a resolution of 0.1 dB. If either the local or remote demod is unlocked, the SNR
will show No Sync. Of course, under MONITOR: Rx PARAMETERS, the Eb/No continues to be
displayed corrected for modulation type and code rate, in case you do not wish to deal with SNR
values.
If you wish to see the exact detail of the ModCod (data rate, modulation, code rate), then these
parameters can be seen under INFO: TX or INFO: Rx. Furthermore, if you are in a CONFIG: TX or
CONFIG: RX screen, both the symbol rate and data rate are displayed. All of these screens
update dynamically, so if a ModCod changes, the parameters are refreshed.
This information is also available through the Remote Control (serial interface), as well as the
Web Server, SNMP and Telnet interfaces.
If you wish to use the Constellation over Ethernet application that comes with the released
code, it is also informative to see the demodulator changing type on the fly. With no noise, and
a modem in a loop on itself, you may wish to experiment with Min and Max ModCod values to
drive the adaptation.
Alternately, if you have access to an Oscilloscope in X-Y mode, the Alarms connector provides
analog voltages to monitor the constellation. This has the advantage that it will show a change
in modulation type instantaneously, unlike the Constellation over Ethernet application, which
only updates once per second.
1711
If you wish to verify that link performance is meeting the required level, the internal BERT tester
is an excellent tool. When using the IP interface it is not an easy matter to verify BER
performance, but the internal BERT will not only do this, but is also tolerant of the change in bit
rate that accompanies a change in ModCod. The BERT can be used to confirm that there are no
sync losses or bursts of bit errors when a ModCod changes.
Conversely, when the ACM controller switches from a higher to a lower ModCod the bandwidth
of the Ethernet link is instantaneously reduced. Unless the FIFO in the WAN encapsulator is
configured to be very large, the FIFO will tend to overflow, and packets will be lost before the
network recognizes that there is congestion, and reduces the rate at which packets are sent.
In order to mitigate packet loss when bandwidth is reduced, the CDM-625 ACM system
incorporates a method for congestion control. This is illustrated in Figure 17-4:
In the diagram it can be seen that when the WAN FIFO reaches a fill state of 87%, it signals the
Ethernet Switch to send Pause frames back to the LAN to inhibit the sending of further data. The
Pause Frames continue to be sent until the FIFO fill state has reduced to 75%. At this point,
normal operation in resumed by sending a Pause Frame with Pause time set to 0x0000.
1712
This mechanism has been shown to be very effective at mitigating packet loss when the ACM
controller reduces bandwidth.
VersaFEC ACM is for point-to-point applications. It is required that both directions on the link
run in IP-ACM mode, although the symbol rates do not need to be equal. If you wish to
constrain one direction to run in CCM, simply set the Min and Max ModCod to be equal.
ACM constitutes a closed-loop control system (similar in concept to AUPC) and it should be
remembered that like all control systems, the speed at which the system can react is governed
by a number of factors, including the time taken to estimate SNR to the required accuracy,
and the transport delay over the satellite. Realistically, it can cope with fading and other link
impairments that do not exceed 1dB/second (more if Target Eb/No margin is increased).
The ACM controller algorithm that resides in the CDM-625 modem does not have to switch
through ModCods sequentially it can change, if needed, directly from ModCod0 to
ModCod11 (or vice versa). When the demod first locks at ModCod0 the ACM controller will
examine the SNR from the remote end and switch directly to the ModCod that maximizes
throughput.
While ACM can do remarkable things, the fundamentals still apply. Dont expect the demod to
run at a 16-QAM ModCod if the SNR instantaneously drops to 0dB the demod will lose lock
and the system will recover by switching to ModCod0 (if so configured). We highly
recommend setting the Minimum ModCod to 0 (the ModCod of last resort) and set the
Unlock Action to Go to minimum ModCod. This will give the most robust link performance.
When running in ACM mode the demodulator is performing blind acquisition meaning that it
has no a priori knowledge of the modulation type or code rate. For this reason the
demodulator acquisition time will be slower than in CCM mode. However, the acquisition time
is typically under 1 second for all symbol rates and noise conditions.
Running the ACM link with the Target Eb/No Margin set to 0dB will give the best utilization
of link power, but in conditions of fast fading may cause demod unlock events, or highly
degraded BER just prior to the switch to a lower ModCod. In order to mitigate this, we
recommend a Target Eb/No Margin of at least 1dB more if the fading events are
particularly severe and/or frequent.
The value of Max ModCod may be limited by other FAST codes installed in the CDM-625. For
example, suppose the 4100 ksps FAST option is installed, and the symbol rate set to 4100
ksps, the theoretical maximum data rate would be 14 Mbps at ModCod 11. However, if CnC
is being used with a 10 Mbps FAST limit, then ACM Max ModCod will be limited to ModCod
7, or 9.6 Mbps. Therefore, if it is not possible to set the Maximum ModCod to the desired
value for a given symbol rate, you should check to determine what other FAST codes may be
limiting it.
1713
The BER versus Eb/No performance of the ModCods is identical to the VersaFEC CCM modes
described in the FEC Options Chapter.
SNR is the preferred metric for driving the adaptation this is the value displayed on the
monitor screens. If you want to convert this to Eb/No then remember that the relationship is
simply Eb/No = SNR - 10log (Spectral Efficiency).
To achieve minimum latency, set the WAN buffer to the smallest practical value. The default
setting is 20ms, and we recommend keeping it at this level.
At this time Comtech EF Data has chosen to disable AUPC while ACM is active. This may
change in the future, but for now, ACM should be considered to be a constant power,
constant symbol rate scheme.
All IP features that are available in the CDM-625 (VLAN, QoS, etc) are available when in IP-
ACM mode. The Sub-Mux feature, however, is not available.
If required, VersaFEC ACM may be used in conjunction with any of the EDMAC modes, either
for serial remote control of the remote modem, or for SNMP proxy. It should be emphasized,
however, that unlike AUPC, a framing mode is not required for SNR reporting.
ACM maximizes throughput not only when Eb/No varies due to atmospheric conditions, but
will also mitigate the effects of other impairments, such as antenna pointing error, excessive
phase noise and certain types of interference. However, rapidly fluctuating impairments (~
less than 1 second) such as scintillation at low antenna look-angles at C-band will generally not
be improved by ACM.
VersaFEC ACM modes are not compatible with VersaFEC CCM modes, due to differences in
frame preambles.
The CDM-625 was purposely architected to provide the platform for VersaFEC ACM, and has
required new approaches to the signal processing employed in both modulator and
demodulator. It is the intention of Comtech EF Data to include VersaFEC ACM in future
modem platforms.
1714
Switch point (decreasing SNR) Corresponds to SNR (Eb/No) that gives BER = 5 x 10-8
Max fading rate Approximately 1 dB/second (higher if Target Eb/No margin > 1 dB)
Max ModCod update rate 1 update every 2 seconds (no restriction on distance between ModCods)
Minimum and Maximum ModCod (ModCod0 through ModCod11)
Remote Demod Unlock Action: Maintain current ModCod
Configurable parameters
Go to minimum ModCod
Target Eb/No margin (0 to 4.5 dB, 0.5 dB steps)
54 milliseconds max (for a system operating at 100 ksps, and assuming a WAN
System latency
buffer of 20 milliseconds, not including satellite path)
Tx and Rx ModCods
Local and Remote SNR
Monitored parameters (-3.0 dB to +22.0dB, 0.1dB resolution, +/- 0.5 dB accuracy)
Config and monitor menus displaying data rate, modulation and code rate update
dynamically with ModCod
Typical
Spectral Efficiency, Min. Data Rate, Max. Data Rate,
Modulation Code Rate Eb/No, for
bps/Hz ACM mode ACM mode
BER = 5 x 10-8
BPSK 0.488 0.49 2.4 dB 18.1 kbps 2.00 Mbps
1715
Notes:
1716
The IP Packet Processor enables efficient IP networking and transport over satellite, in either
Router Mode or Managed Switch Mode, by adding routing capability with very low overhead
encapsulation, header compression, payload compression, and Quality of Service (QoS). The
Advanced QoS combined with header and payload compression ensures the highest quality of
service with minimal jitter and latency for real-time traffic, priority treatment of mission critical
applications and maximum bandwidth efficiency.
CDM-625 Power Requirements for the IP Packet Processor Board (CEFD P/N
PL-0000481): When ordering the IP Packet Processor as a factory installed option,
the modem power supply that is specified at the time of order must either be 175
watts for AC units, or 125 watts for DC units.
Existing field units that meet either power supply configuration requirement are
user-upgradable in the field using CEFD Kit KT-0000176 refer to Section 18.5 in
this chapter for the field upgrade procedure using this kit.
However, existing field units that do not meet these power supply configuration
requirements i.e., units that are configured with 65W AC or 65W DC power
supplies must be returned either to Comtech EF Data or sent to a Comtech EF
181
Data Authorized Service Center for upgrade using CEFD Kit KT-0000174 (for 65W
AC units) or CEFD Kit KT-0000175 (for 65W DC units).
CDM-625 Firmware Version 1.5.0 or later, which supports the IP Packet Processor
operational features. Factory-shipped units (i.e., units shipped with the IP Packet
Processor option) already have this firmware version pre-installed. However,
existing field units that do not run this firmware version (at a minimum) may
upgrade the firmware loads via the Flash Upgrade procedure explained in Chapter
4. UPDATING FIRMWARE.
182
A CDM-625 equipped with the IP Packet Processor can operate in four modes to support Point-
to-Point and Point-to-Multipoint network topologies:
Sub-Mux is a secondary framing structure that combines IP traffic with any currently available
combination of framing and interface type (excluding IP itself). A specific, user-selected ratio
references the composite data rate to the modulator and from the demodulator to the primary,
non-IP interface rate.
Sub-Mux capability can be used with the IP Packet Processor to multiplex a primary serial
synchronous or G.703 traffic stream with IP.
Comtech EF Datas VersaFEC Adaptive Coding and Modulation (ACM) feature, a patents-
pending technology wholly owned and developed by Comtech EF Data and CEFD sister division
Comtech AHA Corp., can be used with the IP Packet Processor to maximize throughput.
ACM converts available link margin into additional throughput, thereby maximizing throughput
under all conditions, including rain fade, inclined orbit satellite operation, antenna mispointing,
interference and other impairments.
183
If there is a need to upgrade the CDM-625 IP Packet Processors functionality, Comtech EF Data
provides Fully Accessible System Topology (FAST), a technology that permits the purchase and
installation of options through special authorization codes. These unique Fast Access Codes may
be purchased from Comtech EF Data during normal business hours, and then loaded into the
unit using the front panel keypad.
Header Compression:
o Up to 5 Mbps (CCM) / 1200 ksps (ACM) o Up to 10 Mbps (CCM) / 4100 ksps (ACM)
o Up to 15 Mbps (CCM) / 4100 ksps (ACM) o Up to 20 Mbps (CCM) / 4100 ksps (ACM)
o Up to 25 Mbps (CCM) / 4100 ksps (ACM)
Payload Compression:
o Up to 5 Mbps (CCM) / 1200 ksps (ACM) o Up to 10 Mbps (CCM) / 4100 ksps (ACM)
o Up to 15 Mbps (CCM) / 4100 ksps (ACM) o Up to 20 Mbps (CCM) / 4100 ksps (ACM)
o Up to 25 Mbps (CCM) / 4100 ksps (ACM)
Quality of Service
AES Encryption
For applications such as Voice-over-IP (VoIP), header compression can provide bandwidth
savings exceeding 60%. For example, the 8 kbps G.729 voice codec requires 24 kbps of IP
bandwidth once encapsulated into an IP/UDP/RTP datagram. With header compression, the
same voice call needs about 8.5 kbps a saving of almost 65%.
In addition, bandwidth requirements for typical Web/HTTP traffic can be reduced by 10% or
more with TCP/IP header compression.
184
When using rule-based QoS, you can configure up to 32 different rules based on:
Source IP address and subnet mask Destination IP address and subnet mask
Source Port Destination Port
Protocols (well known) Priority
When the AES Encryption option is active and enabled on a WAN route, the IP Packet Processor
will encrypt all outgoing traffic on the WAN, and decrypt any encrypted traffic it receives.
185
Using the keypad on the front panel, you may access a variety of nested
menus to configure the options available whenever the CDM-625 is
equipped with the IP Packet Processor.
Telnet Interface This requires use of a user-supplied terminal emulation program such as
HyperTerminal (for use with the remote control protocol) or PuTTY (for use with the Telnet
Command Line Interface), installed on the user PC.
CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface This requires a compatible user-supplied web
browser such as Internet Explorer.
The managed device This includes the CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem.
The SNMP Agent The software that runs on the CDM-625. The CDM-625 SNMP Agent
supports both SNMPv1 and SNMPv2c.
186
The user-supplied Network Management System (NMS) The software that runs on
the manager.
Comtech EF Data provides a Telnet interface for the purpose of equipment monitor and control
(M&C) using either the standard remote control protocol or, when the optional IP Packet
Processor is installed and enabled, the Telnet Command Line Interface (CLI).
The embedded Web Server (HTTP) application provides an easy to use interface designed for
optimal performance when using Microsofts Internet Explorer Version 9.0 or higher. The
interface features enhanced functionality when the CDM-625 is equipped with the IP Packet
Processor.
187
2474 Definition of the Differentiated Services Field (DS Field) in the IPv4 and IPv6 Headers
188
18.5.1 Overview
This section describes the procedure required to field upgrade any user CDM-625-Advanced Satellite Modem having a 175W AC or 125W
DC Power Supply with the optional IP Packet Processor card. See Sections 18.1.1 and 18.1.2 in this chapter for a detailed description of
the requirements and limitations of using the IP Packet Processor with the CDM-625.
Needle-nose pliers
CEFD P/N KT-0000176 IP Packet Processor with Fan Upgrade Kit, containing:
189
Step Task
1 Turn off the CDM-625 and disconnect the modems power
cord from its power source.
1810
Step Task
2 The illustration a t r ight i dentifies t he u pgrade l ocations
within the chassis for:
1811
Step Task
4 Use the screwdriver and pliers, as needed, to install the fan
(CEFD P /N P L-0000449) and f an gu ard ( CEFD P /N
FN/FGDC12V01) securely i nto t he c hassis with t he
provided m ounting h ardware ( 4X 4 -40 x 3/4 pan h ead
screws and 4X 4 -40 l ocking hex nu ts) a t the d esignated
location.
1812
Step Task
6 Prepare t he I P P acket P rocessor C ard f or i nstallation b y
aligning i ts r eceptacle w ith t he m ating c onnector o n t he
modems framing board.
1813
Step Task
8 Plug the f ront p anel r ibbon c able back i nto its mating
connector on the modems framing board.
Plug the modems power cord back into its power source.
The CDM-625 IP Packet Processor upgrade is now complete and you may turn on and resume use of the modem.
1814
19.1 Introduction
CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modems running Firmware Version 2.2.1 or later incorporate a
patent-pending carrier identification (CID) technique that uses MetaCarrier spread spectrum
technology to embed a unique carrier identification sequence for the transmitted carrier.
The CDM-625 with MetaCarrier provides a subset of the functionality of the Comtech EF Data
MCED-100 MetaCarrier Embedding Device. It is used in tandem with the Comtech EF Data
MCDD-100 MetaCarrier Detection Device to provide a complete MetaCarrier embedding and
decoding solution.
The MetaCarrier operates independent of the modulation and forward error correction rate of
the transmitted carrier. In configurations where the carrier is encrypted or uses cryptographic
technologies, the CID contained in the MetaCarrier is not affected.
Traditionally, the method for identifying an interfering carrier involves using a geo-location
system that, in turn, uses the phase offset from an adjacent satellite to triangulate the
approximate location on the surface of the earth where the interference is being generated.
While such tried-and-true geo-locating methods have proven beneficial to satellite operators
and service providers, they are nevertheless imprecise. For example, in densely populated areas,
a helicopter equipped with a feed horn and spectrum analyzer must be used to find the exact
location of the transmission source; the time and costs associated with such methods are
significant.
191
By contrast, Comtech EF Datas CID products provide the operator with the interference
sources identification information within seconds. Once the offending carrier is identified, the
uplinking station may be contacted and the request made to shut down or otherwise remove
the identified transmission from service.
The CDM-625 creates a composite carrier by first sizing the appropriate MetaCarrier, and then
by adding the spread spectrum CID (with power spectral density approximately 22 dB below the
transmission carriers spectral power density) to the transmission carrier.
The size of the MetaCarrier is determined based purely on symbol rate and is totally
independent of modulation and coding, resulting in three (3) discrete sizes of MetaCarrier being
combined with the transmission carrier. The available MetaCarrier sizes are as follows:
As shown here, the MetaCarrier is sized to be no more than 87.5% of the bandwidth of the
transmission carrier. In all configurations of the combined carrier, the MetaCarrier raises the
transmission power less than 0.1 dB above the original carrier.
Note that other fields supported in the MCED-100 are not included.
192
The entire CID message is broken into 18 packets containing 122 bits (formatting, FEC and user
information) for a total message length of 2,196 bits for the transmission of the MetaCarrier.
Each packet of the MetaCarrier message carries 32 bits of CID information data. However, the
MAC address is sent at a higher rate (more often), so that upon reception of a frame that is
comprised of three (3) packets, the MAC address may be obtained.
The data rate of messages being carried in the MetaCarrier is shown before spreading is applied
and the associated time to send a complete CID message (including the framing and FEC). The
time for a complete message is only valid once the MCDD-100 has achieved lock to the
MetaCarrier that may cause the stated times to be longer:
Therefore, the time for the CDM-625 with MetaCarrier to insert a complete CID ID sequence is
as follows. Note that the time for unique ID may be shorter than shown, since upon achieving
lock to the MetaCarrier, the unique ID is made available immediately since MetaCarrier lock
requires the reception of three full packets to declare lock.
Local Control via the CDM-625 Front Panel keypad and VFD.
193
19.4.1.1 Enabling Operation via the CDM-625 Front Panel and VFD
From the front panel main (SELECT:) menu, use the arrow keys to select the Utility menu
branch, and then press ENTER. Then, from the Utilities: screen, use the arrow keys to
select the CarrID submenu. Press ENTER to continue (the solid block indicates the cursor
position upon navigation to that display item):
Use the arrow keys to select Carrier ID (MetaCarrier) operation as Enabled, and then press
ENTER.
19.4.1.2 Enabling Operation via the CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface
194
It is IMPORTANT to understand that Carrier ID and Circuit ID, while named similarly,
are two distinct features of the CDM-625. Read your documentation carefully.
19.4.2.1 Creating the Message via the CDM-625 Front Panel and VFD
From the front panel main (SELECT:) menu, use the arrow keys to select the Utility menu
branch, and then press ENTER. Then, from the Utilities: screen, use the arrow keys to
select the Circuit-ID submenu. Press ENTER to continue (the solid block indicates the cursor
position upon navigation to that display item):
To compose a MetaCarrier Custom Message On the bottom line, first use the arrow keys
to select the alphanumeric character space to edit, and then use the arrow keys to edit that
character.
You may use the following characters to compose a MetaCarrier Custom Message of 24
characters or less:
Press ENTER once you finish composing the MetaCarrier Custom Message string.
With Carrier ID enabled, the first 24 characters of the 40-character Circuit ID are
intended for and sent as the MetaCarrier Custom Message. While you must limit
your MetaCarrier Custom Message to 24 characters or less, the full 40 characters of
the Circuit ID will display on the front panel screen saver (see Sect. 5.1.3.1 Screen
Saver).
195
19.4.2.2 Creating the Message via the CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP)
Interface
196
20.1 Overview
Quality of Service (QoS) enables a network to use WAN bandwidth more efficiently by managing
delay, jitter (delay variation), throughput, and packet loss.
The CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem incorporates two Per Hop Behavior (PHP) QoS
methods Layer 2 QoS and Layer 3 QoS:
Layer 2 QoS is available on the CDM-625 by default when the optional IP Packet
Processor card is either not installed, or is installed but disabled. Layer 2 QoS is based
on OSI model Layer 2 header parameters such as IEEE 802.1q VLAN priority field, and is
also based on the CDM-625s physical Ethernet port.
Layer 3 QoS requires the optional IP Packet Processor card to be installed and enabled,
and the Advanced QoS FAST option must be purchased and activated. Layer 3 QoS is
based on OSI model Layer 3 to Layer 7 protocol header parameters.
Jitter Jitter is the amount of variation that is measured, in milliseconds, between two
consequent frames at the receiving end.
201
See Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL OPERATION for complete information about using
this interface.
Layer 2 QoS is implemented on System on Chip (SoC) hardware having a total queue memory of
1 Mbits (128 Kilobytes). This limits traffic burst size to no more than 128 Kilobytes. The Layer 2
QoS system has four queues and four priorities; each queue is assigned to each priority with a
total of 128 KB for all four queues.
A Layer 2 QoS system uses the strict priority-scheduling algorithm the higher the priority
number, the higher the priority. For example, a Priority 4 queue schedules and drains before a
Priority 3 queue; similarly, Priority 3 packets will schedule and drain before Priority 2 packets;
Priority 2 packets schedule and drain before Priority 1 packets. Priority 1 queue packets,
therefore, will schedule and drain only if QoS bandwidth is available after serving the three
higher-priority packet queues. High priority queues may starve low priority queues.
Three modes of Layer 2 QoS are available: Port-based, VLAN-based, or Port- and VLAN-based.
Note that the Layer 2 QoS scheduling algorithm runs on the basis of QoS Tx data rate; however,
the modem can send only the modem Tx data rate. In the event of difference between QoS data
rate and modem Tx data rate, after QoS scheduling the modem further clips the input data rate
to the modem Tx data rate without considering the scheduling priorities.
Table 20-1. Modem Tx Data Rate vs. QoS Tx Data Rate (Hardware-limited)
QoS Tx Data Rate
Modem Tx Data Rate
HW Ver. 2.1 or newer HW Ver. Rev 1.1 or older
Less than 128 Kbps 64 Kbps steps Limited to 128 Kbps
128 Kbps to 256 Kbps 64 Kbps steps Limited to 256 Kbps
256 Kbps to 512 Kbps 64 Kbps steps Limited 512 Kbps
512 Kbps to 1 Mbps 64 Kbps steps Limited to 1 Mps
1 Mbps to 2 Mbps 1 Mbps steps Limited to 2 Mbps
2 Mbps to 4 Mbps 1 Mbps Steps Limited to 4 Mbps
4 Mbps to 8 Mbps 1 Mbps steps Limited to 8 Mbps
8 Mbps to 25 Mbps 1 Mbps steps Limited to 100 Mbps
202
QoS Example 1
QUESTION: If the modem Tx data rate is set to 180 Kbps, then what is the QoS Tx data rate?
In the event any port is overdriven with ingress traffic, if there is insufficient queue memory to
store the packet, then the packet will be dropped and drop stats will be incremented against
that port.
QoS Example 2
Port-based Layer 2 QoS mode is selected.
203
QUESTION: What is the total output data rate and what is individual ports output data rate?
Based on Table 20-1 for a modem Tx bandwidth of 1 Mbps, the QoS output bandwidth is set
to 1 Mbps.
Based on Table 20-1 for a modem Tx bandwidth of 1 Mbps, the QoS output bandwidth is set
to 1 Mbps.
QoS Example 3
Port-based Layer 2 QoS mode is selected.
204
QUESTION: What is the total output data rate and what are the individual port output data
rates?
Based on Table 20-1 for a modem Tx bandwidth of 2.5 Mbps, the QoS output bandwidth is
set to 3 Mbps.
Since the modem Tx bandwidth and QoS output data rates are not the same, after Layer 2
QoS prioritization the modem will further limit the output data rate to the Tx bandwidth of
the mode. The individual port data rates will henceforth be trimmed (normalized) to the
data rate of the modem Tx bandwidth without considering the priorities.
Remaining Data
L2 QoS Input QoS Output
Port Rate* (After Serving Output Data Rate
Priority Data Rate Data Rate
the Priority Queue)
4 4 500 Kbps 500 Kbps 2500 Kbps 500 x (2.5/3) = 417 Kbps
3 3 800 Kbps 800 Kbps 1700 Kbps 800 x (2.5/3) = 667 Kbps
2 2 2 Mbps 1700 Kbps 0 Kbps 1700 x (2.5 /3) = 1416 Kbps
1 1 2 Mbps 0 Kbps 0 Kbps 0 Kbps
Total 5.3 Mbps 3 Mbps 0 Kbps 2.5 Mbps
*After Priority 4, even though the actual modem TX data rate is 2500 kbps, the QoS
leftover data rate is still 2500 kbps since QoS bandwidth is 3000 kbps.
Based on Table 20-1 for a modem Tx bandwidth of 2.5 Mbps, the QoS output bandwidth is
set to 4 Mbps.
Since the modem Tx bandwidth and QoS output data rates are not the same, after Layer 2
QoS prioritization the modem will further limit the output data rate to the Tx bandwidth of
the modem. The individual port data rates will henceforth be trimmed (normalized) to the
data rate of the modem Tx bandwidth without considering the priorities.
205
Even though it is not necessary to configure multiple ports with VLANs, the VLAN QoS will not
look in the port information when classifying the packets into queue.
Similar to the Port-based scheduler, VLAN-based QoS also observes strict priority-based
scheduling. Should overdriving of VLAN priority traffic occur, the packet will be dropped and
drop stats will be incremented against that port.
In case VLAN Q-in-Q (double VLAN tag), the L2 VLAN QoS considers first VLAN tag
priority field only for traffic prioritization.
206
QoS Example 4
1. VLAN-based Layer 2 QoS mode is selected.
3. Four streams of VLAN ingress traffic is sent to the modem with VLAN Priorities set to 7, 5, 3,
and 1, respectively.
QUESTION: What is the total output data rate and what are the individual port output data
rates?
Based on Table 20-1 for a modem Tx bandwidth of 1 Mbps, the QoS output bandwidth is set
to 1 Mbps.
Based on Table 20-2, the VLAN Priorities 7, 5, 3, and 1 are mapped, respectively, to L2 QoS
Priorities 4, 3, 2, and 1.
Since the modem Tx bandwidth and QoS output data rates are the same, there is no need
for normalization.
VLAN L2 QoS QoS Output Data Remaining Data Rate (After Output Data
Input Data Rate
Priority Priority Rate Serving the Priority Queue) Rate
7 4 500 Kbps 500 Kbps 500 Kbps 500 Kbps
5 3 500 Kbps 500 Kbps 0 Kbps 500 Kbps
3 2 500 Kbps 0 Kbps 0 Kbps 0 Kbps
1 1 500 Kbps 0 Kbps 0 Kbps 0 Kbps
Total 2 Mbps 1 Mbps 0 Kbps 1 Mbps
Based on Table 20-1 for a modem Tx bandwidth of 1 Mbps, the QoS output bandwidth is set
to 1 Mbps.
Based on Table 20-2, the VLAN Priorities 7, 5, 3, and 1 are mapped, respectively, to L2 QoS
Priorities 4, 3, 2, and 1.
207
Since the modem Tx bandwidth and QoS output data rates are the same, there is no need
for normalization.
QoS Example 5
1. Port- and VLAN-based Layer 2 QoS mode is selected.
6. The ingress traffic on Port 2 is set to 2000 Kbps with a VLAN Priority of 1.
7. The ingress traffic on Port 4 is set to 800 Kbps with a VLAN Priority of 7.
QUESTION: What is the total output data rate and what are the individual port output data
rates?
Based on Table 20-1 for a modem Tx bandwidth of 4 Mbps, the QoS output bandwidth is set
to 4 Mbps.
Since the modem Tx bandwidth and QoS output data rates are the same, there is no need
for normalization.
Based on Table 20-2, the VLAN Priorities 7 and 1 are mapped, respectively, to L2 QoS
Priorities 4 and 1.
208
Based on Table 20-1 for a modem Tx bandwidth of 4 Mbps, the QoS output bandwidth is set
to 4 Mbps.
Since the modem Tx bandwidth and QoS output data rates are the same, there is no need
for normalization.
Based on Table 20-2, the VLAN Priorities 7 and 1 are mapped, respectively, to L2 QoS
Priorities 4 and 1.
1. Layer 2 QoS can be enabled only when the optional Packet Processor is
not enabled.
209
Layer 3 QoS is implemented with at least one 1-second burst at maximum data rate. So Layer 3
QoS can process much larger bursts than Layer 2 QoS.
Excluding the default queue, the Layer 3 QoS system has up to 32 QoS with 8 configurable
priorities rules. The Layer 3 QoS system creates a separate queue for each rule to store the
incoming stream of packets. (In this chapter, QoS rules and QoS queues are interchangeable).
Layer 3 QoS systems use a strict priority QoS scheduling algorithm. Layer 3 QoS priority numbers
are inverse to Layer 2 QoS system numbers the lower the priority number, the higher the
priority. For example, a Priority 1 queue schedules and drains before a Priority 2 queue;
similarly, Priority 2 packets will schedule and drain before Priority 3 packets, etc.
Layer 3 QoS systems incorporates WRED (Weighted Random Early Detection) based congestion
avoidance algorithm in addition to tail drop.
Three modes of Layer 3 QoS are available: MAX-Pri (Max-Priority), MIN-MAX (Minimum-
Maximum), and DiffServ (Differentiated Services).
When WRED is enabled for a specific queue, QoS randomly drops packets after reaching 50% of
the QoS queue.
When the FILTER option is enabled for a rule, Layer 3 QoS provides the ability to filter the packet
completely.
2010
QoS Example 6
1. Max-Pri Layer 3 QoS mode is selected.
Steam Data
Stream Protocol VLAN Range TOS Src IP Dest IP Src Port Dest Port
Rate
QUESTION: What are the total output data rates and the individual stream data rates?
2011
When WRED is enabled for a specific queue, QoS randomly drops packets after reaching 50% of
the QoS queue.
When the FILTER option is enabled for a rule, Layer 3 QoS provides the ability to filter the packet
completely.
QoS Example 7
1. Min-Max Layer 3 QoS mode is selected.
Steam Data
Stream Protocol VLAN Range TOS Src IP Dest IP Src Port Dest Port
Rate
QUESTION: What are the total output data rates and the individual stream data rates?
ANSWER:
In Min-Max QoS mode, other than the default rule, which is configured as Priority 9, all QoS
rules are configured as Priority 8.
2012
In this mode, the minimum bandwidth for all rules the excluding the default rule will be
served first in round robin fashion.
In this example, the total minimum BW for Rules 1 and 2 is 5000 Kbps. Since the total
bandwidth is 20 Mbps, it has enough bandwidth to serve.
After serving the minimum bandwidth, the leftover bandwidth is 15 Mbps (20,000 Kbps
5000 Kbps).
Leftover bandwidth will be served among all rules in round robin fashion until it hits
maximum bandwidth limitations.
Since Rule 1 maximum clipping was set to 4000 Kbps, and minimum bandwidth has already
taken 2500 bytes, it will use 1500 Kbps more before reaching the maximum clipping. The
leftover 3500 Kbps (5000-1500=3500) is again given to the main pool.
Rule 2 does not have enough traffic coming in, so it will use only 2500 kbps (5000-2500);
the remaining bandwidth (5000-2500=2500) is again given to the main pool.
Rule 3s input stream is 7000 bytes; it will take its share of the 5000 allocation. Still, it needs
7000-5000=2000).
After serving the fair share, the total leftover bandwidth is 6000 kbps (3500+2500=6000).
Since Rule 3 needs the bandwidth, the leftover bandwidth is applied to that rule.
After serving Rule 3, the leftover bandwidth 4000 Kbps will be applied to the default queue.
The default rule will see the data rate of 4000 Kbps.
QoS Rule Layer 3 QoS Priority Input Data Rate QoS Output Data Rate
1 1 10000 Kbps 4000 Kbps
2 2 5000 Kbps 5000 Kbps
3 3 7000 Kbps 7000 Kbps
4 9 10000 Kbps 4000 Kbps
Total 32000 Kbps 20000 Kbps
2013
QoS Example 8
1. DiffServ Layer 3 QoS mode is selected.
3. The data rate of the modem drops down from 10 Mbps to 8.7 Mbps due to EbNo.
4. The input data streams to the modem are the same as those of QoS Example 7.
QUESTION: What is the total output data rate and what are the individual port output data
rates?
ANSWER:
The Layer 3 QoS system first drains Priority 1 traffic. Since the management data stream is
only 200 Kbps, after serving Priority 1 traffic, QoS still has 9.8 Mbps (10.0-0.2=9.8).
QoS next drains Priority 2s 800 Kbps traffic. After the end of the Priority 2 traffic, QoS still
has 9 Mbps traffic available (9.8-0.8=9).
Similarly, QoS walks through all priorities until it hits the ASFD classes:
o All ASFD classes have the same Priority of 7, with different service rates.
o ASFD service rate is a Committed Information Rate (CIR), except serviced if bandwidth
available after serving all high priority queues. In this case, 2 Mbps bandwidth is
available, serving all service rates first. The total of all ASFD service rates are 1.6 Mbps,
which is less than the 2 Mbps leftover bandwidth.
o After serving the service rates, the leftover bandwidth is 400 Kbps. This 400 Kbps will be
distributed to all ASFD classes equally in round robin fashion until either there is no
more bandwidth, or the input streams have no data.
2014
Stream Priority PHB / DSCP Code Service Rate Drop Precedence Data Rate
Management 1 CS7 / b111000 200 Kbps 9.8 Mbps 200 Kbps
Networking
2 CS6 / b110000 800 Kbps 9.0 Mbps 800 Kbps
Control
Voice 3 EXFD / b101110 1 Mbps 8.0 Mbps 1Mbps
Video 3 CS5 / b101000 4 Mbps 4.0 Mbps 4 Mbps
Data-1 4 CS4 / b100000 550 Kbps 3450 Kbps 550 Kbps
Data-2 5 CS3 / b011000 1450 2000 Kbps 1450 Kbps
Data-3 7 ASFD4 / b100010 1 Mbps NA 100 + 100 Kbps
Data-4 7 ASFD3 / b011010 1 Mbps NA 400 + 100 Kbps
Data-5 7 ASFD2 / b010010 1 Mbps NA 500 + 100 Kbps
Data-6 7 ASFD1 / b001010 1 Mbps NA 800 + 100 Kbps
Data-7 8 BE / bXXXXXX 2 Mbps NA 0 Kbps
Total 14 Mbps 0 Kbps 10 Mbps
2015
When the available data rate is less than the maximum clipping rate, the QoS system has
nothing to clip, since it has not exceeded the defined maximum bandwidth rate.
When the available data rate is less than the minimum data rate, then the QoS system shares
equally among all same priority queues in a round robin fashion until either minimum
bandwidth is met, or no more data is available to drain.
QoS Example 9
1. DiffServ Layer 3 QoS mode is selected.
2. ACM is enabled.
3. The data rate of the modem drops down from 10 Mbps to 8.7 Mbps due to EbNo.
4. Input data streams are the same as with QoS Example 7 (see Sect. 20.3.2).
QUESTION: What will be the total data rate and what will be the individual data rates?
ANSWER:
After serving all high priority queues, only 500 Kbps is left for ASFD classes.
This leftover bandwidth is less than the total minimum bandwidth; it must therefore share
the residual 500 Kbps among all four ASFD classes equally - i.e., 500/4=175 Kbps per class.
2016
Since ASFD 4 has the service rate 100 Kbps, the excess 75 Kbps will be given the other
queues where the service rate not met.
In this case the 75 Kbps again will share equally among ASFD3, ASFD2, and ASFD1 since
these service rates were not met.
Leftover BW (After
Stream Priority PHB / DSCP Code Input Data rate QoS output Data rate
Serving the Queue)
Management 1 CS7 / b111000 200 Kbps 9.8 Mbps 200 Kbps
Networking
2 CS6 / b110000 800 Kbps 9.0 Mbps 800 Kbps
Control
Voice 3 EXFD / b101110 1 Mbps 8.0 Mbps 1Mbps
2017
Notes:
2018
Figure A-1 depicts the cable required for EIA-530 -to- EIA-422/449 DCE conversion.
Figure A-2 depicts the cable required for EIA-530 -to- V.35 DCE conversion.
Figure A-3 depicts a standard EIA-232 cable for connection between the CDM-625 Rear Panel Remote Control port and any
serial port on the user PC.
All dimensions, where specified in the illustrations featured in this appendix, are in inches.
A-1
Figure A-1. EIA-530 to RS-422/449 DCE Conversion Cable (CEFD P/N CA/WR0049)
A-2
A-3
Figure A-3. RS-232 Remote Control Cable (CDM-625 Remote Control Port to PC 9-Pin Serial Port)
A-4
The idea is to accurately measure the value of (Co+No)/No, (Carrier density + Noise density/Noise
density). This is accomplished by tuning the center frequency of the Spectrum analyzer to the
signal of interest, and measuring the difference between the peak spectral density of the signal
(the flat part of the spectrum shown) and the noise density.
Set the Resolution Bandwidth of the Spectrum Analyzer to < 20 % of the symbol rate.
Use video filtering and/or video averaging to reduce the variance in the displayed trace
to a low enough level that the difference can be measured to within 0.2dB.
Place a marker on the flat part of the signal of interest, then use the MARKER DELTA
function to put a second marker on the noise to the side of the carrier. This value is
(Co+No)/No, in dB.
Use this value of (Co+No)/No in the table on the following page to determine the Eb/No.
You will need to know the operating mode to read from the appropriate column.
If the (Co+No)/No value measured does not correspond to an exact table entry,
interpolate using the two nearest values.
Note that the accuracy of this method degrades significantly at low values of (Co+No)/No
(approximately less than 6 dB).
B1
Example: In the above diagram, the (Co+No)/No measured is 4.6 dB. If Rate 1/2 QPSK is used,
this corresponds to an Eb/N0 of approximately 2.6 dB. The exact relationship used to derive the
table values is as follows:
See Chapter 12. ESC++ for details of how the Eb/No performance degrades when
ESC++ is used, particularly at lower data rates, where the percentage overhead is
high.
B2
1.4 - - - 0.8 - - - - - - - - - - -
1.6 - - - 1.5 - - - - - - - - - - -
1.8 - - - 2.1 - - - - - - - - - - -
2.0 - 0.7 0.9 2.7 - - - - - - - - - - -
2.2 - 1.2 1.4 3.2 - - - - - - - - - -
2.4 - 1.7 1.9 3.7 - - - - - - - - - - -
2.6 - 2.1 2.3 4.2 - - - - - - - - - - -
2.8 - 2.6 2.8 4.6 - - - - - - - - - - -
3.0 0.0 3.0 3.2 5.0 - - - - - - - - - - -
CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem
B3
9.0 8.4 11.4 11.6 13.4 5.4 8.4 6.6 6.0 5.6 5.4 4.9 - - - -
9.5 9.0 12.0 12.2 14.0 6.0 9.0 7.2 6.6 6.2 6.0 5.5 4.8 4.5 - -
10.0 9.5 12.5 12.7 14.6 6.5 9.5 7.7 7.1 6.7 6.5 6.0 5.3 5.0 - -
10.5 10.1 13.1 13.3 15.1 7.1 10.1 8.3 7.7 7.3 7.1 6.6 5.9 5.6 5.3 -
11.0 10.6 13.6 13.8 15.7 7.6 10.6 8.8 8.2 7.8 7.6 7.1 6.4 6.1 5.8 5.2
11.5 11.2 14.2 14.4 16.2 8.2 11.2 9.4 8.8 8.4 8.2 7.7 7.0 6.7 6.4 5.8
12.0 11.7 14.7 14.9 16.7 8.7 11.7 9.9 9.3 8.9 8.7 8.2 7.5 7.2 6.9 6.3
12.5 12.2 15.2 15.4 17.3 9.2 12.2 10.4 9.8 9.4 9.2 8.7 8.0 7.7 7.4 6.8
13.0 12.8 15.8 16.0 17.8 9.8 12.8 11.0 10.4 10.0 9.8 9.3 8.6 8.3 8.0 7.4
13.5 13.3 16.3 16.5 18.3 10.3 13.3 11.5 10.9 10.5 10.3 9.8 9.1 8.8 8.5 7.9
14.0 13.8 16.8 17.0 18.8 10.8 13.8 12.0 11.4 11.0 10.8 10.3 9.6 9.3 9.0 8.4
14.5 14.3 17.3 17.5 19.4 11.3 14.3 12.5 11.9 11.5 11.3 10.8 10.1 9.8 9.5 8.9
15.0 14.9 17.9 18.1 19.9 11.9 14.9 13.1 12.5 12.1 11.9 11.4 10.7 10.4 10.1 9.5
15.5 15.4 18.4 18.6 20.4 12.4 15.4 13.6 13.0 12.6 12.4 11.9 11.2 10.9 10.6 10.0
16.0 15.9 18.9 19.1 20.9 12.9 15.9 14.1 13.5 13.1 12.9 12.4 11.7 11.4 11.1 10.5
16.5 16.4 19.4 19.6 21.4 13.4 16.4 14.6 14.0 13.6 13.4 12.9 12.2 11.9 11.6 11.0
17.0 16.9 19.9 20.1 21.9 13.9 16.9 15.1 14.5 14.1 13.9 13.4 12.7 12.4 12.1 11.5
17.5 17.4 20.4 20.6 22.4 14.4 17.4 15.6 15.0 14.6 14.4 13.9 13.2 12.9 12.6 12.0
18.0 17.9 20.9 21.1 23.0 14.9 17.9 16.1 15.5 15.1 14.9 14.4 13.7 13.4 13.1 12.5
18.5 18.4 21.4 21.6 23.5 15.4 18.4 16.6 16.0 15.6 15.4 14.9 14.2 13.9 13.6 13.0
19.0 18.9 21.9 22.1 24.0 15.9 18.9 17.1 16.5 16.1 15.9 15.4 14.7 14.4 14.1 13.5
19.5 19.5 22.5 22.7 24.5 16.5 19.5 17.7 17.1 16.7 16.5 16.0 15.3 15.0 14.7 14.1
20.0 20.0 23.0 23.2 25.0 17.0 20.0 18.2 17.6 17.2 17.0 16.5 15.8 15.5 15.2 14.6
Notes: IBS Framing: add 0.2 dB EDMAC Framing: rates below 2048 kbps add 0.2 dB, otherwise 0 Reed-Solomon: add an additional 0.4 dB to the values shown
MN-CDM625
Revision 13
CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix B MN-CDM625
Notes:
B4
If you wish to upgrade the functionality of a unit at a later date, Comtech EF Data provides Fully
Accessible System Topology (FAST), which permits the purchase and activation of options
through special authorization codes. You may purchase these unique, register-specific Fast
Access Codes from Comtech EF Data during normal business hours, and then load these codes
into the unit using either the front panel keypad or the CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface.
Contact a Comtech EF Data sales representative during normal business hours, or via e-mail to
sales@comtechefdata.com, to order the desired options.
See Table 1-2 in Chapter 1. INTRODUCTION or Sect. 5.2.8.1.1 in Chapter 5. FRONT
PANEL OPERATION for listings of the available FAST and FAST-accessible hardware
options.
FAST System Theory: FAST facilitates on-location upgrade of the operating feature set without
removing a unit from the setup. FAST technology allows you to order a unit precisely tailored for
the initial application. When your service requirements change, you can upgrade the topology of
the unit to meet these requirements within minutes. This accelerated upgrade can be
accomplished because of FASTs extensive use of the programmable logic devices incorporated
into Comtech EF Data products.
FAST Accessible Options: Hardware options can be ordered and installed either at the factory or
in the field. Depending on the current hardware configuration of the unit, you can select options
that can be easily activated on-site. The FAST Access Code that is purchased from Comtech EF
Data enables configuration of the available hardware. The base CDM-625 unit is equipped with
Viterbi and Reed-Solomon codecs. It offers BPSK, QPSK, and OQPSK modulation types, and data
rates up to 5.0 Mbps, with all interface types. While it is limited to Closed Network operation, it
also includes EDMAC and AUPC.
C1
Step Task
1 Before contacting Comtech EF Data to order FAST feature upgrades, obtain and r ecord the modems
motherboard serial number:
a) From the front panel main menu, SELECT: FAST, and then press [ENTER].
b) The modems 9-digit Baseboard S/N is displayed on the bottom line, to the left.
a) From the front panel main menu, SELECT: FAST, then press [ENTER].
b) From the SELECT: FAST OPTIONS menu, select View Options, then press [ENTER].
c) Use the up and down arrow keys ) ( to scroll through the list of available FAST options.
Options ar e i dentified as Installed or Not In stalled. A ny t hat are Not In stalled may be
purchased as a FAST upgrade.
3 Contact a Comtech EF Data sales representative during normal business hours to order features:
Obtain the invoice, the register-specific 20-digit FAST Access Code(s), and the FAST option
activation instructions.
When a F AST ac cess c ode i s obt ained f rom C omtech E F D ata, it will be for a
specific option register. The FAST options are linked to three option registers:
a) Press [CLEAR] to return to the SELECT: FAST Options Set Registers menu.
b) Use the arrow keys ( ) to carefully enter each register-specific 20-character FAST
access code.
c) Press [ENTER].
C2
Step Task
For Firmware Ver. 1.5.1 or earlier, enter the FAST access code for option
register(s) #1, #2 and/or #3 as required. For Firmware Ver. 1.5.2 and
later, all three FAST access codes must be entered in sequence in order
for the purchased option upgrades to be properly activated.
The m odem r esponds with Configured Successfully i f th e FAST upgrade is accepted; the m odem
then resets to its newly-incorporated default configuration.
Repeat the FAST access code entry procedure. Should the code entry error persist, contact Comtech
EF Data Customer Support for further assistance.
C3
C.2.2 FAST Activation via the CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface
Figure C-1. CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface ADMIN | FAST page
Use the CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface Admin | FAST page (Figure C-1) for complete
management of FAST Features. This page provides scrollable list boxes that display the
availability and activation status for all FAST options. FAST code entry/option activation control
is also provided.
Step Task
1 Before contacting Comtech EF Data to order FAST feature upgrades, use the front panel SELECT: FAST
menu, as explained in Sect. C.2.1 Step 1, to obtain and record the modems motherboard serial number.
2 Use the Admin | FAST page to view the currently installed features. Any options that appear in the
scrollable Options Not Installed list box may be purchased as a FAST upgrade.
C4
Step Task
3 Contact a Comtech EF Data sales representative during normal business hours to order features:
Obtain the invoice, the register-specific 20-digit FAST Access Code(s), and t he FAST option
activation instructions.
When a F AST ac cess c ode i s obt ained f rom C omtech E F D ata, it will be for a
specific option register. The FAST options are linked to three option registers:
a) In the Admin | FAST page FAST code section, carefully enter each register-specific 20-
character FAST access code in sequence.
With Firmware Ver. 2.1.0 and later, all three FAST access codes must be entered in
sequence in order for the purchased option upgrades to be properly activated.
The message Configured S uccessfully appears at the t op of t he FAST code section if th e FAST
upgrade is accepted; the modem then resets to its newly-incorporated default configuration.
However, if an invalid code is entered, either of the following messages may appear instead:
Repeat the FAST access code entry procedure. Should the code entry error persist, contact Comtech EF
Data Customer Support for further assistance.
C5
Notes:
C6
D.2 EIA-485
For applications where multiple devices are to be monitored and controlled, a full-duplex (or 4-wire plus ground) EIA-485 is preferred.
Half-duplex (2-wire plus ground) EIA-485 is possible, but is not preferred. In full-duplex EIA-485 communication, there are two separate,
isolated, independent, differential-mode twisted pairs, each handling serial data in different directions.
It is assumed that a 'Controller' device (a PC or dumb terminal) transmits data in a broadcast mode via one of the pairs. Multiple 'Target'
devices are connected to this pair, and all simultaneously receive data from the Controller. The Controller is the only device with a line-
driver connected to this pair the Target devices have only line-receivers connected.
In the other direction, on the other pair each Target has a tri-state line driver connected, and the Controller has a line-receiver
connected. All the line drivers are held in high-impedance mode until one (and only one) Target transmits back to the Controller. Each
Target has a unique address, and each time the Controller transmits, the address of the intended recipient Target is included in a framed
'packet' of data. All of the Targets receive the packet, but only one (the intended) will reply. The Target enables its output line driver and
transmits its return data packet back to the Controller in the other direction, on the physically separate pair.
D1
Two differential pairs one pair for Controller-to-Target, one pair for Target-to-Controller.
Controller-to-Target pair has one line driver (Controller), and all Targets have line-receivers.
Target-to-Controller pair has one line receiver (Controller), and all Targets have Tri-State drivers.
D.3 EIA-232
This is a much simpler configuration in which the Controller device is connected directly to the Target via a two-wire-plus-ground
connection. Controller-to-Target data is carried, via EIA-232 electrical levels on one conductor, and Target-to-Controller data is carried in
the other direction on the other conductor.
All data is transmitted in framed packets. The Controller is in charge of the process of monitor and control, and is the only device that is
permitted to initiate, at will, the transmission of data. Targets are only permitted to transmit when they have been specifically instructed
to do so by the Controller.
All bytes within a packet are printable ASCII characters, less than ASCII code 127. In this context, the Carriage Return and Line Feed
characters are considered printable.
All messages from Controller-to-Target require a response, with one exception: This will be either to return data that has been
requested by the Controller, or to acknowledge reception of an instruction to change the configuration of the Target. The exception to
this is when the Controller broadcasts a message (such as Set Time/Date) using Address 0, when the Target is set to EIA-485 mode.
D2
In this context, the Carriage Return and Line Feed characters are considered printable. With one exception, all messages from Controller-
to-Target require a response this will be either to return data that has been requested by the Controller, or to acknowledge reception of an
instruction to change the configuration of the Target.
Controller-to-Target
Start of Packet Target Address Address Delimiter Instruction Code Code Qualifier Optional Arguments End of Packet
< / = or ? Carriage Return
ASCII code 60 ASCII code 47 ASCII codes 61 or 63 ASCII code 13
(1 character) (4 characters) (1 character) (3 characters) (1 character) (n characters) (1 character)
Example: <0135/TFQ=70.2345{CR}
Target-to-Controller
Start of Packet Target Address Address Delimiter Instruction Code Code Qualifier Optional Arguments End of Packet
> / =, ?, !, or * Carriage Return, Line
ASCII code 62 ASCII code 47 ASCII codes Feed
61, 63, 33, or 42 ASCII codes 13,10
(1 character) (4 characters) (1 character) (3 characters) (1 character) (From 0 to n characters) (2 characters)
Example: >0654/RSW=32{CR}{LF}
The < and > characters indicate the start of packet. They may not appear anywhere else within the body of the message.
D3
Symbol Definition
= The = code is used as the Assignment Operator (AO) and is used to indicate that the parameter defined by the preceding byte should
(ASCII code 61) be set to the value of the argument (s) which follow it.
Example: In a message from Controller-to-Target, TFQ=0950.0000 would mean set the transmit frequency to 950 MHz.
? The ? c ode i s us ed as t he Query O perator ( QO) and i s us ed to i ndicate t hat t he Target should r eturn t he c urrent value of t he
(ASCII code 63) parameters defined by the preceding byte.
Example: In a message from Controller-to-Target, TFQ? Would mean return the current value of the transmit frequency.
D4
Symbol Definition
= The = code is used in two ways:
(ASCII code 61) a. If the Controller has sent a query code to a Target.
(Example: TFQ? (meaning whats the Transmit frequency?), the Target would respond with TFQ=xxxx.xxxx, where xxxx.xxxx
represents the frequency in question.
b. If the Controller sends an instruction to set a parameter to a particular value, then, providing the value sent is valid, the Target will
acknowledge the message by replying with TFQ= (with no message arguments).
? If th e Controller sends an instruction t o s et a par ameter t o a p articular v alue, t hen, i f the v alue s ent i s not valid, t he Target will
(ASCII code 63) acknowledge the message by replying (for example) with TFQ? (with no message arguments). This indicates that there was an error in
the message sent by the Controller.
! If the Controller sends an instruction code which the Target does not recognize, the Target will acknowledge the message by echoing
(ASCII code 33) the invalid instruction, followed by the ! character.
Example: XYZ!
* If the Controller sends an instruction to set a parameter to a particular value, then, if the value sent is valid BUT the modulator will not
(ASCII code 42) permit that particular parameter to be c hanged at this time, the Target will acknowledge the message by replying, for example, with
TFQ* (with message arguments).
# If the Controller sends a correctly formatted command BUT the modem is in local mode, it will not allow reconfiguration and will
(ASCI code 35) respond with TFQ#
~ If a m essage was sent via a l ocal modem to a di stant end device or ODU, the message was transmitted transparently through the
(ASCI code 126) local modem. In the event of the distant-end device not responding, the local modem would generate a response.
Example: 0001/RET~ (indicating that it had finished waiting for a response and was now ready for further comms).
^ If the Controller sends a correctly formatted command BUT the modem is in Ethernet Remote mode, it will not allow reconfiguration,
(ASCI code 94) and will respond with TFQ^.
D5
Target-to-Controller: This is the two-character sequence Carriage Return, Line Feed (ASCII codes 13 and 10). Both indicate
the valid termination of a packet.
D6
1. Index Columns Where Column C = Command, and Column Q = Query, columns marked X designate the instruction code as
Command only, Query only, or Command or Query. Where CODE = XXX, this indicates a priority command.
2. In the tables that follow, the following codes are used in the Response to Command column (per Sect. D.5.5):
= Message ok # Message ok, but unit is not in Remote mode.
? Received ok, but invalid arguments were found. ~ Time out of a pass-through message, either to via EDMAC or to a local ODU
^ Message ok, but unit is in Ethernet mode.
D7
D8
D9
D.5.2 Tx Parameters
Priority System: TIT (Highest priority) , TFM, TFT, TMD, TCR, TDR, and TSR (Lowest Priority), indicated by shading. Any change to a higher
priority parameter can override any of the parameters of lower priority.
Exception Select DROP, D&I++, QDI or Framed QDI mode using TFM (Transmit Framing type), which is highest priority.
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Tx Interface TIT= 1 byte, value Command or Query. TIT= TIT? TIT=x
Type of 0 thru 9, or Tx Interface Type, where: TIT?
A 0=RS422 TIT* (see Description of
1=V.35 TIT# Arguments)
2= reserved do not use.
3=Balanced G.703
4=Unbalanced G.703
5=Audio (Data rate fixed at 64 kbps) (IBS/EDMAC only)
6=LVDS
7=HSSI
8=IP
9=ASI
A=IP-ACM (Unframed, EDMACs only)
Example: TIT=1 (selects V.35)
Tx Framing TFM= 1 byte, value Command or Query. TFM= TFM? TFM=x
Mode of 0 thru 9, A Tx Framing mode, where: TFM?
0=Unframed TFM* (see Description of
1=IBS TFM# Arguments)
2=IDR
3=D&I - DROP (requires D&I FAST option)
4=EDMAC
5=D&I++ (requires D&I FAST option)
6=ESC++
7=EDMAC-2
8=Quad Drop & Insert (requires QDI FAST option)
(G.703 Balanced, E1-CCS only)
9=Framed QDI (requires QDI FAST option)
(G.703 Balanced, E1-CCS only)
A=EDMAC-3
Example: TFM=0 (selects Unframed mode)
D10
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Tx FEC Type TFT= 1 byte, value Command or Query. TFT= TFT? TFT=x
of 0 thru 9, A, Tx FEC coding type, where: TFT?
B 0=None (uncoded) with differential encoding ON TFT* (see Description of
1=Viterbi TFT# Arguments)
2=Viterbi + Reed-Solomon
3=Sequential
4=Sequential + Reed-Solomon
5=TCM (Trellis Code Modulation)
(Forces Rate 2/3)
6=TCM + Reed-Solomon (Forces Rate 2/3)
7=TPC (aka Turbo) (requires TPC/LDPC Codec)
8=None (uncoded) with differential encoding OFF
9=LDPC (Requires TPC/LDPC Codec)
A=VersaFEC CCM or ACM (fixed in IP-ACM)
B=VersaFEC ULL
Example: TFT=1 (selects Viterbi coding)
Tx TMD= 1 byte, value Command or Query (Query only in IP-ACM). TMD= TMD? TMD=x
Modulation of 0 thru 5 Tx Modulation type in the form x, where: TMD?
Type 0=BPSK TMD* (see Description of
1=QPSK TMD# Arguments)
2=OQPSK
3=8-PSK
4=16-QAM (Turbo or Viterbi + RS only)
5=8-QAM (TPC/LDPC only) (Need Codec & FAST option)
6=Reserved
7=Reserved
8=Reserved
Depending on FEC type, not all of these selections will be valid.
Example: TMD=2 (selects OQPSK)
D11
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Tx FEC Code TCR= 1 byte, value Command or Query (Query only in IP-ACM). TCR= TCR? TCR=x
Rate of 0 thru 7, A Tx FEC Code Rate in the form x, where: TCR?
to U 0=Rate 1/2 TCR* (see Description of
1=Rate 3/4 TCR# Arguments)
2=Rate 7/8
3=Rate 2/3 (8-PSK TCM or LDPC only)
4=Rate 1/1 (Uncoded or No FEC)
5=Rate 21/44 (Turbo Only)
6=Rate 5/16 (Turbo Only)
7=Rate 0.95 (Turbo Only) (aka 17/18)
8=Reserved
9=Reserved
A=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 0 BPSK 0.488
B=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 1 QPSK 0.533
C=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 2 QPSK 0.631
D=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 3 QPSK 0.706
E=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 4 QPSK 0.803
F=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 5 8-QAM 0.642
G=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 6 8-QAM 0.711
H=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 7 8-QAM 0.780
I=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 8 16-QAM 0.731
J=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 9 16-QAM 0.780
K=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 10 16-QAM 0.829
L=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 11 16-QAM 0.853
M=Reserved
N=Reserved
O=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 14 8-QAM 0.576
P=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 15 16-QAM 0.644
Q=Reserved
R=VersaFEC CCM ULL ModCod 17 BPSK 0.493
S=VersaFEC CCM ULL ModCod 18 QPSK 0.493
T=VersaFEC CCM ULL ModCod 19 QPSK 0.654
U=VersaFEC CCM ULL ModCod 20 QPSK 0.734
Depending on FEC type, not all of these selections will be valid.
Example: TCR=1 (selects Rate 3/4)
D12
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Tx Data Rate TDR= 9 bytes Command or Query (Query only in IP-ACM). TDR= TDR? TDR=xxxxx.xxx
Tx Data rate, in kbps, between 18 kbps and 25 Mbps Resolution=1 bps TDR?
Example: TDR=02047.999 (selects 2047.999 kbps) TDR* (see Description of
Additional auxiliary G.703 sub-rates are available, selected using: TDR# Arguments)
00512.AUX
01024.AUX
02048.AUX
The connectors used for the Aux rates are IDI/DDO.
These Aux rates are not available with Drop & Insert or IDR.
Read-only if Framing Mode is Quad Drop & Insert (TFM=8). Data rate is set by assigning the number of
channels on each port.
Read-only if Modulation Type is a Reserved type
Tx TSR= 9 bytes, Query only (Command or Query in IP-ACM). TSR? TSR? TSR=ddddd.ddd
Symbol Rate numeric Allows remote access to the Tx symbol rate, in the form ddddd.ddd TSR=
Note: Symbol Rate ranges in IP-ACM = 37 ksym/sec to 4100 ksym/sec TSR* (see Description of
TSR# Arguments)
Tx Frequency TFQ= 9 bytes Command or Query. TFQ= TFQ? TFQ=xxxx.xxxx
Frequency ranges: TFQ?
50 MHz to 180 MHz, and TFQ*
950 MHz to 1950 MHz (L-Band FAST option) TFQ#
Exception Resolution=100Hz. Exception
600 Emulation Note: The CDM-625 supports 70,140 MHz bands and L-Band. 600 Emulation:
8 bytes Example: TFQ=0950.9872 TFQ=xxx.xxxx
Tx Sub-Mux TMX= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. TMX? TMX? TMX=x
on/off Tx Sub-Mux in the form x, where: TMX=
0=Off TMX* (see Description of
1=On TMX# Arguments)
Tx Sub-Mux TMR= 2 bytes, Command or Query. TMR? TMR? TMR=xx
Ratio numeric Tx Sub-Mux Ratio (IP/Synchronous Interface) in the form xx, where TMR=
00=1/9 08=2/5 16=5/4 24=7/2 TMR* (see Description of
01=1/8 09=3/7 17=4/3 25=4/1 TMR# Arguments)
02=1/7 10=1/2 18=3/2 26=5/1
03=1/6 11=3/5 19=5/3 27=6/1
04=1/5 12=2/3 20=2/1 28=7/1
05=1/4 13=3/4 21=7/3 29=8/1
06=2/7 14=4/5 22=5/2 30=9/1
07=1/3 15=1/1 23=3/1 31=1/59 32=1/39 33=1/19
Example: TMR=01 (Selects ratio 1/8)
D13
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Tx TDI= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. TDI= TDI? TDI=x
Data Invert Invert Transmit Data TDI?
Exception 0=Normal TDI* (see Description of
600/L 1=Inverted TDI# Exception Arguments)
Emulation: Example: TDI = 1 (selects TX Data Invert) 600/L Emulation:
ITD= Exception In 600/L Emulation Mode, instruction is ITD. ITD?
Tx TRS= 1 byte, value Command or Query. TRS= TRS? TRS=x
Reed- of 0 thru 3 Tx RS encoding TRS?
Solomon 0=Normal (based on the Open Network framing selected) TRS* (see Description of
Encoding 1=IESS-310 mode, valid with QDI, unframed, IBS, D&I, IDR. TRS# Arguments)
2=EF Data legacy standard (225,205) unframed, QDI only
3=IBS (126,112) unframed only
Example: TRS=0 (This is a dont care if no RS is selected under FEC Type)
Available all framing modes, except EDMAC.
Tx Spectrum TSI= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. TSI= TSI? TSI=x
Invert Tx Spectrum Invert selection, where: TSI?
0=Normal TSI* (see Description of
1=Tx Spectrum Inverted TSI# Arguments)
Example:TSI=0 (selects normal)
Tx Scrambler TSC= 1 byte, 0, 1 or Command or Query. TSC= TSC? TSC=x
2 Tx Scrambler state, where: TSC?
0=Off TSC* (see Description of
1=Normal TSC# Arguments)
2=IESS-315
Note: When CnC mode is ON, Tx Scrambler state is fixed as IESS-315.
Example: TSC=1 (Scrambler On)
Tx Power TPL= 4 bytes Command or Query. TPL= TPL? TPL=xx.x
Level Tx Output power level between 0 and -40 dBm (minus sign assumed) for 950 to 1950MHz range. TPL?
Tx Output power level between 0 and -25 dBm (minus sign assumed) for 50 to 180MHz range. TPL* (see Description of
Example: TPL=13.4 TPL# Arguments)
In AUPC mode, command is not valid. Response will be TPL*.
When APC is active, query returns TPL=99.9; when command is not valid, response will be TPL*.
When the external 20 dB attenuator is activated (via AUP), the permitted power level range shifted down by
20dB.
Example: 65 and -20 dBm.
600 Emulation:
Level range: 0 to -20 dBm (minus sign assumed).
600L Emulation:
Level range: 0 to -45 dBm (minus sign assumed).
D14
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Tx Carrier TXO= 1 byte, value Command or Query. TXO= TXO? TXO=x
State of 0 thru 9 Tx Carrier State in the form x, where: TXO?
0=OFF due to front panel or remote control command TXO* (see Description of
1=ON TXO# Arguments)
2=RTI (receive/transmit inhibit), timeout = 10 seconds
3=OFF due to ext H/W Tx Carrier- Off control *
4=OFF due to BUC or High-Stability Ref warm-up *
5= Carrier controlled by STDMA Controller *
6=RTI (receive/transmit inhibit), timeout = 1 second
7=RTI (receive/transmit inhibit), timeout = 2 seconds
8=RTI (receive/transmit inhibit), timeout = 4 seconds
9=RTI (receive/transmit inhibit), timeout = 7 seconds
Note: arguments indicated with a * are status-only. They are not valid as a command, and are not
indicated in MGC? response.
Example: TXO=1 (Tx Carrier ON)
Tx Alpha TXA= 1 byte, value of Command or Query. TXA= TXA? TXA=x
0 or 1 Tx Filter Rolloff Factor in the form x, where: TXA? (see Description of
x = 0 (0.35) or 1 (0.25) TXA# Arguments)
Example: TXA=0 (Tx filter rolloff factor is 0.35)
Power Level AUP= 1 byte, 0, 1, 2 Command or Query. AUP= AUP? AUP=x
Mode or 3 Power level mode in the form x, where: AUP?
(was AUPC 0=MANUAL mode (AUPC disabled). AUP* (see Description of
Enable) Normal power mode AUP# Arguments)
1=AUPC enabled.
2=MANUAL-LOW.
Low power mode (-65 to -20dBm) - external attenuator activated.
3=AUPC-LOW.
AUPC enabled and external attenuator activated
Example: AUP=1
Notes:
1. EDMAC or D&I++, E1 D&I w/ccs or ESC++ framing must be selected for the AUPC feature to be
available.
2. External 20dB Attenuator is a hardware option.
D15
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
AUPC APP= 6 bytes Command or Query. APP= APP? APP=abc.cd
Parameters Defines AUPC operating parameters in the form abc.cd: APP?
a=Defines action on max. power condition, where: APP* (see Description of
(0=do nothing, 1=generate Tx alarm) APP# Arguments)
b=Defines action on remote demod unlock, where:
(0=go to nominal power, 1=go to max power)
c.c=Target Eb/No value, for remote demod from 0.0 to 14.9 dB, where:
numbers above 9.9 use hex representation for the first character, i.e. 14.9 is coded as E.9.
d =Max increase in Tx Power permitted, from 0.0 to 9.0 dB
Example: APP=015.67 (Sets no alarm, max power, 5.6 dB Target and 7 dB power increase.)
In IP-ACM mode:
a=Defines action on max. power condition, where:
(0=do nothing, 1=generate Tx alarm when max power is reached, 2=generate Tx alarm when mimimum
ModCod is reached)
b=Defines action on remote demod unlock, where:
(0=go to nominal power, 1=go to max power, 2=hold)
c.c = Max increase in Tx Power permitted, from 0.0 to 9.9 dB OR when CnC mode is on, from 0.0 to 3.0 dB
d = Mode (0=Normal, 1=+/- Track), read-only
Remote N/A 4 bytes Query only. N/A REB? REB=xx.x
Eb/No Returns the value of Eb/No of the remote demod in the form xx.x, where:
xx.x=02.0 to 16.0 (see Description of
Responds 99.9 = remote demod unlocked. Arguments)
Responds xx.x if EDMAC is disabled.
Example: REB=12.4
Note: For values > 16.0 dB, the reply will be 16.0
Tx Power N/A 3 bytes Query only. N/A PLI? PLI=x.x
Level Returns the increase in Tx power level, in dB (from the nominal setting) due to the action of AUPC.
Increase Responds x.x if AUPC is disabled. (see Description of
Example: PLI=2.3 Arguments)
Tx Clock TCK= 1 byte, value Command or Query. TCK= TCK? TCK=x
Source of 0 thru 3 Tx Clock Source, where: TCK?
0=Internal TCK* (see Description of
1=Tx Terrestrial TCK# Arguments)
2=Rx Loop-Timed
3=Ext TT (ST=RxSat)
Example: TCK=0 (selects Internal)
D16
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Tx Clock TCI= 1 byte, value 0 Command or Query. TCI= TCI? TCI=x
Invert or 1 Invert Transmit Data Clock in the form x, where: TCI?
0=Normal TCI* (see Description of
1=Inverted TCI# Arguments)
Tx Audio TVL= 4 bytes Command or Query. (Audio/IDR parameter) TVL= TVL? TVL=aabb
Volume Tx Audio Volume control in the form aabb, where: TVL?
Control aa=Tx 1 volume control in dB, valid values are -6, -4, -2, +0, +2, +4, +6, +8; TVL* (see Description of
bb=Tx 2 volume control in dB, valid values are -6, -4, -2, +0, +2, +4, +6, +8; TVL# Arguments)
Example: TVL= -2+4 (sets Tx 1 to 2 dB and Tx 2 to +4 dB)
Transmit TTA= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. (DROP parameter) TTA= TTA? TTA=x
Terrestrial Transmit terrestrial Alarm Mask conditions in the form x, where: TTA?
Alarm Mask 0=Alarm is active (unmasked). TTA* (see Description of
1=Alarm is masked. TTA# Arguments)
Example: TTA=1 (masks an alarm).
Drop Type DTY= 1 byte, value Command or Query. (DROP/D&I++/QDI parameter) DTY= DTY? DTY=x
of 0 thru 3 Drop Type in the form x, where: DTY?
0=T1D4 DTY* (see Description of
1=T1ESF DTY# Arguments)
2=E1CCS
3=E1CAS
Tx Drop DTS= 3 bytes Command or Query. (Drop parameter) DTS= DTS? DTS=yyyyyyyyyyyyy
Timeslot (Note different format between command and query.) DTS? yyyyyyyyyyy
Command format: DTS=xxy, where: DTS* indicating all 24 Drop
xx = Channel 01 through 24 DTS# timeslots values
y = timeslot: 0-9, A=10, B=11, C=12, D=13,V=31 associated with the
24 Tx Satellite
channels.
Tx Ternary TTC= 1 byte, value Command or Query. (G.703 parameter) TTC= TTC? TTC=x
Code of 0 thru 3 Tx Ternary Code in the form x, where: TTC?
0=AMI TTC* (see Description of
1=B8ZS TTC# Arguments)
2=B6ZS
3=HDB3
Example: TTC=1 (selects B8ZS)
Transmit TBA= 4 bytes, each Command or Query. (IDR parameter) TBA= TBA? TBA=xxxx
Backward a value of 0 Transmit Backward Alarm enable in the form xxxx, where: TBA?
Alarms thru 2 0=Disable TBA* Position indicates
Enable 1=Enable Internal (S/W) TBA# backward alarm
2=Enable External (H/W) numbers: 1234
Example: TBA=0120
D17
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Transmit TET= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. (IDR parameter) TET= TET? TET=x
ESC Type IDR ESC Type in the form x, where: TET?
0=64k data channel TET* (see Description of
1=2 Audio channels TET# Arguments)
TX LO TLO= 6 bytes Command or Query. TLO= TLO? TLO=xxxxxs
Frequency Tx LO frequency information in the form xxxxxs, where: TLO?
xxxxx is the LO frequency, 3000 through 65000 MHz or 00000 (OFF) TLO* (see Description of
s is the sign for the MIX TLO# Arguments)
Terminal Frequency = LO TFQ (see below)
Example: TLO=12000+ (BUC LO is 12GHz, low-side mix)
Tx Satellite N/A 10 bytes Query only. N/A TTF? TTF=xxxxx.xxxx
(Terminal) Terminal (aka satellite) Tx Frequency, which is the frequency transmitted to the satellite.
Frequency Resolution=100 Hz (see Description of
Returns 00000.0000 if LO is zero Arguments)
Example: TTF=11650.2249
Tx N/A 9 bytes, Query only. TIR? TIR? TIR=ddddd.ddd
Information numeric This command allows remote access to the Aggregate Tx Information rate in the form: ddddd.ddd TIR=
Rate TIR* (see Description of
TIR# Arguments)
Tx Sub-Mux N/A 9 bytes, Query only. TMI? TMI? TMI=ddddd.ddd
IP numeric This command allows remote access to the IP portion of the Tx Information rate in the form: ddddd.ddd TMI=
Information TMI* (see Description of
Rate TMI# Arguments)
D18
D.5.3 Rx Parameters
Priority System: RIT (Highest priority) , RFM, RFT, RMD, RCR, RDR, and RSR (Lowest Priority), indicated by shading. Any change to a higher
priority parameter can override any of the parameters of lower priority.
Exception Select DROP, D&I++ or QDI mode using RFM (Transmit Framing type), which is highest priority.
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Rx Interface RIT= 1 byte, value Command or Query. RIT= RIT? RIT=x
Type of 0 thru 9, or Rx Interface Type in the form x, where: RIT?
A 0=RS422 RIT* (see Description of
1=V.35 RIT# Arguments)
2= reserved do not use.
3=Balanced G.703
4=Unbalanced G.703
5=Audio (only at 64 kbps) (IBS/EDMAC only) (FAST option)
6=LVDS
7=HSSI
8=IP
9=ASI
A=IP-ACM
Example: RIT=1 (selects V.35)
Rx Framing RFM= 1 byte, value Command or Query. RFM= RFM? RFM=x
Mode of 0 thru 9, A Rx Framing mode in the form x, where: RFM?
0=Unframed RFM* (see Description of
1=IBS (requires Open Network FAST option) RFM# Arguments)
2=IDR (requires Open Network FAST option)
3=D&I (requires D&I FAST option)
4=EDMAC
5=D&I++ (requires D&I FAST option)
6=ESC++
7=EDMAC-2
8=Quad Drop & Insert (requires QDI FAST option)
9=Framed QDI (requires QDI FAST option)
(G.703 Balanced, E1-CCS only)
A=EDMAC-3
Example: RFM=0 (selects Unframed mode)
D19
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Rx FEC Type RFT= 1 byte, value Command or Query. RFT= RFT? RFT=x
of 0 thru 9, A, Rx FEC Type in the form x, where: RFT?
B 0=None (uncoded) with differential encoding ON RFT* (see Description of
1=Viterbi RFT# Arguments)
2=Viterbi + Reed-Solomon
3= Sequential
4= Sequential + Reed-Solomon
5=TCM (Trellis Code Modulation)
6=TCM + Reed-Solomon
7=TPC (aka Turbo) (Requires Codec, FAST)
8=None (uncoded) with differential encoding OFF
9=LDPC (Requires Codec, FAST)
A=VersaFEC CCM or ACM (Fixed in IP-ACM)
B=VersaFEC ULL
Example: RFT=1 (selects Viterbi only)
Rx Demod RMD= 1 byte, value Command or Query (Query only in IP-ACM). RMD= RMD? RMD=x
Type of 0 to 5 Rx Demodulation in the form x, where: RMD?
0=BPSK RMD* (see Description of
1=QPSK RMD# Arguments)
2=OQPSK
3=8-PSK (FAST option)
4=16-QAM (Turbo or Viterbi + RS only)(FAST option)
5=8-QAM (TPC/LDPC only) (Needs Codec + FAST option)
6=Reserved
7=Reserved
8=Reserved
Depending on FEC type, not all of these selections will be valid.
All other codes are invalid.
Example: RMD=2 (selects OQPSK)
D20
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Rx FEC Code RCR= 1 byte, value Command or Query (Query only in IP-ACM). RCR= RCR? RCR=x
Rate of 0 to 7, A to Rx FEC Code Rate in the form x, where: RCR?
U 0=Rate 1/2 RCR* (see Description of
1=Rate 3/4 RCR# Arguments)
2=Rate 7/8
3=Rate 2/3 (8-PSK TCM or LDPC only)
4=Rate 1/1 (Uncoded or No FEC)
5=Rate 21/44 (Turbo Only)
6=Rate 5/16 (Turbo Only)
7=Rate 0.95 (Turbo Only) (aka 17/18)
8=Reserved
9=Reserved
A=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 0 BPSK 0.488
B=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 1 QPSK 0.533
C=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 2 QPSK 0.631
D=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 3 QPSK 0.706
E=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 4 QPSK 0.803
F=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 5 8-QAM 0.642
G=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 6 8-QAM 0.711
H=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 7 8-QAM 0.780
I=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 8 16-QAM 0.731
J=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 9 16-QAM 0.780
K=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 10 16-QAM 0.829
L=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 11 16-QAM 0.853
M=Reserved
N=Reserved
O=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 14 8-QAM 0.576
P=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 15 16-QAM 0.644
Q=Reserved
R=VersaFEC CCM ULL ModCod 17 BPSK 0.493
S=VersaFEC CCM ULL ModCod 18 QPSK 0.493
T=VersaFEC CCM ULL ModCod 19 QPSK 0.654
U=VersaFEC CCM ULL ModCod 20 QPSK 0.734
Depending on FEC type, not all of these selections will be valid.
Example: RCR=1 (selects Rate 3/4)
D21
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Rx Data Rate RDR= 9 bytes Command or Query (Query only in IP-ACM). RDR= RDR? RDR=xxxxx.xxx
Rx Data Rate, in kbps, between 18 kbps to 25 Mbps. RDR?
Resolution=1 bps RDR* (see Description of
Example: RDR=02047.999. RDR# Arguments)
Additional auxiliary G.703 sub-rates are available, selected using:
00512.AUX
01024.AUX
02048.AUX
If set for QDI (Quad D&I), RDR is query only.
The connectors used for the Aux rates are IDI/DDO.
These Aux rates are not available with D&I or IDR.
Rx Symbol RSR= 9 bytes, Query only (Command or Query in IP-ACM). RSR= RSR? RSR=ddddd.ddd
Rate numeric Allows remote access to the Rx Symbol Rate in the form ddddd.ddd RSR? (see Description of
Note: Symbol Rate ranges in IP-ACM = 37 ksym/sec to 4100 ksym/sec RSR* Arguments)
RSR#
Rx RFQ= 9 bytes Command or Query. RFQ= RFQ? RFQ=xxxx.xxxx
Frequency Frequency ranges: RFQ? (see Description of
50 MHz to 180 MHz, and RFQ* Arguments)
950 MHz to 1950 MHz (L-Band FAST option) RFQ#
Exception 950 MHz to 2150 MHz (Top card hardware Revision 2) Exception
600 Emulation: Resolution=100Hz. 600 Emulation:
8 bytes Note: The CDM-625 supports 70,140 MHz bands and L-Band. RFQ=xxx.xxxx
Example: RFQ=0950.9872
Rx Sub-Mux RMX= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. RMX? RMX? RMX=x
on/off Rx Sub-Mux in the form x, where: RMX=
0=Off RMX* (see Description of
1=On RMX# Arguments)
Rx Sub-Mux RMR= 2 bytes, Command or Query. RMR? RMR? RMR=xx
Ratio numeric Rx Sub-Mux Ratio (IP/Synchronous Interface) in the form xx, where: RMR=
00=1/9 08=2/5 16=5/4 24=7/2 RMR* (see Description of
01=1/8 09=3/7 17=4/3 25=4/1 RMR# Arguments)
02=1/7 10=1/2 18=3/2 26=5/1
03=1/6 11=3/5 19=5/3 27=6/1
04=1/5 12=2/3 20=2/1 28=7/1
05=1/4 13=3/4 21=7/3 29=8/1
06=2/7 14=4/5 22=5/2 30=9/1
07=1/3 15=1/1 23=3/1 31=1/59 32=1/39 33=1/19
Example: RMR=01 (Selects ratio 1/8)
D22
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Rx Data RDI= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. RDI= RDI? RDI=x
Invert Exception Invert Receive Data in the form x, where: RDI?
600/L 0=Normal RDI* Exception (see Description of
Emulation: 1=Inverted RDI# 600/L Emulation: Arguments)
IRD= Example: RDI=1 (selects Inverted RX Data) IRD?
Rx Reed- RRS= 1 byte, value Command or Query. RRS= RRS? RRS=x
Solomon of 0 thru 3 Rx RS decoding in the form x, where: RRS?
Decoding 0=Normal (based on the Open Network framing selected) RRS* (see Description of
1=IESS-310 mode, valid with QDI, unframed, IBS, D&I, IDR. RRS# Arguments)
2=EF Data legacy standard (225,205) unframed, QDI only
3=IBS (126,112) unframed only
Note: Available in all framing modes, except EDMAC.
(This is a dont care if no R-S is selected in FEC type)
Example: RRS=0 (selects Normal)
Rx Spectrum RSI= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. RSI= RSI? RSI=x
Invert Rx Spectrum Invert in the form x, where: RSI?
0=Normal RSI* (see Description of
1=Rx Spectrum Invert RSI# Arguments)
Example: RSI=0 (selects Normal)
Rx RDS= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. RDS= RDS? RDS=x
Descrambler Rx Descrambler state in the form x, where: RDS?
0=Off RDS* (see Description of
1=Normal RDS# Arguments)
2=IESS-315
Example: RDS=1 (Scrambler On)
Rx Demod RSW= 3 bytes Command or Query. RSW= RSW? RSW=xxx
Acquisition Rx acquisition sweep range of demodulator, in kHz. Available range depends on the symbol rate: RSW?
Sweep Width 18ksps to 64ksps: 1 to the symbol rate (ksps)/2 RSW* (see Description of
Exception 64ksps to 389ksps: 1 to 32 kHz RSW# Arguments)
600L 389ksps to 2000ksps: 1 to 10% of sym rate
Emulation: >2000ksps: 1 to 200 kHz
2 bytes
Example: RSW=009 (selects 9 kHz)
D23
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Rx Clock RCK= 1 byte, value Command or Query. RCK= RCK? RCK=x
Source of 0 thru 3 Rx Clock Source in the form x, where: RCK?
0=Rx Satellite RCK* (see Description of
1=Tx-Terrestrial RCK# Arguments)
2=Internal(SCT)
3=INSERT (command valid only when Rx framing is Insert or D&I++ and interface is G.703 or set for
D&I loop)
Example: RCK=1 (selects Tx-Terrestrial)
Rx Clock RCI= 1 byte, value 0 Command or Query. RCI= RCI? RCI=x
Invert or 1 Invert Receive Clock, in the form x, where: RCI?
0=Normal RCI* (see Description of
1=Inverted RCI# Arguments)
Eb/No Alarm EBA= 4 bytes Command or Query. EBA= EBA? EBA=xx.x
Point Eb/No alarm point in dB, with a range between 0.1 and 16 dB, in the form xx.x, where: EBA?
Resolution=0.1 dB EBA* (see Description of
Example: EBA=12.3 EBA# Arguments)
Rx Buffer RBS= 5 bytes Command or Query. RBS= RBS? RBS=xxxxx
Size Rx Buffer Size, 16 to 32768 bytes, in 2-byte steps, unless other limitations apply. RBS?
(See Sect. 5.3.1.5.2) RBS* (see Description of
Example: RBS=08192 (selects 8192 bytes) RBS# Arguments)
Rx Audio RVL= 4 bytes Command or Query. (Audio/IDR parameters) RVL= RVL? RVL=aabb
Volume Rx Audio Volume control, in the form aabb, where: RVL?
Control aa=Rx 1 volume control in dB, valid values are -6, -4, -2, +0, +2, +4, +6, +8; RVL* (see Description of
bb=Rx 2 volume control in dB, valid values are -6, -4, -2, +0, +2, +4, +6, +8. RVL# Arguments)
Example: RVL= -2+4 (sets Rx 1 to -2 dB and Rx 2 to +4 dB)
Receive RTE= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. (INSERT mode parameter) RTE= RTE? RTE=x
Terrestrial Receive Terrestrial Alarm Enable conditions in the form x, where: RTE?
Alarm Enable 0=Disables the alarm RTE* (see Description of
1=Enables the alarm. RTE# Arguments)
Example: RTE=0 (disables the alarm).
Insert Type ITY= 1 byte, value Command or Query. (INSERT/D&I++/QDI parameter) ITY= ITY? ITY=x
of 0 thru 3 Insert Type, in the form x where: ITY?
0=T1D4 ITY* (see Description of
1=T1ESF ITY# Arguments)
2=E1CCS
3=E1CAS
D24
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Rx Ternary RTC= 1 byte, value Command or Query. (G.703 parameter) RTC= RTC? RTC=x
Code of 0 thru 3 Rx Ternary Code in the form x, where: RTC?
0=AMI RTC* (see Description of
1=B8ZS RTC# Arguments)
2=B6ZS
3=HDB3
Example: RTC=1 (selects B8ZS)
Receive RBA= 4 bytes, each Command or Query. (IDR parameter) RBA= RBA? RBA=xxxx
Backward a value of 0 or Enable Receive backward alarm enable in the form xxxx, where: RBA?
Alarms 1 0=Disable RBA* (see Description of
Enable 1=External trigger Enable RBA# Arguments)
Example: RBA=0101
Receive ESC RET= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. (IDR parameter) RET= RET? RET=x
Type Sets or queries IDR ESC Type in the form x, where: RET?
0=64k data channel RET* (see Description of
1=2 Audio channels RET# Arguments)
Insert ITS= 3 bytes Command or Query. (D&I/D&I++ only) ITS= ITS? ITS=yyyyyyyyyyyyy
Timeslot (Note different format between command and query.) ITS? yyyyyyyyyyy
Insert Timeslot in the form xxy, where: ITS* indicating all 24 Insert
xx = Channel 01 through 24 ITS# timeslots values
y = timeslot: 0-9, A=10, B=11, C=12, D=13,V=31 associated with the 24
Rx Satellite channels.
ReCenter RCB= None Command only. RCB= N/A N/A
Buffer Forces the software to recenter the receive Plesiochronous/Doppler buffer. RCB?
Note: This command takes no arguments. RCB*
Example: RCB= RCB#
RX LO RLO= 6 bytes Command or Query. RLO= RLO? RLO=xxxxxs
Frequency LNB Rx LO frequency information in the form xxxxxs, where: RLO?
xxxxx is the LO frequency: 03000 through 65000 MHz, or 00000=Off RLO* (see Description of
s is the sign for the MIX (Note: negative mix induces a spectral inversion) RLO# Arguments)
Note: For additional information refer to Chapter 5 for LO, MIX, and Spectrum Settings.
Terminal Frequency = RX LO modem RFQ (see below)
Rx Terminal N/A 10 bytes Query only. N/A RTF? RTF=xxxxx.xxxx
Frequency Rx Terminal Frequency, which is the frequency (MHz) being received from the satellite.
Note: For additional information refer to Chapter 5 for LO, MIX, and Spectrum Settings. (see Description of
Resolution=100 Hz Arguments)
Returns 00000.0000 if LNB LO is zero
Example: RTF=11650.2249 (MHz)
D25
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Receive REE= 1 byte Command or Query. REE= REE? REE=x
Equalizer Rx Equalizer in the form x, where: REE?
Enable 0=disabled REE* (see Description of
1=enabled REE# Arguments)
The default is 0.
Rx Info Rate N/A 9 bytes, Query only. RIR? RIR? RIR=ddddd.ddd
numeric Allows remote access to the Aggregate Rx Information rate in the form ddddd.ddd RIR=
RIR* (see Description of
RIR# Arguments)
Rx Sub-Mux N/A 9 bytes, Query only. RMI? RMI? RMI=ddddd.ddd
IP Info Rate numeric Allows remote access to the IP portion of the Rx Information rate in the form ddddd.ddd RMI=
RMI* (see Description of
RMI# Arguments)
D26
D27
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
RTC Time TIM= 6 bytes Command or Query. TIM= TIM? TIM=hhmmss
A time in the form hhmmss, indicating the time from midnight, where: TIM? (see Description of
hh = hours (00 to 23) TIM* Arguments)
mm = minutes (00 to 59) TIM#
ss = seconds (00 to 59)
Example: TIM=231259 (23 hours:12 minutes:59 seconds)
EDMAC EFM= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. EFM= EFM? EFM=x
Framing EDMAC mode in the form x, where: EFM? (see Description of
Mode 0=EDMAC OFF (Idle Mode) EFM* Arguments)
1=EDMAC ON (Master Mode) EFM#
2=EDMAC ON (Slave Mode, Query Only)
Example: EFM=1 (EDMAC Enabled as Master)
EDMAC ESA= 4 bytes Command or Query. ESA= ESA? ESA=xxxx
Slave EDMAC Slave Address Range - sets the range of addresses of distant-end units (modems or transceivers) ESA? (see Description of
Address that this unit, as the Master, will forward messages for. Only values which are integer multiples of ten are ESA* Arguments)
Range permitted. (0010, 0020, 0030, 0040 etc.) ESA#
Example: ESA=0090
This command is only valid for an EDMAC master. When used as a Query, it may be sent to an EDMAC
slave, which will respond with the appropriate address.
One Time OTO= 1 byte, value Command or Query. OTO= OTO? OTO=x
EDMAC Slave of 0 or 1 One Time Overwrite to EDMAC Slave modem in the form x, where: OTO?
Overwrite 0=Off OTO* (see Description of
1=On OTO# Arguments)
Examples:
OTO=1 causes EDMAC Slave modem to be able to accept ONE remote control command locally after
OTO=1 command.
OTO=0 turns off One Time Overwrite, only EDMAC command from EDMAC Master modem will be
accepted by Slave modem.
Engineering ESC= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. (IBS and ESC++ feature) ESC= ESC? ESC=x
Service ESC in the form x, where: ESC? (see Description of
Channel 0 = Disable the high-rate ESC ESC* Arguments)
1 = Enable the high-rate ESC ESC#
IBS ESC may only be enabled when:
1. Both Tx and Rx framing modes are set to IBS.
2. Data rate is not 1544 kbps (as spare overhead bits are not available in this mode).
3. IBS high-rate ESC FAST option is enabled.
D28
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
ESC SCP= 3 bytes, Command or Query. (IBS and ESC++ feature) SCP= SCP? SCP=xyz
Parameters numeric Allows control of the ESC baud rate and character format in the form xyz, where: SCP? (see Description of
x is the index for baud rate: SCP* Arguments)
0=1200 baud SCP#
1=2400 baud
2=4800 baud
3=9600 baud
4=19200 baud
5=38400 baud
6=14400 baud
7=28800 baud
y is the character format (data bits, parity, stop bits):
0=8N1 char format
1=7E2 char format
2=7O2 char format
z is the interface type:
0=RS-232
Exception 1=RS-485 Exception
600/L The baud rate may be l imited by the data rate. The ESC baud rate breakpoints (determined by data rate) 600/L Emulation:
Emulation: are shown in Chapter 5 and Chapter 12. A response of SCP* will indicate if the data rate will not allow a SCP=xy
SCP=xy selected baud rate to operate.
External EFR= 1 byte, value of Command or Query. EFR= EFR? EFR=x
Frequency 0 thru 6 External Frequency Reference in the form x, where: EFR? (see Description of
Reference 0=Internal 10MHz (default) EFR* Arguments)
1=External 1 MHz EFR#
2=External 2 MHz Exception
3=External 5 MHz 600L Emulation:
4=External 10 MHz MRC=
Exception 5=spare MRC? Exception Exception
600L Emulation: 6=Internal 10MHz plus output. MRC* 600L Emulation: 600L Emulation:
MRC= This means that the Reference is available on the Ext Ref rear connector (small rear-panel LED MRC# MRC=? MRC=x
indicates when ON)
Adjustment ADJ= 4 bytes, Command or Query. ADJ= ADJ? ADJ=sddd
for Internal numeric Provides fine adjustment of the Internal 10MHz Reference on the High-Stability Frequency Reference ADJ? (see Description of
10MHz High- module in the form sddd, where: ADJ* Arguments)
stability s= sign (+ or ) ADJ#
Reference ddd= value, 0-999.
Warm-up WRM= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. (Hi-Stab Ref parameter) WRM= WRM? WRM=x
Delay Hi-stab Ref warm-up delay parameter in the form x, where: WRM? (see Description of
0= Delay off (instant on) WRM* Arguments)
1= Warm-up Delay on WRM#
D29
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Countdown of CTD= 3 bytes, Command or Query. (Hi-Stab Ref parameter) CTD= CTD? CTD=xxx
Warm-up numeric Hi-stab Ref countdown parameter in the form xxx, where: CTD? (see Description of
Delay xxx = countdown of the number of seconds remaining of the Warm-up time. CTD* Arguments)
remaining As a command, the only permitted format is CTD=000, which abandons the delay. CTD#
Unit Test TST= 1 byte, value of Command or Query. TST= TST? TST=x
Mode 0 thru 6 Unit Test Mode, where: TST? (see Description of
0=Normal Mode (no test) TST* Arguments)
1=Tx CW TST#
2=Tx Alternating 1,0 Pattern
3=IF Loopback
4=RF Loopback
5=Digital Loopback
6=I/O Loopback
Example: TST=3 (IF Loopback)
Unit Alarm MSK= 13 bytes Command or Query. MSK= MSK? MSK=abcdefghjklxx
Mask Alarm mask conditions in form abcdefghjklxx, where: MSK? (see Description of
a=Tx AIS MSK* Arguments)
b=Rx AIS MSK#
c=bufferslip Alarm
d=spare
e=Rx AGC Alarm
f=Eb/No Alarm
g=BUC Alarm
h=LNB Alarm
j=G.703 Loss of Signal alarm
k=Reference alarm
l=Tx Clock Alarm
xx (spare)
Exception Value of each mask:
600L 0 = unmasked
Emulation: 1 = masked
6 bytes Example: MSK=0101100000000
Attach ABA= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. ABA= ABA? ABA=x
summary BUC 0= Tx FLT status unaffected by BUC fault ABA? (see Description of
fault to Tx FLT 1= Attach a summary BUC fault to Tx FLT status ABA* Arguments)
status ABA#
Attach ALA= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. ALA= ALA? ALA=x
summary LNB 0= Rx FLT status unaffected by LNB fault ALA? (see Description of
fault to Rx FLT 1= Attach a summary LNB fault to Rx FLT status ALA* Arguments)
status ALA#
D30
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Number of N/A 3 bytes Query only. N/A NUE? NUE=xxx
Unread Unit returns the Number of stored Events, which remain Unread, (over remote control) in the form xxx (0-255). (see Description of
stored Events Example: NUE=126 Arguments)
Retrieve next N/A 80 bytes Query only. N/A RNE? RNE=[CR]ABCddm
5 unread Unit returns the oldest 5 Stored Events which have not yet been read over the remote control in the reply myyhhmmss[CR]A
Stored format BCddmmyyhhmms
Events [CR]sub-body[CR]sub-body[CR]sub-body[CR]sub-body[CR]sub-body, where: s[CR]ABCddmmyyh
sub-body=ABCddmmyyhhmmss, where: hmmss[CR]ABCdd
A is the fault/clear indicator: mmyyhhmmss[CR]
F=Fault ABCddmmyyhhmm
C=Clear ss
I=Info
B is the fault type where: (see Description of
1=Unit Arguments)
2=Rx Traffic
3=Tx Traffic
4=Info (Power on/off, or log cleared)
5=Open Network
6=BUC
7=LNB
C is Fault Code number, as in FLT? or Info Code, which may be:
0=Power Off
1=Power On
2=Log Cleared
3=Global Config Change
4=Redundancy Config Change
5=Fractional CnC License is expiring.
6=Time Limited CnC License is expiring.
7=Fractional CnC is in use.
ddmmyy = date stamp.
hhmmss = time stamp.
If there are less than 5 events to be retrieved, the remaining positions are padded with zeros. If there are no
new events, the response is RNE*.
Clear All CAE= None Command only. CAE= N/A N/A
Stored Forces the software to clear the software events log. CAE?
Events Note: This command takes no arguments CAE*
Example: CAE= CAE#
D31
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Initialize IEP= None Command only. IEP= N/A N/A
Stored Resets internal pointer to allow RNE? queries to start at the beginning of the stored events log. IEP#
Events
Pointer
Statistics SSI= 1 byte, Command or Query. SSI= SSI? SSI=x
Sample numerical Used to set the sample interval for the Statistics Logging Function in the form x, where: SSI? (see Description of
Interval x= 0 to 9 in 10 minute steps. SSI* Arguments)
Note: Setting this parameter to 0 disables the statistics logging function. SSI#
Example: SSI=3 means 30 minutes
Number of N/A 3 bytes Query only. N/A NUS? NUS=xxx
Unread Unit returns the number of stored Statistics, which remain Unread (over remote control) in the form xxx, (see Description of
stored where: Arguments)
Statistics x = 0-255
Example: NUS=187
Retrieve next N/A 135 bytes Query only. N/A RNS? RNS=[CR]AA.ABB.
5 unread Unit returns the oldest 5 Stored Statistics, which have not yet been read over the remote control in the reply BC.CD.Dddmmyyhh
Stored format [CR]sub-body[CR]sub-body[CR]sub-body[CR]sub-body[CR]sub-body, where sub-body= mmss[CR]AA.ABB.
Statistics AA.ABB.BC.CD.Dddmmyyhhmmss: BC.CD.Dddmmyyhh
AA.A=Minimum Eb/No during sample period. mmss[CR]AA.ABB.
BB.B=Average Eb/No during sample period. BC.CD.Dddmmyyhh
C.C=Max. Tx Power Level Increase during sample period. mmss[CR]AA.ABB.
D.D=Average Tx Power Level Increase during sample period. BC.CD.Dddmmyyhh
ddmmyy = date stamp. mmss[CR]AA.ABB.
hhmmss = time stamp. BC.CD.Dddmmyyhh
If there are no new events, the unit replies with RNS*. If there are less than 5 statistics to be retrieved, the mmss
remaining positions are padded with zeros. (see Description of
Arguments)
D32
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Retrieve N/A 180 bytes Query only. N/A RNN? RNN=[CR]AA.ABB.
next 5 Unit returns the oldest 5 Stored Statistics (including newly added Minimum and Average Receive Signal level), BC.CD.DEE.E,FF.F
unread New which have not yet been read over the remote control in the reply form [CR]sub-body[CR]sub-body[CR] ddmmyyhhmmss[C
Stored sub-body[CR]sub-body[CR]sub-body, where sub-body = AA.ABB.BC.CD.DEE.E,FF.Fddmmyyhhmmss: R]AA.ABB.BC.CD.D
Statistics AA.A=Minimum Eb/No during sample period. EE.E,FF.Fddmmyyh
BB.B=Average Eb/No during sample period. hmmss[CR]AA.ABB.
C.C=Max. Tx Power Level Increase during sample period. BC.CD.DEE.E,FF.F
D.D=Average Tx Power Level Increase during sample period. ddmmyyhhmmss[C
EE.E=Negative value of Minimum Receive Signal Level in dB during sample period. R]AA.ABB.BC.CD.D
FF.F=Negative value of Average Receive Signal Level in dB during sample period. EE.E,FF.Fddmmyyh
ddmmyy = date stamp. hmmss[CR]AA.ABB.
hhmmss = time stamp. BC.CD.DEE.E,FF.F
If there are no new events, the unit replies with RNN*. If there are less than 5 statistics to be retrieved, the ddmmyyhhmmss
remaining positions are padded with zeros. (see Description of
Note: RNN includes all information provided in RNS, plus Rx Signal level. Do not mix use of RNS and Arguments)
RNN.
Clear All CAS= None Command only. CAS= N/A N/A
Stored Forces the software to clear the software statistics log. CAS?
Statistics Example: CAS= CAS*
Note: This command takes no arguments. CAS#
Initialize ISP= None Command only. ISP= N/A N/A
Statistics Resets internal pointer to allow RNS? queries to start at the beginning of the statistics log. ISP#
Pointer
Force 1:1 FSW= None Command only. FSW= N/A N/A
Switch Forces unit to toggle Unit Fail relay to fail state for approx 500ms. If unit is part of a 1:1 pair and is currently FSW*
the Online unit, this will force a switchover, so unit will then be in Standby mode. The command is always
executed by the unit, regardless of whether it is standalone, in a 1:1 pair, or part of a 1:N system.
Note: This command takes no arguments.
Outdoor Unit ODU= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. ODU= ODU? ODU=x
Comms Enables or disables communications, via the FSK link, with a Comtech EF Data transceiver (ODU) in the ODU? (see Description of
enable form x, where: ODU* Arguments)
0=Disabled ODU#
1=Enabled
Example: ODU=0 (selects Disabled)
D33
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
1:N (One For OFN= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. OFN= OFN? OFN=x
N) control Enables or disables the 1:N control. This affects a control line on the 25-pin rear panel connector. This must OFN? (see Description of
be enabled when the modem is attached to a CRS-300 1:N Controller or a CRS-500 1:N Switch in the form OFN* Arguments)
x, where: OFN#
0=Disabled
1=Enabled
Example: OFN=0 (selects Disabled)
IP Address IPA= 18 bytes Command or Query. IPA= IPA? IPA=
numerical Used to set the IP Address and network prefix for the 10/100 Base T Ethernet management port, in the form IPA? aaa.bbb.ccc.ddd.yy
aaa.bbb.ccc.ddd.yy, where permitted ranges are: IPA* (see Description of
aaa = 0-223 IPA# Arguments)
bbb = 0-255
ccc = 0-255
ddd = 001-255
yy=08-30
Example: IPA=010.006.030.001.24
IP Gateway IPG= 15 bytes Command or Query. IPG= IPG? IPG=
numerical Used to set the IP Gateway Address for the Ethernet management port, in the form aaa.bbb.ccc.ddd, where IPG? aaa.bbb.ccc.ddd
permitted ranges are: IPG* (see Description of
aaa = 0-223 IPG# Arguments)
bbb = 0-255
ccc = 0-255
ddd = 001-255
Example: IPG=010.006.030.001
Traffic IP IPT= 18 bytes Command or Query. IPT= IPT? IPT=
Address numerical In a 1:1 system, each modem has its own unique IP address that would be used by an external M&C IPT? aaa.bbb.ccc.ddd.yy
application to address each modem. The IP traffic uses a different address, and whichever modem is IPT* (see Description of
online, uses this address for the IP traffic in the form aaa.bbb.ccc.ddd.yy where permitted ranges are: IPT# Arguments)
aaa = 0-223
bbb = 0-255
ccc = 0-255
ddd = 001-255.
yy is the Subnet Mask Length (range: 08 to 30)
Example: IPT=010.006.030.002.24
MAC Address N/A 12 bytes, Query only. N/A MAC? MAC=aabbccddeeff
alpha- Used to query the unique MAC Address for the modem. (see Description of
numerical Example: MAC=0006B00001C2 Arguments)
D34
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Request to RTS= 1 byte, value of Command or Query. RTS= RTS? RTS=x
Send 0, 1, 2 Defines how RTS/CTS will operate at the main data interface in the form x, where: RTS? (see Description of
0=RTS/CTS Loop, No Action. RTS and CTS are looped, so that CTS echoes the state of RTS, but RTS RTS* Arguments)
does not control the ON/OFF state of carrier. RTS#
1=Loop, RTS Controls TX O/P. RTS and CTS are looped, so that CTS echoes the state of RTS and
RTS controls the ON/OFF state of carrier (in order words, the modem will not bring up its TX carrier
until RTS is asserted.
2=Ignore RTS, Assert CTS.
Example: RTS=0 (RTS/CTS Loop, No Action)
HSSI HHC= 1 byte, value of Command or Query. (HSSI parameter) HHC= HHC? HHC=x
Handshake 0,1 Defines TA/CA control of the HSSI interface in the form x, where: HHC? (see Description of
Control 0 = TA to CA loop (default) HHC* Arguments)
1 = RR control CA, TA control Tx output. HHC#
Example: HHC=0 (TA to CA loop)
POCO PCO= 1 byte, value of Command or Query. PCO= PCO? PCO=x
feature 0,1 Use with caution. PCO? (see Description of
(Power-On If enabled, when a modem is power cycled, it will power up with the Tx carrier setting OFF. PCO* Arguments)
Carrier-Off) 0=POCO disabled (normal operation) PCO#
1=POCO enabled care!
Example: PCO=0 (disabled normal operation)
DoubleTalk CNM= 1 byte, value of Command or Query. CNM= CNM? CNM=x
Carrier-in- 0 to 9 CnC enable in the form x, where: CNM? (see Description of
Carrier (CnC) 0=Off CNM* Arguments)
Mode 1=On (normal) CNM#
2=APC, C-Band, Side A
3=APC, X-Band, Side A
4=APC, Ku-Band, Side A
5=APC, Ka-Band, Side A
6=APC, C-Band, Side B
7=APC, X-Band, Side B
8=APC, Ku-Band, Side B
9=APC, Ka-Band, Side B
Notes:
1. CnC may be enabled only if:
The optional plug-in hardware CnC card has been installed AND a CnC FAST option is unlocked.
The range of permitted data rates is controlled by a FAST feature code. (Read EID to decode the
installed options for the modem)
2. If CnC-APC is active (APS=22), key transmission/reception (Modulation, FEC type, Code Rate,
Framing, Data Rate, Interface) cannot be modified until CnC-APC is suspended. (Use APC
command to suspend or activate.)
D35
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
DoubleTalk CPM= 1 byte, value of Command or Query. (CnC parameter) CPM= CPM? CPM=x
Carrier-in- 0 to 3 CnC PMSI (Pre-Mapped-Symbol Interface) mode in the form x, where: CPM? (see Description of
Carrier (CnC) 0=Idle CPM* Arguments)
PMSI Mode 1=Redundancy (1:1 or 1:N) CPM#
2=Talk
3=Listen
CnC CCF= 3 bytes Command or Query. (CnC parameter) CCF= CCF? CCF=xxx
Frequency The maximum value that may be entered, in the form xxx, as the CnC Sweep frequency range depends on CCF? (see Description of
Range/offset the Rx symbol rate as follows: CCF* Arguments)
18ksps to 64ksps: 1 to the symbol rate (ksps)/2 CCF#
64ksps to 389ksps: 1 to 32 kHz
389ksps to 2000ksps: 1 to 10% of sym rate
>2000ksps: 1 to 200 kHz
Example: CCF=030
CnC CSD= 6 bytes Command or Query. (CnC parameter) CSD= CSD? CSD=xxxyyy
Min/Max CnC min/max delay value in milliseconds, in the form xxxyyy, where: CSD? (see Description of
Search Delay xxx=minimum delay CSD* Arguments)
yyy=maximum delay CSD#
Maximum allowable value is 330ms
Example: CSD=010325
G.703 Clock CEX= 2 bytes Command or Query. (FAST option) CEX= CEX? CEX=ab
Extension G.703 Clock Extension in the form ab, where: CEX? (see Description of
a = G.703 Clock Extension Mode CEX* Arguments)
0 = None CEX#
1 = TxLock
2 = RxEnable
b = G.703 Clock Extension Interface
0 = T1
1 = E1Bal
2 = E1Unbal
Example: CEX=12 (Sets Tx Lock to E1 Unbalanced)
Notes:
1. Not all CEX modes are valid all the time.
2. For argument a:
If Data Interface (ITF) is G.703, only 0=None is allowed.
If Tx clock (TCK) is not Internal, 1=TxLock is not allowed.
D36
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Tx BERT BTX= 1 byte, value of Command or Query. BTX= BTX? BTX=x
State 0 or 1 Tx BERT State in the form x, where: BTX? (see Description of
0 = Off BTX# Arguments)
1 = On
Example: BTX=1 (Tx BERT On)
Rx BERT BRX= 1 byte, value of Command or Query. BRX= BRX? BRX=x
State 0 or 1 Rx BERT State in the form x, where: BRX? (see Description of
0 = Off BRX# Arguments)
1 = On
Example: BRX=1 (Rx BERT On)
Tx BERT TBP= 1 byte Command or Query. TBP= TBP? TBP=x
Pattern Tx BERT Pattern, in the form x, where: TBP? (see Description of
0=space TBP# Arguments)
1=mark
2=1:1
3=1:2
4=63
5=511
6=2047 (default)
7=2047R (or 2047 Alternate)
8=Mil-188
9=2^15-1
A=2^20-1
B=2^23-1
Example: TBP=6 (Tx BERT Pattern is 2047)
Rx BERT RBP= 1 byte Command or Query. RBP= RBP? RBP=x
Pattern Rx BERT Pattern, in the form x, where: RBP? (see Description of
0=space RBP# Arguments)
1=mark
2=1:1
3=1:2
4=63
5=511
6=2047 (default)
7=2047R (or 2047 Alternate)
8=Mil-188
9=2^15-1
A=2^20-1
B=2^23-1
Example: RBP=6 (Rx BERT Pattern is 2047)
D37
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
BERT 10E-3 BKE= 1 byte, value of Command or Query. BKE= BKE? BKE=x
Error Insert 0 or 1 Inserts 10E-3 BER in the form x, where: BKE? (see Description of
x = 0 (Off) or 1 (On) BKE# Arguments)
Example: BKE=1
BERT Restart BRM= None Command only. BRM= N/A N/A
Monitor Example: BRM=
Note: This command takes no arguments.
BERT Result N/A 7 bytes, Query only. N/A BRE? BRE=xxxxxxx
in bit errors numeric BERT monitor results in bit errors. If bit errors exceed 9999999, then BRE=9999999.
BERT Result N/A 6 bytes Query only N/A BRR? BRR=a.bEcx
in average Returns the value of the average BER in the form a.b x 10-c. First 3 bytes are the value. Byte 5 is the
BER exponent. Last byte is the indicator of Sync Loss. A * in last byte means there was a loss of pattern
synchronization since last restart, but now is synchronized. A _ (space) in last byte means pattern
synchronization is achieved.
Returns 999999 if theres no sync in BERT monitor.
Example 1: BRR=2.8E7 (BER is 2.8 x 10-7, and in sync)
Example 2: BRR=3.4E5* (BER is 3.4 x 10-5, and there was a Sync Loss)
ACM ACM= 4 bytes Command or Query. ACM= ACM? ACM=mMAT
parameters Defines ACM operating parameters in the form mMAT, where: ACM? (see Description of
m=Minimum ModCod, range is 0 to 9, and A (for ModCod=10) or B (for ModeCod=11) ACM# Arguments)
M=Maximum ModCod, range is 0 to 9, and A (for ModCod=10) or B (for ModeCod=11)
A= Defines action on remote demod unlock (0=go to minimum Tx ModCod, 1=maintain Tx ModCod)
T=Target Eb/No Margin, from 0 to 9 that is two times of the Eb/No in dB (from 0.0dB to 4.5dB).
Example: ACM=0B12
(Sets min ModCod=0, max ModCod=11, maintain Tx ModCod when remote demod unlocks,
sets Target Eb/No at 1.0dB.)
Forced FRB= None Command only. FRB= N/A N/A
Reboot Force a hard reset of the unit in 5 seconds. FRB?
FRB*
FRB#
Carrier ID CAI= 1 byte, value Command or Query. CAI= CAI? CAI =x
of 0 thru 1 Carrier ID Enable/Disable in the form x, where: CAI? (see Description of
0 = Disabled CAI * Arguments)
1 = Enabled CAI #
D38
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Demo Time N/A 6 bytes Query only. N/A DMT? DMT=ddhhmm
Remaining Demo time remaining in the form ddhhmm, (see Description of
dd = days (00 to 30) Arguments)
hh = hours (00 to 23)
mm = minutes (00 to 59)
Example: DMT=032312 (3 days 23 hours 12 minutes)
Demo Mode DMM= 1 byte, value Command or Query. DMM= DMM? DMM=x
of 0 thru 2 Demo Mode Enable/Disable in the form x, where: DMM? (see Description of
0 = Disabled DMM* Arguments)
1 = Enabled DMM#
2 = Expired
Medium- MEO= 1 byte Command or Query. MEO= MEO? MEO=x
Earth Orbit Medium Earth Orbit Enable/Disable in the form x, where: (see Description
0 = Disabled of Arguments)
1 = Enabled
Antenna AHO= 1 byte Command or Query. AHO= AHO? AHO=x
Handover Antenna Handover Enable/Disable in the form x, where: (see Description of
0 = Disabled Arguments)
1 = Enabled
Antenna AHM= 1 byte Command or Query. AHM= AHM? AHM=x
Handover Antenna Handover Mode in the form x, where: (see Description of
Mode 0 = Manual Arguments)
1 = Auto
Antenna AHD= 3 bytes Command or Query. AHD= AHD? AHD=xx
Handover Differential Path Delayin the form +xx (-13 to +13) (see Description of
Differential Arguments)
Path Delay Example: AHD=+12 (Lead 12)
AHD=-03 (Lag 3)
Time Protocol TPE= 1 byte Command or Query. TPE= TPE? TPE=x
Enable Used to disable or enable the Time Protocol, where: TPE? (see Description of
0 = Time Protocol disabled Arguments)
1 = Time Protocol enabled
D39
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Primary TPS= 15 bytes Command or Query. TPS= TPS? TPS=
Ethernet Used to set the Primary Ethernet Time Server IP address for the Unit. Tx Ethernet management port, in the TPS? xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx
Time Server format: (see Description of
xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx, where: Arguments)
xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx is the Time server IP address
D40
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Global MGC= 224 bytes, Command or Query. MGC= MGC? MGC=FFFF.FFFFD
Configuration numerical Global Configuration of CDM625, in the form shown in the Response to Query column (to right) where: MGC? MGC?n (where DDDD.DDDGYRMV
entries, fixed * FFFF.FFFF=Tx Frequency same as TFQ MGC* n = 0 to 9. SPP.PBaaa.aaCXIK
values and DDDDD.DDD=TX Data Rate same as TDR MGC# Returns the NZffff.ffffddddd.dddg
delimiters G=Tx FEC Type same as TFT MGC portion of yrmvswwwcll.lbbbbb
Y=Tx Reed-Solomon Type same as TRS 1 of 10 stored iknzOEEEETeeeee
R=Tx FEC Rate same as TCR configurations) eeeeeeeeWALQUH
M=Tx Modulation Type same as TMD HHHhhhhJJJJjjjjabc
V=Tx Spectrum Inversion same as TSI defxxxxxxxxxxrrrrr.rr
S=Tx Scrambler State same as TSC
PP.P Tx Power Level same as TPL
rsssss.ssshgkpmnn
B=AUPC Enable same as AUP nttuuu.uuu.uuu.uuu.
aaa.aa=AUPC Parameter Setup same as APP uuvvv.vvv.vvv.vvvx
C=Tx Clock Source same as TCK GHIJKwAAABBBC
X=Tx Carrier State same as TXO CCeexEFGGGH
I=Tx Interface Type same as TIT
K=Tx Ternary Code same as TTC
N=Tx Framing Mode same as TFM
* Z=Tx Clock Invert same as TCI
* ffff.ffff=Rx Frequency same as RFQ
ddddd.ddd=Rx Data Rate same as RDR
g=Rx FEC Type same as RFT
y=Rx Reed-Solomon Type same as RRS
r=Rx FEC Rate same as RCR
m=Rx Modulation Type same as RMD
v=Rx Spectrum Inversion same as RSI
s=Rx Scrambler State same as RDS
* www=Rx Sweep Width same as RSW
c=Rx Clock Source same as RCK
ll.l=Eb/No Alarm Point same as EBA
bbbbb=Rx Buffer Size same as RBS
i=Rx Interface Type same as RIT
k=Rx Ternary Code same as RTC
D41
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Global n=Rx Framing Mode same as RFM
Configuration * z=Rx Clock Invert same as RCI
(cont.) * O=EDMAC mode same as EFM
* EEEE=EDMAC Address same as ESA
T=Unit Test Mode same as TST
* eeeeeeeeeeeee=Unit Alarm Mask same as MSK
W=Hi-Stab Reference choice same as EFR
A=Statistics Sampling Interval same as SSI
L=Rx Terrestrial Alarm Enable same as RTE
Q=Tx Terrestrial Alarm Enable same as TTA
U=ODU Common Enable same as ODU
HHHH=Tx Backward Alarm same as TBA
hhhh=Rx Backward Alarm same as RBA
JJJJ=Tx Audio Volume same as TVL
jjjj= Rx Audio Volume same as RVL
a=Drop Type same as DTY
b=Insert Type same as ITY
c=Tx ESC Type same as TET
d=Rx ESC Type same as RET
e=Tx Data Invert same as TDI
f=Rx Data Invert same as RDI
* A=Tx Sub-Mux on/off same as TMX
* B=Rx Sub-Mux on/off same as RMX
* CC=Tx Sub-Mux Ratio same as TMR
* DD=RX Sub-Mux Ratio same as RMR
* mMAT same as ACM
* rrrrr.rrr=TX Symbol Rate same as TSR
* sssss.sss=RX Symbol Rate same as RSR
* h=HSSI handshake control same as HHC
* g=RTS/CTS setting same as RTS
k=Rx Equalizer Enable same as REE
p=Power-On/Carrier-Off Enable same as PCO
m=ESC enable same as ESC
nnn=ESC parameters same as SCP
tt=G.703 Clock Extension same as CEX
* uuu.uuu.uuu.uuu.uu=IP address same as IPA
* vvv.vvv.vvv.vvv=IP gateway address same as IPG
*w same as TXA
* G=Tx BERT State same as BTX
* H=Tx BERT Pattern same as TBP
* I=BERT 10E-3 Error Insert same as BKE
* J=Rx BERT State same as BRX
* K=Rx BERT Pattern same as RBP
* w=CnC mode same as CNM
* AAA=CnC frequency offset same as CCF
BBBCCC=CnC search delays same as CSD
D=CnC PMSI mode same as CPM
D42
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Global ee=Compressed Ethernet port speed see **
Configuration E=Attach summary BUC alarm to Tx same as ABA
(cont.) F=Attach summary LNB alarm to Rx same as ALA
GGG=WAN buffer length same as WBL
H=Dedicated Management Port same as DMP
Note: Much of the 625 MGC format has been kept similar to the 600/L MGC format.
* indicates differences.
** E thernet po rt s peed i s c ompressed f rom 4 by tes i n S EC c ommand t o 2 by tes i n MG C. F irst by te
represents speed settings for Port 1 and Port 2, second byte represents speed settings for Port 3 and Port
4. In each byte, character A through Y is used to represent 25 possible combinations of two port speed.
A=00, B=01, C=02, D=03, E=04, F=10, G=11, H=12, I=13, J=14, K=20, L=21, M= 22, N=23, O=24, P=30,
Q=31, R=32, S=33, T=34, U=40, V=41, W=42, X=43, Y=44.
Example: BN is converted to 0123, that means Port 1 is AutoNeg, Port 2 is 100Full, Port 3 is 100Half, Port
4 is 10Full.
OGC Outdoor OGC= 50 Bytes Command or Query. OGC= OGC? OGC=aabxdexxxxxg
Unit Global ODU Global Configuration of CDM-625, in the form shown in the Response to Query column (to the right), where: OGC? OGC?n (where n ggghhhhxxxxixklllnn
Copy aa=BUC Address same as BAD OGC* = 0 to 9. Returns nFFFFFSfffffsxxxxxx
b=BUC Tx Output Enable same as BOE OGC# the OGC portion
* x (spare) of 1 of 10 stored (Returns current
d=BUC Power Supply same as BPS configurations) OGC Configuration)
e=BUC 10MHz Reference State same as BFR
xxxxx (spares)
gggg=BUC Current - Low Limit same as BCL
hhhh=BUC Current - High Limit same as BCH
* xxxx (spares)
* i=LNB Power Supply same as LPS
* x (spare)
k=LNB 10MHz Reference same as LNR
lll=LNB Low Alarm Limit same as LNL
nnn=LNB High Alarm Limit same as LNH
FFFFFS=TX LO Frequency same as TLO
fffffs=RX LO Frequency same as RLO
xxxxxx (spares)
Notes:
1. Much of the 625 O GC f ormat has been k ept s imilar t o t he C DM-600L OGC f ormat ( * i ndicates t he
differences). In 600L Emulation Mode, OGC follows the CDM-600Ls OGC format.
2. Any unavailable parameters will be filled with xs.
D43
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Drop & Insert DNI= 51 bytes Command or Query. (D&I only) DNI= DNI? DNI=dddddddddddd
25 bytes of Drop information: DNI? DNI?n ddddddddddddtiiiiiiiiiii
d= 24 channels (bytes) defining Timeslot locations DNI* (where n = 0 to 9. iiiiiiiiiiiiiTL
t= Drop type: DNI# Returns the DNI (see Description of
0=T1-D4, 1=T1-ESF, 2=E1-CCS, 3=E1-CAS, as DTY portion of 1 of 10 Arguments)
25 bytes of Insert information: stored
i= 24 channels (bytes) defining Timeslot location configurations) (Returns current D&I
T= Insert type: Configuration)
0=T1-D4, 1=T1-ESF, 2=E1-CCS, 3=E1-CAS) as ITY
Each Timeslot definition:
0= Unused
1-9 for timeslots 19, A=10, B=11, C=12, D=13V=31.
z=timeslot zero
L= D&I Internal Loop
0 = OFF, 1 = ON
Example: DNI=123456789ABC0000000000003123456789ABC00000000000031
Drop channels 112 using timeslots 112, and unused channels 1324. Same for Insert. E1-CAS, D&I types,
Internal Loop ON.
If framing is D&I and data rate is 1920 kbps and DNI Type is E1-CCS or E1-CAS, then channels cannot be
programmed (i.e. FIXED CHANNEL MODE).The DNI? response will display all x in the time-slot positions.
Drop & Insert DIC= 67 bytes Command or Query. (D&I++ only) DIC= DIC? DIC=dddddddddddd
Configuration (Not available in 600/L Emulation mode) DIC? dddddddddddddddd
(31 channels) 31 channels of Drop Timeslot information: xx= spares DIC* dddxxsssssssssssss
31 channels of Insert Timeslot information: xx= spares DIC# ssssssssssssssssss
Each Timeslot definition: xxL
0= Unused (see Description of
1-9 for timeslots 19, Arguments)
A=10,
B=11, DIC?n Returns current DIC
C=12, Configuration,
D=13, etc ..V=31, where:
z=timeslot zero n = 0 to 9.
L= D&I Internal Loop Returns the DIC
0 = OFF, 1 = ON portion of 1 of 10
Example: stored
DIC=123456789ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVxx123456789ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVxx0 configurations
Drop channels 132 using timeslots 131 and timeslot zero. Same for Insert. E1-CCS, Internal Loop Off.
D44
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Quad Drop & QDI= 73 bytes Command or Query. QDI= QDI?p QDI=pccddddddddd
Insert Quad Drop & Insert Commands (E1 CCS Only) QDI? QDI?pn dddddddddddddddd
QDI=pccddddddddddddddddddddddddddddddddCCssssssssssssssssssssssssssssssssrrrr, where: QDI* (where n = 0 to 9 dddddddCCssssssss
p = Port number 1 thru 4 QDI# returns the QDI ssssssssssssssssss
cc = Number of Drop Channels, 0-32. portion of 1 of 10 ssssssrrrr
Used to decide Port ps TX Tributary Rate if Interface Type is Quad Drop & Insert (TFM=8). stored
d = 32 bytes defining Timeslot locations (or channels) configurations for (Returns current
CC = Number of Insert Channels, 0-32. a single port p) Quad D&I
Used to decide Port ps RX Tributary Rate if Interface Type is Quad Drop & Insert (RFM=8). configuration of a
s = 32 bytes defining Timeslot locations (or channels) single port p)
Timeslot definition:
0 = Unused
1-9 for timeslots 19,
A=10, B=11, C=12, D=13V=31
z=timeslot zero
r = reserved (set to value 0)
Example 1:
131123456789ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUV031123456789ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUV00000
Port 1s Drop channels 131 using timeslots 131. Same for Insert
Example 2:
30412340000000000000000000000000000204123400000000000000000000000000002000000
Port 3s Drop channels 14 using timeslots 14. Same for Insert.
Note: This command is a bit forgiving in the sense that the modem accepts the command even though the
interface type is other than Quad Drop & Insert. This is intentional for use with the CRS-300 switch for 1:N
redundancy.
Configuration CST= 1 byte, value Command only. CST= N/A N/A
Save of 0 thru 9 Causes the modem to store the current modem configuration in Configuration Memory location in the form CST?
x, where x=0 to 9. CST*
Example: CST=4 (stores the current configuration in location 4) CST#
Configuration CLD= 1 byte, value Command only. CLD= N/A N/A
Load of 0 thru 9 Causes the modem to retrieve a previously stored modem configuration from Configuration Memory location in the CLD?
form x, where x=0 to 9 CLD*
Example: CLD=4 (loads modem configuration from location 4 to be the active configuration) CLD#
D45
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Bulk Status N/A 29 bytes Query only. N/A BSQ? BSQ=abcccc,ddddd,
Query Response has the form abcccc,ddddd,eeffffffggggghhh, where: eeffffffggggghhh
a = LRS? response
b = RED? response (see Description of
cccc = EBN? response Arguments)
ddddd = BER? response
eeeee = BFS? Response
Exception * ffffff = RFO? response
600 or 600L ggggg = RSL? response
Emulation: hhh = TMP? response
28 chars, as This command is intended to reduce the need for excessively frequent queries to a modem, and will be useful
RFO is for a unit in a redundancy system, where the redundancy system has monitoring of its own occurring. The latter
different 6 parameters are only updated once per second.
D46
D47
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Equipment ID N/A 33 bytes Query only. N/A EID? EID=AAAABCDEFGHsJ
Unit returns the equipment ID and installed options in the form AAAABCDEFGHsJKLMNPQRSTUVWXYssssss, where: KLMNPQRSTUVWXYZa
AAAA=0625 , the modem model number ssss
Installed hardware: (see Description of
B=Slot 1: TPC/LDPC codec Arguments)
0 = not present, 1=present
C=Slot 2: DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier board (CnC)
0 = not present, 1=present
D=Slot 3: VersaFEC board
0 = not present, 1=present,
E=Slot 4: Network Processor card
0 = not present, 1=present
F=Slot 5: RAN Optimization card
0 = not present, 1=present
G=External 20dB attenuator
0 = not present, 1=present
H=Audio chips
0=not present, 1=present
s=spares (0)
Software FAST options:
J=Frequency option
0=70/140MHz, 1= 70/140MHz & L-Band
K=Modulation option
0=Standard: BPSK, QPSK, OQPSK.
1=Option 0 plus 8-PSK and 8-QAM
2=Option 0 plus 16-QAM
3=Option 1 and option 2
L=Data Rate option
M=TPC/LDPC data rate option
For L and M, the value is decoded:
0=Base, up to 5Mbps
1=up to 10Mbps
2=up to 15 Mbps
3=up to 20Mbps
4=up to 25Mbps
N=CnC data rate option, where
0=No CnC FAST installed
1=up to 512kbps
2=up to 1.1Mbps
3=up to 2.5 Mbps
P=VersaFEC CCM data rate option, where
0=Base, up to 1.1Mbps
1=up to 2.5Mbps
2=up to 5 Mbps
3=up to 16Mbps
D48
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Equipment ID Q=IP-ACM symbol rate option, where
(cont) 0=None
1=up to 300ksym/sec
2=up to 1200ksym/sec
3=up to 4100ksym/sec
R=Framing option
0=Standard: (Unframed, EDMAC, EDMAC2)
1 = Option 0 plus Open Network (IBS with hi-rate ESC, IDR, Audio)
S=D&I option
0=None
1=D&I,D&I++ for single port E1/T1
2=Option 1 plus Quad D&I (4 ports)
T= G.703 Clock Extension
0=Not installed, 1=installed on
U=Time based CnC option
0=Not installed
1=Fractional CnC installed
2=Time Limited CnC installed
3=Option 1 and Option 2
V=Header Compression
0=None
1=up to 5Mbps / 1200ksps (ACM)
2=up to 10Mbps / 4100ksps (ACM)
3=up to 15Mbps / 4100ksps (ACM)
4=up to 20Mbps / 4100ksps (ACM)
5=up to 25Mbps / 4100ksps (ACM)
W=Payload Compression
0=None
1=up to 5Mbps / 1200ksps (ACM)
2=up to 10Mbps / 4100ksps (ACM)
3=up to 15Mbps / 4100ksps (ACM)
4=up to 20Mbps / 4100ksps (ACM)
5=up to 25Mbps / 4100ksps (ACM)
X=Advanced QoS
0=Not installed, 1=Installed
Y=AES Encryption
0=Not installed
1=Installed
Z= Advanced Network Timing
0=Not installed
1=Installed
a= Carrier ID
0=Not installed
1=Installed
ssss = spares (0)
600/L Emulation: See CDM-600/600L manual
Example: EID=062510000000134473412113233000000 indicates all software options, TPC/LDPC card installed.
Note: To achieve LDPC or TPC to 25 Mbps, the modem will require:
Hardware option B, slot 1, a TPC/LDPC Codec;
Software options: L: data rate FAST option to 25 Mbps AND M:TPC/LDPC data rate FAST option to 25 Mbps.
D49
D50
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Offline Unit N/A 8 bytes Query only. (1:1 set-up) N/A OUS? OUS=xxxxxx
Status This query is sent to the online modem of a 1:1 pair. It provides access to the fault status information (FLT?) (see Description of
of the offline modem. This is the only way to interrogate the status of an offline modem at the distant-end of Arguments)
a link. The response format may be:
No_1for1 = Indicates that no 1:1 system has been detected. Presence of a 1kHz signal from the
CRS-150 is used to indicate a 1:1 set-up;
No_Comms = Indicates that a 1kHz signal has been detected, but that there is no (or not yet) a response
for the modem;
abcdef = The FLT? response information from the offline 600L unit; or
abcdefghxx = The FLT? response information from the offline 625 unit.
Faults and N/A 10 bytes Query only. N/A FLT? FLT=abcdefghxx
Status Unit returns the current highest-priority fault and status codes for the Unit (hardware), TX Traffic, RX Traffic, and ODUs: (see Description of
a = Unit status: Arguments)
0 = No faults
1 = Power supply fault, +5 volts
2 = Power supply fault , +12 volts Exception
3 = Power supply fault, 5 volts 600L Emulation
4 = Power supply fault, +3.3 volts format:
5 = Power supply fault, 12 volts FLT=abcdef
6 = Power supply fault, +2.5 volts
7 = Top Card comms
8 = Tx synthesizer lock
9 = Rx synthesizer
A = Top card load fail
B = TPC/LDPC FPGA load fail
C = HDLC FPGA load fail
D = CnC FPGA load fail
E = VersaFEC FPGA load fail
F = Calibration data missing
Exception 600L: F = Rx synthesizer2
G = Reference unlocked (Note: Tx off)
H = TXDCM fail
I = Over Temperature Alarm
J = Packet Processor mailbox fault
K = Fractional CnC use only
b = Tx Traffic status:
0 = Tx traffic OK
1 = No clock from terrestrial interface
2 = Tx FIFO slip
3 = AIS detected on incoming data
4 = AUPC upper limit reached
5 = (Hi-Stab) No External Ref found (no activity)
6 = BUC summary alarm (if ABA enabled)
7 = G.703 Loss of Signal (only valid in Clock Extend Mode)
Exceptions 600L:6 = BUC current
7 = BUC voltage
D51
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Faults and 8 = BUC no comms/bad checksum
Status (cont.) 9 = BUC PLL
A = BUC temperature
8 = CnC-APC home state
c = Rx Traffic status:
0 = Rx Traffic OK
1 = Demodulator unlocked
2 = AGC Alarm - signal out of range
3 = Demux Lock (Frame SYNC)
4 = Spare
5 = Buffer Slip
6 = AIS detected on incoming data
7 = Eb/No alarm
8 = Buffer Clock activity
9 = LNB summary alarm (if ALA enabled)
A = QDI Deframer Unlocked
Exception 600L: 9 = LNB current
A = LNB voltage
B,C,D,E,F = Spare
G = CnC-APC band mismatch
d = Open Network:
0 = No Faults
1 = Loss of Tx frame
2 = BER Alarm
3 = Loss of Tx multiframe
4 = Tx signaling AIS
5 = Tx Remote alarm
6 = IBS satellite alarm
7 = IDR Rx BWA1
8 = IDR Rx BWA2
9 = IDR Rx BWA3
A = IDR Rx BWA4
B = IDR Tx BWA1
C = IDR Tx BWA2
D = IDR Tx BWA3
E = IDR Tx BWA4
e = Change in modem fault status since last poll
0 = unchanged
1 = changed
f = Change in modem configuration since last poll
0 = unchanged
1 = changed
g= BUC status/faults:
0 = OK, masked, or not present
1 = BUC current
2 = BUC voltage
3 = spare
D52
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Faults and 4 = BUC no comms/bad checksum
Status (cont.) 5 = BUC PLL
6 = BUC temperature
h= LNB status/faults:
0 = OK, masked, or not present
1 = LNB current
2 = LNB voltage
xx = spares
CnC N/A 4 bytes Query only. N/A CRM? CRM=xxxx
Ratio Monitor When CnC is enabled and the modem is locked, ratio (in dB) is monitored between the interferer and the (see Description of
desired power. Arguments)
Example 1: CRM=+02 (interferer > desired) (format = sdd)
Example 2: CRM=LT11 (less than 11 dB)
Example 3: CRM=GT11 (greater than +11 dB)
Example 4: CRM=99.9 (not locked or CnC not enabled)
Example 5: CRM=AUTO (in CnC-APC mode)
CnC N/A 6 bytes Query only. N/A CDM? CDM=xxxxxx
Delay Monitor When CnC is enabled and the modem is locked, delay (in microseconds) of the interferer is monitored. (see Description of
Example 1: CDM=229500 (229.5 ms) Arguments)
Example 2: CDM=999999 (not locked or CnC not enabled)
CnC N/A 6 bytes Query only. N/A CFM? CFM=xxxx.x
Freq Offset When CnC is enabled, an estimated frequency offset (in kHz) is calculated between the interferer and the (see Description of
Monitor desired power. Arguments)
Example 1: CFM=+001.0 (1 kHz)
Example 2: CFM=9999.9 (not locked or CnC not enabled)
CnC Power N/A 6 bytes Query only. N/A CPR? CPR=xxxxxx
Ratio Monitor When CnC is enabled and the modem is locked, ratio (in dB) between the interferer and the desired power (see Description of
is monitored.. The precision is 0.1dB. Arguments)
Example 1: CPR=+02.8 (interferer > desired) (format = sdd.d)
Example 2: CPR=LT11.0 (less than 11.0 dB)
Example 3: CPR=GT19.0 (greater than +19.0 dB)
Example 4: CPR=9999.9 (not locked or CnC not enabled)
Example 5: CPR=AUTO (in CnC-APC mode)
D53
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
CnC PSDR N/A 5 bytes Query only. N/A PSD? PSD=xxxxx
When CnC is enabled and the modem is locked, ratio (in dB) between the interferer and the desired power (see Description of
is monitored. The precision is 0.1dB. Arguments)
Example 1: PSD=+02.8 (interferer > desired) (format = sdd.d)
Example 2: PSD=999.9 (not locked or CnC not enabled)
Example 3: PSD=AUTO (in CnC-APC mode)
CnC-APC Bit N/A 4 bytes Query only. N/A ABE? ABE=xxxx
Error Rate Unit returns the value of CnC-APC BER in the form ax10-3, where:
First byte is the value, last two bytes are the exponent.
Returns 9999 if modem is not in CnC-APC mode or there is an APC frame sync error.
BER is measured in frame UW.
Example: ABE=8E-5
CnC-APC BER ABR= None Command only. ABR= N/A N/A
Reset Restart CnC-APC BER measurement.
Note: This command takes no arguments.
CnC-APC N/A 4 bytes Query only. N/A AFE? AFE=xxxx
Frame Error Unit returns the value of CnC-APC FER in the form ax10-3, where:
Rate First byte is the value, last two bytes aret he exponent.
Returns 9999 if modem is not in CnC-APC mode or there is an APC frame sync error.
Example: Example: AFE=8E-2
CnC-APC FER AFR= None Command only. AFR= N/A N/A
Reset Restart CnC-APC FER measurement.
Note: This command takes no arguments.
CnC-APC APC= 1 byte, 0 thru 2 Command only. APC= N/A N/A
Activate/Suspe Used to activate or suspend APC operation, in format APC=x, where:
nd 0 = no action
1 = Activate APC
2 = Suspend APC
D54
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
CnC-APC N/A 2 bytes Query only. N/A APS? APS=xx
state Unit returns the state of APC operation. Return value is in form xx, where:
00 = APC is not active
01 = No Solution
02 = OK - ReBalance Done
03 = OK(Partial) - CnC Ratio approaches limit
04 = OK(Partial) - Local power approaches miminum value (-25 dBm for IF band)
05 = OK(Partial) - Local power approaches minimum value (-40 dBm for L-Band)
06 = OK(Partial) - Local power approaches maximum value (0 dBm)
07 = OK(Partial) - Local power approaches limit set by max power level increase
08 = OK(Partial) - Distant power approaches miminum value (-25 dBm for IF band)
09 = OK(Partial) - Distant power approaches minimum value (-40 dBm for L-Band)
10 = OK(Partial) - Distant power approaches maximum value (0 dBm)
11 = OK(Partial) - Distant power approaches limit set by max power level increase
12 = OK(Partial) - Incomplete
13 = No APC Frame Sync
14 = CnC Ratio Problem
15 = Local EbNo too high
16 = Distant EbNo too high
17 = Distant End ReBalance failed
18 = Distant End NoResponse
19 = Fail-Calculate Mismatch
20 = CnC Ratio too high
21 = Please run again
22 = APC is active
23 = Local margin too low
24 = Distant margin too low
25 = Rx Data Rate<64kbps
26 = Tx Data Rate<64kbps
27 = Local RSL too low
28 = Distant RSL too low
CnC-APC Max APL= 3 bytes Command or Query. APL= APL? APL=xx.x
Power Level CnC-APC maximum power level increase in the form x.x, range from 0.0 to 9.9 dB, limited by Tx power APL? (see Description of
Increase level. APL* Arguments)
Example: APL=3.9 (APC max power level increase is 3.9 dB.) APL#
D55
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
CnC-APC AHS= 12 bytes Command or Query. AHS= AHS? AHS=a,bbb,cc,ddd
Home State Command is only for Offline unit in Redundancy system, sent by 1:N switch or Online unit in 1:1 system. AHS? (see Description of
Returns CnC-APC home state parameters in the form a,bbb,cc,ddd, where: AHS* Arguments)
a = APC state. (1 = APC is active, 0 = APC is not active) AHS#
bbb = APC home state Tx power, in 0.1dB. (minus sign assumed)
cc = APC home state max power level increase, in 0.1 dB.
ddd = APC Tx power threshold, in 0.1 dB. (minus sign assumed)
Example: AHS=1,100,60,085 (APC is active, home state power is -10.0 dB, home state max power level
increase is 6.0 dB, power threshold is -8.5 dB)
ACM Remote N/A 4 bytes Query only. N/A RSN? RSN=xx.x
Signal Noise Returns the value of SNR of the remote demod in the form xx.x, where: (see Description of
Ratio 99.9 = Demod is unlocked. Arguments)
xx.x = Not in IP-ACM.
Example: RSN=12.4
ACM Local N/A 4 bytes Query only. N/A SNR? SNR=xx.x
Signal Noise Unit returns the value of Local Signal Noise Ratio in the form xx.x, where: (see Description of
Ratio 99.9 = demod is unlocked. Arguments)
xx.x = Not in IP-ACM, Resolution 0.1 dB.
Example: SNR=12.3 (selects SNR=12.3 dB)
Uncorrected N/A 7 or 8 bytes Query only. N/A RBE? RBE=xxxxxxxx
BER Units returns the value of the uncorrected BER. (See Description of
LT = less than Arguments)
GT = greater than
Returns 9999999 if the demodulator is unlocked or uncorrected BER data is unavailable.
Example: BER=4.3E-02 BER=GT1.0E-1
D56
D57
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
BUC N/A 4 bytes Query only. N/A BUT? BUT=sxxx
Temperature BUCTemperature, in the form sxxx, where: Exception (see Description of
s = sign 600L Emulation: Arguments)
xxx = number ODT?
Note: This query is only valid when the FSK and BUC power are turned On.
BUC N/A 1 byte, value Query only. N/A BPA? BPA=x
Phase Lock of 0 or 1 BUC phase lock loop in the form x, where: (see Description of
Loop 0 = Locked Exception Arguments)
1 = Unlocked 600L Emulation:
Note: This query is only valid when the FSK is enabled. OLL?
BUC Software N/A 2 bytes Query only. N/A BSV? BSV=xx
Version BUC software version in the form xx, where xx is between 0 and 15. Exception (see Description of
Note: This query is only valid when the FSK and BUC power are turned On. 600L Emulation: Arguments)
OSV?
BUC N/A 2 bytes Query only. N/A BPC? BPC=xx
Power Class BUC Power Class in the form xx, where xx indicates the Power Class in watts. Exception (see Description of
Example: BPC=25 600L Emulation: Arguments)
Note: This query is only valid when the FSK is enabled. OPC?
D58
D59
D60
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Ethernet EGC= Up to 347 Command or Query. EGC= EGC? EGC=1abccccdxxx;2
Global bytes Global Configuration of CDM625 Ethernet, in the form shown in the Response to Query column, where: EGC? EGC?n (where n abccccdxxx;3abcccc
Configuration 1abccccdxxx;2abccccdxxx;3abccccdxxx;4abccccdxxx=Switch Ports configuration same as SPC EGC* = 0 to 9. Returns dxxx;4abccccdxxxD
D=VLAN Mode Enable same as SVM EGC# the EGC portion EFFGHIJKKKKLLLL
E=Switch MAC Learning same as SML of 1 of 10 stored .
FF=QoS Priority same as QOS configurations) (see Description of
G= Ethernet 2048 Frame Size same as EFS Arguments)
H= Precision Time Protocol Feature same as PTP
I= Precision Time Protocol Mode same as PTM
J= Carrier ID same as CAI
KKKK=Management VLAN ID same as SMV
LLLL.=VLAN Table same as SVT
VLAN Mode SVM= 1 byte, value Command or Query. SVM= SVM? SVM=x
Enable 0 or 1 VLAN Mode Enable, in the form x, where: SVM? (see Description of
0 = VLAN is Disabled SVM* Arguments)
1 = VLAN is Enabled SVM#
Switch MAC SML= 1byte, value Command or Query. SML= SML? SML=x
Learning 0 or 1 Switch MAC learning in the form x, where: SML? (see Description of
0 = Off SML* Arguments)
1 =On SML#
VLAN Table SVT= Up to 287 Command or Query. SVT= SVT? SVT=aaaabcde,aaa
byes Sets/Returns all the entries in the VLAN table in the form aaaabcde,aaaabcde,aaaabcde,, where: SVT? abcde,aaaabcde
aaaa = VLAN ID. Value range is 1-4095, must not be duplicate of any PVID. SVT* (see Description of
b = property of port 1: 0=Tagged, 1=Filtered, 2=Untagged SVT# Arguments)
c = property of port 2: 0=Tagged, 1=Filtered, 2=Untagged
d = property of port 3: 0=Tagged, 1=Filtered, 2=Untagged
e = property of port 4: 0=Tagged, 1=Filtered, 2=Untagged
Add entry to SVA= 8 bytes Command only. SVA= N/A SVA=aaaabcde
VLAN table Adds entry to VLAN table in the form aaaabcde, where: SVA? (see Description of
aaaa = New VLAN ID. Value range is 1-4095, must not be duplicate of any PVID or VLAN ID existing in SVA* Arguments)
VLAN table. SVA#
b = property of port 1. 0=Tagged, 1=Filtered, 2=Untagged
c = property of port 2. 0=Tagged, 1=Filtered, 2=Untagged
d = property of port 3. 0=Tagged, 1=Filtered, 2=Untagged
e = property of port 4. 0=Tagged, 1=Filtered, 2=Untagged
Management SMV= 4 bytes Command or Query. SMV= SMV? SMV=aaaa
VLAN ID Management Ports VLAN ID in the form aaaa, where: SMV? (see Description of
aaaa = the ID number in the range 0001-4095. SMV* Arguments)
SMV#
D61
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Delete entry in SVD= 4 bytes Command only. SVD= N/A SVD=aaaa
VLAN table Deletes VLAN table entry in the form aaaa, where: SVD? (see Description of
aaaa = the VLAN ID number in the range 0001-4095. SVD* Arguments)
SVD#
Packet PPE= 1 byte, value Command or Query. PPE= PPE? PPE=x
Processor 0 or 1 Packet Processor Card Enable, in the form PPE=x, where: PPE? (see Description of
Card Enable 0 = Packet Processor Card is Disabled PPE* Arguments)
1 = Packet Processor Card is Enabled PPE#
Note: Change of this configuration results in modem auto-reboot only when IP Packet Processor option card
is installed and enabled. Otherwise, when the IP Packet Processor option card is not installed, this selection
is stored but is otherwise non-functional.
QoS Mode QOS= 2 bytes Command or Query. QOS= QOS? QOS=ab
Qo (Quality of Service) Mode, in the form QOS=ab where: QOS? (see Description of
a = Layer 2 QoS; QOS* Arguments)
0 = Off, Layer 2 QoS is disabled QOS#
1 = VLAN Priority only
2 = Port Priority only
3 = VLAN and Port Priority
b =Layer 3 QoS;
0 = Off, Layer 3 QoS is disabled
1 = Advanced QoS Max / Priority (requires Advanced QoS FAST Option)*
2 = Advanced QoS Min Max (requires Advanced QoS FAST Option)*
3 = Advanced QoS DiffServ (requires Advanced QoS FAST Option)*
*Note: Layer 3 QoS settings 1 through 3 apply to modem only with IP Packet Processor option card installed
and enabled.
Switch Ports SPC= 47 bytes Command or Query. SPC= SPC? SPC=1abccccdxxx,2
Configuration Sets/Returns Ethernet switch ports priority and PVID in the form SPC? abccccdxxx,3abcccc
1abccccdxxx;2abccccdxxx;3abccccdxxx;4abccccdxxx, where: SPC* dxxx,4abccccdxxx
1, 2. 3. 4 = Port number. SPC# (see Description of
a = Port priority; Arguments)
Value is 1, 2, 3 or 4 (the higher the number, the higher the priority).
b = Port Native Mode;
0 = Native Mode Disabled, 1 = Native Mode Enabled.
cccc = Port VLAN ID in the range of 0000-4095;
Value 0000 is only valid when port Native Mode is disabled.
d = Pause flow control;
0 = Off, 1 = On
xxx = Eeserved.
D62
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Edit entry in SVE= 8 bytes Command only. SVE= N/A SVE=aaaabcde
VLAN table Edit VLAN table entry in the form aaaabcde, where: SVE? (see Description of
aaaa = existing VLAN ID. Value range is 1-4095. SVE* Arguments)
b = property of port 1; SVE#
0=Tagged, 1=Filtered, 2=Untagged
c = property of port 2;
0=Tagged, 1=Filtered, 2=Untagged
d = property of port 3;
0=Tagged, 1=Filtered, 2=Untagged
e = property of port 4;
0=Tagged, 1=Filtered, 2=Untagged
Packet WMD= 1 byte, value Command or Query. WMD= WMD? WMD=x
Processor 0 thru 3 Packet Processor Working Mode in the form x, where: WMD? (see Description of
Working Mode 0 = Managed Switch WMD* Arguments)
1 = Router Point to Point* WMD#
2 = Router Multipoint Hub*
3 = Router Multipoint Remote*
*Note: Settings 1 through 3 apply to modem only with IP Packet Processor option card installed and enabled.
Dedicated DMP= 1 byte, value Command or Query. DMP= DMP? DMP=x
Management 0 thru 8 Dedicated Ethernet Management port in Redundancy system in the form x, where: DMP? (see Description of
Port 0 = Disabled (Any Ethernet port can do management, default value) DMP* Arguments)
1 = Port 1 DMP#
2 = Port 2
3 = Port 3
4 = Port 4
5 = Port 1 Local only*
6 = Port 2 Local only*
7 = Port 3 Local only*
8 = Port 4 Local only*
Notes:
1. VLAN must be Disabled to be able to select a port as Dedicated Management Port.
2. * Only LAN devices can access M&C of modem. NO remote modem access.
Ethernet 2048 EFS= 1 byte, value Command or Query. EFS= EFS? EFS=x
Frame Size 0 or 1 2048 byte Ethernet Frame Size Enable/Disable in the form x, where: EFS? (see Description of
0 = 2048 Ethernet Frame Size is Disabled EFS* Arguments)
1 = 2048 Ethernet Frame Size is Enabled (supported by modem with baseboard hardware Rev2 and EFS#
above)
D63
Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Host Access ACL= 1 byte, value Command or Query. ACL= ACL? ACL=x
List 0 or 1 IP Host Access List Enable/Disable in the form x, where: ACL? (see Description of
Enable/Disable 0 = Host Access List is Disabled ACL* Arguments)
1 = Host Access List is Enabled ACL#
Packet PRD= 1 byte, value Command or Query. PRD= PRD? PRD=x
Processor 0 or 1 Valid only when Packet Processor is installed and Enabled. PRD? (see Description of
Redundancy Packet Processor Redundancy Enable/Disable, where: PRD* Arguments)
0 = Disable Packet Processor Redundancy PRD#
1 = Enable Packet Processor Redundancy
Precision Time PTP= 1 byte, value Command or Query. PTP= PTP? PTP=x
Protocol 0 or 1 Precision Time Protocol Feature Enable/Disable in the form x, where: PTP? (see Description of
0 = PTP is Disabled PTP* Arguments)
1 = PTP Enabled PTP#
Precision Time PTM= 1 byte, value Command or Query. PTM= PTM? PTM=x
Protocol 0 or 1 Precision Time Protocol Grandmaster selection in the form x, where: PTM? (see Description of
Grandmaster 0 = Grandmaster reachable over LAN. PTM* Arguments)
1 = Grandmaster reachable over WAN. PTM#
Packet N/A None Query only. N/A VS0? VS0=x
Processor Valid only when Packet Processor is installed and Enabled. x is variable length of
Bootrom FW Returns Packet Processor Bootrom firmware version. text
Version
Packet N/A None Query only. N/A VS1? VS1=x
Processor Valid only when Packet Processor is installed and Enabled. x is variable length of
Image1 FW Returns Packet Processor Image 1 firmware version. text
Version
Packet N/A None Query only. N/A VS2? VS2=x
Processor Valid only when Packet Processor is installed and Enabled. x is variable length of
Image2 FW Returns Packet Processor Image 2 firmware version. text
Version
Packet N/A None Query only. N/A AFI? AFI=x
Processor Valid only when Packet Processor is installed and Enabled. x is variable length of
Running FW Returns Packet Processor Running firmware image. text
Image
D64
E.1 Overview
The Telnet Command Line Interface (referred to hereafter as the Telnet CLI or the CLI) is an
Ethernet-based user menu system for the CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem equipped with
an installed and enabled optional IP Packet Processor card. The CLI facilitates configuration,
monitoring and control of the unit using a user-supplied terminal emulator (e.g., PuTTY or Tera
Term).
E1
3. The numeric keypads ENTER key may not work on some terminal emulators.
For Host Name (or IP Address), enter the interface IP Address (e.g., 192.168.1.11);
E2
Next, log in to the Telnet CLI using a valid Username and Password:
1. In order to use the Telnet CLI to make configuration changes to the CDM-625,
Remote Access Mode should always be set to [Ethernet].
Settings > Window > Translation > Override with UTF-8 if locale says so [UNCHECK]
E3
Select TCP/IP;
E4
Next, before you log in, Tera Term requires the following settings on the Setup > Terminal page:
Finally, log in to the Telnet CLI using a valid Username and Password:
E5
In order to use the Telnet CLI to make configuration changes to the CDM-625,
Remote Access Mode should always be set to [Ethernet].
E6
In order to use the Telnet CLI to make configuration changes to the CDM-625,
Remote Access Mode should always be set to [Ethernet].
Dialog windows:
Table pages:
E7
Selection Description
Press [ENTER] to accept any updates or changes made on this page this does not
[ENTER]Select
save the selection to configuration memory, additional action is required.
[ESC] Back Press [ESC] to exit the current menu and return to the parent submenu.
Press [F5] to discard any changes made on the page and restore all values from the
[F5] Refresh
modem
[F8] Save Press [F8] to save the currently defined settings to configuration memory
[F9] Add Press [F9] to add a new index to a table (e.g., VLAN Table, Sect. E.3.4.4.1)
[F10] Exit Press [F10] to end the CLI session and close the terminal emulator window
Press [F11] to delete an ex isting i ndex f rom a t able ( e.g., VLAN T able, S ect.
[F11] Delete
E.3.4.4.1)
Type the new parameter, and then press [ENTER] to accept the entry. The dialog window closes
and the CLI returns you to the active configuration page.
Here, the CLI rejects the attempted entry of 6 and displays the message Number is out of
range. Re-enter a new value (in this example, a value within the acceptable ranges of 0 and
8-32) and then press [ENTER] to continue. Otherwise, press [ESC] to quit the dialog window
and return to the configuration page. You may then proceed with further configuration
updates.
E8
You must press [F8] to save any changes to the modem memory. If you press [ESC]
after changes have been made but not saved on a page, the Unsaved Changes
window opens to force further action:
Selection Action
[Save] Save any changes made to the page to memory
[Discard] Exit the page without saving and return to the parent submenu
[Go Back] Return to the active configuration window to review or make further changes
Use the arrow keys within the window to scroll through the page contents.
This appendix documents the entire Telnet Command Line Interface. Some
features may not be available with your modem as equipped. Your CLI window
appearances may differ based on your terminal emulators configured window
settings.
E9
The Home Menu serves as the CLIs primary navigation page. All selections made on this page
take you to the submenus listed in this table. Press a hot key to access a submenu from this top-
level navigation page.
Hot
Description Function Sect.
Key
A Administration Access administrative configuration submenu E.3.2
B Modem Access modem configuration submenu E.3.3
C Network Access network configuration submenu E.3.4
D WAN Access WAN configuration submenu E.3.5
Access ODU comms, CSAT-5060 configuration submenus (summary E.3.6
E Outdoor Unit (ODU)
only)
F Redundancy Access 1:1 or 1:N redundancy configuration submenu E.3.7
Enter alphanumeric Circuit ID; view read-only CDM-625 operations E.3.8
G General Information
information screens
Access Base Modem and Packet Processor stored events and E.3.9
H Logs
statistics logs, alarms control submenus
I Statistics Access CDM-625 operational statistics submenus E.3.10
J Contact View read-only Customer Support contact information screen E.3.11
K Remote Mode Open the Remote Access Mode setting E.3.1.1
See the listed appendix section for further information. Once you have confirmed that the
Telnet CLIs Remote Access Mode is set to [Ethernet], press a hot key to access a configuration
submenu.
E10
First, from the Home menu, press [K] to open the Remote Access Mode dialog window:
Then, use the arrow keys to select the Remote Mode as Ethernet, and press [ENTER] to
accept the selection. Finally, press [F8] to save to memory. Note the following:
E11
Open the Administration submenu from the Home menu. This submenu contains the following
options:
Hot
Configuration Page Function Sect.
Key
A Host Access List Configure Host Access List(s) E.3.2.1
B SNMP Configure SNMP parameters and traps E.3.2.2
C Firmware (Base Modem) View Base Modem firmware information or select image load
View Packet Processor firmware information or select image E.3.2.3
D Firmware (Packet Processor)
load
E Reboot Reboot the CDM-625 E.3.2.4
Set the FAST Feature Demo Mode or view currently installed
F FAST Codes E.3.2.5
FAST options
G Save Modem Configuration Save up to 10 modem configurations to memory
E.3.2.6
H Load Modem Configuration Recall 1 of 10 modem configurations from memory
Discard any configuration changes and restore all settings
I Restore Factory Defaults E.3.2.7
as shipped
Press a hot key to access a configuration page. See the specified appendix section for further
configuration information. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Home menu.
E12
Open the scrollable Host Access List page from the Administration submenu. This page contains
the following options:
Hot
Dialog Window Function / Option Entry
Key
A Access List Enforcement Use arrow keys to select Enabled or Disabled
B Access IP 1 Access IP List Entry Enable
E Access IP 2 Access IP List Entry Enable Typical for each entry Use arrow keys to set each list as
Enabled or Disabled
H Access IP 3 Access IP List Entry Enable
K Access IP 4 Access IP List Entry Enable
C Access IP 1 Access IP Address Typical for each entry Enter each IP Address in the form
F Access IP 2 Access IP Address XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX
D Access IP 1 Access Network Prefix Typical for each entry Enter a value as follows:
Range 1 Enter a value of 0
G Access IP 2 Access Network Prefix Range 2 Enter a value from 8 to 32
J Access IP 3 Access Network Prefix If you enter an invalid value, the CLI displays
M Access IP 4 Access Network Prefix error message Number is out of range
Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Administration
submenu.
E13
Open the SNMP page from the Administration submenu. This page contains the following
options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Contact
B Name Typical for each entry Enter the desired designations
C Location
D Enable Authentication Traps Use the arrow keys to select Enabled or Disabled
E SNMP Trap Destination IP Address 1 Typical for either entry Enter either IP Address in the form
F SNMP Trap Destination IP Address 2 XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX
G SNMP Trap Version Use the arrow keys to select SNMP V1 or SNMP V2
Enter the desired Trap Community name the default name is
H SNMP Trap Community
comtech
Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Administration
submenu.
E14
Open the Base Modem and Packet Processor Firmware pages from the Administration submenu.
Use these pages to view the current firmware information, or to select the alternate firmware
image to be loaded at startup or reboot. Both pages contain the following option:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Boot From Use the arrow keys to set load as Image1 or Image2
Press the hot key to open the dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the
Administration submenu.
You must reboot the unit in order for the new firmware image load selection to take
effect.
E15
Open the Reboot page from the Administration submenu. Use this page to perform a soft reboot
of the CDM-625. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Administration submenu.
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Force Reboot Use the arrow keys to select No (default) or Yes to reboot
You must restart your Telnet CLI session upon reboot of the CDM-625.
E16
Open the FAST Options page from the Administration submenu. Use this page to review your
units available and installed FAST features.
E17
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Demo Mode Use the arrow keys to set Demo Mode as Disabled
(default) or Enabled
1. If Enabled, the CDM-625 begins operation in
FAST Demo Mode FAST Options Demo
Mode allows access to ALL CDM-625 FAST
options for 30 calendar days
Press [A] to open the Demo Mode dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the
Administration submenu.
E18
Open the Save Modem Configuration and Load Modem Configuration pages from the
Administration submenu. Use these pages to save and load up to 10 modem configurations.
Press [A] to open the Save to Slot or Load from Slot dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to
return to the Administration submenu.
E19
Then, enter 0 through 9, and then press [ENTER] to accept the selection.
Finally, press [F8] to save (store) the configuration. Wait while the configuration is
stored into memory.
Once a modem configuration is stored into the designated slot, the time and date are recorded,
and this information appears on the configuration slot line.
Finally, press [F8] to load (recall) the configuration. Wait while the configuration is
loaded from memory.
E20
Open the Restore Factory Default page from the Administration submenu. Use this page to
restore the CDM-625 settings to the original settings as shipped from the factory.
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Restore Factory Defaults Use the arrow keys to set as Cancel (default) or Restore
Press [A] to open the Restore Factory Defaults dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return
to the Administration submenu.
By selecting Restore, the unit proceeds with restoration of factory defaults. Wait while the unit
reboots.
You must restart your Telnet CLI session upon reboot of the CDM-625.
E21
Open the Modem submenu from the Home menu. This submenu contains the following options:
Hot
Configuration Page Function Sect.
Key
A Interface Configure the Tx and Rx Framing Modes E.3.3.1
B Modem TX Configure the units Tx parameters E.3.3.2
C Modem RX Configure the units Rx parameters E.3.3.3
D Carrier-in-Carrier (CnC) Configure CnC FAST Option E.3.3.4
Adaptive Coding and
E Configure ACM FAST Option E.3.3.5
Modulation (ACM)
F Drop and Insert (D&I) Configure D&I parameters E.3.3.6
G Block Upconverter (BUC) Configure BUC parameters and view operating statistics E.3.3.7
Low-Noise Block
H Configure LNB parameters and view operating statistics E.3.3.8
Downconverter (LNB)
I MEO (Medium Earth Orbit) Configure MEO and Antenna Handover parameters E.3.3.9
J Utilities Configure and monitor a variety of unit operational settings E.3.3.10
K Overhead Configure ESC, IDR Backward Alarms, AUPC, and EDMAC E.3.3.11
Press a hot key to access a configuration page. See the specified appendix section for further
configuration options. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Home menu.
E22
Open the Interface page from the Modem submenu. This page contains the following options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
Typical for either entry Use the arrow keys to select:
A Tx Interface Type
RS-422 V.35 G.703 Balanced
G.703 Unbalanced Audio LVDS
C Rx Interface Type HSSI IP ASI
IP ACM
Typical for either entry Use the arrow keys to select:
B Tx Framing Mode
Unframed IBS IDR
DNI EDMAC DNI ++
D Rx Framing Mode ESC ++ EDMAC2 ODI
Frm QDI EDMAC3
Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Modem
submenu.
E23
Open the Modem TX page from the Modem submenu. This page contains the following options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Tx FEC Type Use the arrow keys to select:
None Diff Enc On Viterbi Viterbi Reed-Solomon
Sequential Sequential Reed-Solomon TCM
TCM Reed-Solomon TPC None Diff Enc Off
LDPC VersaFEC ULL
Use the arrow keys to select:
B Tx Mod Type BPSK QPSK OQPSK
8PSK 16QAM 8QAM
Use the arrow keys to select:
Rate 1/2 Rate 3/4 Rate 7/8
Rate 2/3 Rate 1/1 Rate 21/44
Rate 5/16 Rate 0.95 VersaFEC BPSK 0.488
VersaFEC QPSK 0.533 VersaFEC QPSK 0.631 VersaFEC QPSK 0.706
C Tx FEC Code Rate VersaFEC QPSK 0.803 VersaFEC 8QAM 0.642 VersaFEC 8QAM 0.711
VersaFEC 8QAM 0.780 VersaFEC 16QAM 0.731 VersaFEC 16QAM 0.780
VersaFEC 16QAM 0.829 VersaFEC 16QAM 0.853 VersaFEC 8QAM 0.576
VersaFEC ULL BPSK VersaFEC ULL QPSK
VersaFEC 16QAM 0.644
0.493 0.493
VersaFEC ULL QPSK 0.654 VersaFEC ULL QPSK 0.734
D Tx Data Rate Enter a value from 18.000 to 25000.000 Kbps
E Tx Symbol Rate Enter a value from 18.000 to 25000.000 Ksps
E24
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
Enter a value as follows:
F Tx Frequency Range 1 From 50.0000 to 180.0000 MHz
Range 2 From 950.0000 to 2000.0000 MHz
G Tx Spectrum Invert Use the arrow keys to select Normal or Inverted
H Tx Scrambler Use the arrow keys to select Off, Normal, or IESS315
Enter a value as follows:
I Tx Power Level Range 1 From -99.9 to 99.9 dBm
Range 2 From-40.00 to 0.0 dBm
Tx Reed-Solomon
J Use the arrow keys to select Normal, IESS410, EF Data, or IBS
Encoding
K Tx Data Invert
Typical for either entry Use the arrow keys to select Normal or Inverted
L Tx Data Clock Invert
M Tx Ternary Code Use the arrow keys to select AMI, B8zs, B6zs, or Hdb3
Use the arrow keys to select:
Off On RTI, 10 s timeout
N Tx Carrier State
Off External Off BUC delay RTI, 1 s timeout
RTI, 2 s timeout RTI, 4 s timeout RTI, 7 s timeout
O POCO Use the arrow keys to select Disabled or Enabled
P Tx Submux Use the arrow keys to select Off or On
Use the arrow keys to select an IP/Synchronous setting:
1/9 1/8 1/7 1/6 1/5 1/4
2/7 1/3 2/5 3/7 1/2 3/5
Q Tx Submux Ratio 2/3 3/4 4/5 1/1 5/4 4/3
3/2 5/3 2/1 7/3 5/2 3/1
7/2 4/1 5/1 6/1 7/1 8/1
9/1 1/59 1/39 1/19
R Tx Filter Rolloff Factor Use the arrow keys to select Factor 0.35 or Factor 0.25
Valid code rates depend on the selected FEC and Mod types for example, you
cannot select VersaFEC 16QAM 0.644 if your FEC is TCM
Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Modem
submenu.
E25
Open the Modem RX page from the Modem submenu. This page contains the following options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Rx FEC Type Use the arrow keys to select
None Diff Enc On Viterbi Viterbi Reed-Solomon
Sequential Sequential Reed-Solomon TCM
TCM Reed-Solomon TPC None Diff Enc Off
LDPC VersaFEC ULL
E26
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
Enter a value from 18.000 to 25000.000 Kbps
D Rx Data Rate
Data Rate applies only when not in ACM Mode
Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Modem
submenu.
E27
Open the Carrier-in-Carrier (CnC) page from the Modem submenu. This page contains the
following options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
Use the arrow keys to select:
Off On Normal APC CBand Side A
A CnC Mode APC XBand Side A APC KuBand Side A APC KaBand Side A
APC CBand Side B APC XBand Side B APC KuBand Side B
APC KaBand Side B
B CnC Search Min Delay Enter a minimum value from 0 to 330 ms
C CnC Search Max Delay Enter a maximum value from 0 to 330 ms
D CnC Frequency Offset Enter a value from 1 to 200 KHz
E CnC PMSI Mode Use the arrow keys to select Idle, Redundancy, Talk, or Listen
Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Modem
submenu.
E28
E.3.3.5 Home > Modem > Adaptive Coding and Modulation (ACM)
Open the ACM page from the Modem submenu. Use this page as a quick reference guide for the
Minimum and Maximum Tx ModCod settings. This submenu contains the following options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A ACM Min Tx Mod Cod Enter a minimum value from 0 to 11
B ACM Max Tx Mod Cod Enter a maximum value from 0 to 11
Use the arrow keys to select Go To Min Tx Modcod or
C ACM Action on Remote Demod Unlock
Maintain Tx Modcod
D ACM Target Eb No Margin Enter a value from 0.0 to 4.5 dB
Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Modem
submenu.
E29
Open the Drop and Insert (D&I) page from the Modem page. This page contains the following
options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Drop Type Typical for either entry Use the arrow keys to select T1D4, T1
B Insert Type ESF, E1 CCS, or E1CAS
C Tx Terrestrial Alarm Mask Use the arrow keys to select Alarm Active or Alarm Masked
D Rx Terrestrial Alarm Enable Use the arrow keys to select Disable or Enable
E D&I Table
F D&I++ Table See Sect. E.3.3.6.1 for details
G D&I Quad Table
Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Modem
submenu.
E30
E.3.3.6.1 Home > Modem > Drop and Insert (D&I) > D&I Tables
From the Drop and Insert (D&I) page, press E (D&I Table), F (D&I++ Table ) or G D&I Quad Table
to continue.
Typical for any table, enter a new value, and then press [ENTER] to accept the change or [ESC]
to return to the D&I page.
The D&I Table dialog window shows the current value for the table. To edit the table value,
press A, and then enter a new value*. Press [ENTER] to accept the change or [ESC] to return
to the D&I dialog window.
E31
The D&I++ Table dialog window shows the current value for the table. To edit the table
value, press A, and then enter a new value*. Press [ENTER] to accept the change or [ESC] to
return to the D&I dialog window.
The D&I Quad Table dialog window shows the current value for each table. To edit a table
value*, press A (Quad Drop And Insert Port 1), B (Quad Drop And Insert Port 2), C (Quad
Drop And Insert Port 3), or D (Quad Drop And Insert Port 4).
E32
Open the Block Upconverter (BUC) page from the Modem submenu. This page features a read-
only status section for the installed device and contains the following options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A BUC DC Power Use the arrow keys to select Disable or Enable
B BUC 10 MHz Reference
Typical for either entry Use the arrow keys to select Off or On
C BUC RF Output
D BUC Low Current Limit Enter a low limit value from 0 to 4000 mA
E BUC High Current Limit Enter a high limit value from 0 to 4000 mA
Enter a value as follows:
F BUC LO Frequency Range 1 From 0 to 0 MHz
Range 2 From 3000 to 65000 MHz
G BUC LO Mix Use the arrow keys to select Low Side Mix or High Side Mix
H BUC Address Enter a value from 1 to 15
Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Modem
submenu.
E33
Open the (Low-Noise Block Downconverter) LNB page from the Modem submenu. This page
provides a read-only status section for the installed device and contains the following options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A LNB DC Power Use the arrow keys to select Off, On 13V, On 18V, or On 24V
B LNB 10 MHz Reference Use the arrow keys to select Disable or Enable
C LNB Low Current Limit Enter a low limit value from 0 to 500 mA
D LNB High Current Limit Enter a high limit value from 0 to 500 mA
Enter a value as follows:
E LNB LO Frequency Range 1 From 0 to 0 MHz
Range 2 From 3000 to 65000 MHz
F LNB LO Mix Use the arrow keys to select Low Side Mix or High Side Mix
Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Modem
submenu.
E34
CDM625 modems are configurable for continuous pairing as Primary and nonPrimary Modems
in an Antenna Handover System when the MEO (Medium Earth Orbit) feature is enabled. Open
the MEO page from the Modem submenu. This page contains the following options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A MEO Enable Typical for either entry Use the arrow keys to select Disabled
B Antenna Handover Enable or Enabled
C Antenna Handover Mode Use the arrow keys to select Manual or Auto
D Antenna Handover DPD Enter a Differential Path Delay value from -30 to 30
E Antenna Handover Port Enter a value from 1001 to 65535
Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Modem
submenu.
E35
Open the scrollable Utilities page from the Modem submenu. This page contains the following
options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Unit Test Mode Use the arrow keys to select
Normal Tx CW Tx Alt10 Pattern
IF Loopback RF Loopback Digital Loopback
I/O Loopback
E36
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
B Statistics Sample Interval Use the arrow keys to select Disabled, or 10 minutes to 90 minutes
Use the arrow keys to select Loop No Action, Loop RTS Controls
C Request To Send
Tx Output, or Ignore RTS Assert CTS
Use the arrow keys to select TA To CA Loop or RR Control CA TA
D HSSI Handshake Control
Control TxS
E Circuit ID Enter a Circuit ID value as needed
F Carrier ID Use the arrow keys to select Disable or Enable
G RTC Time Enter a value in the form HH:MM:SS
H RTC Date Enter a value in the form DD:MM:YY
Use the arrow keys to select Internal, Tx Terrestrial, Rx Loop
I Tx Clock Source
Timed, or Rx Sat
Use the arrow keys to select Rx Satellite, Tx Terrestrial, Internal
J Rx Clock Source
SCT, or Insert
K Rx Buffer Size Enter a value from 16 to 32768
Use the arrow keys to select:
L Modem Reference Clock Internal External 1 MHz External 2 MHz
External 5 MHz External 10 MHz Internal Plus Output
M G703 Clock Extend Mode Use the arrow keys to select None, Tx Lock, or Rx Enable
N G703 Clock Extend Intf Use the arrow keys to select T1, E1 Balanced, or E1 Unbalanced
O Warm Up Delay Use the arrow keys to select Disable or Enable
P Warm Up Countdown Enter a value from 0 to 999 seconds
Q BERT Restart Monitor Use the arrow keys to select No or Yes
R BERT Tx State Use the arrow keys to select Off or On
Typical for either entry Use the arrow keys to select:
S BERT Tx Pattern BERT Pattern Space BERT Pattern Mark BERT Pattern 11
BERT Pattern 12 BERT Pattern 63 BERT Pattern 511
BERT Pattern 2047 BERT Pattern 2047 R BERT Pattern MIL188
U BERT Rx Pattern
BERT Pattern 2^15 BERT Pattern 2^20 BERT Pattern 2^23
T BERT Rx State
V BERT 10^-3 Error Insert Typical for each entry Use the arrow keys to select Off or On
W Recenter Buffer
Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Modem
submenu.
E37
Open the scrollable Overhead page from the Modem submenu. This page contains the following
options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A IDR Tx ESC Type Typical for either entry Use the arrow keys to select 64k Data
B IDR Rx ESC Type Channel or 2 Audio Channels
C Tx Audio Volume Port 1 Typical for each entry Use the arrow keys to select:
D Tx Audio Volume Port 2 Negative6 Negative4 Negative2 Zero
E Rx Audio Volume Port 1 Positive2 Positive4 Positive6 Positive8
F Rx Audio Volume Port 2
G High Rate ESC Use the arrow keys to select Disabled or Enabled
E38
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
I Tx Backward Alarm Enable Port1
J Tx Backward Alarm Enable Port2
K Tx Backward Alarm Enable Port3
L Tx Backward Alarm Enable Port4
Typical for each entry Use the arrow keys to select Off or On
M Rx Backward Alarm Enable Port1
N Rx Backward Alarm Enable Port2
O Rx Backward Alarm Enable Port3
P Tx Backward Alarm Enable Port4
Q AUPC Enable Use the arrow keys to select Disable or Enable
R AUPC Remote Demod Target Eb No Enter a value from 0.0 to 14.9 dB
S AUPC Tx Power Max Increase Enter a value from 0 to 9 dB
Use the arrow keys to select No Action, Generate Tx Alarm
T AUPC Action On Max Power
Max Power, or Generate Tx Alarm Minimum ModCod
AUPC Action On Remote Demod Use the arrow keys to select Go To Nominal Power, Go To
U
Unlock Max Power, or Hold
V EDMAC Mode Use the arrow keys to select Off, Master, or Slave
W EDMAC Address Enter a value from 0 to 9999
Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Modem
submenu.
E39
Open the Network submenu from the Home menu. This submenu contains the following
options:
Hot
Configuration Page Function Sect.
Key
A Ethernet Ports Configure Ethernet Ports 1 through 4 E.3.4.1
Configure Ethernet Framing, IP addresses, QoS, Working
B LAN IP E.3.4.2
Mode, Packet Processor parameters
C LAN ARP Configure LAN ARP operation and table entries E.3.4.3
D VLAN Configure VLAN operation and table entries E.3.4.4
Enter static routes into the IP Packet Processor to route IP
E Routes E.3.4.5
traffic over the satellite or to another device on the local LAN
Configure Header and Payload Compression and Encryption
F Managed Switch E.3.4.6
operations
Configure use of IGMP (Internet Group Management Protocol)
G IGMP E.3.4.7
with configured multicast routes
Configure use of DNS (Domain Name System) caching
H DNS E.3.4.8
function
Configure use of DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration
I DHCP E.3.4.9
Protocol) Relay function
Configure use and review status of PTP (Precision Time
J PTP E.3.4.10
Protocol) feature
Configure use of SNTP (Simple Network Time Protocol)
K SNTP E.3.4.11
feature, set RTC (Real Time Clock) time and date
View the MAC Addresses that the modem has discovered on
L MAC Table E.3.4.12
one or more of its Ethernet switch ports
Press a hot key to access a configuration page. See the specified appendix section for further
configuration options. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Home menu.
E40
Open the scrollable Ethernet Ports page from the Network submenu. This page lists the current
configuration settings for Ethernet Ports 1 through 4.
Use the arrow keys to select <Ethernet Port 1>, <Ethernet Port 2>, <Ethernet Port 3>, or
<Ethernet Port 4>, and then press [ENTER] to continue.
E41
E.3.4.1.1 Home > Network > Ethernet Ports > Ethernet Port #
Open the nested Ethernet Port 1 through Ethernet Port 4 pages from the scrollable Home >
Network> Ethernet Ports page. Each page contains the following options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
Use the arrow keys to select:
A Ethernet Ports Speed Auto Full 100 Mbps Half 100 Mbps
Full 10 Mbps Half 10 Mbps
B Ethernet Ports Pause Flow Control Use the arrow keys to select Off or On
C Ethernet Port Mode Use the arrow keys to select Trunk or Access
D Ethernet PVID Enter a value from 1 to 4095
E Ethernet Port Priority Enter a priority value from 1 to 4
Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Ethernet Ports
page.
E42
Open the LAN IP page from the Network submenu. This page contains the following options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A 2048-byte Ethernet Frames Use the arrow keys to select Disabled or Enabled
B Default Gateway Typical for either entry Enter an IP address in the form
C IP Address XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX
Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Network
submenu.
E43
Open the LAN ARP page from the Network submenu. This page contains the following options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A ARP Table Use the arrow keys to select a table see Sect. E.3.4.3.1.
B Flush Dynamic ARP Entries Use the arrow keys to select Cancel or Flush
Press a hot key to view the ARP Table or open the dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to
return to the Network submenu.
E44
E.3.4.3.1 Home > Network > LAN ARP > Arp Table > Arp Entry #
Open the ARP Table from the nested ARP submenu. Use the arrow keys to scroll through
the available entries. You may also select a header (e.g., <ARP Entry 1>) and press [ENTER] to
view, in a standalone window, a specific ARP Entry page as shown in this example:
This window displays the ARP Type for the specific ARP Entry #. It contains the following options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A ARP IP Address Enter an IP Address in the form XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX
Enter a MAC Address in the form of this example:
B ARP MAC Address
90:e2:ba:2b:a6:bb
Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] twice to return to the Network
submenu.
E45
Open the VLAN submenu from the Network submenu. This submenu contains the following
options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A VLAN Table Use the arrow keys to select a table see Sect. E.3.4.4.1
B VLAN Mode Enable Use the arrow keys to select Disabled or Enabled
C Ethernet Management PVID Enter a value from 1 to 4095
Press a hot key to open the VLAN Table or a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to
the Network submenu.
E46
E.3.4.4.1 Home > Network > VLAN > VLAN Table > VLAN #
Open the VLAN Table from the nested VLAN submenu. Use the arrow keys to scroll through
the available entries. You may also select a header (e.g., <VLAN 1>) and press [ENTER] to view,
in a standalone window, a specific VLAN page as shown in this example:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A VLAN Entry VID Enter a value from 1 to 4095
B VLAN Entry Port1 Property
C VLAN Entry Port2 Property Typical for each entry Use the arrow keys to select Tagged,
D VLAN Entry Port3 Property Filtered, or Untagged
Typical for any accessed VLAN table, press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press
[ESC] twice to return to the Network submenu.
E47
Open the Routes page from the Network submenu. This page contains the following options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Route Table Use the arrow keys to select an index see Sect. E.3.4.5.1
B Delete All Route Entries Use the arrow keys to select No or Yes
Press a hot key to open the Route Table or the dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return
to the Network submenu.
E48
Open the Route Table from the nested Routes submenu. Use the arrow keys to scroll
through the available entries. You may also select a header (e.g., <Index 1>) and press [ENTER]
to view, in a standalone window, a specific Route Index page as shown in this example:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Route Description Enter a description here
B Route Destination Address/Mask Enter an IP Address/Range in the form XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX/XX
C Route Interface Use the arrow keys to select LAN or WAN
D Route LAN Next Hop Address Enter an IP Address in the form XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX
E Route Header Compression
Typical for each entry Use the arrow keys to select Disable
F Route Payload Compression
or Enable
G Route Encryption
Use the arrow keys to select Key 1 through Key 8, or
H Route Encryption Key
Random
Typical for any accessed Index # page, press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press
[ESC] twice to return to the Network submenu.
E49
Open the Managed Switch page from the Network submenu. This page contains the following
options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
Use the arrow keys to select Disable, Layer 2 Only, or Layer
A Header Compression
2 And 3
B Payload Compression Typical for either entry Use the arrow keys to select Disable
C Encryption Feature or Enable
Use the arrow keys to select Key 1 through Key 8, or
D Encryption Key Select
Random
Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Network
submenu.
E50
E.3.4.7 Home > Network > IGMP (Internet Group Management Protocol)
Open the IGMP page from the Network submenu. This page contains the following options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
Lists the IGMP Groups that are active on the modem. If none
A IGMP Joined Groups
exist, this window displays the message <No IGMP Groups>
Lists the Multicast Routes that are active on the modem. If none
B Multicast Traffic exist, this window displays the message <No IGMP Multicast
Entries>
C IGMP Version Use arrow keys to select IGMPv1, IGMPv2, or IGMPv3
D IGMP Last Member Query Interval Enter a value from 1 to 25 seconds
E IGMP Query Interval Enter a value from 1 to 18000 seconds
F IGMP Query Response Interval Enter a value from 1 to 25 seconds
Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Network
submenu.
E51
Open the DNS Caching page from the Network submenu. This page contains the following
options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A DNS Caching Feature Use the arrow keys to select Disable or Enable
B DNS Caching Flush Use the arrow keys to select Cancel or Flush
Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Network
submenu.
E.3.4.9 Home > Network > DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol)
Open the DHCP Relay page from the Network submenu. This page contains the following
options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A DHCP Relay Feature Use the arrow keys to select Disable or Enable
B DHCP Relay IP Address Enter an IP Address in the form XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX
Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Network
submenu.
E52
Open the PTP (Precision Time Protocol) page from the Network submenu. This page contains the
following options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A PTP Feature Use the arrow keys to select Disable or Enable
B PTP Grandmaster Use the arrow keys to select LAN or WAN
Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Network
submenu.
E53
E.3.4.11 Home > Network > SNTP (Simple Network Time Protocol)
Open the Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) page from the Network submenu. This page
contains the following options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A SNTP Enable Use the arrow keys to select Disabled or Enabled
B SNTP Primary Server Typical for either entry Enter an IP Address in the form
C SNTP Backup Server XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX
[R/O] SNTP Primary Last Update These read-only entries display the date/timestamp of the last
updates otherwise, if no updates have occurred, entries will
[R/O] SNTP Backup Last Update read Never
D RTC Time Enter a time in the form HH:MM:SS
E RTC Date Enter a date in the form DD:MM:YY
Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Network
submenu.
E54
Open the MAC Table page from the Network submenu. Use this page to review status
information on the recognized MAC Addresses.
Use the arrow keys to scroll through the available indices. You may also press [ENTER] to
select, and then view in a standalone window, a specific Index entry. Otherwise, press [ESC] to
return to the Network submenu.
E55
Open the WAN submenu from the Home menu. This submenu contains the following options:
Hot
Configuration Page Function Sect.
Key
A QoS Configure Quality of Service operation E.3.5.1
B Compression Configure Router Mode compression refresh rates E.3.5.2
Configure Managed Switch Mode Encryption and define
C Encryption E.3.5.3
Encryption Keys 1 through 8
Press a hot key to access a configuration page. See the specified appendix section for further
configuration options. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Home menu.
Open the QoS (Quality of Service) submenu from the WAN submenu. This submenu contains the
following options:
Hot
Page / Dialog Window Description / Option Entry
Key
A QoS Max-Pri and Min-Max Table See Sect. E.3.5.1.1
B QoS Differentiated Services Table See Sect. E.3.5.1.2
C QoS SAR Feature Use the arrow keys to select Disable or Enable
D QoS Rules Delete All Use the arrow keys to select No or Yes
Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Network
submenu.
E56
E.3.5.1.1 Home > WAN > QoS > Max-Pri and Min-Max Table
Open the scrollable QoS Table (Max-Pri and Min-Max Table) from the QoS submenu.
Use the arrow keys to scroll through the available entries. You may also select a header
(e.g., <Index 1>) and press [ENTER] to view, in a standalone window, a specific set of statistics as
shown in this example:
E57
E.3.5.1.2 Home > WAN > QoS > QoS Differentiated Services Table
Open the nested QoS Differentiated Services page from the QoS submenu. This page contains
the following options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A AF4 Service Rate
D AF3 Service Rate
Typical for each entry Enter a value from 0 to 100000000 Kbps
G AF2 Service Rate
J AF1 Service Rate
B AF4 Medium Drop Precedence Level
E AF3 Medium Drop Precedence Level
Typical for each entry Enter a value from 20 to 90%
H AF2 Medium Drop Precedence Level
K AF1 Medium Drop Precedence Level
C AF4 High Drop Precedence Level
F AF3 High Drop Precedence Level
Typical for each entry Enter a value from 10 to 80%
I AF2 High Drop Precedence Level
L AF1 High Drop Precedence Level
Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the QoS submenu.
E58
Open the Compression page from the WAN submenu. This page contains the following options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Header Comp RTP Refresh Rate
B Header Comp UTD Refresh Rate Typical for each entry Enter a value from 1 to 600
C Header Comp Default Refresh Rate
D Payload Comp Refresh Rate Enter a value from 1 to 255
Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the WAN submenu.
E59
Open the Encryption page from the WAN submenu. This page contains the following options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Allow Unencrypted Rx Use the arrow keys to select Drop or Allow
C Encryption Key Select Use the arrow keys to select Key1 through Key8, or Random
D Encryption Key 1
E Encryption Key 2
Typical for each key entry Enter a 32-character encryption code
F Encryption Key 3
G Encryption Key 4
E60
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
H Encryption Key 5
I Encryption Key 6
Typical for each key entry Enter a 32-character encryption code
J Encryption Key 7
K Encryption Key 8
L Decryption Key 1
M Decryption Key 2 Typical for each key entry Enter a 32-character decryption code
N Decryption Key 3
Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the WAN submenu.
E61
E62
Open the Redundancy submenu from the Home menu. This submenu additionally displays the
status of the redundant modem setup. The redundant modem operation options are as follows:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Traffic IP Address Enter an IP address in the form XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX
B Traffic IP Network Prefix Enter a value from 8 to 30
C Redundancy 1-for-N Mode Typical for either entry Use the arrow keys to select
D Packet Processor Redundancy Disabled or Enabled
E Force Redundant Switch Use the arrow keys to select No Switch or Force Switch
Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Home
submenu.
E63
Open the General Information submenu from the Home menu. This submenu contains the
following options:
Hot
Information Page Sect.
Key
A Modem Status E.3.8.1
B Modem Information E.3.8.2
C MAC Table E.3.8.3
D Block Upconverter (BUC) E.3.8.4
E Low Noise Block Downconverter (LNB) E.3.8.5
Press a hot key to access a read-only (except where noted) information page. See the specified
appendix section for further information. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Home menu.
E64
E65
Open the Modem Information page from the General Information submenu. This page contains
the following option:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Circuit ID Enter an identifying label for the modem
Press the hot key to open the dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the General
Information submenu.
E66
E67
E.3.8.5 Home > General Information > Low Noise Block Downconverter
(LNB)
E68
Open the Logs submenu from the Home menu. This submenu contains the following options:
Hot
Dialog Window Sect.
Key
A Base Modem E.3.9.1
B Packet Processor E.3.9.2
Press a hot key to access a submenu. See the specified appendix section for further information.
Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Home menu.
E69
Open the Base Modem page from the Logs submenu. This page contains the following options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Stored Event Table See Sect. E.3.9.1.1
B Stored Statistic Table See Sect. E.3.9.1.2
C Clear All Stored Events Typical for either entry Use the arrow keys to select
D Clear All Stored Statistics Cancel or Clear
E70
E.3.9.1.1 Home > Logs > Base Modem > Stored Event Table
Open the scrollable Stored Event Table from the Base Modem page. Use the arrow keys to
scroll through the available entries. A date, time, and description is provided for each event.
Events are numbered in the order logged, from the time the event logging buffer was last
cleared.
Press [ESC] to return to the Base Modem page. Or, you may press [ENTER] to select, and then
view in a standalone window, a specific stored event as shown in this example:
E71
E.3.9.1.2 Home > Logs > Base Modem > Stored Statistic Table
Open the scrollable Stored Statistic Table from the Base Modem page. Use the arrow keys
to scroll through the available entries. A date, time, and description is provided for each
statistic. Statistics are numbered in the order logged, from the time the statistics logging buffer
was last cleared.
Press [ESC] to return to the Base Modem page. Or, you may press [ENTER] to select and view in
a standalone window, a specific stored statistic as shown in this example:
E72
Open the Packet Processor page from the Logs submenu. This page contains the following
options:
Hot
Page / Dialog Window Description / Option Entry
Key
A Stored Event Table See Sect. E.3.9.2.1
B Logging Use the arrow keys to select Enable or Disable
Use the arrow keys to select Errors Only, Errors And
C Logging Level
Warnings, or All Information
D Clear Event Log Use the arrow keys to select Cancel or Clear
Press a hot key to open a dialog window. See the specified appendix section for further
information. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Logs submenu.
E73
E.3.9.2.1 Home > Logs > Packet Processor > Stored Event Table
Open the scrollable Stored Event Table from the Packet Processor page. Use the arrow keys
to scroll through the available entries. You may also select a header (e.g., <Event 1>) and press
[ENTER] to select, and then view in a standalone window, a specific stored event as shown in
this example:
A date, time, and description is provided for each event. Events are numbered in the order
logged, from the time the event logging buffer was last cleared.
E74
Hot
Page Description Sect.
Key
Access pages to review Ethernet Ports 1 through 4 Rx, Tx,
A Ethernet E.3.10.1
and Error Statistics
B Router Review received, routed, transmitted, and errored packets E.3.10.2
Review Managed Switch LAN/WAN/Management received,
C Managed Switch E.3.10.3
transmitted, and errored packets statistics
Review Router Mode WAN/Interface/Satellite received,
D WAN (Router Mode) E.3.10.4
transmitted, and errored packets and counters statistics
Review Managed Switch Mode WAN/Interface/Satellite
E WAN (Managed Switch Mode) received, transmitted, and errored packets and counters E.3.10.5
statistics
F Compression Review payload and header compression statistics E.3.10.6
G QoS Review Quality of Service statistics E.3.10.7
H PTP Access pages to review LAN/WAN/PTP Engine statistics E.3.10.8
I CPU Review CPU total, kernel and apps usage statistics E.3.10.9
J Reset Counters Clear and reset all counters E.3.10.10
Press a hot key to access a nested statistics page submenu. See the specified appendix section
for further information. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Home menu.
E75
Hot
Page / Dialog Window Description / Option Entry
Key
A Rx Statistics See Sect. E.3.10.1.1
B Tx Statistics See Sect. E.3.10.1.2
C Error Statistics See Sect. E.3.10.1.2
D Clear IP Statistics Use the arrow keys to select Cancel or Clear
Press a hot key to open a statistics page or dialog window. See the specified appendix section
for further information. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the nested Ethernet submenu.
E76
Open the scrollable Rx statistics page from the nested Ethernet submenu. Use the arrow
keys to scroll through the available entries. You may also select a header (e.g., <Port 1>) and
press [ENTER] to view, in a standalone window, a specific set of statistics as shown in this
example:
E77
Open the scrollable Tx statistics page from the nested Ethernet submenu. Use the arrow
keys to scroll through the available entries. You may also select a header (e.g., <Port 1>) and
press [ENTER] to view, in a standalone window, a specific set of statistics as shown in this
example:
E78
Open the scrollable Error statistics page from the nested Ethernet submenu. Use the arrow
keys to scroll through the available entries. You may also select a header (e.g., <Port 1>) and
press [ENTER] to view, in a standalone window, a specific set of statistics as shown in this
example:
E79
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Router Clear Stats Use the arrow keys to select Cancel or Clear
Press the hot key to open the dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Statistics
submenu.
E80
Open the Managed Switch statistics page from the Statistics submenu:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Router Clear Stats Use the arrow keys to select Cancel or Clear
Press the hot key to open the dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Statistics
submenu.
E81
Open the scrollable WAN (Router Mode) statistics page from the Statistics submenu. Otherwise,
press [ESC] to return to the Statistics submenu.
E82
Open the scrollable WAN (Managed Switch Mode) statistics page from the Statistics submenu:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Clear Stats Use the arrow keys to select Cancel or Clear
Press the hot key to open the dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Statistics
submenu.
E83
Hot
Page / Dialog Window Option Entry / Description
Key
A Compression Clear Counters Use the arrow keys to select Cancel or Clear
B View Statistics Table See Sect. E.3.10.6.1
Press a hot key to open the dialog window or view the statistics table. Otherwise, press [ESC] to
return to the Statistics submenu.
E84
Open the scrollable Compression statistics table from the nested Compression submenu.
Use the arrow keys to scroll through the available entries. You may also select a header
(e.g., <Route Index 1>) and press [ENTER] to view, in a standalone window, a specific set of
statistics as shown in this example:
E85
Hot
Page / Dialog Window Option Entry / Description
Key
A QoS Clear Counters Use the arrow keys to select Cancel or Clear
B View Statistics Table See Sect. E.3.10.7.1
Press a hot key to open the dialog window or view the table. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to
the Statistics submenu.
Open the scrollable QoS statistics table from the nested QoS submenu.
Use the arrow keys to scroll through the available entries. You may also select a header
(e.g., <QoS Index 1>) and press [ENTER] to view, in a standalone window, a specific set of
statistics as shown in this example:
E86
Hot
Page Description
Key
A LAN Details See Sect. E.3.10.8.1
B WAN Details See Sect. E.3.10.8.2
Press a hot key to view a statistics page. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Statistics
submenu.
E87
Open the LAN Details statistics page from the PTP page. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the
PTP page.
Open the WAN Details statistics page from the PTP page. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the
PTP page.
E88
Open the CPU statistics page from the Statistics submenu. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to
the Statistics submenu.
Open the Clear All Counters page from the Statistics submenu:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Clear All Counters Use the arrow keys to select Cancel or Clear
Press the hot key to open the dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Statistics
submenu.
E89
Open the read-only Contact information page from the Home menu. Use this page to retrieve
Comtech EF Data contact information. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Home menu.
E90
F.1 Introduction
The CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem permits configuration, monitoring, and control of
Comtech EF Data ODUs (Outdoor Units) either in standalone or 1:1 redundant configuration.
Under L-Band operation, ODU refers to use of a Comtech EF Data LPOD Outdoor Amplifier /
Block Up Converter (BUC), or an LNB (Low-Noise Block Down Converter).
For either 70/140 MHz or L-Band operation, you can fully monitor and control ODU operations
in the following ways:
By using the CDM-625 front panel keypad and VFD. The Front Panel ODU menu branch
allows you to configure power supplies, a 10 MHz reference, and low/high current alarm
thresholds for the BUC and LNB.
LO (Local Oscillator) menus allow you to set up the upconversion and downconversion
settings for the BUC and LNB so that you can view the satellite frequencies as well as the
modem IF input/output frequencies.
By using the SNMP Interface with the CSAT-5060 or KST-2000A/B Transceiver MIB.
F1
By using the CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface (excluding the LPOD).
By using the CDM-625 Telnet Command Line Interface for CSAT-5060 Transceiver
operation (excluding the KST-2000A/B Transceiver or the LPOD).
o Use the Modems RC Address + 1 for a Standalone Unit or the Online Unit in a 1:1
Redundancy System;
o Use the Modems RC Address + 2 for the Offline Unit in a 1:1 Redundancy System.
o Use the EDMAC Slave Address (ESA) Range +4 for Standalone Unit or the Online Unit
in a 1:1 Redundancy System;
o Use the EDMAC Slave Address (ESA) Range +5 for the Offline Unit in a 1:1
Redundancy System.
F2
2. This appendix deals strictly with ODU operations. Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL
OPERATION provides detailed information for any CDM-625 menu operations
or selections not otherwise specified here.
See
Feature Description Function Chapter
Section...
1 LED Indicators The LEDs indicate, in a summary fashion, the status of the modem. 5.1.1
The k eypad c omprises s ix i ndividual k eyswitches. T he k eys ha ve a
2 Keypad positive click action that provides tactile feedback. Enter data via the 5.1.2
keypad. Data, prompts, and messages are displayed on the VFD.
The V FD is an ac tive di splay s howing t wo l ines of 40 c haracters
Vacuum
each. I t pr oduces a bl ue l ight with adj ustable br ightness. N ested
3 Fluorescent 5.1.3
menus display al l av ailable opt ions and pr ompt you to c arry ou t a
Display (VFD)
required action.
F3
Figure F-2.CDM-625 Front Panel ODU Operation Menu Tree (FW Ver. 2.3.1)
F4
Press ENTER or CLEAR to immediately access the SELECT: menu screen from the opening screen.
From any nested menu, press CLEAR repeatedly until this screen reappears.
The table that follows identifies each menu branch available from the SELECT: menu and its
content section in Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL OPERATION. ODU M&C is available for selection as
noted:
Menu Branch Chapter 5 Sect. Function
Configuration 5.2.1 Use to fully configure the modem and the ODU alarm masks.
The Tx, Rx, and Mask submenus incorporate ODU functionality. For
detailed information see the following sections in this appendix:
Test 5.2.2 Use to configure the modem into one of several Test modes, and
configures/monitors the BER Tester.
Monitor 5.2.3 Use to monitor the current status of the modem and ODUs and view
the log of stored events for the modem.
Info 5.2.4 (Information) Use to view information on the modem without having to
access the Configuration screens.
Utility 5.2.6 Use to perform miscellaneous functions e.g., setting the Real-Time Clock,
adjusting the VFD brightness, etc.
ODU 5.2.7 (Summary) (Outdoor Unit) For detailed information, see Sect. F.3.3.3 (SELECT:
ODU) Menu Branches in this appendix.
FAST 5.2.8 (Fully Accessible System Topology) Use to configure available options
e.g., extended data rates, interfaces, etc. Contact a Comtech EF Data sales
representative for details.
From the top SELECT: menu, use the arrow keys to select Configuration or ODU, and then
press ENTER.
F5
Use the arrow keys to select Tx, Rx, or Mask, and then press ENTER.
When you use the ODU menus to configure a BUC or LNB LO-frequency, the CONFIG: TxFreq
and CONFIG: RxFreq menu screens provide supplemental information on the bottom line. As
you edit the IF frequency, the Satellite frequency updates accordingly.
To edit the Tx-IF or Rx Frequency, use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit, and then use
the arrow keys to change that digit. The available ranges are 50-180 MHz, and 950-2000
MHz (L-Band) (FAST option). The resolution is 100Hz. Press ENTER when done.
Use the arrow keys to select BUC or LNB, and then press ENTER.
F6
When using L-Band, a Block Up Converter (BUC) may be included in the system. A smart BUC
may be monitored and/or controlled via the modem via FSK (Frequency-Shift Keying control).
For a modem in a 1:1 redundancy setup, the fault indications must be customized for
the physical setup:
2. The more common redundancy setup is Two modems in parallel, one BUC If a
fault occurs on the active modem, switchover is desired. But, if a fault occurs on
the BUC yet a switchover of modems does not fix the problem, then switchover
should not occur and the BUC mask should be configured as Attach to Tx alarm
= No.
If the system has no redundancy and was attached to an external audio alarm,
Attach to Tx alarm = Yes would indicate that a BUC fault has occurred, as the
fault would be included in the FORM C alarms.
First, use the arrow keys to select BUC Alarm or Attach to Tx alarm. Then:
For BUC Alarm, use the arrow keys to select Active or Masked.
For Attach to Tx alarm, use the arrow keys to select Yes or No.
F7
When using L-Band, a Low-Noise Block Down Converter (LNB) may be included in the system. It
cannot be monitored and/or controlled by the modem, except for the power supply values.
For a modem in a 1:1 redundancy setup, the fault indications must be customized for
the physical setup:
1. Two modems, two LNBs in parallel If a fault occurs on the active modem/LNB
pair and switchover is desired, the LNB mask should be configured as Attach to
Rx alarm = Yes.
2. The more common redundancy setup is Two modems in parallel, one LNB If a
fault occurs on the active modem, switchover is desired. But, if a fault occurs on
the LNB, a switchover of modems might or might not fix the problem. If
switchover should take place, the LNB mask should configured as Attach to Rx
alarm = Yes.
If the system has no redundancy and was attached to an external audio alarm,
Attach to Rx alarm = Yes would indicate that a LNB fault has occurred, as the
fault would be included in the FORM C alarms.
First, use the arrow keys to select LNB Alarm or Attach to Rx alarm. Then:
For LNB Alarm, use the arrow keys to select Active or Masked.
For Attach to Rx alarm, use the arrow keys to select Yes or No.
F8
Live BUC=None
Alarms LNB=None ()
Six alarm types are provided across two screens. The last two alarm types (on the second
screen) pertain to ODU operation as shown in the preceding examples.
Use the arrow keys to navigate between these read-only pages. The highest priority alarms
currently active for each of the ODU alarm types are as follows:
ALARM TYPE
BUC BUC current
BUC voltage
BUC PLL
BUC temperature
LNB LNB current
LNB voltage
F9
ODU: BUC:PwrSupply+Ref
LNB:PwrSupply+Ref FSK-control ()
The modem provides DC power and a 10MHz reference that may be used by a BUC. Use the
arrow keys to select PSU-and-10MHz, LO-Freq, or PSUmonitor, and then press ENTER.
Use the arrow keys to select BUC Supply, 10MHz-ref, or Alarm Limits, and then use the
arrow keys to select a setting:
Selection Setting
Use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit, and then use the arrow keys to
Alarm Limits
change that digit. Valid range, in Amps, is 0.0 to 4.0.
Press ENTER when done.
F10
Use the arrow keys to select BUC-LO (Local Oscillator) Frequency for the upconversion, or
Mix to set the polarity for the upconversion mix in the BUC.
On the top line To set the BUC-LO Frequency, use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit,
and then use the arrow keys to change that digit. The valid LO range is 3000 to 65000 MHz.
Entering a non-zero value for BUC LO causes the Tx-IF frequency menu to show LO and Satellite
frequencies (satellite frequency = LO frequency modem frequency).
On the bottom line To set the Mix polarity, use the arrow keys to set polarity as Hi (to
indicate a high side, inverting mix) or Lo (to indicate a low side, non-inverting mix).
Use this read-only display to view the power supply current and voltage information. Press
ENTER or CLEAR to return to the previous menu.
F11
LNB control/monitor:
PSU-and-10MHz LO-freq PSUmonitor ()
The modem can supply DC power to an LNB connected to the Type N rear panel Rx connector.
It can also supply a 10 MHz reference for a phase-locked LNB. Use the arrow keys to select
PSU-and-10MHz, LO-freq, or PSUmonitor, and then press ENTER.
Use the arrow keys to select Voltage, 10MHz, or Alarm Limits. Then, use the arrow
keys to edit that setting:
Selection Setting
Use the arrow keys to select the LNB-LO (Local Oscillator) Frequency for the
downconversion, or Mix to set the polarity for the downconversion mix in the LNB.
On the top line To set the LNB-LO Frequency, use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit,
and then use the arrow keys to change that digit. The valid LO range is 3000 to 65000 MHz.
Entering a non-zero value for LNB LO causes the Rx-IF frequency menu to show LO and Satellite
frequencies (satellite frequency = LO frequency modem frequency).
On the bottom line To set the Mix polarity, use the arrow keys to set polarity as Hi (to
indicate a high side, inverting mix) or Lo (to indicate a low side, non-inverting mix).
F12
This read-only display shows the LNB power supply information. Press ENTER or CLEAR to return
to the previous menu.
o Use the Modems RC Address + 1 for a Standalone Unit or the Online Unit in a 1:1
Redundancy System;
o Use the Modems RC Address + 2 for the Offline Unit in a 1:1 Redundancy System.
o Use the EDMAC Slave Address (ESA) Range +4 for Standalone Unit or the Online Unit
in a 1:1 Redundancy System;
o Use the EDMAC Slave Address (ESA) Range +5 for the Offline Unit in a 1:1
Redundancy System.
The appearance of the ODU: FSK-control screen adjusts automatically to the mode of operation:
70/140 MHz or L-Band.
When the Tx frequency is 70/140 MHz Communication with a Comtech EF Data CSAT or KST
transceiver is achieved using a low-speed, half-duplex FSK link over the Rx IF port, with a carrier
frequency around 2.7 MHz.
With FSK communication disabled, the ODU: FSK-control screen appears as shown here:
F13
To enable FSK, on the top line use the arrow keys to select FSK, and then use the
arrow keys to set control as On.
Once FSK is enabled, the modem attempts to communicate with the installed transceiver(s).
Once communications are established, the bottom line of the ODU: FSK-control screen updates
to show the attached and therefore controllable via FSK transceiver(s), as per the following
examples:
At this time, use the arrow keys to navigate to the bottom line, and then use the
arrow keys to select (where appropriate), CSAT, 2CSATs, or KST.
When the Tx frequency is L-Band Communication with a smart BUC is achieved using a low-
speed, half-duplex FSK link over the Tx IF port, with a carrier frequency around 650 kHz.
With FSK communication disabled, the ODU: FSK-control screen appears as shown here:
Use the arrow keys to select FSK control, and then use the arrow keys to set control as
On, and then press ENTER. Once FSK is On, the ODU type is fixed as BUC and the screen
appears as shown here:
F14
The CSAT menus that follow assume that you have already selected, and the
system has identified, a (standalone) CSAT connected via the rear panel Rx IF port.
CSAT-5060/050 V1.02
Configuration Monitor Alarms Info()
For clarity, this common submenu branch and its nested menus are defined in this
section. (CSAT#X denotes CSAT#1 or CSAT#2.)
Use the arrow keys to select Configuration, Monitor, Alarms, or Info, and then press
ENTER.
Configuration settings:
Tx Rx LNA Misc ()
Use the arrow keys to select Tx, Rx, LNA, or Misc, and then press ENTER.
Use the arrow keys to select the setting to edit, and then use the arrow keys to edit
that setting:
Selection Setting
F15
Selection Setting
Press ENTER to save, or CLEAR to cancel and return to the previous menu.
Use the arrow keys to select the setting to edit, and then use the arrow keys to edit
that setting:
Selection Setting
Use the arrow keys to select the setting to edit, and then use the arrow keys to edit
that setting:
Selection Setting
(LNA State) Off or On. This controls whether or not the CSAT provides LNA
State
Power via the Receive RF Cable.
Select YES and press ENTER to calibrate the LNA current for use with the
Calibrate-LNA-Current
Current-Window function. (Default is NO.)
A value from 20% to 50% defines the allowable LNA Current change before
Current-Window:
declaring a fault. Select 99% to disable the Current Window function.
F16
Selection Setting
Use the arrow keys to select the setting to edit, and then use the arrow keys to edit
that setting:
Selection Setting
Cold-Start If enabled, when the CSAT is powered on, the IF and RF outputs remain muted for 15
minutes.
AFR (Auto Fault Recovery) This defines how a CSAT reacts to momentary fault conditions:
Off: CSAT mutes when faulted and remain muted.
On: CSAT mutes when faulted, but unmute after the fault goes away.
Xref (External R eference) The C SAT aut omatically locks t o an e xternal 5 or 10 MHz
reference independent of the state of this selection. This selection determines whether
or not the Summary Fault Relay ac tivates i f t he CSAT loses lock w ith the ex ternal
reference.
Ref-Adj Select a value for the Internal 10MHz Reference setting from 000 to 255.
NOTE: The Internal Reference is set in the factory to be very accurate with the default
setting of 087. This setting is provided to compensate for the long-term frequency drift
of the oscillator.
Sync-Clk (Default is NO.) Selecting YES and pr essing ENTER causes t he C SAT RTC ( Real-
Time Clock) to be synchronized to the Modem RTC.
F17
Monitor:
Tx Rx Misc Power-Supplies ()
To view these read-only displays, use the arrow keys to select Tx, Rx, Misc, or Power-
Supplies, and then press ENTER.
Press ENTER or CLEAR after viewing any Monitor screen to return to the previous menu.
Alarms:
Current-Alarms Stored-Alarms ()
Use the arrow keys to select Current-Alarms or Stored-Alarms, and then press ENTER.
Current Status: Tx = OK Rx = OK
Power-Supply = OK Misc = OK
F18
This screen is read-only. Press ENTER or CLEAR to return to the previous menu.
Once the events are compiled, the Stored Alarms screen appears as shown here:
Use the arrow keys to select between the log entries and the Clear-All option.
To view a log entry: With the cursor on the entry number, use the arrow keys to view
through the entries. Up to 99 entries are stored. Each entry provides the following information:
Item Comments
To clear the Stored Alarms Log, use the arrow keys to select Clear-All, and then use the
arrow keys to select Yes. Press ENTER to clear the log.
Info:
Model Tx Rx Misc LNA ()
These read-only screens provide the ODUs current configuration information without risking
inadvertent changes.
Use the arrow keys to select Model, Tx, Rx, Misc, or LNA, and then press ENTER.
F19
After viewing any CSAT/CSAT#X Info screen, press ENTER or CLEAR to return to the previous
menu.
Use this screen to view the CSAT model number, its operating firmware, and the unit serial
number.
Use this screen to view the Tx state, Frequency, Tx Attenuation, Amplifier state, Tx Mute state
and Tx Slope adjustment (value or CAL).
Use this screen to view the Rx state, Rx Frequency, Rx Attenuation, Rx Reference, Rx Mute state
and Rx Slope adjustment (value or CAL).
Info: Cold-Start:Off
Auto-Fault-Recovery:Summary (EC)
Use this screen to view the Cold Start and Auto Fault Recovery settings.
Use this screen to view the Low Noise Amplifier operational settings.
F20
The menus that follow assume that you have selected and the system has identified
two CSATs connected via the Rx IF port and the ODU Redundancy Controller Box.
Use the arrow keys to select CSAT#1, CSAT#2, or Redundancy-Box, and then press ENTER.
CSAT-5060/050 V1.02
Configuration Monitor Alarms Info ()
Use the arrow keys to select Configuration, Monitor, Alarms, or Info, and then press
ENTER.
Sect. F.3.3.3.3.1 ODU: FSK-control CSAT for complete information for these
nested menu choices.
This menu provides operating mode and switchover controls. You may also view the following
read-only information here:
Redundancy Controller Box 5V and 12V values (to aid trouble-shooting system
problems).
F21
To set Operating Mode, use the arrow keys to select Mode, and then use the arrow
keys to select this mode as Auto or Manual:
AUTO mode When the Online ODU faults, the switchover is done automatically to
replace the faulty unit.
To force a switchover to the other CSAT unit, use the arrow keys to select Switch: N, and
then use the arrow keys to select Y (Yes). Press ENTER when done.
F22
KST Select:
Configuration Information Alarms ()
Use the arrow keys to select Configuration, Information, or Alarms, and then press ENTER.
KST Config:
Tx Rx Miscellaneous ()
Use the arrow keys to select Tx, Rx, or Miscellaneous, and then press ENTER.
Use the arrow keys to select Tx, Freq, Att, or AGC, and then use the arrow keys to edit
that setting. Press ENTER when done.
HPA:Off Fault-Logic=Summary
LNA:OFF Fault-Logic=Summary Cal:No
Use the arrow keys to select HPA, (HPA) Fault-Logic-Summary, LNA, (LNA) Fault-Logic-
Summary, or Cal, and then use the arrow keys to edit that setting:
Selection Setting
F23
Selection Setting
This controls whether or not a HPA fault is indicated on t he Fault status, and ac tivates
Fault-Logic
the Summary Fault Relay. Select Summary or No-Summary.
These read-only screens provide the ODUs current configuration information without risking
inadvertent changes.
Use the arrow keys to select Model, Tx+Rx-Param, Misc, or Numbers, and then press
ENTER.
Once any KST Info screen has been viewed, press ENTER or CLEAR to return to the previous
menu.
MODEL: KST-2000B
HPA: CEFD-SSPA
This screen displays the Tx and Rx states, Frequencies, and Attenuation, and the reference.
F24
This screen displays the HPA and LNA operational and fault logic summary settings.
Note that the Rx Band information is not shown for the KST-2000A.
Use the arrow keys to view the Up-Converter, Down-Converter and HPA assembly and
serial numbers as well as their firmware numbers/versions.
This is Summary Status information. Use the arrow keys to select Up, Ref, AGC, Power-
Supplies, Down, HPA, or LNA, and then press ENTER. A detailed status screen, similar to the
following examples, is then shown:
F25
Once any KST Alarms screen has been viewed, press ENTER or CLEAR to return to the previous
menu.
The menus that follow assume that you have selected and the system has identified a
BUC connected via the Tx IF port.
Use the arrow keys to select Configuration, Status, or Advanced-FSK, and then press ENTER.
On the top line For Tx: use the arrow keys to select Off or On.
On the bottom line For Addr: use the arrow keys to select an address from 01 to 15.
Press ENTER when done.
This screen provides read-only status information for the BUC setup. Press ENTER or CLEAR to
return to the previous menu.
Advanced FSK:
CEFD BUC Type: LPOD (LPOD,2LPODs) ()
Use the arrow keys to select LPOD or 2LPODs, and then press ENTER.
F26
This submenu and its nested menus are identical in form and function for the
following menu structures:
Use the arrow keys to select Cnfg, Monitor, Alarms, Stats, Info, or Redun, and then press
ENTER.
Configuration settings:
Amplifier LNB Mask Misc ()
Use the arrow keys to select Amplifier, LNB, Mask, or Misc, and then press ENTER.
Use the arrow keys to select the setting to edit, and then use the arrow keys to edit
that setting:
Selection Setting
(Attenuation) 0 to 20 dB, in increments of .25dB. Limit and increments are variable
Att
based upon unit Info string.
Amp (Amplifier setting) Off or On
F27
Use the arrow keys to select the setting to edit, and then use the arrow keys to edit
the setting:
Selection Setting
Src (LNB Current Source) Disabled or Enabled.
SwitchBiasTee Off (mute LNB) or Thru (unmute LNB).
(LNB Current-Window) Selecting a value from 20% to 50% defines the allowable
Window LNB Current change before declaring a fault. Selecting 99% disables the Current
Window function.
(LNB Current Window Alarm Enable ) Disable or Enable the current window
Alarm
alarm.
(Calibrate-LNB-Current ) Select Yes and press ENTER to calibrate the LNB current.
(Default is No.)
Cal
Note: LNB Current Source must be Enabled before the LNB current can be
calibrated.
First, use the arrow keys to select LFRFPower (Low Forward RF Power), ERLD (External
Reference Lock detect), FanSpd (Fan Speed), LNBCD (LNB Current Detect), or LNB22V (LNB 22V
Power Supply)
Then, for each selection, use the arrow keys to set that alarm to Fault, Alarm, or Masked.
Press ENTER when done.
Use the arrow keys to select the setting to edit, and then use the arrow keys to edit
the setting:
F28
Selection Setting
(Auto Fault Recovery) This defines how a LPOD reacts to momentary fault conditions:
AFR Disable LPOD mutes when faulted and remain muted.
Enable LPOD mutes when faulted, then unmutes once the fault goes away.
Select an Internal 10MHz Reference setting from 000 to 255.
Ref-Adjust NOTE: The Internal Reference is set in the factory to be very accurate with the default setting
of 087. This setting is provided to compensate for the long-term frequency drift of the
oscillator.
This sets the threshold for the low forward power alarm/fault. An alarm/fault is triggered if the
LowFwdPower
forward power drops below the specified value. Set this setting to 00.00 to disable the
Threshold
threshold.
Select YES and press ENTER to synchronize the LPOD RTC to the Modem RTC. (Default is
Sync-Clock
NO.)
Press ENTER when done.
To view these read-only LPOD Monitor screens, use the arrow keys to select Tx, Temp,
FETs, Misc, or Power-Supplies, and then press ENTER.
Once any of these screens are viewed, press ENTER or CLEAR to return to the previous menu.
F29
Fan1Speed=100.0% Fan2Speed=100.0%
LNB Current Draw=005.5mA
Alarms:
Current-Alarms Stored-Events ()
Use the arrow keys to select Current-Alarms or Stored-Alarms, and then press ENTER.
Use the arrow keys to view additional Current Alarm status screens. Press ENTER or CLEAR
to return to the previous menu.
F30
Once all events are compiled, the Stored-Events screen appears as shown here:
On the top line Use the arrow keys to select between log entries and the Clear-All option.
To clear the Stored -Events Log, use the arrow keys to select Clear-All, and then use the
arrow keys to select Yes. Press ENTER when done.
On the bottom line To view the Stored-Events Log: With the cursor on the entry number, use
the arrow keys to scroll through the entries. Up to 512 entries are stored.
Item Comments
Info (Information)
Entry Type Fault
Clear (fault cleared)
Entry Number 001 through 511
Description of the
Example: Info PWR ON
fault/information
Statistics:
Config Stored-Statistics ()
Use the arrow keys to select Config or Stored-Statistics, and then press ENTER.
Use the arrow keys to select Logging, Interval, Averaging, or Clear-All, and then use the
arrow keys to set that setting:
F31
Selection Setting
Logging Enabled or Disabled.
Interval The Loggi ng I nterval i s t he per iod of t ime ov er w hich per formance s tatistics ar e
measured. S et t his i nterval as 00 to di sable t he f eature ( i.e., no l ogging) or ,
otherwise, def ine t he l ogging i nterval f rom 10 through 90 minutes i n 10 -minute
increments.
Averaging Enabled or Disabled.
Clear-All When prompted, select YES.
Once the statistics are compiled, the Stored-Statistics screen displays this data as shown here:
Use the arrow keys to scroll backwards or forwards through the statistics log entries.
The top line displays:
The statistics log entry number (up to 512 entries may be stored)
Operating Temperature
Amplifier Temperature
Power
Attenuation
F32
LNB current
Info:
Model Amp LNB Mask Misc ()
These read-only screens provide you with the ODUs current configuration information without
risking inadvertent changes. Use the arrow keys to select Model, AMP, LNB, Mask, or Misc,
and then press ENTER.
For any LPOD Information screen: Once viewed, press ENTER or CLEAR to return to the previous
menu.
This screen displays the LPOD model number, the unit serial number and its operating firmware.
This screen displays the RF Amplifier state, RF Mute state, Attenuation, and AUX Mute state.
F33
This screen displays the Auto Fault Recovery state, the Internal 10MHz Reference setting, and
the Low Forward Power Threshold setting.
Use the arrow keys to select the setting to edit, and then use the arrow keys to edit
that setting:
Selection Setting
F34
The menus that follow assume that you have selected and the system has
identified two LPODs connected via the Tx IF port.
Use the arrow keys to select Online LPOD or Offline LPOD, and then press ENTER.
Use the arrow keys to select Cnfg, Monitor, Alarms, Stats, Info, or Redun, and then press
ENTER.
F35
F.4 ODU Operations via the CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface
The CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modems embedded HTTP Interface provides an
easy to use application to configure and monitor all aspects of an ODU. See
Chapter 6. ETHERNET-BASED REMOTE PRODUCT MANAGEMENT for complete
instructions on using this interface.
The Comtech EF Data LPOD Amplifier / Block Up Converter is not supported by the
CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface at this time.
A user-supplied web browser allows the full monitor and control (M&C) of an installed Comtech
EF Data CSAT-5060 or KST-2000A/B Transceiver (ODU), installed in standalone or 1:1
Redundancy configurations, from the CDM-625s Web Server Interface. This embedded web
application is designed for, and works best with, Microsofts Internet Explorer Version 7.0 or
higher.
F36
(shown in blue). Beyond this top-level row of navigation tabs, the diagram illustrates the available
primary (green) and nested (yellow) page tabs that afford you more specific functionality.
Tabs not specific to ODU operation appear dimmed and are explicitly defined in Chapter 6.
ETHERNET-BASED REMOTE PRODUCT MANAGEMENT. Click a navigation tab to continue.
Pages marked with double asterisks (**) are operable only when BUCs or LNBs
are installed.
Figure F-4. CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface Menu Tree (FW Ver. 2.3.1)
F37
BUC Configuration
BUC Power Enable, 10 MHz Ref Enable, and Output Power Enable Use the drop-down
lists to turn these functions ON or OFF.
BUC Low and High Current Limit Assign a value (in mA) ranging from 0 to 4000.
Tx LO (Low Oscillator) Frequency Assign a value (in MHz) to the Tx LO Frequency, and then
use the drop-down list to designate the value as a HIGH (+) or LOW (-) limit.
BUC Address Assign a value for the BUC Address from 1 to 15.
Click [Submit BUC Controls] to save the setting changes made in this section.
BUC Status
This section refreshes automatically every ten seconds. These status settings are read-only and
cannot be changed.
F38
LNB Control
LNB DC Power and LNB Reference Enable Use the drop-down lists to turn either function
ON or OFF.
LNB Low and High Current Threshold Assign a value (in mA) ranging from 0 to 500 for
either function.
Rx LO (Low Oscillator) Frequency Assign a value (in MHz) to the Rx LO Frequency, and
then use the drop-down list to designate the value as a HIGH (+) or LOW (-) limit.
F39
Events Log
Unread Events Displays the total number of unread stored events in the scrollable events
window. As you display stored event groups, this number decrements accordingly.
Read Next Five Events Click to buffer the next group of five stored events into the
scrollable events window.
Clear Events Log Click to wipe clean the stored events log.
F40
Statistics Log
Read Next Five Statistics Click to buffer the next group of five stored events into the
scrollable statistics window.
Clear Statistics Log Click to wipe clean the stored statistics log.
Unread Statistics Displays the total number of unread stored statistics in the scrollable
statistics window. As stored statistics are displayed, this number decrements accordingly.
Alarm Mask
Use the available option buttons to define a designated BUC or LNB alarm as Masked or Active,
and then click [Submit Alarm Mask] to save these changes.
F41
When configuring the CDM-625 for 70/140 MHz operation, use the ODU (Outdoor Unit) pages
to control and monitor the CSAT-5060 or KST-2000A/B Outdoor Unit that is connected via FSK
to the CDM-625.
ODU Comms must be Enabled, and the CDM-625 must be configured for 70/140
MHz operation, in order to fully access the ODU | Config, ODU | Status, and
ODU | Utilities pages.
If the CDM-625 is otherwise configured for L-Band operation and selection of the
ODU | Config, ODU | Status, and ODU | Utilities pages is attempted, the
following error message displays:
When you configure the CDM-625 for L-Band operation, use the ODU | Enable page to enable
FSK operation for BUC products.
F42
ODU Comms
Use the drop-down list to select ODU operation as Disabled or Enabled, and then click [Submit].
If you encounter a communications issue e.g., an ODU is either physically not present or the
ODU Comms cable is not connected to the CDM-625 the following error page displays after
clicking [Submit]:
Take steps to troubleshoot the ODU setup before attempting to enable ODU operations from
this page. See the pertinent ODU Installation and Operation Manual for further information.
F43
F44
ODU Selection
If you use ODUs in redundancy, you may toggle this page between the Online and Offline units.
Use the drop-down list to select CSAT #1 or CSAT #2, and then click [Select ODU]. A message in
the right hand column of this section identifies which unit is ONLINE.
Up Converter Parameters
Frequency Enter a value in MHz.
Slope Adjust (Manual Mode Only) Select the desired setting from the drop-down list.
Gain Offset (1:1 Redundancy Only) Select the desired setting from the drop-down list.
Slope Adjust (Manual Mode Only) Select the desired setting from the drop-down list.
Gain Offset (1:1 Redundancy Only) Select the desired setting from the drop-down list.
Unit Parameters
Mute Mode From the drop-down list, select Muted after freq change or Unmuted after
freq change.
Auto Fault Recovery, Cold Start, and Ext Reference Fault Logic From the drop-down lists,
select Disable or Enable.
F45
LNA Parameters
Current Alarm Window Enter a value of 20-50, or 99 to disable this feature.
F46
Up Converter
Frequency Enter a value in MHz.
Down Converter
Frequency Enter a value in MHz.
Rx Band (For KST-2000B Only) From the drop-down list, select band A (10950 to 11700
MHz), band B (11700 to 12200 MHz), or band C (12250 to 12750 MHz).
HPA
HPA Power Enable From the drop-down list, select On or Off.
HPA Fault Logic From the drop-down list, select Summary or No Summary.
F47
LNA
LNA Power Enable From the drop-down list, select On or Off.
LNA Fault Logic From the drop-down list, select Summary or No Summary.
Unit
AGC (Automatic Gain Control) From the drop-down list, select On or Off.
F48
The appearance of the ODU | Status page adjusts to the type of ODU that is
configured for operation with the CDM-625.
Use this page to review read-only status windows pertaining to the current operating condition
for either the Comtech EF Data CSAT-5060 or the KST-2000A/B ODU.
ODU Selection
If you use ODUs in redundancy, you may toggle this page between the Online and Offline units.
Use the drop-down list to select CSAT #1 or CSAT #2, and then click [Select ODU]. A message
identifies the currently active unit as ONLINE in the right-hand column of this section.
F49
The remainder of this page provides configuration and operational status information (e.g., OK /
FT = Fault) for the following settings:
F50
The appearance of the ODU | Utilities page adjusts to the type of ODU that is
configured for operation with the CDM-625.
Use this page to configure various ODU utility functions for either the Comtech EF Data
CSAT-5060 or the KST-2000A/B ODU.
ODU Selection
If you use ODUs in redundancy, you may toggle this page between the Online and Offline units.
Use the drop-down list to select CSAT #1 or CSAT #2, and then click [Select ODU]. A message
identifies the currently active unit as ONLINE in the right-hand column of this section.
F51
Enter a time using HH:MM:SS format (where HH = hour [00 to 23], MM = minutes [00 to 59],
and SS = seconds [00 to 59]).
Click [Enter Date/Time] once you enter the desired date and time in this section.
Unread Events Displays the total number of unread stored events in the scrollable events
window. As stored event groups are displayed, this number decrements accordingly.
Read Next Five Events Click to buffer the next group of five stored events into the
scrollable events window.
Clear Stored Events Click to wipe clean the stored events log.
F52
The remainder of this page identifies the configured ODU chassis installed component assembly
numbers and serial numbers, and firmware numbers and versions.
F53
F.5 ODU Operations via the CDM-625 Telnet Command Line Interface (CLI)
The Telnet Command Line Interface (referred to hereafter as the Telnet CLI or the CLI) (Figure
F-15) is an Ethernet-based user menu system for the CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem
equipped with an installed and enabled optional IP Packet Processor card. The CLI facilitates
configuration, monitoring, and control of a CSAT-5060 Transceiver (ODU), installed in standalone
or 1:1 Redundancy configurations, using a user-supplied terminal emulator.
1. The CDM-625 Telnet Command Line Interface (CLI) is accessible only when the
optional IP Packet Processor is installed and enabled.
2. The CDM-625 Telnet CLI uses Telnet TCP Port 107. Be sure to specify this port
when configuring your terminal emulator for CLI operation.
3. For best results Comtech EF Data recommends PuTTY or Tera Term as the
preferred terminal emulators.
4. The Telnet CLIs Remote Access Mode must be set to [Ethernet] in order to use
the Telnet CLI for ODU operations.
F54
The Home Menu serves as the CLIs primary navigation page. Press the E hot key to access the
ODU submenus.
F55
Open the Outdoor Unit (ODU) submenu from the Home menu. This submenu contains the
following options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A ODU Comms Enabled Use the arrow keys to select Disabled or Enabled
B CSAT-5060 Open the CSAT-5060 submenu See Sect. F.5.1.2.1
Press a hot key to open the dialog window or the submenu. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to
the Home submenu.
F56
Open the nested CSAT-5060 submenu from the Outdoor Unit (ODU) submenu. This submenu
contains the following options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry Sect.
Key
A Select Use the arrow keys to select Csat1 or Csat2 N/A
B Up Converter Settings (1/2)
Configure an Up Converter F.5.1.2.1.1
C Up Converter Settings (2/2)
D Down Converter Settings (1/2)
Configure a Down Converter F.5.1.2.1.2
E Down Converter Settings (2/2)
F Unit Settings (1/2)
Configure an ODU F.5.1.2.1.3
G Unit Settings (2/2)
H LNA Settings Configure a Low Noise Amplifier F.5.1.2.1.4
I Status Review ODU Status Information F.5.1.2.1.5
J Logs Review and manage Event Logs F.5.1.2.1.6
K Redundancy Configure ODUs for 1:N Redundancy F.5.1.2.1.7
Set device time and date, review the units firmware
L Utilities F.5.1.2.1.8
version and serial number
Press a hot key to open a dialog window or configuration page. See the specified appendix
section for further configuration options. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the ODU submenu.
F57
F.5.1.2.1.1 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 > Up Converter
Settings 1/2, 2/2
After configuring the CDM-625 for L-Band operation, and when a Block Up
Converter (BUC) is installed, you may use this page to configure BUC operating
settings and to view the BUC operational status.
Open the Up Converter Settings 1/2 page or the Up Converter Settings2/2 page from the nested
CSAT-5060 submenu.
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Tx Frequency Enter a value from 5845.000 to 6725.000 MHz
B Tx Attenuation Enter a value from 0.00 to 25.00 dB
C Tx Slope Mode Use the arrow keys to select Manual or Calibrated
D Tx Slope Value Enter a value from 0.0 to 1.0 units
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Tx Mute Use the arrow keys to select Disabled or Enabled
B Tx Amplifier Use the arrow keys to select Off or On
C Tx Gain Offset Enter a value from -4.00 to 0.00 dBm
Typical for either page, press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to
return to the nested CSAT-5060 submenu.
F58
F.5.1.2.1.2 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 > Down Converter
Settings 1/2, 2/2
After configuring the CDM-625 for L-Band operation, and when a Low Noise Block
Down Converter (LNB) is installed, you may use this page to configure LNB
operating settings and to view the LNB operational status.
Open the Down Converter Settings 1/2 page or the Down Converter Settings 2/2 page from the
nested CSAT-5060 submenu.
The Down Converter Settings 1/2 page contains the following options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Rx Frequency Enter a value from 3400.000 to 4200.000 MHz
B Rx Attenuation Enter a value from 0.00 to 20.00 dB
C Rx Slope Mode Use the arrow keys to select Manual or Calibrated
D Rx Slope Value Enter a value from 0.0 to 1.0 units
The Down Converter Settings 2/2 page contains the following options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Rx Mute Use the arrow keys to select Disabled or Enabled
B Rx Gain Offset Enter a value from -4.00 to 0.00 dBm
Typical for either page, press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to
return to the nested CSAT-5060 submenu.
F59
F.5.1.2.1.3 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 > Unit Settings 1/2, 2/2
Open the Unit Settings 1/2 page or the Unit Settings 2/2 page from the nested CSAT-5060
submenu.
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
Use the arrow keys to select Unmuted After Freq Change or
A Unit Mute Mode
Muted After Freq Change
B Unit Auto Fault Recovery Use the arrow keys to select Disabled or Enabled
C Unit Cold Start Use the arrow keys to select Disabled or Enabled
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Unit Ext Ref Fault Logic Use the arrow keys to select No Summary or Summary
B Unit Ref Osc Adjust Enter a value from 0 to 255
C Circuit ID Enter an identifying label for the ODU here
Typical for either page, press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to
return to the nested CSAT-5060 submenu.
F60
F.5.1.2.1.4 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 > LNA Settings
Open the LNA Settings page from the nested CSAT-5060 submenu. This page contains the
following options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
Enter a value as follows:
A Unit LNA Current Window Range 1 20 to 50
Range 2 99 to 99
Use the arrow keys to select Disabled, Enabled, or Enabled
B Unit LNA Current Window
When Online
C Unit LNA Fault Logic Use the arrow keys to select No Summary or Summary
Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the nested CSAT-
5060 submenu.
F61
F.5.1.2.1.5 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 > Status
Open the read-only Status page from the nested CSAT-5060 submenu. This page provides the
following information:
Item Description
Online State Identifies the unit as Online or Offline
Maintenance Parameters Info needed
Unit Faults Lists the curren t number of unit faults
Lists the number of unread events that are currently stored in the Events
Number Unread Events
Log
F62
F.5.1.2.1.6 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 > Logs
Open the Logs page from the nested CSAT-5060 submenu. This page contains the following
options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Reset Event Pointer Typical for either entry Use the arrow keys to select No or
B Clear Event Log Yes
Stored Events: The page additionally provides a listing of the latest five stored events. Each
event consists of a description, its time in HHMMSS format, and the date in DDMMYY format.
Press [F5] to update this page with the next five events. Accessing event items in this manner
causes the Number U nread E vents count on the CSAT-5060 > Status page to decrement
accordingly.
F63
F.5.1.2.1.7 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 > Redundancy
Open the Redundancy page from the nested CSAT-5060 submenu. Redundant ODU
configuration options are as follows:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Unit Red Force Switch Use the arrow keys to select No or Yes
B Unit Redundancy Mode Use the arrow keys to select Manual or Auto
Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the nested CSAT-
5060 submenu.
F.5.1.2.1.8 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 > Utilities
Open the Utilities page from the nested CSAT-5060 submenu. This page contains the following
options:
Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Device Time Enter a time in the form HH:MM:SS
B Device Date Enter a date in the form DD/MM/YY
The page additionally provides the model number, software version, and unit serial number of
the recognized ODU.
Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the nested CSAT-
5060 submenu.
F64
Units of Length
1 inch 25.4 2.54 1 0.0833 0.0278 0.0254 2.54 x 10-5 1.578 x 10-5
1 mile 1.609 x 106 1.609 x 105 6.336 x 104 5280 176 0 1609 1.609 1
Temperature Conversions
Units of Weight